PUBLIC WORKS DEPARTMENT (BUILDING WING) BIDDING DOCUMENT Name of work: - “CONSTRUCTION WORK OF THE PROPOSED NEW ASSAM LEGISLATIVE ASSEMBLY BUILDING AT DISPUR WITH BUDGETARY COST ESTIMATE & REVISED DESIGN PROPOSAL (INTERIOR WORKS FOR ASSEMBLY MAIN BUILDING)” OFFICE OF THE CHIEF ENGINEER, P.W.D., BUILDING ASSAM, CHANDMARI, GUWAHATI. 2 GOVERNMENT OF ASSAM OFFICE OF THE CHIEF ENGINEER: P.W.D.: BUILDING: ASSAM: GUWAHATI-3 NATIONAL COMPETITIVE BIDDING (CIVIL WORKS) NAME OF THE WORK : “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” NODAL AUTHORITY : The Chief Engineer, PWD (B), Govt. of Assam. PERIOD OF DOWNLOAD OF BIDDING DOCUMENT. : Date31-03-2015 at 13.31 hrs to 18-04-2015 at 14.00 hrs DATE AND TIME OF PRE-BID CONFERENCE : Date: 10-04-2015 time 14:00 hrs LAST DATE AND TIME FOR RECEIPT OF BIDS : Date:18-04-2015 time 14:00 hrs DATE AND TIME OF OPENING OF TECHNICAL BIDS. : Date 20-04-2015 time 11:01 hrs to 27-04-2015 time 17:00 hrs DATE AND TIME OF OPENING OF FINANCIAL BIDS : Date 27-04-2015 time 11:01 hrs to 28-04-2015 time 17.00hrs PLACE OF OPENING BIDS : Office of the Chief Engineer, P.W.D., (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. OFFICER INVITING BIDS : Chief Engineer, P.W.D., (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. 3 INVITATION FOR BID ( IFB ) 4 GOVERNMENT OF ASSAM OFFICE OF THE CHIEF ENGINEER: : P.W.D.: : BUILDING: ASSAM : : CHANDMARI : : GUWAHATI-3 No. CS/T/BD/8/2013/46 Dated Guwahati the 17th March 2015 PRESS NOTICE The Chief Engineer, P.W.D (Building), Assam on behalf of the Governor of Assam invites bids for “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” amounting to Rs. 40,00,00,000.00 (approx) from Reputed firms experienced in execution of Interior works in Individual/Joint Venture(JV). Details of the bids may be seen at website- assam.etenders.in and also in the office of the undersigned from 30-03-2015 to 31-03-2015 during office hours. Press Notice published vide this office letter No: CS/T/BD/8/2013/28 dated 31 st October 2014 and subsequent extension Notices may be treated as canceled. Chief Engineer, P.W.D. (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3. Memo No: CS/T/BD/8/2013/ 46-A Copy to: Dated Guwahati the 17th March 2015 1.The Principal Secretary, Assam Legislative Assembly for favour of information. 2.The Commissioner & Special Secretary to the Govt. of Assam, PW (Bldg. & NH) Deptt., Dispur, Guwahati6 for favour of information. 3.The Addl. Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg) P.C.C. Project Complex Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3 for information. 4.The Addl. Chief Engineer P.W.D. (Electrical) O/o the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati3 for information. 5.The Director of Information and Public Relation, Govt. of Assam, Dispur, Guwahati-6 for information. He is requested to publish the notice in two consecutive issues of at least widely circulated English daily The Telegraph, The Assam Tribune and Assamese Daily News papers on or before 26-03-2015. Enclosed: 6 (six) spare copies. 6.The Director Printing & Stationary, Bamunimaidam, Guwahati-21, for information with 2(two) spare copies with a request to publish the notice in Assam Gazette on or before 26-03-2015. 7.The Superintending Engineer, P.W.D. Guwahati Building Circle-I, Fancy Bazar, Guwahati-1 for information and wide circulation. Enclosed: 4(Four) spare copies. 8.The Sr Architect (B/N) O/o the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 for information. 9.The Executive Engineer, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati-6, for information and wide circulation. Enclosed: 4(Four) spare copies 10.Consultant M/S Dulal Mukherjee & Associates for information and necessary action. 11.M/S Nex Tenders India Pvt. Ltd. camp Guwahati for information with a request to publish the notice in their web site. The time schedule has been fixed as discussed with the officials of Nex Tenders stationed at the CE PWD’s office premises at Guwahati. 12.Notice Board Chief Engineer, P.W.D. (Bldg.) Assam ,Chandmari, Guwahati-3. 5 Name of work: “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” Tender Schedule Seq. No. 1 PWD Stage Contractor Stage Tender Release 2 Tender Download 3 Submit Bid-Hash online and payment 4 5 Super hash Generation & Bid Lock 6 Technical Bid Opening 7 Financial Bid Opening Control transfer of bid Start Date & Time 30-03-2015 10:01 31-03-2015 13:31 31-03-2015 13:31 18-04-2015 14:01 18-04-2015 17:01 20-04-2015 11:01 27-04-2015 11:01 Expiry Date & Time 31-03-2015 13:30 18-04-2015 14:00 18-04-2015 14:00 18-04-2015 17:00 20-04-2015 11:00 27-04-2015 17:00 28-04-2015 17:00 Note: 1.The dates & time shown in above table for Technical & financial Bid opening is tentative. 2.Cost of Bid document should be drawn in favour of Assam State Road Board Maintenance (Roads) Fund; A/C No. 10566991479 is to be submitted along with the technical Bid. 3.Bid Security should be drawn in favour of the respective Executive Engineer, PWD (Building) as stated in the bid document. 4.A sum of Service fees shall be paid online to M/S Nextenders (India) Pvt. Ltd., in order to participate on Tender. However contractors can download documents free of cost. 5.Pre-bid meeting will be held at 14.00 Hrs of 10-04-2015. Venue: - O/o the Chief Engineer, PWD (Building) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3. 6.Technical bid is to be submitted manually only & financial bid is to be submitted online only. 7.Bid Security, Cost of Bid document and Supporting Documents are to be submitted together along with the technical bid before the expiry date & time of the sequence-“Submit BidHash online and payment” as given in the above tender schedule. 8.Last date and time of manual submission of Technical Bid on or before 14:00 Hrs of 18.04.2015. 9.In case of any Bandh falls in any sequence will be held in next working day. 10.Detailed NIT amount may vary from the Press Notice amount. 11.Any modification of tender may be seen in the P.W.D. portal http://assam.etenders.in. Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3 6 Conditions for E-Tendering This annexure contains instructions and rules governing e -Tendering that is now to be adopted. This is not a user guide. Please obtain a user guide from the service provider M/s Nextenders India Private Limited Name of work: “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” Tender Schedule Seq. No. 1 PWD Stage Contractor Stage Tender Release 2 Tender Download 3 Submit Bid-Hash online and payment 4 5 Super hash Generation & Bid Lock 6 Technical Bid Opening 7 Financial Bid Opening Control transfer of bid Start Date & Time 30-03-2015 10:01 31-03-2015 13:31 31-03-2015 13:31 18-04-2015 14:01 18-04-2015 17:01 20-04-2015 11:01 27-04-2015 11:01 Expiry Date & Time 31-03-2015 13:30 18-04-2015 14:00 18-04-2015 14:00 18-04-2015 17:00 20-04-2015 11:00 27-04-2015 17:00 28-04-2015 17:00 All the key dates and deadlines will be followed as per the above time schedule unless explicitly amended through a corrigendum pursuant to clause 10 of ITB. Only those clauses of ITB and Appendix to ITB are mentioned in this Annexure where the procedure differs from manual tendering. These notes must be read in conjunction with ITB. A. GENERAL B. BIDDING DOCUMENTS Additional Notes to Clause 8 of ITB The technical Bids of the bidders will be received manually. Priced Bill of Quantities Irrespective of the mode of submission selected, the following documents will have to be submitted on paper. Bid Security or EMD Documents to be furnished by the bidder in compliance to section 2 that have not been submitted online, specifically Certificates, undertakings, affidavits as specified in Section 2. Shall be prepared by the bidder and furnished in duplicate. (refer clause 12) in A-4 size paper in a bound form and 7 not in loose forms. The serial order will be maintained for the different forms as furnished in the section. Additional Notes to Clause 10 All amendments issued will be published on the website – assam.etenders.in. It is the prerogative of the contractors to visit the aforementioned site for corrigendum, addendum and amendment notices. These notices have to be read in conjunction with the tender document and have to be signed and submitted manually along with the bid. C. PREPARATION OF BIDS Additional Notes to clause 12 Mode of Bid Preparation and Documents comprising the Bid Technical Bid should be prepared as per Part-I of Clause no. 12.1 of ITB. Online Price (Financial) Bid shall not be submitted on paper. Bidders need not submit form of bid and priced bid of quantities in paper form. Even if these are submitted in paper form, the data filled up online would be considered in bid evaluation and price paper bids will not be opened. Additional Notes to clause 18 of ITB – Format and Signing of Bid All online forms to be filled up by the bidders will be hashed and digitally signed as per the procedure described in the user guide. For manual submission of Technical bid refer clause no 18 of ITB. Financial bid needs to be submitted online only. D. SUBMISSION OF BIDS Notes to Clause 19 of ITB -Sealing and Marking of Bids Refer to notes 19.1 to 19.8 mentioned hereafter. Notes 19.1 through 19.4 apply to all documents comprising the technical bid. Financial bid needs to be submitted online only. Notes 19.5 through 19.8 apply to online bid forms. 19.1The Bidder shall seal the technical bids (original & copy) in one envelope duly marking the envelope as “Technical Bid” respectively. Technical Bid: to be opened not before (date & time of Technical Bid opening) The contents of Technical Bids will be as specified in clause 12.2 of ITB and notes to Clause 12 of ITB in this appendix. 19.2The envelope containing Technical Bid shall be (a)Addressed to the Employer at the address given in Appendix to ITB (b)Bear the identification as indicated in Appendix to ITB 8 19.3In addition to the identification required in Sub-Clauses 19.1 and 19.2 of ITB, each of the envelopes shall indicate the name and address of the bidder to enable the bid to be returned unopened in case it is declared late, pursuant to Clause 21 of ITB, or the Evaluation Committee declares the bid as nonresponsive pursuant to Clause 23 of ITB. Bidders are required to mention the Company ID (obtained at the time of the ETS registration), and the Tender No (as seen on the ETS website) on the outer envelope of the bid as well as each enclosed envelope (viz., Technical, Financial, EMD and Document Fee). 19.4 19.5 If the outer envelope is not sealed and marked as above, the Employer will assume no responsibility for the misplacement or premature opening of the bid. The Bidder shall fill up all online forms following the procedure for e-tendering. 19.6 The Bidder shall generate the bid hash following the procedure of online bid preparation and digitally sign with his own digital certificate and submit the hash as per the online bidding procedure for financial bid. 19.7 The bidder shall verify the generation of the Super hash as per the time schedule in IFB. 19.8 The bidder shall decrypt the bid and submit it in an encrypted form as per the online bidding procedure. Additional Notes to Clause 20 of ITB -Deadline for Submission of the Bids Online bid forms must be filled up and bid hashes signed and submitted before the deadline specified at serial no. 5 in the tender time schedule of IFB All Documents to be submitted in paper form must be received by the Employer at the address specified in Appendix to ITB not later than the date indicated at serial no. 3 of the tender time schedule of IFB;. In the event of the specified date for the submission of bids declared a holiday for the Employer, the Bids will be received up to the appointed time on the next working day. Online bidders must decrypt and submit their re-encrypted bids before the expiry date specified at Serial No 5 of the Tender Time Schedule in IFB. Failure to submit re-encrypted bids will result in the bids being treated as cancelled bids and would entail forfeiture of the bid security. The Employer may extend the deadline for submission of the bids by issuing an amendment in accordance with clause 10 of ITB, in which case all rights and obligations of the Employer and the bidders previously subject to the original deadline will then be subject to the new deadline. Additional Notes to Clause 22 of ITB. Online bids can be modified or cancelled online before the expiry date and time specified at Serial No 3 of the Tender Time Schedule in IFB. After the deadline no modifications or withdrawals are allowed. E. BID OPENING AND EVALUATION Notes to Clause 23 of ITB - Bid Opening The Employer will open all the technical Bids received (except those received late), including modifications made pursuant to Clause 22 of ITB and serial-3 of time schedule, in the presence of the 9 Bidders or their representatives who choose to attend at time, date specified in Tender Time Schedule in IFB at the address specified in Appendix to ITB in the manner specified in Clause 20 and 23.3. In the event of the specified date of Bid opening being declared a holiday for the Employer, the Bids will be opened at the appointed time and location on the next working day. After opening the envelope containing “Technical Bid” the amount, form and validity of the bid security furnished with each bid will be announced. If the bid security furnished does not conform to the amount and validity period as specified in the Appendix to ITB, and has not been furnished in the form specified in Clause 16, the “Technical Bid” will be returned and their online financial bid with be destroyed. The “Technical Bid” of only those bidders will be entitled for financial evaluation online whose technical bids are found responsive. 1. Electronic Tender No: 887 2. Package No.: 3. Name of Work “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” 4. Value of work (in Rs.): Rs. 40, 00, 00,000.00) 5. Bid Security (in Rs): Rs. 80,00,000.00 6. Cost of Document (in Rs.): Rs. 12,500/- 7. Time of Completion: 9 (nine) months 8. Name of the officer inviting Bid: Shri.P.K.Choudhury. 9. Address for Paper Submissions and Opening: Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati 3. 10 INDEX SECTION ITEM 1) INSTRUCTION TO BIDDER 2) QUALIFICATION INFORMATION 3) CONDITIONS OF CONTGRACT (GCC & SCC) 4) CONTRACT DATA 5) TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION 6) SECURITIES AND OTHER FORMS 7) FORM OF BID 8) BILL OF QUANTITIES 9) DRAWINGS 10) DOCUMENTS TO BE FURNISHED BY THE BIDDER PAGE NO. 11 SECTION : 1 INSTRUCTION TO BIDDERS ( ITB ) 12 INSTRUCTION TO BIDDERS Table of clauses SL NO. A) PAGE NO. General 1. Scope of Bid …… 2. Source of Funds …… 3. Eligible Bidders …… 4. Qualification of the Bidder …… 5. One bid per Bidder …… 6. Cost of Bidding …… 7. Site Visit …… B) Bidding Documents 8. Contents of Bidding Documents …… 9. Clarification of Bidding Documents. …… 10 Amendments of Bidding Documents. …… C) D) ITEM Preparation of Bids 11 Language of Bid. …… 12 Documents Comprising the Bid …… 13 Bid Prices. …… 14 Currencies of Bid and Payment. …… 15 Bid Validity …… 16 Bid Security. …… 17 Alternative Proposals by Bidders …… 18 Format and Signing of Bid …… Submission of Bids 13 19 Sealing and Marking of Bids. …… 20 Deadlines for Submission of Bids. …… 21 Late Bids. …… 22 Modification and withdrawal of Bids. …… E) Bid Opening and Evaluation 23. Bid Opening. …… 24 Process to be Confidential …… 25 Clarification of Financial Bids …… 26. Examination of Bids and Determination of responsiveness. …… 27. Correction of Errors. …… 28 Deleted. …… 29. Evaluation and comparison of Financial Bids. …… 30 Deleted. …… F) Award of Contract 31. Award Criteria …… 32. Employer’s right to accept any Bid and to reject any or all bids. …… 33. Notification of Award and Signing of Agreement. …… 34. Performance Security. …… 35. Advance Payment and security. …… 36 Dispute Review Expert. …… 37. Corrupt or Fraudulent Practices. …… 14 GENERAL 1.0 Scope of Bid 1.1. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati (named in Appendix to ITB) invites bids for the work: “Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” from eligible bidders. 1.2. The successful bidder will be expected to complete the works by the intended completion date specified in the Contract data. 1.3. Throughout this bidding document, the terms `bid’ and `tender’ and their derivatives (bidder/tenderer, bid/tender, bidding/tendering, etc.) are synonymous. 2.0 Source of Funds 2.1 The expenditure on this project will be met by the Government of Assam from fund made available by the Government of India, Plan and Non-Plan Resources of the State Government. 3.0 Eligible Bidders 3.1 This Invitation for Bids is open to all bidders who meet the qualification criteria. 3.2. All bidders shall provide in Section 2, Forms of Bid and Qualification Information, a statement (unless otherwise specified) that the Bidder is neither associates, nor has been associated directly or indirectly with the Consultant or any other entity that has prepared the design, specifications and other documents for the project or propose the Consultancy as Project-incharge for the contract. A firm that has been engaged by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 to provide consultancy services for the preparation or supervision of the works, and any of its affiliates shall not be eligible to bid. 4.0 Qualification of the Bidder 4.1. All bidders shall provide in Section -2, Forms of Bid and Qualification, Information, a preliminary description of the proposed work method and schedule, including charts, PERT & CPM diagram as necessary. The proposed methodology should include programme of construction backed with equipment planning and development duly supported with broad calculations and quality assurance procedures proposed to be adopted justifying their capability of execution and completion of work as per technical specifications, within stipulated period of completion. A Quality Assurance Manual (QAM) including but not limited to policy statement, project organization (Flow Chart) Project Organisation (Duties and Responsibilities), Project Control and Administration, Document control, control of Material, Methodology of Working, Test and Inspection Plan, Calibration, Non Conformity and Corrective Actions, Quality Audits and 15 Safety should also accompany the bid. 4.2. Deleted. 4.3. All bidders shall include the following information and documents with their bids in Section 2. 4.4. i) Copies of Original documents defining the constitution or legal status, place of registration, and principal place of business; written power of attorney of the signatory of the Bid to commit the bidder; ii) Total monetary value of construction work performed during each of the last five years; iii) Experience in works of a similar nature and size of each of the last five years, and details of works underway or contractually committed; and clients who may be contacted for further information on those contracts; iv) Major items of construction equipment proposed to carry out the contract; v) Qualification and experience of key site management and technical personnel proposed for contract; vi) Reports on the financial standing of the Bidder, such as profit and loss statements and auditor’s reports for the past five years; vii) Evidence of access to line (s) of credit and availability of other financial Resources facilities (10% of Contract Value), certified by the Bankers (Not more than 1 Month old); viii) Undertaking that the bidder will be able to invest a minimum cash of 25% of contract value of work, during implementation of work; ix) Authority to seek references from the Bidder’s Bankers; x) Information regarding any litigation, current or during the last five years in which the Bidder is involved, the parties concerned, and disputed amount; xi) Proposals for sub Contracting components of the Works amounting to more than 20% of the Bid Price (for each , the qualifications and experience of the identified subcontractor in the relevant field should be annexed); and xii) The proposed methodology and programme of construction, backed with equipment planning and deployment, duly supported with broad calculations and quality control procedures proposed to be adopted, justifying their capability of execution and completion of the work as per Technical Specification within the stipulated period of completion Milestones. xiii) Details of plants for seasoning and treatment of timber articles and thin preservative treatment system equipments. Subject to fulfillment of qualifying criteria Joint Venture (JV) of contractors or consortium may also participate in the bidding. 16 GENERAL EXPERIENCE: 4.5. A. To qualify for award of the contract, each bidder in its name should have in the last five years as referred to in Appendix. (a) Achieved a minimum average financial turnover (in all classes of civil engineering construction works only) over the last five years equivalent to amount indicated in Appendix – I (not less than 40% of the value of contract applied for) (b) The bidder must be a profit making one for the last five years. (c) Satisfactorily completed 90% of contract value, as a prime contractor (or as a nominated sub contractor, where the sub contractor involved in execution of all main items of work described in the bid document, provided further that all other qualification criteria are satisfied) at least one similar work of minimum value in last 5 (five) years must be as follows: Rs.16 Crores - In case of single order / In multiple order limiting the maximum number of orders to the number of stories in single Building. (d) Deleted (e) The contractor should possess required valid electrical license B. Each Bidder should demonstrate :(a) Availability (either owned or leased) of the following key and critical equipment for this work : Based on the Studies, carried out by the Engineer the minimum suggested major equipment to attain the completion of works in accordance with the prescribed construction schedule is shown in the Appendix – II. The bidders should , however, undertake their own studies and furnish with their bid, a detailed construction planning and methodology supported with layout and necessary drawings and calculations (detailed) as stated in Clause 4.3 ( i) above to facilitate the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 to review their proposals. The numbers, types and capacities of each plant / equipment shall be shown in the proposals along with the cycle time for each operation for the given production capacity to match the requirements. (b) Availability for this work of personnel with adequate experience as required; as per Appendix – III. (c) Liquid assets and/ or availability of credit facilities of not less than the amount indicated in Appendix – I (Credit lines / letter of credit/ certificates from nationalized/ Scheduled banks for meeting the funds requirement etc.) 17 C. To qualify for the package of contracts made up of this contract for which bids are invited, the bidder must demonstrate having experience and resources sufficiently to meet of the qualifying criteria for the contracts. D. JOINT VENTURES 1. If a Joint Venture (JV) or consortium wish to participate in the bidding (a) The JV/ consortium should be formed with a maximum of 3 partners. (b) A financial partner in the JV, who need not have any technical qualification but should pitch in with financial support to the JV is permitted (c) The JV shall submit along with the bid, in a separate envelope super scripting ‘JOINT VENTURE/ CONSORTIUM DETAILS’, the following-----(i) Name of the Lead partner or the Partner-in-Charge duly evidenced by Power of Attorney signed by legally authorized signatories of all the partners. (ii) Complete information pertaining to each partner. (iii) Copy of agreement confirming the intent of all parties to form a JV. It should distinctly show The financial participation of each member as regards to planning and execution of the work. Name of the lead partner or Partner-in-charge authorized to incur liabilities and receive instructions for or on behalf of any / all partner(s) of the JV and the execution of the contract including receiving of payment due. All partners of the JV shall be liable jointly or severally for the execution of the contract, in accordance with the terms and conditions of the contract. 2. In a JV/ Consortium, the combined standing of all the partners, irrespective of their proposed financial participation in the work, shall be considered in evaluation of its credentials. 3. At least one of the JV/ Consortium partner should meet the minimum qualification criteria in respect of single similar works. 4. Firm, individual, company or corporation neither can join more than one JV nor they can also participate in the bidding in individual capacity. 5. A JV cannot incorporate more partner(s) in the JV after submission of bids. 4.6 4.6.1. Joint Ventures must comply with the following requirements: a) Following are the minimum qualification requirements, i) The lead partner shall meet not less than 50% of all the qualifying criteria given in paras 2.6.3 and 2.6.6 of chapter Joint Venture. The joint venture must collectively satisfy the criteria of para 2.6.3 & 2.6.6 of chapter Joint Venture. The experience of the other joint venture partners shall be considered if it is not less than 30 per cent of the qualifying criteria given in paras 2.6.3. and 2.6.6 of Chapter Joint Venture. However, in case one of the joint venture partners is proposed to be included 18 primarily to provide financial strength to the joint venture, such joint venture partner shall have to commit to provide liquidity support to the project to the extent of 20 percent of the value of the contract. The joint ventures must satisfy collectively the criteria of paras 2.6.4 & 2.6.5 of chapter Joint Venture for which purpose the relevant figures for each of the partners shall be added together to arrive at the joint venture’s total capacity. Individual members must each satisfy requirements of para 2.6.7 & 2.6.8 chapter Joint Venture. ii) b) Bid shall be signed so as to legally bind all partners, jointly and severally, and shall be submitted with a copy of the joint venture agreement providing the ‘joint and several’ liability with respect to the contract. 4.6.2 Qualification of a joint venture does not necessarily qualify any of its partners individually or as a partner in any other joint venture. In case of dissolution of a joint venture, each one of the constituent firms may qualify if they meet all the qualification requirements, subject to the written approval of the Employer. 4.7. Sub Contractor’s experience and resources shall not be taken into account in determining the bidder’s compliance with the qualifying criteria except to the extent stated in 4.5(A), above. 4.8. Bidders who meet the minimum qualification criteria will be qualified only if their available bid capacity is more than the total bid value. The available bid capacity will be calculated as under : Assessed Available bid Capacity = (A X N X 2 – B) Where, A = Maximum value of Interior works executed in any one year during the last five years (updated to the price level of the year indicated in Appendix – I) taking into account the completed as well as works in progress. N = Number of years prescribed for completion of the works for which bids are invited. B = Value (updated to the price level of the year indicated in Appendix – I) of existing commitments and on-going works to be completed during the next 9 months. (Period of completion of the works for which bid is invited). Note 4.9. : The Statements showing the value of existing commitments and ongoing works as well as the stipulated period of completion remaining for each of the works listed should be countersigned by the Engineerin-charge, not below the rank of an Executive Engineer or equivalent. Even though the bidders meet the above qualifying criteria, they are subject to be disqualified if they have : 19 Made misleading or false representations in the forms, statements and attachments submitted in proof of the qualification requirements; and/or. Record of poor performance such as abandoning the works, not properly completing the contract, inordinate delays in completion, litigation history, or financial failures etc. and /or Participated in the previous bidding for the same work and had quoted unreasonably high bid prices and could not furnish rational justification to the Chief Engineer, PWD (BLDG.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. 5.0. One Bid per Bidder 5.1. Each bidder shall submit only one bid for one package. A bidder who submits or participates in more than one Bid (other than as a sub-contractor or in cases of alternatives that have been permitted or requested) will cause all the proposals with the Bidder’s participation to be disqualified. 6.0. Cost of Bidding 6.1. The bidder shall bear all costs associated with the preparation and submission of this Bid, and the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 will in no case responsible and liable for those costs. 7.0. Site Visit 7.1. The Bidder, at the Bidder’s own responsibility and risk is encouraged to visit and examine Site of Works and its surroundings and obtain all information that may be necessary for preparing the Bid and entering into a contract for construction of the works. The cost of visiting the Site shall be at the Bidder’s own expense. be 20 B. BIDDING DOCUMENTS 8.0. Content of Bidding Documents 8.1. The set of bidding documents comprises the documents listed below and agenda in accordance with Clause 10 : Section 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 8.2. Particulars Invitation of Bids Instruction to Bidders Qualification Information, and other forms Conditions of Contract Contract of Data Technical Specifications Securities and other forms of Bid Form of Bid Bill of Quantities Drawings Documents to be furnished by bidder issued Volume No. I II III IV Table - 1 One copy of each of the volumes I, II & III will be issued to the bidder. Documents to be furnished by the bidder in compliance to section 2 will be prepared by him and furnished as Volume – IV in two parts (to be submitted in A4 size paper in a bound volume) (refer clause 12). 8.3. The bidder is expected to examine carefully all instructions, conditions of Contract, contract data, forms, terms, technical specifications, bill of quantities, forms, Appendices and drawings in the Bid Document. Failure to comply with the requirements of Bid Document shall be at the bidder’s own risk. Pursuant to clause 26 here of bids, which are not substantially responsive to the requirements of the Bid Documents shall be rejected. 9.0. Clarification of Bidding Documents 9.1. A prospective bidder requiring any clarification of the bidding documents may notify the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 in writing or by cable (hereinafter “cable” includes telex and facsimile) at the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s address indicated in the invitation to bid. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg) will respond to any request for clarification. Copes of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s response will be forwarded to all purchasers of the bidding documents in the pre-bid meeting, including a description of the enquiry but without identifying its source. Pre-bid meeting 9.1.1 The bidder or his official representative is invited to attend a pre-bid meeting, which will take place at the address, venue, time and date as indicated in APPENDIX-1. 9.1.2 The purpose of the meeting will be to clarify issues and to answer questions on any matter that may be raised at that stage. 9.1.3 The bidder may submit any questions in writing to the Chief Engineer, PWD 21 (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 on the day of the meeting. 9.1.4 Minutes of the meeting, including the text of the questions (without identifying the source of enquiry) and the responses given will be transmitted without delay. Any modification of the bidding documents listed in Sub Clause 8.1, which may become necessary as a result of the pre-bid meeting shall be made by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandrmari, Guwahati-3 exclusively through the issue of an Addendum pursuant to Clause 10 and not through the minutes of the pre-bid meeting. 9.1.5 Non-attendance at the pre-bid meeting will not be a cause for disqualification of a bidder. 10.0 Amendment of Bidding Documents 10.1. Before the deadline for submission of bids, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 may modify the bidding documents by issuing addenda/ amendments. 10.2 Any addendum thus issued shall be a part of the bidding documents and shall be communicated in writing or by cable to all the purchasers of the bidding documents. Prospective bidders shall acknowledge receipt of each addendum in wiring or by cable to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will assume no responsibility for postal delays. 10.3. All corrections / amendments may be seen in the website- assam.etenders.in 10.4. To give prospective bidders reasonable time in which to take an addendum into account in preparing their bids, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 may, at his discretion, extend as necessary the deadline for submission of bid, in accordance with SubClause 20.2. below 22 C. 11. PREPARATION OF BIDS Language of the Bid All documents relating to the bid shall be in the English Language. 12. Documents Comprising Bid 12.1 The bid to be submitted by the bidder as Volume IV of the bid document (refer Clause 8.1) shall be in Two separate parts : Part – I shall be named “Technical Bid” and shall comprise i) Bid Security in the form Specified in Section 6. ii) Qualification Information and supporting documents as specified in Section – 2. iii) Certificates, undertakings, affidavits as specified in Section -6, 2 iv) Undertaking that the bid shall remain valid for the period specified in Clause 15.1 v) Acceptance / non acceptance of Dispute Review Expert proposed in Clause 36.1 Part – II shall be named “Financial Bid” and shall comprise 1) Form of Bid as Specified in Section – 7. 2) Priced Bill of Quantities for items specified in Section – 8. Part-I will be separately sealed and marked in accordance with the sealing and Marking Instructions in clause 19. Part – II shall be submitted online. The bidder shall prepare Two Copies of the bid, marking them “Original” and “Copy” respectively. Following documents, which are not submitted with the bid, will be deemed to be part of the bid. Section Invitation of Bids 1 Instruction to Bidders 3 Conditions of Contract 4 Contract Data 5 Specifications 9 Drawings Particulars Volume No. Volume - I Volume - III 23 13.0 Bid Prices 13.1 The contract shall be for the whole works as described in Sub-Clause 1.1 based on the priced Bill of Quantities submitted by the Bidder. 13.2 The Bidder shall fill in rates and prices and line item total (both in figures and words) for all items of the works rounded to the nearest rupee described in the bill of Quantities along with total bid price (both in figures and words). Items for which no rate or price is entered by the bidder will not be paid for by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 when executed and shall be deemed covered by the other rates and prices in the Bill of Quantities. Corrections, if any, shall be made by crossing out, initialing, dating and rewriting. The Bidder must quote his bid price in Section 7 (Form of Bid) both in figures and words, which is to be duly signed by the bidder. A Financial Bid without any mention of bid price in the Form of Bid shall be treated as Non-Responsive and shall not be considered for evaluation. 13.3 All duties, taxes (VAT, forest Royalty, labour cess etc.) levies payable by the contractor under the contract, or for any other cause shall be included in the rates, prices and total Bid Price submitted by the Bidder. 13.4 The rates and prices quoted by the Bidder shall be fixed for the duration of the Contract and shall not be subject to adjustment on any account. 14. Currencies of Bid and Payment 14.1 The unit rates and the prices shall be quoted by the bidder entirely in Indian Rupees. All payments shall be made in Indian Rupees. 15. Bid Validity 15.1 Bids shall remain valid for a period not less than 180 days after the deadline date for bid submission specified in Clause 20.A bid valid for a shorter period shall be rejected by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 as non-responsive. In case of discrepancy in bid validity period between that given in the undertaking pursuant to Clause 12.1 (iv) and Form of Bid submitted by the bidder, the later shall be deemed to stand corrected in accordance with the former and the bidder has to provide for any additional security that is required. 15.2. In exceptional circumstances, prior to expiry of the original time limit, the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 may request that the bidders may extend the period of validity for a specified additional period. The request and the bidder’s responses shall be made in writing or by cable. A bidder may refuse the request without forfeiting his bid security. A bidder agreeing to the request will not be required or permitted to modify his bid, but will be required to extend the validity of his bid security for a period of the extension, and in compliance with Clause 16 in all respects. 24 15.3. Deleted. 15.4. Bid evaluation will be based on the bid prices without taking into consideration the above correction. 16. Bid Security. 16.1 The Bidder shall furnish, as a part of his Bid, a Bid Security in the amount as shown in the press notice for this particular work. The bid security shall be in favour of The Executive Engineer, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati Assam as named in Appendix and may be in one of the following forms : i) Deleted. ii) Deleted iii) Bank Guarantee from any Nationalized Indian Bank, in the format given in section-8 in favour of Executive Engineer, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati-6 (A written confirmation in the Bank’s letterhead confirming the authenticity of the Guarantee shall be furnished along with the Guarantee) iv) Fixed Deposit Receipt issued by any nationalized / schedule Indian Bank or a foreign Bank approved by R.B.I. acceptable to the employer. 16.2 Bank guarantees (and other instruments having fixed validity) issued as security for the bid shall be valid for 45 days beyond the validity of the bid. 16.3 Any bid not accompanied by an acceptable Bid Security and not secured as indicated in SubClause 16.1 and Sub Clause 16.2 above shall be rejected by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 as non-responsive. 16.4 The bid Security of unsuccessful bidders will be retuned within 28 days of the end of the validity period specified in Sub Clause 15.1. 16.5 The Bid Security of the Successful Bidder will be discharged when the bidder has signed the Agreement and furnished the Performance Security. 16.6 The Bid Security may be forfeited :a) If the Bidder withdraws the Bid after Bid opening during the period of Bid Validity; b) If the Bidder does not accept the correction of the Bid Price, pursuant to Clause 27; or c) In the case of a successful Bidder, if the Bidder fails within the specified time limit to : i) Sign the Agreement; or. 25 17.0. ii) Furnish the required Performance Security. Alternative Proposals by Bidders 17.1. Bidders shall submit offers that fully comply with the requirements of the bidding documents, including the conditions of contract (Time for completion), basic technical design as indicated in the drawing and specifications. Conditional offers or alternative offers will not be considered further in the process of bid evaluation. 18. Format and Signing of Bid 18.1. The Bidder shall prepare one original and one copy of the documents comprising the bid as described below in Clause 12 of these Instruction to Bidders, bound with the volume containing the “Technical Bid” in separate parts and clearly marked “ORIGINAL” and “COPY” as appropriate. In event of discrepancy between them, the original shall prevail. “Financial Bid” shall be submitted online. 18.2. The Original copy of bid shall be typed or written in indelible ink and shall be signed by a person or persons duly authorized to sign on behalf of the Bidder, pursuant to Sub-Clause 4.3, 4.4 and 4.5(B). All pages of the bid where entries or amendments have been made shall be initialed by person signing the bid. 18.3. The Bid shall contain no alterations or additions, except those to comply with instructions issued by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, or as necessary to correct errors made by the Bidder, in which case such corrections shall be initialized by the person or persons signing the bid. 26 D. SUBMISSION OF BIDS 19.0. Sealing and Marking of Bids 19.1. The Bidder shall seal the original and copy of the Bid in separate envelopes, duly marking the envelopes as “ORIGINAL” and “COPY”. These two envelopes (called as inner envelopes) shall then be put inside one outer envelope. Each set of the inner envelopes marked “ORIGINAL” and “COPY” shall contain within sealed envelopes marked as “Technical Bid” with additional markings as follows : . “Original or Copy”, as the case may be Bid to be opened on 20-04-2015 at 11:01 Hrs. The contents of Bid will be as specified in Clause 12.1. 19.2. The inner and outer and separate enveloped containing Technical shall (a)Be addressed to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 (b) Bear the identification as indicated in Appendix-I 19.3. In addition to the identification required in Sub-Clause 19.1 and 19.2, each of the enveloped shall indicate the name and address of the bidder to enable the bid to be returned unopened incase it is declared late, pursuant to Clause 21, or the Evaluation Committee declares the Bid as non-responsive pursuant to Clause 23. 19.4. If the outer envelope is not sealed and marked as above, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 will assume no responsibility for the misplacement or premature opening of the bid. 19.5 The Financial Bid along with the Form of Bid as specified in section-7 shall be submitted online. 20. Deadline for Submission of Bids 20.1. Complete Bids (including Technical and Financial Bids) must be received by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 at the address specified above not later than the date indicated in Appendix-I. In the event of the specified date for the submission of bids declared as holiday on the date of receipt of the bids as specified the bids will be received and opened on the next working day at the same time and venue. 20.2 The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 may extend the deadline for submission of bids by issuing an amendment in accordance with Clause 10, in which case all rights and obligations of the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 and the Bidders previously subject to original deadline will then be subject to the new deadline. 27 21. Late Bids 21.1. Any Bid received late by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati -3 after the deadline prescribed in Clause 20 will be returned unopened to the bidder. 22. Modifications and Withdrawal of Bids 22.1 Deleted 22.2 Each Bidder’s modification or withdrawal notice shall be prepared, sealed, marked, and delivered in accordance to Clause 18 & 19, with the outer and inner envelopes additionally marked “MODIFICATION” or “WITHDRAWAL” as appropriate. 22.3 No bid may be modified after the Deadline for submission of bids except in pursuance of Clause - 23. 22.4 Withdrawal or modification of a Bid between the deadline for submission of bids and the expiration of the original period of bid validity specified in Clause 15.1 above or as extended to Clause 15.2 may result in the forfeiture of Bid Security pursuant to Clause 16.6. 28 E.BID OPENING AND EVALUATION 23. Bid Opening 23.1 The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 will open all the Bids received (except those received late), including modifications made pursuant to Clause 22, in the presence of the Bidders or their representatives who choose to attend at time, date and the place specified in Appendix-I in the manner specified in Clause 20 and 23.3. In the event of specified date of Bid opening being declared a holiday on the date of receipt of the bids as specified the bids will be received and opened on the next working day at the same time and venue. 23.2 Envelope marked “WITHDRAWAL” shall be opened and read out first. Bids for which an acceptance notice of withdrawal has been submitted pursuant to Clause 22 shall not be opened. 23.3 The envelope “Technical Bid” shall be opened. The amount, form and validity of the Bid security furnished with each bid will be announced. If the bid security furnished does not conform to the amount and validity period as specified in the Invitation for Bid, and has not been furnished in the form specified in Clause 16, the bid shall be returned to the bidder. 23.4 i) Subject to confirmation of the bid security by the issuing Bank, the bid accompanied with valid bid security will be taken up for evaluation with respect to the Qualification information and other information furnished in Part I if the bid pursuant to Clause 12.1. ii) After receipt to confirmation of the bid security, the bidder will be asked in writing (usually) within 10 days of opening of the Technical Bid) to clarify or modify his technical bid, if necessary, with respect to any rectifiable defects. Tiii) The bidders will respond in not more than 7 days of issue of the clarification letter, which will also indicate the date, time and venue of opening of the financial bid (usually on 21st day of opening of the technical bid). iv) Immediately (usually within 3 or 4 days), on receipt of these clarifications the Evaluation Committee will finalize the list of responsive bidders, whose financial bids are eligible for consideration. 23.5 If, as a consequence of the modification carried out by the bidder. In response to sub-clause 23.4, the bidders desire to modify their financial bid; they will submit the modification in separate sealed envelope so as to reach the Employer’s address (refer sub-clause 19.2) before the opening of the Technical Bid/financial bid as intimated in the clarification letter (refer subclause 23.4). The envelope shall have clear marking “MODIFICATION TO BID – Not to be opened except with the approval of the Evaluation Committee”. 23.6 At the time of opening of “Bid”, the name of the bidders will be announced. The Bidders Names, the Bid prices, the total amount of each bid, any discounts, Bid modifications and withdrawals, and such others details as the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati- 29 3 may consider appropriate, will be announced by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 at the opening. Any bid price or discounts, which is not read out recorded will not be taken into account in Bid Evaluation. The Bidders responsiveness to the Bids will be examined as per Clause 26.2. Only the responsive bidders’ Bids will be evaluated. 23.7. Deleted. 23.8. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 shall prepare minutes of the Bid opening, including the information disclosed to those present in accordance with Sub-Clause 23.6. 24. Process to be Confidential 24.1. Information relating to the examination, clarification, evaluation and comparison of Bids and recommendations for the award of a contract shall not be disclosed to Bidders or any other person officially concerned with such process until the award to the successful Bidder has been announced. Any effort by a Bidder to influence the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s processing of Bids or award decision may result in the rejection of his Bid. 25. Clarification of Financial Bids 25.1 To assist in the examination, evaluation and comparison of Bids, the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 may, at his discretion, ask any Bidder for clarification of his bid, including breakdowns of unit rates. The request for clarification and the response shall be in writing or by cable, but no change in the price or substance of the Bid shall be sought, offered, or permitted except as required to confirm the correction of arithmetic errors discovered by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 in the evaluation of the Bids in accordance with Clause 27. 25.2 Subject to sub-clause 25.1, no Bidders shall contact the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 on any matter relating to his bid from the time of the bid opening to the time the contract is awarded. If the Bidders wish to bring additional information to the notice of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, it should do so in writing. 25.3 Any effort by the Bidders to influence the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 in the Chief Engineer , PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s bid evaluation, bid comparisons or contract award decisions may result in the rejection of the Bidders’ bid. 26. Examination of Bids and Determination of Responsiveness 26.1 Deleted. 26.2 A substantially responsive “Bid” in one, which conforms to all the terms, conditions, and specifications of bidding documents, without material deviation or reservation. A material deviation or reservation is one (a) which affects in any substantial way the scope, quality, or performance of the works; (b) which limits in any substantial way, inconsistent with the Bidding documents, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s right or the Bidder’s obligations under the contract; or (c) whose rectification would affect unfairly the competitive position of other Bidders presenting substantially responsive Bids. 26.3 If a “Bid” is not substantially responsive, it will be rejected by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), 30 27. 27.1 27.2. Chandmari, Guwahati-3 and may not subsequently be made responsive by correction or withdrawals of the non-conforming deviation or reservation. Correction of Errors “Bids” determined to be substantially responsive will be checked by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 for any arithmetic errors. Errors will be corrected by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 as follows : a) Where there is a discrepancy between the rates in figures and in words, the rate in words will govern; and b) Where there is a discrepancy between the unit rate and the line item total resulting from multiplying the unit rate by the quantity, the unit rate as quoted will govern. The amount stated in the “Bid” will be corrected by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 in accordance with the above procedure and the bid amount adjusted with the concurrence of the Bidder in the following manner : a) If the Bid price increases as a result of this correction, the amount as stated in the bid will be the `bid price’ and the increase will be treated as rebate; b) If the Bid price decreases as a result of this correction, the decreased amount will be the “bid price”. Such adjusted bid price shall be considered as binding upon the Bidder. If the Bidder does not accept the corrected amount the Bid will be rejected, and the Bid security may be forfeited in accordance with Sub-Clause 16.6(b). 28. Deleted. 29. Evaluation and Comparison of Bids 29.1. The chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will evaluate and compare only the Bids determine to be substantially responsive in accordance with Sub-Clause 26.2. 29.2. In evaluating the Bids the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will determine for each Bid the evaluated Bid Price by adjusting the Bid Price as follows : a) Making any correction for errors pursuant to Clause 27; or b) Making an appropriate adjustments for any other acceptable variations, deviations; and c) Making appropriate adjustments to reflect discounts or other price modifications offered in accordance with Sub-Clause 23.6. 29.3. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 reserves the right to accept or reject any variation or deviation. Variations and deviations and other factors, which are in excess of the requirements of the Bidding documents or otherwise results in unsolicited benefits for the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.),Chandmari, Guwahati-3 shall not be taken into account in Bid evaluation. 29.4. The estimated effect of the price adjustment during the period of implementation of the contract will not be taken into account in Bid evaluation. 31 29.5. If the Bid of the successful Bidder is seriously unbalanced in relation to the Department’s estimate of the cost of work to be performed under the contract, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3 may require the Bidder to produce detailed price analysis for any or all item of the Bill of Quantities, to demonstrate the internal consistency of those prices with the construction methods and schedule proposed. After evaluation of the amount of the performance security set forth in Clause 34 be increased at the expense of the successful Bidder to a level sufficient to protect the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 against financial loss in the event of default of the successful Bidder under the Contract. 29.6. If a bid contains several items in the Bill of Quantities, which are unrealistically priced low, and which cannot be substantiated satisfactorily by the bidder, may be rejected as non-responsive. 30. Deleted. 32 F. AWARD OF CONTRACT 31. Award Criteria 31.1. Subject to Clause 32, the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will award the Contract to the Bidder whose Bids has been determined. i) To be substantially responsive to the Bidding documents and who has offered the lowest evaluated Bid pursuant to Clause 29 provided further that the bidder has the capability and resources to carry out the contract effectively. ii) To be within the available Bid capacity adjusted to account for his quoted bid price. iii) The work shall be awarded at the lowest responsive bid price. In no case, the contract shall be awarded to any bidder whose available bid capacity is less than the evaluated bid price, even if the said bid is the lowest evaluated bid. The contract will in such case be awarded to the next lowest bidder at his evaluated bid. 31.2 Deleted. 32. Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s right to accept any Bid and to reject any or all Bids. 32.1 Notwithstanding Clause 31, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 reserves the right to accept or reject any Bid and to cancel the Bidding process and reject all bids, at any time prior to the awards of Contract, without thereby incurring any liability to the affected Bidder or Bidders or any obligations to inform the affected Bidder or Bidders of the grounds for the chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3’s actions. 33. Notification of Award and Signing of Agreement. 33.1 The Bidders whose Bid has been accepted will be notified for the award by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 prior to expiration of the Bid validity period by cable, telex or facsimile confirmed by registered letter. This letter (hereinafter and in the Condition of Contract called the “Letter of Acceptance”) will state the sum that the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will pay the Contractor in consideration of the execution, completion and maintenance of the Works by the Contractor as prescribed by the contract (hereinafter and in the Contract called the “Contract Price”). 33.2 The notification of award will constitute the formation of the Contract, subject only to the furnishing of a performance security in accordance with the provisions of Clause 34. 33.3 The agreement will incorporate all agreements between the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 and the Successful Bidder. Within 21days of receipt of the “Letter of Acceptance”, the successful Bidder will deposit the requisite Performance Security and attend before the Chief Engineer, P.W.D. (Building) to sign the Agreement and deliver it to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3. 33.4 Upon the furnishing of the Performance security by the successful Bidder, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 will promptly notify the other Bidders that their Bids have been unsuccessful. 34. Performance Security 33 34.1 Within 21 days of receipt of the Letter of Acceptance, the successful Bidder shall deliver to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, a Performance Security in any of the form given below for an amount equivalent to 5% of the Contract price plus additional security for unbalanced Bids in accordance with Clause 29.5 of ITB Clause - 52 of Conditions of Contract. A bank guarantee in the form given in section 6 : If the performance security is provided by the successful Bidder in the form of a Bank Guarantee, it shall be issued at the Bidder’s option, by a Nationalized Indian Bank, prepared in non-judicial stamp paper of specified value. 34.2 Failure of the successful Bidder to comply with the requirements of Sub-Clause 34.1. shall constitute sufficient grounds for cancellation of the award and forfeiture of the Bid security. 35. Advance Payment and Security 35.1. The Executive Engineer of the concerned Division will provide an advance Payment as stipulated in the conditions of Contract, subject to maximum amount, as stated in the Contract Data. However such advance will be subject to fund made available. 36. . Dispute Review Experts 36.1. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 proposes that ( name of proposed Dispute Review Expert in Appendix - I) be appointed as Disputes Review Expert under the Contract, at a daily fee plus reimbursable expenses. If the Bidders disagree with this proposal, the Bidders should so state in the Bids. 37. . Corrupt or Fraudulent Practices 37.1. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 will reject a proposal for award if it determine that the Bidder recommended for award has engaged in corrupt or fraudulent in competing for the contract in question and will declare the firm ineligible, either indefinitely or for a stated period of time to be awarded a contract with CPWD / APWD and any other agencies, if it at any time determines that the firm has engaged in corrupt or fraudulent practices in competing for the contractor, or in execution. 37.2 Furthermore, Bidders shall be aware of the provision stated in Sub-Clause 25.3 and Sub-Clause - 59.2 of the Condition of Contract. 34 APPENDIX – I ( PRIME QUALIFICATION INFORMATION ) 1. Name of the Employer is: Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. (Cl. 1.1) 2. The Total Volume of Interior work performed in the last five years : i) 2009 – 2010 ii) 2010 – 2011 iii) 2011 – 2012 iv) 2012– 2013 v) 2013– 2014 3. The annual minimum average financial turn over amount is Rs. 16.00 crore (Rupees sixteen crore) only over the last five years. (Cl. 4.5A (a)) 4. Value of completed work of similar nature (Cl. 4.5A (c)) Rs.16 Crores - In case of single order / In multiple order limiting the maximum number of orders to the number of stories in single Building. 5. Deleted (Cl. 4.5A (d)) 6. Liquid assets and / or availability of credit facilities is 10% of Bid Value (Cl. 4.5B (c)) 7. Deleted 8. The pre bid meeting will take place at the Office of the CE, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 on 10-04-2015 at 14-00 Hours. 9. The Bids will be opened at the Office of the CE, PWD (Bldg.) Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 on 20-04-2015 at 11-01Hours. 10. Address of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 Office of the Chief Engineer, PWD (B), Chandmari, Guwahati - 781003, Assam. 11. Identification : i) Construction work of the proposed New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building) 35 ii) Bid reference No.CS/T/BD/8/2013/46 Dated Guwahati-17-03-2015 iii) . Do not open before 11:01Hours of 20-04-2015 iv) The bid should be submitted latest by 14:00 Hours on 18-04-2015 12. The Bid Security should be drawn in favour of the Executive Engineer, PWD, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati – 781 003, Assam. 13. The name of Dispute Review Expert – 14 Updating factors for updating work value of single building project executed during last five years. Year before Multiply factor One 1.10 Two 1.21 Three 1.33 Four 1.46 Five 1.61 36 APPENDIX – II ( LIST OF KEY PLANT & EQUIPMENT TO BE DEPLOYED ON CONTRACT WORK ) [ Reference Cl. 4.5 (B) (a) ] Sl No. Maximum age as on March’2014 (Years) Required Type of Equipment 1.0 Wood Planning machine. 2 4 Nos 2.0 Wood moulding and carving machine. 2 2 Nos 3.0 Wood lathe machine. 2 3 Nos 4.0 Concrete drilling machine a) Pneumatic. 3. 4 Nos b) Electrical. 3 4 Nos 5.0 Timber steam seasoning equipments and pressure chamber. 1 1 Set. 6.0 Timber preservation treatment vat. 2 2 Sets. 7.0 Floor Grinding Machine. 2 6 Nos. 8.0 Hand Grinding Machine. 2 4 Nos. 9.0 Mirror Polish Grinder. 2 2 Sets. 10. Spray painting equipments. 2 4 Sets. 11. Palette Painting equipments. 2 4 Sets. 12. Welding machine. 2 2 Sets. 13. Steel grinders (Hand & stationery). 2 4 Sets. 14. Equipments / grinders for stone relief works. 1 4 Sets. Table - 2 The bidder hereby confirms that the quality and type of equipments, he will deploy for construction will not be less than listed in Appendix – II and agreed to bring more equipments, if so warranted, in the opinion of the Engineer at no extra cost to the Chief Engineer, P.W.D. (Building). NB: The bidder should owned or should have assured ownership to the key items of equipment in full working order and must demonstrate that based on known commitment, they will be available for use in the proposed contract. 37 APPENDIX – III ( LIST OF KEY PERSONNEL TO BE DEPLOYED ON CONTRACT WORK ) [ Reference Cl. 4.5 (B) (b) ] Sl No. 1 Personnel 2 1.0 Project Manager 2.0 Site Engineer 3.0 Qualification 3 Nos. Required 4 B.E. Civil + 10 years experience (5 years as Manager) 1 Diploma in Civil + 15 years experience B.E. Civil + 10 years experience or (5 years as in Interior works.) 2 Electrical Engineer B.E. Elect. + 10 years experience 2 4.0 Interior Decorators Diploma in interior decoration + 10 years experience in interior decoration works. 4 5.0 Interior works supervisor Interior works supervision. Certificate + 5 years experience. 4 6.0 Quality Assurance Engineer B.E Civil + 5 years Experience or Diploma Civil + 10 years Exp. 1 7.0 Other Staff (Supervisor, Overseers, Office Assistant, Foreman, Machine Operator etc. 15 TOTAL ………. 29 Table - 3 N.B :The bidder should submit the Bio data of the Key personnel as above with attested copies of certificates in support of their qualification and their experience and their consent letters (not more than one month old) for working on behalf of the contractor for work concerned. 38 SECTION 2 QUALIFICATION INFORMATION 39 QUALIFICATION INFORMATION The information to be filled in by the Bidder in the following pages will be used for purposes of post qualification as provided for in Clause 4 of the Instruction to Bidders. The information will not be incorporated to the Contract. For Individual Bidders 1. Constitution or legal status of Bidder ( Attach Copy ) Place of Registration : Principal Place of Business : Power of Attorney of Signatory of Bid (Attach) Total value of Civil Engineering Construction Work performed in the last five years (In Rs. Crore) 2009-2010 2010-2011 2011-2012 2012-2013 2013-2014 (Attach Certificate from Chartered Accountant) 1.2.1. Work performed as prime contractor, work performed in the past as a nominated subcontractor will also be considered provided the sub-contract involved execution of all main items of work described in the bid document, provided further that all other qualification criteria are satisfied (in the same name) on works of a similar nature over the last five years. 1 Name of the Employer Description of work Contract No. Value of Contract (Rs. Crore) Date of Issue of Work order Stipulated period of completion 2 3 4 5 6 7 Table – 4 Actual date of completion (Attach certificate from Engineerin Charge 8 Remarks explaining reasons for delay & work completed 9 40 1.3.2. Quantities of work executed as prime contractor, work performed in the past as a nominated sub-contractor, will also be considered provided the sub-contract involved execution of all main items of work described in the bid document, provided further that all other qualification criteria are satisfied ( in the same name and style ) in the last five years. Quantity of work performed ( Cu.m) Remarks Year Name of the work 1 Name of the Employer Cement Concrete (including RCC & PCC.) Brick Work 3 4 5 2 Steel Reinforcement 6 Remarks (indicate contract Ref.) (Attach Certificate from Engineerin-Charge) 7 2009-2010 2010-2011 2011-2012 2012-2013 2013-2014 Table - 5 1.4 Information of Bid Capacity (works for which bids have been submitted and works which are yet to be completed) as on date of this bid. A) Existing Commitments and on-going works : Description works Place & State Contract No. Name & Address of Employer 1 2 3 4 Value of Contract (Rs.) Stipulated Period of Completion 5 Total = Table - 6 6 Value of Work Remaining to be completed (Rs.) 7 Anticipated date of completion 8 41 B) Works for which bids are already submitted : Description works Place & State 1 Name & Address of Employer 2 3 Estimated Value of Works (Rs. Crore) 4 Stipulated Period of Completion Date when Decision is expected 5 Remarks If any 6 7 Table - 7 1.5 Availability of key items of Contractor’s Equipment essential for carrying out the works (Ref. Clause – 4.5(B)(a)]. The Bidder should list all the information requested below. Refer also to Sub-Clause 4.3 (iv) of the Instruction to Bidders. Item of Equipment 1 Wood Plaining machine. Wood moulding and carving machine Wood lathe machine Concrete drilling machine (Pneumatic) Concrete drilling machine (Electrical) Timber steam seasoning equipments and pressure chamber. Timber preservation treatment vat. Floor Grinding Machine. Hand Grinding Machine. Mirror Polish Grinder. Spray painting equipments. Palette Painting equipments. Welding machine. Steel grinders (Hand & stationery). Equipments / grinders for stone Requirement No. Capacity 2 3 Availability Proposals Owned/Leased Nos./ Age/ to be Procured Capacity Condition 4 5 6 Remarks (From whom to be purchased) 7 42 relief works. Table - 8 NB: The bidder should owned or should have assured ownership to the key items of equipment in full working order and must demonstrate that based on known commitment, they will be available for use in the proposed contract. .6 Qualifications and experience of key personnel required for administration and Execution of the contract [Ref. Clause 4.5(B)(b)]. Attach biographical data. Refer also to Sub-Clause 4.3 (v) of instructions to Bidders and Sub-Clause 9.1 of the Conditions of Contract. Position Name Qualification Year of Experience 1 2 3 4 Year of Experience in the proposed position 5 Project Manager Site Engineer Electrical Engineer Interior Decorators Interior works supervisor Quantity Assurance Engineer Other Staff (supervisor, Overseers, office assistant, Foreman, Machine Operator etc.) Table - 9 1.7 Proposed Sub-contracts and firms involved, (Refer IITB Clause 4.3 (xi)] Sanctions of the Works 1 Value of Sub-Contract 2 Sub-Contractor (Name & Address) 3 Experience in similar work 4 Table - 10 1.8 Financial reports for the last five years; balance sheets, profit and loss statements, auditor’s reports (in case of companies/corporation), etc. List them below and attach copies. 1.9 Evidence of access to financial resources to meet the qualification requirements; cash in Hand, lines of credit, etc. List them below and attach copies of support documents. 43 1.10. Name, address and telephone, telex and fax numbers of the bidder’s bankers who may provide references if contacted by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. 1.11. Information of litigation history in which the Bidder is involved. Order Party Employer Cause of Dispute 1 2 3 Amount involved 4 Remark showing present status 5 Table - 11 1.12. Statement of compliance under the requirements of Sub-Clause - 3.2 of the instructions to Bidders. ( name of Consultant engaged for project preparation is M/s. Dulal Mukherjee & Associates, 28B, Shakespeare Sarani, Kolkata – 700 017 (email : [email protected].) (Web : www.dmaindia.org). 1.13. Proposed work method and schedule. The bidder should attach descriptions, drawings and charts as necessary to comply with the requirements of the Bidding Documents. (Refer ITB Clause 4.1 & 4.3 (xii)]. 1.14. Programme. 1.15. Quality Assurance Programme. 2. Deleted. 3. Additional Requirements 3.1 Bidders should provide any additional information required to fulfill the requirements of Clause – 4 of Information to Bidders, if applicable. I. Affidavit. II. Undertaking. III. Authority to seek reference from Bidders Banker 44 SECTION 3 CONDITIONS OF CONTRACT 45 GENERAL CONDITIONS OF CONTRACT ( G.C.C.) A. GENERAL 1. Definitions 1.1. Terms which are defined in the Contract Data are not also defined in the Conditions of Contract but deep their defined meanings. Capital. The Adjudicator will be a Dispute Review Board jointly appointed by the Employer and the Contractor to resolve disputes as provided for in Clauses 24 and 25. The name of the Adjudicator is defined in the Contract Data. Bill of Quantities means the priced and completed Bill of Quantities forming part of the Bid. Compensation Events are those defined in Clause 44 hereunder. The Completion Date is the date of completion of the Works as certified by the Engineer in accordance with Sub Clause 55.1. The Contract is the contract between the Employer and the Contractor to design, plan and execute complete and maintain the Works. It consists of the documents listed in Clause - 2.3 below. The Contract Data defines the “documents and other information which comprise the Contract. The Contractor is a person or corporate body whose Bid to carry out the Works has been accepted by the Employer. The Contractor’s Bid is the completed Bidding document submitted by the Contractor to the Employer includes Technical and Financial bids. The Contract Price is the price stated in the Letter of Acceptance and thereafter as adjusted in accordance with the provisions of the Contract. Days are calendar days; months are calendar months. A Defects Liability Period is the period named in the Contract Data and calculated from the Completion Date. The Employer is the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam. The “Engineer” is the Executive Engineer, PWD, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati, Assam who is responsible of supervising the Contractor, administering the Contract, certifying payments due to the Contractor issuing and valuing Variations to the Contract, awarding extensions of time, and valuing the Compensation Events. Equipment is the contractor’s machinery and vehicles brought temporarily to the Site to construct the Works. The Initial Contract Price is the Contract Price listed in the Employer’s Letter of Acceptance. 46 The Intended Completion Date is the date on which it is intended that the Contractor shall complete the Works. The Intended Completion Date is specified in the Contract Data. The Intended Completion Date may be revised only by the Engineer by issuing an extension of time. Materials are all supplies, including consumables, used by the contractor for incorporation in the Works. Plant is any integral part of the Works that is to have a mechanical, electrical, electronic or chemical or biological function. The Site is the area defined as such in the Contract Data. Site Investigation Reports are those, which were included in the bidding documents and are factual interpretative reports about the surface and sub-surface conditions at the site. Specification means the Specification of the Works included in the contract and any modification or addition made or approved by the Engineer. The Start Date is given in the Contract Data. It is the date when the Contractor shall commence execution of the works. It does not necessarily coincide with any of the Site Possession Dates. A Subcontractor is a person or corporate body who has a Contract with the Contractor to carry out a part of the work in the Contract, which includes work on the Site. Temporary Works are works designed, constructed, installed , and removed by the contractor, which are needed for construction or installation of the Works A Variation is an instruction given by the Engineer, which varies the Works. The Works are what the contract requires the Contractor to construct, install, and turn over to the Employer, as defined in the Contract Data. 2. Interpretation 2.1 In interpreting these Conditions of Contract, singular also means Plural, male also means female or neuter, and the other way around. Headings have no significance. Works have their normal meaning under the language of the Contract unless specifically defined. The Engineer will provide instructions clarifying queries about the Conditions of Contract. 2.2 If sectional completion is specified in the Contract Data, references in the conditions of Contract to the Works, the Completion Date, and the Intended Completion Date apply to any Section of the Works (other than references to the Completion Date and Intended Completion date for the whole of the Works). 2.3 The documents forming the contract shall be interpreted in the following order of priority : 1) Agreement. 2) Letter of Acceptance, notice to proceed with the works. 47 3. 3) Contractor’s Bid. 4) Contract Data. 5) Conditions of Contract including Special Conditions of Contract. 6) Specifications. 7) Drawings. 8) Bill of quantities and 9) Any other document listed in the Contract in the Contract Data as forming part of the Contract. Language and Law 3.1. The language of the Contract and the law governing the Contract are stated in the Contract Data. 4. Engineer’s Decisions 4.1. Except where otherwise specifically stated, the Engineer will decide contractual matters between the Employer and the Contractor in the role representing the Employer. 5. Delegation 5.1. The Engineer may delegate any of his duties and responsibilities to other people except to the Adjudicate after notifying the Contractor and may cancel any delegation after notifying the Contractor. 6. Communications 6.1. Communications between parties which are referred to in the conditions are effective only when in writing. A notice shall be effective only when it is delivered ( in terms of Indian Contract Act ). 7. Sub-contracting 7.1. 8. The Contractor may sub-contract up to a limit of 20% work as specified in contract data, with the approval of the Executive Engineer, PWD, Assam, PCC Division, Dispur, Division, Guwahati - 6 but may not assign the Contract without the approval of the Employer in writing Sub-contracting does not alter the Contractor’s obligations. Other Contractors 8.1. The Contractor shall cooperate and share the Site with other contractors, public authorities, utilities, and the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati -3, 48 Assam, between the dates given in the Schedule of other Contracts. The Contractor shall as referred to in the Contract Data, also provide facilities and services for them as described in the Schedule. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam may modify the schedule of other contractors and shall notify the contractor of any such modification. 9. Personnel 9.1. The Contractor shall employ the key personnel named in the Schedule of Key Personnel as referred to in the contract Data to carry out the functions stated in the Schedule or other personnel approved by the Engineer. The Engineer will approve any proposed replacement of key personnel only if their qualifications, abilities, and relevant experience are substantially equal to or better than those of the personnel listed in the Schedule. 9.2. If the Engineer asks the Contractor to remove a person who is a member of the Contractor’s staff or his work force stating the reasons the Contractor shall ensure that the person leaves the Site within seven days and has no further connection with the work in the Contract. 10. Employer’s and Contractor’s Risks 10.1. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam carries the risks which this Contract states are contractor’s risks, and the contractor carries the risks, which this Contract states are contractor’s risks. 11. Employer’s Risks 11.1. 12. Contractor’s Risks 12.1. 13. The Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam is responsible for the excepted risks which are (a) in so far as they directly affect the execution of the works in India, the risks of war, hostilities, invasion, act of foreign enemies, rebellion, revolution, insurrection or military or usurped power, civil war, riot commotion or disorder (unless restricted to the Contractor’s employees), and contamination from any nuclear fuel or nuclear waste or radioactive toxic explosive, or (b) a cause due solely to the design of the Works, other than the Contractor’s design. All risks of loss of or damage to physical property and of personal injury and death which arise during and in consequence of the performance of the Contract other than the excepted risks are the responsibility of the Contractor. Insurance 13.1. The Contractor shall provide, in the joint names of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) , Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam and the Contractor, insurance cover from the Start Date to the end of the Defects Liability Period, in the amounts and deductibles stated in the Contract Data for the following events which are due to the contractor’s risks : a) Loss of or damage to the Works, Plant and Materials; b) Loss of or damage to Equipment; 49 c) Loss of or damage of property (except the Works, plant, Materials and Equipment) in connection with the contract; and d) Personal injury or death. 13.2 Policies and certificates for Insurance shall be delivered by the Contractor to the Engineer for the Engineer’s approval before the Start Date. All such Insurance shall provide for compensation to be payable in the types and proportions of currencies required to rectify the loss or damage incurred. 13.3 If the Contractor does not provide any of the policies and certificates required, the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam may effect the insurance which the Contractor should have provided and recover the premiums the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam has paid from payments otherwise due to the contractor or, if no payment is due, the payment of the Premiums shall be a debt due. 13.4 Alterations to the terms of insurance shall not be made without the approval of the Engineer. 13.5 Both parties shall comply with any conditions of the Insurance policies. 14. Currency for payment 14.1. 15. The currency of the contract is Indian Rupees. Queries about the Contract Data 15.1 The Engineer will clarify queries on the Contract Data. 16. Contractor to Construct the Works 16.1 The Contractor shall construct and install the Works in accordance with the Specification and Drawings. 17. The Works to be completed by the Intended Completion Date 17.1 The contractor may commence execution of the Works on the Start Date and shall carry out the Works in accordance with the programmed submitted by the contractor, as updated with the approval of the Engineer, and complete them by the Intended Completion Date. 18. Approval by the Engineer 18.1 The Contractor shall submit Specifications and Drawing showing the proposed Temporary Works to the Engineer, who is to approve them if they comply with the Specifications and Drawings. 50 18.2 The Contractor shall be responsible of design of Temporary Works. 19. 18.3 The Engineer’s approval shall not alter the Contractor’s responsibility for design of the Temporary Works. 18.4 The Contractor shall obtain approval of third parties to the design of the Temporary Works where required. 18.5 All Drawings prepared by the Contractor for the execution of the temporary or permanent Works, are subject to prior approval by the Engineer before their use. Safety 19.1 20. Discoveries 20.1 21. 24. The Chief Engineer, PWD ( Bldg. ), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam / The Executive Engineer, PCC, Division, Dispur Guwahati - 6 shall give possession of the entire site at a time or part by part in a phased manner to the Contractor as stated in contract data. Access to the Site 22.1 23. Anything of his topical or other interest or of significant value unexpectedly discovered on the site is the property of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam. The Contractor is to notify the Engineer of such discoveries and carry out the Engineer’s instructions for dealing with them. Possession of the Site 21.1 22. The Contractor shall be responsible of the safety of all activities on the Site. The Contractor shall allow the Engineer and any person authorized by the Engineer access to the Site, to any place where work in connection with the Contract is being carried out or is intended to be carried out and to any place where materials or plant are being manufactured / fabricated / assembled for the works. Instructions 23.1 The Contractor shall carry out all instructions of the Engineer pertaining to works, which comply with the applicable laws where the Site is located. 23.2 The Contractor shall permit the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam to inspect the Contractor’s accounts and records relating to the performance of the Contractor and to have them audited by auditors appointed by the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam, if so required by the Employer Disputes 24.1 If the Contractor believes that a decision taken by the Engineer was either outside the authority given to the Engineer by the Contract or that the decision was wrongly taken, 51 the decision shall be referred to the dispute Review Board within 14 days of the notification of the Engineer’s decision. If the decision is not referred to the Dispute Review Board within 14 days of the notification of the Engineer’s decision, the matter will be time barred. 25. 26. Procedure for Disputes 25.1 The Dispute Review Board shall be constituted with three members, one from Employer, One from Contractor and the other to be nominated jointly by the above two members to give a decision in writing within 28 days of receipt of a notification of a dispute. 25.2 The Dispute Review Board shall be paid daily at the rate specified in the Contract Data together with reimbursable expenses of types specified in the Contract Data and the cost shall be divided equally between the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.),Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam and the Contractor, whatever decision is reached by the Dispute Review Board. Either party may give notice to the other to refer a decision of the Dispute Review Board to an Arbitrator within 28 days of the Dispute Review Board’s written decision. If neither party refers the dispute to arbitration within the next 28 days, the Dispute Review Board’s decision will be final and binding. 25.3 The arbitration shall be conducted in accordance with the arbitration procedure stated in the Special Conditions of Contract (SCC) The Replacement of Dispute Review Board 26.1 Should any member of the Dispute Review Board resign or die, or should the Chief Engineer, PWD ( Bldg. ), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam and the Contractor agree that the Dispute Review Board is not fulfilling their functions in accordance with the provisions of the Contract, a new Dispute Review Board will be jointly appointed by the Chief Engineer, PWD ( Bldg. ), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam and the contractor. In case of disagreement between the Employer and the Contractor, within 30 days, the Dispute Review Board shall be designated by the Appointing Authority designated in the Contract Data at the request of either party, within 14 days of receipt of such request. B. 27. TIME CONTROL Programme 27.1. Within the time stated in the Contract Data the contractor shall submit to the engineer for approval a Programme showing the general methods, arrangements, order, timing for all the activities in the Works along with monthly cash flow forecast. 27.2. An update of the Programme shall be a programme showing the actual progress achieved on each activity and the effect of the progress achieved on the timing of the remaining work including any changes to the sequence of the activities. 52 28. 27.3. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer, for approval, an updated Programme at intervals no longer than the period stated in the Contract Data. If the Contractor does not submit an updated Programme within this period, the Engineer may withhold the amount stated in the Contract Data from the next payment certificate and continue to withhold this amount until the next payment after the date on which the overdue programme has been submitted. 27.4. The Engineer’s approval of the programme shall not alter the Contractor’s obligations. The Contractor may revise the Programme and submit it to the Engineer again at any time. A revised Programme is to show the effect of Variations and Compensation Events. Extension of the Intended Completion Date 28.1. The Engineer shall extend the Intended Completion Date if a Compensation Event occurs or a Variation is issued which makes it impossible for Completion to be achieved by the Intended Completion Date without the Contractor taking steps to accelerate the remaining work and which would cause the Contractor to incur additional cost. 28.2. The Engineer shall decide whether and by how much to extend the Intended Completion Date within 35 days of the Contractor asking the Engineer for decision upon the effect of a Compensation Event or Variation and submitting full supporting information. If the Contractor has failed to give early warning of a delay or has failed to cooperate in dealing with a delay, the delay by this failure shall not be considered in assessing the new Intended Completion Date. 28.3. The Engineer shall within 14 days of receiving full justification from the contractor for extension of Intended Completion Date refer to the Employer his decision. The Employer shall in not more than 21 days communicate to the Engineer the acceptance or otherwise of the Engineer’s decision. 29. Deleted 30. Delays Ordered by the Engineer 30.1 31. The Engineer may instruct the Contractor to delay the start or progress of any activity within the works. Management meetings 31.1 Either the Engineer or the Contractor may require the other to attend a management meeting. The business of a management meeting shall be to review the plans for remaining work and to deal with matters raised in accordance with the early warning procedure. 31.2 The Engineer shall record the business of management meetings and is to provide 53 copies of his record to those attending the meeting and to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam. The responsibility of the parties of actions to be taken is to be decided by the Engineer either at the management meeting or after the management meeting and stated in writing to all who attended the meeting. 32. Early Warning 32.1 The Contractor is to warn the Engineer at the earliest opportunity of specific likely future events or circumstances that may adversely affect the quality of the work increase the Contract Price or delay the execution of works. The Engineer may require the Contractor to provide an estimate of the expected effect of the future event or circumstance on the Contract Price and completion Date. The estimate is to be provided by the Contractor as soon as reasonably possible. 32.2 The Contractor shall cooperate with the Engineer in making and considering proposals for how the effect of such an event or circumstance can be avoided or reduced by anyone involved in the work and in carrying out any resulting instruction of the Engineer. 54 C. 33. Identifying Defects 33.1 34. 36. The Engineer shall check the Contractor’s work and notify the Contractor of any defects that are found. Such checking shall not affect the contractor’s responsibilities. The Engineer may instruct the Contractor to search for a Defect and to uncover and test any work that the Engineer considers may have a defect. Tests 34.1 35. QUALITY CONTROL If the Engineer instructs the Contractor to carry out a test not specified in the Specification to check whether any work has a effect and the test shows that it does, the Contractor shall pay for the test and any samples. Correction of Defects 35.1 The Engineer shall give notice to the Contractor of any Defects before the end of the Defects Liability Period, which begins at completion and is defined in the Contract Data. The Defects Liability Period shall be extended for as long as Defects remain to be corrected. 35.1 Every time notice of a Defect is given, the Contractor shall correct the notified Defect within the length of time specified by the Engineer’s notice. Uncorrected Defects 36.1 If the Contractor has not corrected a Defect within the time specified in the Engineer’s notice, the Engineer will assess the cost of having the Defect corrected, and the Contractor will pay this amount. 55 D. 37. 38. COST CONTROL Bill of Quantities 37.1 The Bill of Quantities shall contain items for the construction and installation, work to be done by the Contractor. 37.2 The Bill of Quantities is used to calculate the Contract Price. The Contractor is paid for the quantity of the work done at the rate in the Bill of Quantities for each item. Changes in the Quantities 38.1 If the final quantity of the work done differs from the quantity in the Bill of Quantities for the particular item by more than 25 percent provided the change is attributed to the Department i.e., either the B.O.Q. is prepared by the department or variation is due to change / modification ordered by the Department and the same exceeds 1% of initial Contract Price, the Engineer shall adjust the rate to allow for the change, duly considering, a) Justification for rate adjustment as furnished by the contractor, b) Economies resulting from increase in quantities by way of reduced plant, equipment, and overhead costs. c) Entitlement of contractor to compensation events where such events are caused by any additional work. 39. 40. 38.2 The Engineer shall not adjust rates from changes in quantities if thereby the Initial Contract Price is exceeded by more than 15 per cent, except with the prior approval of the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam. 38.3 If requested by the Engineer, the Contractor shall provide the Engineer with a detailed cost break down of any rate in the Bill of Quantities. Variations 39.1 All Variations shall be included in updated Programmes produced by the Contractor. 39.2 The Engineer shall find out and evaluate all the probable variations in the early period of the contract and submit the same to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati - 3, Assam. Payments for Variations 40.1 The contractor shall provide the Engineer with a quotation (with break down of unit rates) for carrying out the Variation when requested to do so by the Engineer. The Engineer shall assess the quotation, which shall be given within seven days of the request or within any longer period stated by the Engineer and before the Variation is ordered. The Engineer shall send the rate so assessed to the Chief Engineer, P.W.D. (Bldg.), Assam for approval. 56 41. 40.2 If the work in the Variation corresponds with an item description in the Bill of Quantities and if, in the opinion of Engineer, the quantity of work above the limit stated in Sub Clause 38.1 or the; timing of its execution do not cause the cost per unit of quantity to change, the rate in the Bill of quantities shall be used to calculate the value of the Variation. If the Cost per unit of quantity changes, or if the nature or timing of the work in the Variation does not correspond with items in the Bill of Quantities, the quotation by the contractor shall be in the form of new rates for the relevant items of work.. 40.3 If the Contractor’s quotation is unreasonable, the Engineer may order the Variation and make a change to the Contract Price, which shall be based on Engineer’s own forecaster of the effects of the Variation on the contractor’s costs. 40.4 If the Engineer decides that the urgency of varying the work would prevent a quotation being given and considered without delaying the work, the Engineer shall allow the contractor to proceed with the work using materials having I.S. marks/ approved brand as specified in the A.P.W.D.S.O.R. obtained from approved dealers of the company. The Engineer shall collect the quotation for himself and assess the cost/ rate of the item considering all aspects and submit the same to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari,Guwahati-3, Assam for approval. 40.5 The contractor shall not be entitled to additional payment for costs, which could have been avoided by giving early warning. No claim of any kind will be entertained for delays in payments. Cash Flow Forecasts 41.1 42. When the Programme is updated, the contractor is to provide the Engineer with an updated cash flow forecast. Payment Certificates 42.1 The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer monthly statements of the estimated value of the work completed less the cumulative amount certified previously. 42.2 The Engineer shall check the Contractor’s monthly statement within 14 days and certify the amount to be paid to the contractor after taking into account any credit or debit for the month in question in respect of materials for the works in the relevant amounts and under conditions set forth in sub-clause 51(3) of the Contract Data (Secured advance). The payment will be made according to the availability of fund. 42.3 The value of work executed shall be determined by the Engineer. 42.4 The value of work executed shall comprise the value of the quantities of the items in the Bill of Quantities completed. 57 43. 44. 42.5 The value of work executed shall include the valuation of variations and Compensation Events. 42.6 The Engineer may exclude any item certified in a previous certificate or reduce the proportion of any item previously certified in any certificate in the light of later information. Payments 43.1 Payments shall be adjusted for deductions for advance payments, retention, other recoveries in terms of the contract and taxes at source, as applicable under the law. The Employer shall pay the Contractor the amounts certified by the Engineer within a reasonable time subject to the availability of fund. The Engineer/ Employer shall not delay the payment unreasonably (i.e., without valid reasons), if fund is available. 43.2 If an amount certified is increased in a later certificate as a result of an award by the Dispute Review Board, the contractor shall be paid interest upon the delayed payment as set out in this clause. Interest shall be calculated from the date upon which the increased amount would have been certified in the absence of dispute. The interest rate will be the Bank’s minimum lending rate prevailing at that time. 43.3 Items of the Works for which no rate or price has been entered in will not be paid for by the Employer and shall be deemed covered by other rates and prices in the contract. 43.4 Payments shall be made subject to availability of fund. The non-payment of bills due to non-availability of fund will not be a ground for compensation or any other claim whatsoever. Compensation Events 44.1 The following are Compensation Events unless they are caused by the contractor. a) The employer does not give access to a part of the Site by the site possession date stated in the contract Data. b) The Employer modifies the schedule of other contractors in a way, which affects the work of the contractor under the contract. c) Engineer orders a delay or does not issue drawings, specifications or instructions required for execution of works on time. d) The Deleted. e) The Engineer unreasonably does not approve of a subcontract to be let, within 15 days. f) Deleted. g) The Engineer gives an instruction for dealing with an unforeseen condition, caused by the Employer, or additional work required for safety or other reasons. h) Other contractors, public authorities, utilities or the Employer does not work within the dates and other constraints stated in the contract, and they cause 58 delay or extra cost to the contractor. i) Deleted. j) The effect on the contractor or any of the Employer’s risks. k) The Engineer unreasonably delays issuing a Certificate of Completion. l) 45. 44.2 If compensation Event would cause additional cost or would prevent the work being completed before the Intended Completion Time, the Date, the Contract price shall be increased and / or the Intended Completion Date is extended. The Engineer shall decide whether and by how much the Contract Price shall be extended. 44.3 As soon as information demonstrating the effect of each Compensation Event upon the contractor, it is to be assessed by the Engineer and the contract price shall be adjusted accordingly. If the Contractor’s forecast is deemed unreasonable the Engineer shall adjust the contract price based on Engineer’s own forecast. The Engineer will assume that the contractor will react competently and promptly to the event. 44.4 The Contractor shall not be entitled to compensation to the extend that the Employer’s interests are adversely affected by the Contractor not having given early warning or not having cooperated with the Engineer. Tax 45.1 46. The rates quoted by the contractor shall be deemed to be inclusive of the VAT, sales, labour cess and any other taxes that the Contractor will have to pay for the performance of this contract. The Employer will perform such duties in regard to the deduction of such taxes at source as per applicable law. Currencies 46.1 47. Other Compensation Events listed in the Contract Data or mentioned in the Contract. All payments shall be made in Indian rupees. Price Adjustment No price adjustment will be allowed during the contract period. 48. Retention 48.1 The Employer shall retain from each payment due to the contractor the proportion stated in the Contract Data until Completion of the whole of the Works. 48.2 On completion of whole of the Works half the total amount retained is repaid to the Contractor and half when the Defects Liability Period has passed and the Engineer has certified that all Defects notified by the Engineer to the Contractor before the end of this period have been corrected. 48.3 On completion of the whole works, the contractor may substitute retention money 59 with an “on demand” Bank guarantee. 49. Liquidated Damages 49.1 The Contractor shall pay liquidated damages to the Employer at the rate per day stated in the contract data for each day that the completion date is later than the intended completion date (for the whole of the works for the milestone as stated in the contract data). The total amount of liquidated damages shall not exceed the amount defined in the contract Data. The Employer may deduct liquidated damages from payments due to the Contractor. Payment of liquidated damages does not affect the Contractor’s liabilities. 49.2 If the Intended Completion Date is extended after liquidated damages have been paid, the Engineer shall correct any overpayment of liquidated damages by the contractor by adjusting the next payment certificate. The contractor shall be paid interest on the over payment calculated from the date of payment to the date of repayment at the rates specified in Sub Clause - 43.1. If the contractor fails to comply with the time for completion as stipulated in the bid, then the contractor shall pay to the employer the relevant sum stated in the contract data as liquidated damages for such default and not as penalty for everyday or part of day which elapse between relevant time for completion and the date stated in the taking over certificate of the whole of the works on the relevant sections, subject top the limit stated in the contract data. 49.3 The employer may without prejudice to any other method of recovery deduct the amount of such damages from any monies due or to decode due to the contractor. The payment or deduction of such damages shall not relieve the contractor from his obligation to complete the works on form any other of his obligations and liabilities under the contract. 49.4. If, before the Time for Completion of the whole of the Works or, if applicable, any Section, a Taking – Over Certificate has been issued for any part of the works or of a section, the liquidated damages for delay in completion of the remainder of the Works or of that Section shall, for any period of delay after the date stated in such Taking-Over Certificate, and in the absence of alternative provisions in the Contract, be reduced in the proportion which the value of the part so certified bears to the value of the whole of the Works or section, a applicable. The provisions of this SubClause shall only apply to the rate of liquidated damages and shall not affect the limit thereof. 50. Deleted 51. Advance Payment 51.1 The Employer shall make advance payment to the Contractor of the amounts stated in the contract Data by the date stated in the Contract Data. Interest will be charged 60 10% per annum on the advance payment. 51.2 Deleted. 51.3 Deleted. 51.4 Secured Advance The engineer shall certify and forward to the competent authority for advance payment in respect of materials intended for but not yet incorporated in the Works in accordance with the conditions stipulated in the Contract Data. 52. Securities 52.1. The Performance Security (including additional security for unbalanced bids) shall be provided to the Employer no later than the date specified in the Letter of Acceptance and shall be issued in an amount and form and by a bank or surety acceptable to the Employer, and denominated in Indian Rupees. The Performance Security shall be valid until a date 28 days from the date of expiry of Defects Liability Period and the additional security for unbalanced bids shall be valid until a date 28 days from the date of issue of the certificate of completion. 53. Deleted 54. Cost of Repairs 54.1. Loss or damage to the Works or Materials to be incorporated in the Works between the Start Date and the end of the Defects Correction periods shall be remedied by the Contractor at the Contractor’s cost if the loss or damage arises from the Contractor’s acts or omissions. E. 55. Completion 55.1. 56. The contractor shall request the Engineer to issue a Certificate of Completion of the Works and the Engineer will do so upon deciding that the Work is completed upto the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-charge and functional aspects of all items are tested to achieve its intended values. Taking Over 56.1. 57. FINISHING THE CONTRACT The employer shall take over the Site and the Works within seven days of the Engineer issuing a certificate of Completion. .Final Account 61 57.1. 58. 59. The Contractor shall supply to the Engineer a detailed account of the total amount that the contractor considers payable under the contract before that end of the Defects Liability Period. The engineer shall issue a Defect Liability Certificate and certify any final payment that is due to the Contractor within 56 days of receiving the contractor’s account if it is correct and complete. If it is not, the Engineer shall issue within 56 days a schedule that states the scope of the corrections or additions that are necessary. If the final Account is still unsatisfactory after it has been resubmitted, the Engineer shall decide on the amount payable to the contractor and issue a payment certificate, within 70 days of receiving the Contractor’s revised account. Operating and Maintenance Manuals 58.1. If “as built” drawings and/or operating and maintenance manuals are required, the Contractor shall supply them by the dates stated in the contract Data. 58.2. If the Contractor does not supply the Drawings and / or manuals by the dates stated in the Contract Data, or they do not receive the Engineer’s approval, the Engineer shall withhold the amount stated in the Contract Data from payments due to the Contractor. Termination 59.1. The Employer or the contractor may terminate the Contract if the other party causes a fundamental breach of the Contract. 59.2. Fundamental breaches of contract include, but shall not be limited to the following : a) The Contractor stops work for 28 days when no stoppage of work is shown on the current Programme and the stoppage has not been authorized by the Engineer. b) The Engineer instructs the Contractor to delay the progress of the Works and the instruction is not withdrawn within 28 days. c) The Employer or the contractor is made bankrupt or goes into liquidation other than for a reconstruction or amalgamation; d) A payment certified by the Engineer is not paid by the Employer to the Contractor within 90 days of the date of the Engineer’s certificate; e) The Engineer gives notice that failure to correct a particular Defect is a fundamental breach of Contract and the Contractor fails to correct it within a reasonable period of time determined by the Engineer; f) The contractor does not maintain a security, which is required; g) The Contractor has delayed the completion of works by the number of days for which the maximum amount of liquidated damages can be paid as defined in the Contract data; and 62 h) If the Contractor, in the judgment of the Employer has engaged in corrupt or fraudulent practices in competing for or in executing the contract. For the purpose of this paragraph: “corrupt practice means the offering, giving, receiving or soliciting of any thing of value to influence the action of a public official in the procurement process or in contract execution. “Fraudulent practice” means a misrepresentation of facts in order to establish bid prices at artificial noncompetitive levels and to deprive the Borrower, and includes collusive practice among Bidders (prior to or after bid submission designed to establish bid prices at artificial non-competitive levels and to deprive the Borrower of the benefits of free and open competition.” 60. 61. 59.3. When either party to the Contractor gives notice of a breach of contract to the Engineer for a cause other than those listed under Sub Clause 59.2 above, the Engineer shall decide whether the breach is fundamental or not. 59.4. Notwithstanding the above, the Employer may terminate the Contract for convenience. 59.5. If the contract is terminated the Contractor shall stop work immediately, make the Site safe and secure and leave the Site within a period of one month. Payment upon Termination 60.1. If the Contract is terminated because of a fundamental breach of Contract by the Contractor, the Engineer shall issue a certificate for the value of the work done less advance payments received up to the date of the issue of the certificate, less other recoveries due in terms of the contract, less taxes due to be deducted at source as per applicable law and less the percentage to apply to the work not completed as indicated in the Contract Data. Additional Liquidated Damages shall not apply. If the total amount due to the Employer exceeds any payment due to the Contractor the difference shall be a debt payable to the Employer. 60.2 If the contract is terminated at the Employer’s convenience or because of a fundamental breach of Contract by the Employer, the Engineer shall issue a certificate for the value of the work done, the cost of balance material brought by the contractor and available at site, the reasonable cost of removal of Equipment, repatriation of the Contractor’s personnel employed solely on the Works, and the Contractor’s costs of protecting and security the Works and less advance payments received up to the date of the certificate, less other recoveries due in terms of the contract and less taxes due to be deducted at source as per applicable law. Property 61.1 All materials on the Site, Plant, Equipment, Temporary Works and Works are deemed to be the property of the Employer, if the contract is terminated because of a Contractor’s default. 63 62. Release from Performance 62.1 If the contract is frustrated by the outbreak of war or by any other event entirely outside the control of either the employer or the contractor the Engineer shall certify that the contract has been frustrated. The contractor shall make the site safe and stop work as quickly as possible after receiving this certificate and shall be paid for all work carried out before receiving it and for any work carried out afterwards to which commitment was made. SPEICAL CONDITIONS OF CONTRACT (SCC) F. 1. GENERAL 1.1 In case of an irreconcilable conflict between general conditions of contract, special conditions of contract, scope of work, specifications, drawings, schedule of rates, prevail to the extent of such irreconcilable conflict in order of precedence. a) Detailed Letter of Award. b) Fax / Letter of intent c) Special conditions of contract. d) Scope of Work. e) Job / Particular specification. f) Drawings. g) Technical / Material specifications. h) General conditions of contract. j) Indian Standards. j) Other applicable standards. k) Assam Public Works Department (A.P.W.D) Specifications. 1.2 It will be Bidder’s responsibility to bring the notice of the Department any irreconcilable conflict in various parts of contract documents before starting the work(s), of making supply with reference to, which the conflict exists. 1.3 In absence of any specifications for any materials, design or work(s), the same shall be performed / supplied / executed in accordance with the instructions / directions of the engineer-in-charge, which will be binding on the contractor. 64 2. SITE INFORMATION 2.1. The Project site is situated at Dispur, Guwahati, Assam. 2.2 The intending bidder shall be deemed to have visited the site and familiarized themselves with site conditions before submitting their bids at their own cost and responsibility. 3 SCOPE OF WORK 3.1 The scope of work shall include inter-alias, the carrying out of any / all works, and providing any and all facilities, as required, for completing all the works as per terms and conditions of contract documents. 3.2 No materials shall be supplied by the Department. Bidder will have to procure all materials, Labour, T&P and any other arrangements for proper execution of the work and to be of the best quality and workmanship in all respect as per relevant I.S. code of practices and A.P.W.D. general specification. The lack of road communication during flood seasons will not be considered as a ground for extension of time of completion of the work and escalation of rates. 4. CEMENT 4.1 The Contractor will have to submit their design mix for different grades of concrete, keeping in view the requirements stipulated in specific gravity of materials brought to site as analyzed in the laboratories. The design shall be based upon absolute volume method and theoretical consumption of cement shall be worked on this basis. For other than concrete items, the coefficient for consumption of cement shall be adopted as per APWD practice and relevant IS Codes. Cement required for the work shall be procured by the Contractor only from manufacturer or their authorized dealer directly to ensure quality to their product. Cement of brand conforming to BIS specification only be used subject to the approval of Engineer-in-charge. Super plasticizer shall have to be used in all concreting works e.g. Choksey, Sika wherever required. 4.2. The Contractor shall maintain a goods store for storing cement. The flooring of the storage house, the clearance of cement bags from the sidewalls etc shall be a instructed by the Engineer-In-Charge or his authorized representatives.. 4.3. The cement store shall be open for supervision and verification by the Engineer-in-charge or his authorized representatives at any time when he feels the need to do so along with the Contractor’s representatives 5. REINFORCEMENT BARS 5.1. Reinforcement bars to be used should be in conformity with relevant IS code of Practice. 65 Steel reinforcement required for the work shall be procured from manufacture or their authorized dealer directly to ensure proper quality of steel. Super ductile T.M.T. Re-bars manufactured by SAIL / TATA can only be used. The Engineer-in-Charge shall conduct necessary tests as per codes of practice on all construction materials and maintain the test reports and submit the same to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. 6. TIME SCHEDULE 6.1. Time is the essence of the Contract. The work shall be executed strictly as per the TimeSchedule attached separately in the Bid document. 7. PROJECT SCHEDULING AND MONITORING 7.1 The following Schedules / documents / reports shall be prepared and submitted by the contractor for review / approval at various stages of the Contract. 8. ALONG WITH BID a) Time Schedule. The Bidder is required to submit a Project Time Schedule as stated in Clause along with the Bid. The Schedule shall cover all aspects like Planning, Designing, Execution, Sub-Ordering and Delivery, Sub-Contracting and within the completion time indicated in the bid Document. The Department interface activities shall be clearly identified with their latest required dates. Department reserves the right to disqualify the Bid if the above Schedule submitted by the Bidder is not in line with the over all Project requirements. b) Scheduling and Monitoring System The Bidder should describe their system of Project Scheduling and Monitoring the extent of Computerization Level of Detailing, Track Methodology etc. with the name of Computer Packages and sample outputs. 9. AFTER THE AWARD OF CONTRACT a) Overall Project Schedule The Contractor shall submit within 2 (Two) weeks of Letter of Intent, a sufficiently detailed overall Project schedule (in Prima Vera/ MS Project) indicating the inter relationship / inter dependence between various events and tasks. The project schedule will be reviewed and approved by the Department and the comments if any shall be incorporated in the network before issuing the same for implementation. The Project Schedule thus finalized shall form part of the Contract Document and the same shall not be revised without prior permission from the Department during the entire period of the contract. b) The contractor shall also submit one quality assurance plan and work programme showing completion of the work in Prima Vera/MS Project with events and tasks. 66 c) Progress Measurement Methodology The contractor is required to submit within two weeks of award of work, the methodology of progress measurement of planning, designing, execution., subordering and delivery, sub-contracting, and commissioning of works and the basis of computation of overall services / physical progress informed. Department reserves the right to modify the methodology in part or in full. d) 10. The Bidder should prepare detailed functional schedule in line with network for functional monitoring and control and submit scheduled progress curves for each function viz., Planning, Designing, Execution, Ordering, Delivery and Commissioning. PROJECT REVIEW MEETINGS The Bidder shall present the programme and status at various review meetings as required. A) Monthly Review Meeting : Level of Participation : i) Senior Officer PWD (Bldg.) Department. ii) The concerned Executive Engineer. iii) A deputed member (MLA or Minister) to be deputed by Speaker of the Assam Legislative Assembly. iv) The contractor or his authorized representatives. v) A representative from the Consultant’s organization. . Agenda : a) Progress status / statistics. b) Completion outlook. c) Major Hold Ups / Slippages. d) Assistance Required. e) Critical Issues. f) Depts. Query/Approval. g) Progress Updating. Venue : Office of the Chief Engineer, PWD(Bldg.), Chandmari, Guwahati-3 67 10.1 PROGRESS REPORTS This report shall be submitted on a monthly basis within ten calendar days from cut-off date as agreed upon, covering overall scenario of the work. The report shall include but not be limited, to the following : a) Brief Introduction of the Work. b) Activities Executed/ Achievements during the Month. c) Schedule v/s actual cumulative percentage progress and progress curves for subcontracting and overall and quantum wise status of purchase orders against schedule. d) Area of Concern/ Problem/ Hold Ups, Impact and action plans. e) Resources deployment status. f) Annexure giving summary for materials requirements and deliveries, sub-contracting and construction. 11. 12. PRICE SCHEDULE WITH PRICE BID 11.1 The rates of price bid shall be read in conjunction of special conditions of contract, General Conditions of contract, Scope of work, scope of supply, Technical specifications, drawings and any other document forming a part of this contract. 11.2. All expenses towards mobilization at site and demobilization including bringing in equipment, work force, materials, dismantling the equipment, clearing the site, etc. shall be deemed to be included in the rates quoted and no separate payment on account of such expenses shall be entertained. MOBILISATION ADVANCE LOAN 12.1 The contractor is entitled for an interest free advance loan for the cost of mobilization in respect of works in lump sum amount equivalent to 5% of Tender value payable in one installment. Payment of loan will be due under separate certification by the Engineer in charge after. a) Execution of form of agreement by the parties thereto. b) Providing by the Contractor 5% of Performance Security in accordance with bid clause. c) Providing by the contractor a non-revocable bank guarantee by a nationalized bank acceptable to the department in an amount equal to the mobilization advance loan. Such bank guarantee to remain effective until the advance loan has been completely repaid by the contractor out of current earning under the contract and certified by the Engineer-in-charge. A form of Bank Guarantee acceptable to the Dept. is indicated in Annexure-X for payment of mobilization advance loan as per this clause. 68 d) The mobilization advance loan shall be used by the contractor exclusively for mobilization expenditure in connection with the works, should the contractor misappropriate any portion of the advance loan, it shall become due and payable to the Chief Engineer, PWD (Building) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3, Assam immediately and no further loan will be made to the contractor thereafter. e) Repayment of Mobilization advance loan shall commence immediately after commencement of the work and shall be entered as a deduction in the first bill and subsequent interim payment certificate in equal installment until the total amount of advance loan has been repaid by the contractor. The entire amount shall be recovered before 75% of work completed, payment of mobilization advance by itself shall not be considered as first interim payment to contractor. Percentage of progress referred to shall be reckoned with reference to the gross value of work done as shown in bill. 13. PRICE ADJUSTMENT The rates and price quoted by the contractor shall be fixed for the duration of the contract and shall not be subjected to adjustment on any account. 14. MEASUREMENT OF WORK In addition to the provisions of Clause of the General Condition of Contract and associated provision thereof the following provisions shall applicable. 15. 14.1 Payment will be made on the basis of joint measurements, taken by contractor and certified by the Engineer-In-Charge. Measurement shall be based on drawings approved for construction to the extent that the work conforms to the drawings and details are adequate. 14.2 Wherever work is executed based on instruction of Engineer-In-Charge or details are not adequate in the drawings, physical measurement shall be taken by the contractor in the presence of authorized representatives of Engineer-In-Charge. 14.3 Measurement of weight shall be in Metric Tonnes/ Quintal, correct to the nearest kilogram, linear measurements shall be in meters, correct to the nearest centimeter. 14.4 Measurements shall be taken over finished surface in all cases. TERMS OF PAYMENT All interim payments to the contractor will be made by Engineer-In-Charge on the basis of price bid rates of as the case may be. The Department reserves the rights to alter the percentage breakup for price bid items rate submitted by the contractor were found reasonably and necessary, which shall be binding on contractor. 16. INCOME TAX 69 Income tax at the prevailing rate as applicable from time to time shall be deducted from the contractor’s bills as per Income Tax Act, and quoted rates shall be deemed to include the same. 17. TAXES, DUTIES AND OTHER LEVIES Without prejudice to stipulations in general conditions of contract, the bidder should quote prices inclusive of all taxes, duties, sales tax, VAT including A.G.S.T on works contract and all other levies. 18. LABOUR If the contractor is covered under the contractor labour (regulation and abolition) act he shall obtain a license from licensing authority (i.e. office of the labour commissioner, Govt. of Assam) by payment of necessary prescribed fees and deposit, if any, before starting the work under the contract. Such fee / deposit shall be borne by the contractor. The contractor shall, if required by the engineer, deliver to the engineer a return in detail, in such form and at such intervals as the engineer may prescribe , showing the staff and the numbers of the several classes of labour from time to time employed by the contractor on the site and such other information as the engineer may require. The contractor shall unless otherwise provided in the contract, make his own arrangements of the engagement of all staff and labour, local or other, and for their payment, housing , feeding and transport. 19. COMPLIANCE WITH LABOUR REGULATIONS During continuance of the contract, the contractor and his sub-contractors shall abide at all times by all existing labour enactments an rules made hereunder, regulations, notifications and bye laws of the State or Central Government or local authority and any other labour law (including rules), regulations, bye laws that may be passed or notification that may be issued under any labour law in future either by the state or the central government or the local authority. Salient features of some of the major labour laws that are applicable to construction authority. Salient features of some of the major labour laws that are applicable to construction industry are given below. The contractor shall keep the Employer indemnified in case any action is taken against the Employer by the competent authority on account of contravention of any of the provisions of any act or rules made there under, regulations or notifications including amendments. If the Employer is caused to pay or reimburse such amount as may be necessary to cause or observe, or for non-observance of the provisions stipulated in the notifications / bye laws / Acts/ Rules / regulations including amendments, if any, on the part of the contractor, the engineer/employer shall have the right to deduct any money due to the Contractor including his amount of performance security.The employer / engineer shall also have right to recover from the contractor any sum required or estimated to be required for making good the loss or damage suffered by the Employer. The employees of the contractor and the sub-contractor in no case shall be treated as the 70 employees of the Employer at any point of time. SALIENT FEATURES OF SOME MAJOR LABOUR LAWS APPLICABLE TO ESTABLISHMENTS ENGAGED IN BUILDING AND OTHER CONSTRUCTION WORK a) Workmen compensation Act 1973 : The Act provides for compensation in case of injury by accident arising out of and during the course of employment. b) Payment Gratuity Act 1972 : Gratuity payable to an employee under the Act on satisfaction of certain conditions on separation if an employee has completed 5 years service or more on death, the rate of 15 days wages for every completed year of service. The Act is applicable to all establishments employing 10 or more employee. c) Employees P.F. and Miscellaneous Provision Act 1952 : The Act provides for monthly contributions by the employer plus worker @ 10% or 8.33%. The benefits payable under the Act are : i) Pension or family pension on retirement or death, as the case may be. ii) Deposit linked insurance on the death in harness of the worker. iii) Payment of P.F. accumulation on retirement / death, etc. d) Maternity Benefit Act 1951 : The Act provides for leave and some other benefits to women employees in case of confinement or miscarriage etc. e) Contract Labour Regulation and Abolition Act 1970 : The Act provides for certain welfare measures to be provided by the Contractor to contract labour and in case the Contractor fails to provide , the same are required to be provided, by the principal Employer by law. The Principal Employer is required to take certificate of registration and the Contractor is required to take license from the designated Officer. The act is applicable to the establishments or contractor of Principal Employer, if they employ 20 or more contact labour. f) Minimum wages Act 1948 : The employer is supposed to pay not less than the minimum wages fixed by appropriate Government as per provision of the act, if the employment is a scheduled employment. Construction of Buildings, roads, and runways are scheduled employments. g) Payment of wages Act 1936 : It lays down as to by what date the wages are to be paid, when it will be paid and what deductions can be made from the wages of the workers h) Equal Remuneration Act 1979 : The Act provides for payment of equal wages for work nature to Male and Female employees in the matters of transfers, training and promotions etc. i) Payment of Bonus Act 1956 : The Act is applicable to all establishments employing 20 or more employees. The Act provides for payments of annual bonus subject to a minimum of 8.33% of wages and maximum of 20% of wages to employees drawing Rs. 3,500/- or less. The bonus to be paid to employees getting Rs.2500/- per month 71 or above up to Rs.3500/- per month shall be worked out by taking wages as Rs. 2,500/- per month only. The Act does not apply to certain establishments. Some of the State Governments have reduced the employment size from 20 to 10 for the purpose of applicability of this Act. j) Industrial Disputes Act : The Act lays down the machinery and procedure for resolution of industrial disputes, in what situations a strike or lock-out becomes illegal and what are the requirements for laying off or retrenching the employees or closing down the establishment. k) Industrial Employment (Standing Orders) Act 1946 : It is applicable to all establishments employing 100 or more workmen (employment size reduced by some of the states and central government to 50). The Act provides for laying down rules governing the conditions of employment by the Employer on matters provided in the Act and get the same certified by the designated Authority. l) Trade Union Act1926 :- The Act lays down the procedure for registration of trade unions of workmen and employers. The trade unions registered under the Act have been given certain immunities from civil and Criminal liabilities. m) Child Labour ( prohibition & Regulation ) Act 1986 : The Act prohibits employment of children below 14 years of age in certain occupations and processes and provides for regulation of employment in all other occupations and processes. Employment of Child Labour is prohibited in Building and Construction Industry. n) Inter-State Migrant workmen’s ( Regulation of Employment & Conditions of Service ) Act 1979 : The Act is applicable to an establishment, which employs 5, or more inter state migrant workmen through an intermediary (who has recruited workmen in one state of employment in the establishment situated in another state. The Inter State migrant workmen, in an establishment to which this Act becomes applicable, are required to be provided certain facilities such as housing, medical aid, traveling expenses from home up to the establishment and back etc. o) The Building and Other Construction workers ( Regulation of Employment and Conditions of Service ) Ct1996 and the Cess Act of 1996 :- All the Establishments who carry on any building or other construction work employs 10 or more workers are covered under this Act. All such establishments are required to pay cess at the rate not exceeding 2% of the cost of construction as may be modified by the Government . The employer of the establishment is required to provide safety measures at the Building or construction works and other welfare measures, such as Canteens, First Aid facilities, Ambulance, Housing accommodations for workers near the work place etc. The Employer to whom the Act applies has to obtain a registration certificate from the Registering Officer appointed by the Government. p) Factories Act 1948 : The Act lays down the procedure for approval of plans before setting up a factory, health and safety provisions, welfare provisions, working hours, annual earned leave and rendering information regarding accidents or dangerous occurrences to designated authorities. It is able to premises employing 10 persons or more with aid of power or 20 or more persons without aid of power engaged in manufacturing process. 72 20. ARBITRATION ( GCC Clause 25.3 ) This procedure for arbitration will be as follows : 21. a) In case of Dispute or difference arising between the Employer and the contractor relating to any matter arising out of or connected with this agreement, such disputes or difference shall be settled in accordance with the Arbitration and Conciliation Act, 1996. The Arbitral Tribunal consisting of 3 arbitrators, one each appointed by the Employer and the Contractor. The third arbitrator shall be chosen by the two Arbitrators so appointed by the parties to act as Presiding Arbitrator. In case of failure of the two arbitrators appointed by the parties to reach upon a consensus within a period of 30 days from the appointment of the arbitrator appointed subsequently, the Presiding Arbitrator shall be appointed by the Indian Council of Arbitration/President of the Institution of Engineers India)/ The International Centre for Alternative Dispute Resolution (India ). b) Deleted c) Deleted d) Arbitration proceedings shall be held in Guwahati, and the language of the Arbitration proceedings and that of all documents and communications between the parties shall be in English. e) The decision of majority of arbitrators shall be final and binding upon both parties. The cost and expenses of Arbitration proceedings will be paid as determined by the arbitral tribunal. However, the expenses incurred by each party in connection with the preparation, presentation etc. of its proceedings as also the fees expenses paid to the arbitrator appointed by such party or on its behalf shall be borne by its party itself. f) Performance under the contract shall continue during the arbitration proceedings and payments due to the contractor by the owners shall not be withheld, unless they are subject matter of the arbitration proceedings. JURISDICTION 21.1 22. In the event of court cases, Jurisdiction for Settlement of any disputes concerning this agreement shall be at the courts situated in Guwahati. STATUTORY APPROVALS 73 The approval from any authority required as per statutory rules and regulations of Central / State Government shall be the Contractor’s Responsibility unless otherwise specified in the bid document. The application of behalf of the Department for submission to relevant authorities along with copies of required certificates complete in all respects shall be prepared and submitted by the contractor well ahead of time so that the actual construction / commissioning of the works is not delayed for want of the approval /inspection by concerned authorities. The inspection of the works by the authorities shall be arranged by the contractor and necessary co-ordination of liaison work in this respect shall be the responsibility of the contractor. However, statutory fees paid , if any, for all inspections and approvals by such authorities shall be reimbursed at the actual y the department, to the contractor on production of the documentary evidence. In any fee is to be paid to A.S.E.B or Development Authority for any permission, then the payment will be made by firm and the same will be reimbursed by the department. Any Changes/ addition required to be made to meet the requirements of the statutory authorities shall be carried by the contractor free of charge. The inspection and acceptance of the work by statutory authorities shall however, not absolve the contractor from any of his responsibilities under this contract. 23. STANDARDS Materials shall be supplied in brand new conditions and work shall be carried out in conformity with specifications herein and Indian Standard Codes. The work shall also conform to the regulations laid down by the local authorities. Approval of statutory authorities for layout and other requirements must be obtained by the contractor before commencement of work. 24. WATER AND POWER Arrangement of water and electric power required by the contractor for the works shall be made by him at own cost. Department will however recommend to the State Electricity board for giving the connection and power to the contractor. However the Department will bear no responsibility in this respect. 25. LAND FOR RESIDENTIAL ACCOMODATION Contractor makes his own arrangement for the engagement of labour at site so far as the contract otherwise provide in respect of housing , feeding and payment thereof. 26. RECRUITMENT OF PERSONNEL The contractor shall not recruit any personnel of any category from those who are already employed by other agencies working within the state. 27. UTILISATION OF LOCAL RESOURCES 74 The contractor shall maximize the employment of local labour, skilled and /or unskilled, to the extent available. In case of any part or parts of the work is / are sub-contracted, the contractor shall ascertain availability of and endeavor to employ the local sub-contractors. The contractor shall, however, be responsible for maintaining quality of works and adherence to time schedule as per the requirements specified in the agreement. 28. COORDINATION WITH OTHER AGENCIES The work shall be carried out in such a manner that the work of other agencies working out at the site is not hampered due to any action of the contractor. The contractor will be responsible for ensuring proper co-ordination with other agencies. In the event of any dispute between the contractor and any other agency employed at or about then job site arising out of or related the performance of work, the decision of Engineer-In Charge shall be final and binding on the contractor. 29. URGENCY OF WORK The work being of very urgent nature it shall be carried out with all efforts by the contractor to complete it in all respects within the stipulated time of completion. The progress of the work as shown in work programme shall be continued, by the contractor even if any dispute arises between the contractor and the department on any matter connected with the work and contractor approaches legal authority for settlement of the dispute, on being not satisfied with the decision of the Deptt. on the matter of dispute. The continuation of progress of the work should not be hampered in any case by both parties and order given by legal authority on matter of dispute shall be binding on the parties. 30. REPORT OF ACCIDENTS The Contractor shall forthwith report of the occurrence of any accident at or about the site or in connection with the execution of the work, report in details such an accident to the Engineer-In-Charge and competent authority wherever such a report is required by law. 31. ROLE OF ARCHITECT / CONSULTANT REPRESENTATIVE : 31.1 Duties & Powers : The duties of the Architect's/consultant’s Representative are to watch and supervise the works periodically and to test and examine any materials to be used or workmanship employed in connection with the works. He shall have no authority to relieve the Contractor of any of his duties of obligations under the contract or except as expressly provided hereunder or elsewhere in the contract, to order any work involving delay or any extra payment by the Employer nor to make any variation of or in the works. The representative of the consultant shall examine the various works at site during execution, so that the vision of the consultant is reflected. 31.2 Delegation of architect’s/ consultant’s Power : The Architect/consultants may from time to time in writing delegate to the 75 Architect'/consultant’s Representative any of the powers and authorities vested in the Architect. Any written instruction of approval given by the Architect'/consultant’s Representative to the Contractor within the terms of such delegation [but not otherwise] shall bind the Contractor and the Employer as though it had been given by the Architect/consultant. Provided always as follows :a) Failure of the Architect'/consultant’s Representative to disapprove any work or materials shall not prejudice the power of the Architect/consultant thereafter to disapprove such work or materials and to order the pulling down removal or breaking up thereof at no additional cost to the Employer may be added. b) If the Contractor shall be dissatisfied by reason of any decision of the Architect'/consultant’s Representative he shall be entitled to refer the matter to the Architect/consultant who shall thereupon confirm, reverse or vary such decision. 76 SPECIAL CONDITIONS FOR AUDIO VISUAL SYSTEM, IBMS, ACCESS CONTROL SYSTEM, IPTV AND TELEPHONE NETWORKING SYSTEM, FIRE ALARM SYSTEM, SECURITY AND SURVEILLANCE SYSTEM AND ACCESS CONTROL SYSTEM ETC. 77 SPECIAL CONDITIONS FOR AUDIO VISUAL SYSTEM, IBMS, ACCESS CONTROL SYSTEM, IPTV AND TELEPHONE NETWORKING SYSTEM, FIRE ALARM SYSTEM, SECURITY AND SURVEILLANCE SYSTEM AND ACCESS CONTROL SYSTEM ETC. 1.GENERAL These special conditions are intended to amplify the General Conditions of Contract, and shall be read in conjunction with the same. For any discrepancies between the General Conditions and Special Conditions, the more stringent shall apply. The tender consists of the following sections: a.Building Automation Management System b.Fire Alarm System. c.Public Address system d.Security and Surveillance System CCTV System Access Control System Intrusion Alarm System e.IPT/Net working System. f. Audio Video System. This tender shall act as a guide to the type of system desired for the project. The specifications described in this tender are as per the ‘Basis of Design’ and are the minimum required from the tenderer. The features offered over and above those mentioned in the tender shall be given due credit. In the event of any discrepancy between the input/output summary and the schedule of quantities, the input/output summary shall have precedence. The basic architecture of the system shall be as described here in the tender and the detail engineering based on this shall be carried out by the Integrated Building Management System Contractor after the award of work. The tenderer shall work out the number of controllers required and mark their tentative position on the drawings along with their model numbers, at the time of submission of tender. The tenderer shall also mark any system integration unit, gateway or interface unit required for their proposed system architecture. The final number of controllers and their relative position shall be decided in consultation with the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge, representative and their decision in this regard shall be final and binding. Standard literature, not complying to the format and requirement of this tender, submitted by the contractor, shall not be considered or evaluated. 78 2.SCOPE OF WORK The general character and the scope of work to be carried out under this contract is illustrated in input/output summary, Specifications and Schedule of Quantities. The Contractor shall execute the said work as per the terms & condition set out in the tender documents and in conformity with the specifications laid down. The contractor shall furnish all labour, materials and equipment, transportation and incidentals necessary for supply, installation, testing and commissioning of the complete Integrated Building Management and other allied system as described in the tender document. This also includes any material, equipment, appliances and incidental work not specifically mentioned herein or noted on the Drawings/Documents as being furnished (or installed), but which are necessary and customary to complete the installation. Contractor should employ an expert and specialized agency who has sound experience in this field and have successfully completed similar type of projects. Before employing the expert agency contractor should submit the credentials of the proposed subcontractor to the Engineer-in-charge and obtain this approval. Subcontractors’ workmen, technicians should also be certified trained personnel from equipment manufacturers. In general, the work to be performed under this contract shall comprise/include the following : 2.1Building Automation System a. The contractor shall supply, install, test, commission and maintain the Building Automation System (BAS) including provision of all necessary hardware, software and relevant spares. Tenant Billing software along with BTU meters for Multitenant Buildings shall also be included in the scope. b. The IBMS Contractor shall provide all interface components for automation system including, sensors, transducers etc. to interface with other mechanical & electrical equipment unless specified otherwise in this contract. Normally, the dry contacts shall be made available, but in the event of these not being available, the BAS contractor may be required to provide the necessary paraphernalia. The terminations in the other services panels shall be in scope of respective services contractors. c. It shall be the responsibility of BAS contractor to perform all checks on wiring, sensor and actuator mounting for trouble-free operation of the equipment. d. It shall be responsibility of BAS contractor to in close coordination with services contractor so that desired results are obtained along with complete monitoring of various systems. e. Cables for the integration of the system shall run in separate ……..(MS/GI) conduits to be provided and installed by the contractor. f. Proper operation and maintenance of the system shall be responsibility of the contractor and shall include debugging and calibration of each component in the entire system. Maintenance Software package also should be included in the scope. IBMS contractor should obtain all technical details of each equipment which are being controlled/ monitored and programme the maintenance software as per the manufacturer’s recommendations. 79 g. No claim for extra items shall be entertained for installation / commissioning of the system. All works in connection with completion of the system shall be in scope of this tender. The tenderer shall take into its scope, price for all works and approvals in connection with installation of the BAS System from government as well as statutory bodies. Besides the above, general scope of work shall also include the following : a. Supply of all shop drawings produced using latest editing of Computer Aided Design (CAD) and drafting package. b.Supply and installation of all necessary BAS control and monitoring outstations. c. Supply and installation of all BAS field controls cabling including local area networks. d. Supply and installation of field interface cabling between all equipment and the BAS System. e. Identification of all field cabling from the motor control panels at both ends of each core, and in junction boxes using the same numbering as used for associated outgoing enclosure terminal. f. Supply and installation of controls for temperature, humidity and pressure detectors, thermostats, flow switches and differential pressure switches, etc. associated with the BAS. g. Ensure all control devices are positioned such that maximum stability of control for each system can be achieved. h. Supply and fitting of necessary clips, hangers and supports for all averaging element detectors and for serpentine them across the ducts. i. G.I trunking/ G.I Trays with GI supports wherever more than 3 Nos. conduits/cables are to be terminated at any point. More than 3 Nos. Armoured cables should not be saddled directly in to wall /ceiling and cable tray/trunking should be used for the same. j. Supply and installation of valves and valve actuators associated with the BAS. k. Supply a 2-dimensional schematic and information page graphic for all systems controlled by or monitored on the BAS. Allowance shall be made for any necessary site modifications in graphics to incorporate any revised locations, presentation of dynamic information and Architect / Consultants / Engineer-in-charge’s comments. l. Supply and fit an engraved “traffolite” label for all controls items, equipment and plant associated with the control system, incorporating the appropriate controller and regulator identification reference number as detailed on the Motor Control Panel Equipment Schedules. All labels shall be fixed with bright finish instrument head screws or plastic flat header push-in rivets of the same colour as the label. Where no flat surfaces are available on valves, labels shall be hung from brass chains. m. Fine tune all temperature, humidity and pressure control loops with a suitable building load. If necessary, an artificial building load shall be generated by the Engineer. n. Provide documentary evidence to the Architect/ Engineer-in-charge prior to offering the system for testing & commissioning. 80 2.2Fire Detection & Alarm System a. The contractor shall supply, install, test, commission and maintain the Fire Alarm System (FAS) including provision of all necessary hardware, software and relevant spares. b. The FAS contractor shall provide all interface components to interface with other mechanical & electrical equipment unless otherwise specified in this contract. The dry contacts shall be made available. c. It shall be the responsibility of FAS contractor to perform all checks on wiring for troublefree operation of the System. d. Proper operation and maintenance of the system shall be responsibility of the contractor and shall include debugging and proper calibration of each component in the entire system. e. No claim for extra items shall be entertained for installation / commissioning of the system. All works in connection with completion of the system shall be in scope of this tender. The tenderer shall take into its scope, price for all works and approvals in connection with installation of the FAS System. f.All necessary Audio interface cards shall be supplied along with the FAS panel for emergency voice evacuation message incase of fire through P A speakers. g.External box with minimum 2 Hour fire rated to be supplied along with PA.Speaker for wall / ceiling mounting application. Besides the above, general scope of work shall also include the following : a. Supply of all drawings produced using latest editing of Computer Aided Design (CAD) and drafting package. b.Supply and installation of all necessary FAS control and monitoring outstations. c. Supply and installation of all FAS field controls cabling including local area networks. d. Supply and installation of field interface cabling between all equipment and the FAS System. e. Supply and fitting of necessary clips, hangers and supports for all detectors. f. Supply a 2-dimensional schematic and information page graphic for all systems controlled by or monitored on the FAS. Allowance shall be made for any necessary site modifications to graphics to incorporate any revised locations, presentation of dynamic information and Architect / Consultants / Owner’s site representatives comments. 3.QUALITY ASSURANCE PLAN 81 The system shall be installed by competent technicians & workers, approved by the manufacturer/supplier of the control equipment. The successful contractor shall furnish a list of workers/ technicians approved by the manufacturer/ supplier of the system prior to commencement of work. The complete IBMS installation shall be in strict accordance with the national and local electrical codes. Contractor shall ensure that software used, shall carry a certificate from the supplier and shall be original software procured for this particular project. This is to ensure that the Owner is provided with regular updated revisions. All third party software shall also be the original version. All system components shall be designed and manufactured to the following fault tolerances: a. All components shall withstand and give satisfactory operation without damage at 110% and 90% of rated voltage and at ± 3 Hertz variation in line frequency. b. All inputs and outputs shall have static and short circuit protection. c. Communication lines shall be protected against static, transient and induced magnetic interference. d. Bus connected devices shall be A.C. coupled or equivalent, and single shall not disrupt bus communication in any way. device failure 4.PROJECT EXECUTION AND MANAGEMENT : One senior planning and erection personnel from the organization with whom the contractor has technical collaboration shall be assigned to the project. He shall have a minimum of 5 years experience in this type of installation and shall be required to be present on site as and when desired by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge during the initial stage of the project and full time during the final stage. The final stage of the project shall be identified by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge. The Contractor shall also assign to the project a Senior Manager who shall be assisted by a minimum of one erection engineer & one supervisor. The project execution shall be carried out using modern techniques. All senior site managers shall be provided with mobile communication means. The contractor shall also ensure that all the design work and shop drawings for the project are made in co-ordination and complete knowledge of their principal organization. All the shop drawings for the project and design calculations etc. shall be certified by senior planning and erection personnel assigned for the project from the principal organization, before being presented to the Architect/Consultant/ Engineer-in-charge for their approval. If any change are made in drawings the certified revision shall be again submitted. 82 5.BYE-LAWS AND REGULATIONS : The installation shall be in conformity with the Bye-laws, Regulations and Standards of the local authorities concerned, in so far as these become applicable to the installation. Any Modifications if suggested by local security agencies like Police or intelligence authorities must be incorporated in the system. Following codes shall be referred while finalizing the scheme : A.National Fire Protection Association (NFPA) - USA : 1.No. 70-90 or 70-93National Electric Code (NEC) 2.No. 72-1993National Fire Alarm Code 3.No. 101-91Life Safety Code B.Underwriters laboratories Inc. (UL) - USA : 1.UL 50 Cabinets and Boxes 2.UL 268 Smoke Detectors for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 3.UL 864 Control Units for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 4.UL 268A Smoke Detectors for Duct Applications 5.UL 521 Thermal Detectors for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 6.UL 228 Door Closers-Holders for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 7.UL 464 Audible Signaling Appliances 8.UL 38 Manually Activated Signaling Boxes 9.UL 346 Water flow Indicators for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 10.UL 1481 Power Supplies for Fire Protective Signaling Systems 11.UL 1076 Proprietary Burglar Alarm Units and Systems 12.UL 1971 Visual Notification Appliances Equivalent European standards shall be acceptable in lieu of UL standards. C.ANSI A17.1 Safety Code for Elevators and Escalators D.National Building Code 6.APPROVALS & CLEARANCES The contractor shall obtain all permits / licenses and pay for any all fees required for the inspection, approval and commissioning of their installation. 83 7.DRAWINGS The IBMS Drawings are to be prepared by the expert agency and to be enclosed with tender and give arrangement of various systems and the extent of work covered in the system. These Drawings indicate the arrangement of equipments, highlight various services and broadly suggest the routes to be followed. Under no circumstances shall dimensions be scaled from these Drawings. The contractor shall follow the proposal drawings in preparation of his shop drawings, and for subsequent installation work after the approval of the Architect / Consultant / Owner’s Site representative . He shall check the drawings of other services to verify spaces in which his work will be installed. The shop drawings prepared by IBMS Contractor shall clearly show equipment size, configuration, capacity & location. Maximum headroom and space conditions shall be maintained at all points. Where headroom appears inadequate, the contractor shall notify the Architect / Consultant / Owner’s Engineer-incharge and take approval before proceeding with the installation. The contractor shall examine all architectural, structural, HVAC, plumbing, electrical and other services drawings before starting the work, and shall report to the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge any discrepancy and obtain clarification. Any changes found essential to co-ordinate installation of this work with other services and trades, shall be made with prior approval of the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge and without additional cost to the Owner. The data given in the drawings and specifications is for contractor’s guidance only. 8.ACCESSIBILITY The contractor shall confirm adequacy of the size of the openings and clearances for proper installation of his equipment. The contractor shall locate all equipments which must be serviced, operated or maintained, in fully accessible positions. The exact location and size of all access panels, required for each concealed control equipment, valve or other devices, shall be finalized and got approved from Engineer well in advance of the site installation. 9.SHOP DRAWINGS a. All the shop drawings shall be prepared on computer and on a system compatible with the kind of system being followed by the Architect . Within four weeks after the award of the contract, the Contractor shall furnish, for the approval of the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge two sets of detailed shop drawings of all controllers and sensors layouts for Plant room, AHU rooms, fan rooms, cooling towers, ventilation fans; ducting drawings showing exact location of sensors; piping drawings showing exact location of supports, valves, fittings, etc; electrical panels drawings with inside/outside views, power and control wiring schematics, cable trays, supports and terminations. Fire alarm & security system if indicated in BOQ shall also be shown & coordinated with various other services in the shop drawings. These shop drawings shall contain all information required to complete the Project as per specifications and as required by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge. These drawings shall contain details of construction, size, arrangement, operating 84 clearances, performance characteristics and capacity of all items of equipment, also the details of all related items of work by other contractors. Each shop drawing shall contain tabulation of all measurable items of equipment/ materials/ works and progressive cumulative totals from other related drawings to arrive at a variation-in-quantity statement at the completion of all shop drawings. Each item of equipment /material proposed shall be a standard catalogue product of an established manufacturer strictly from the approved list of the manufacturers listed in the tender. When the Architect/Consultant/ Engineer-in-charge makes any amendments in the above drawings, the contractor shall supply two fresh sets of drawings with the amendments duly incorporated, alongwith the drawings on which corrections were indicated. After final approval is obtained from the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-incharge the contractor shall submit further twelve sets of shop drawings to the Architect /Consultant / Engineer-in-charge for the exclusive use by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge and other contracting agencies. No material or equipment may be delivered or installed at the job site until the contractor has in his possession, approved shop drawings for the particular material/ equipment installation. b. Shop drawing submittals to include sufficient data to indicate complete compliance with Contract Documents. Submissions in form of drawings, brochures, bulletins, catalog data, and/or narrative descriptions. As a minimum requirement submit: 1. Symbol and abbreviation lists. 2. System block diagram showing quantity and location of Operator’s Work Station (OWS), printer and all Work Station Equipment, DDCPs, Field Equipment Panels, physical communication cable routing between system components, sources for all power to each device (other than final control devices) and coordinated location of all major system components. 3. Network riser and communication map indicating all network resident devises (OWS, DDCP controllers, intelligent sensors & actuators, routers, repeaters, gateways, connectivity to packaged systems, etc. 4. A network map clearly depicting the actual routing of all network wiring and location of all network resident devices. 5. Control diagrams for all systems controlled, including panel layouts and internal wiring details. Controls shall be shown on system flow diagrams, with sources of power for each device. Arrange all sub systems on the same set or series of drawings. Include associated wiring diagrams, bills of material, and DDC panel wiring and mounting details in the same section. It is the intent of this requirement that it is not necessary to page through the submittal to locate associated sub systems. 6. Interfaces (software and hardware) with equipment provided in other sections of specifications. Show connection details based upon the approved submittals of the equipment being interfaced with. Comment such as “information to be completed with As Built Documentation” will not be acceptable. 7. Narrative description of operation for each system, enumerating and describing the function of each component. Include alarm and emergency sequences, and equipment interlocks. 85 8. Description of manual override capabilities. 9. Complete input output point schedule. Identify point function, type and location. 10. Spare capacity provisions. 11. Detailed bill of materials. 12. Valve and Damper Schedule: Provide identification numbers, location, system, dimensions and performance data. Damper schedule shall be based upon approved sheet metal shop drawings. Schedule shall show damper leakage rates. Valve sizing shall be based on approved equipment cut sheets and approved piping shop drawings. 13. Device mounting details. Include as a minimum : i. Sensing elements in ducts or casings. ii.Sensing elements in piping. iii. Variable volume inlet vane damper operator. 14. Ladder wiring diagrams. 15. Data maps for network integrated components, indicating parameters and data being shared amongst systems. 16. Other information as requested herein. 17. Complete full size drawings, 11 in. x 17 in. minimum. Each system shall be submitted separately. Do not submit “typical” system as one drawing unless the systems depicted are identical with the exception of DDCP point addresses. In such cases, provide a schedule on the drawing with rows and columns for each device in each system detailing part numbers, point addresses, etc. 18. Programming i.Point identification code. ii.System advisory messages, printouts, logging formats. iii.Drawings of system graphics showing monitored points. iv.Software flow charts for application and DDCP programs. v. Person machine interface program, include annunciation, logs and programming capabilities. commands, alarm vi. Listing of all alarm messages (with their text) to be programmed for each alarm specified. Messages shall require system operator’s or owner’s representative’s approval. vii. Description of system operation under failure conditions, including restart sequences and hierarchy for all systems. 19. Samples i. Thermostats, temperature sensors, Humidistat and humidity sensors. ii. All devices mounted on finished surfaces. 20. Quality Control Submittals 86 i. U.L., FM, CSA listing compliance certificates. ii. Final calibration, commissioning and testing reports. c. Shop drawings shall be submitted for approval sufficiently in advance of planned delivery and installation of any materials to allow Architect / Consultant / Engineer-incharge ample time for scrutiny. No claims for extension of time shall be entertained because of any delay in the work due to his failure to produce shop drawings at the right time, in accordance with the approved program. d. Manufactures drawings, catalogues, pamphlets and other documents submitted for approval shall be in two sets. Each item in each set shall be properly labeled, indicating the specific services for which material or equipment is to be used, giving reference to the governing section and clause number and clearly identifying in ink the items and the operating characteristics. Data of general nature shall not be accepted. e. Approval of shop drawings shall not be considered as a guarantee of measurements or of building dimensions. Where drawings are approved, said approval does not mean that the drawings supersede the contract requirements, nor does it in any way relieve the contractor of the responsibility or requirement to furnish material and perform work as required by the contract. f. Where the contractor proposes to use an item of equipment, other than that specified or detailed on the drawings, which requires any re-design of any part of the mechanical, electrical or architectural layouts; all such re-design, and all new drawings and detailing required thereof, shall be prepared by the contractor at his own expense and gotten approved by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge Where the work of the contractor has to be installed in close proximity to, or will interfere with work of other trades, he shall assist in working out space conditions to make a satisfactory adjustment. If so directed by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge, the contractor shall prepare composite working drawings and sections at a suitable scale not less than 1:50, clearly showing how his work is to be installed in relation to the work of other trades. If the contractor installs his work before coordinating with other trades, or so as to cause any interference with work of other trades, he shall make all the necessary changes without extra cost to the Owner. g. h. Within four weeks of approval of all the relevant shop drawings, the contractor shall submit four copies of a comprehensive variation in quantity statement, and itemized price list of recommended (by manufacturers) imported and local spare parts and tools covering all equipment and materials in this contract. The Architect / Consultant/ Engineer-in-charge shall make recommendation to Owner for acceptance of anticipated variation in contract amounts and also advise Owner to initiate action for procurement of spare parts and tools at the completion of project. 10.ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION : The electrical work related to Integrated Building Management System works in various panels, shall be carried out in full knowledge of, and with the complete co-ordination of the respective services contractor. Such electrical work shall be in total conformity with the control wiring drawings prepared by the respective contractor and approved by the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge. All equipment other than those in the scope of this 87 tender shall be connected and tested in the presence of an authorized representative of the respective contractor, whose equipment is being tested. The Architect / Consultant / Owner’s site representative decision shall be binding on all parties in case of any dispute. 11.MATERIAL AND EQUIPMENT All materials and equipment shall conform to the relevant Standards and shall be of the approved make listed in Appendix II. Deviation , if any will be highlighted by the tenderer at the time of submission of tenders. 12.MANUFACTURERS INSTRUCTIONS : Specific instructions, from manufacturers of the materials and equipment used in this project, and not specifically mentioned in these documents, shall be followed in all cases. 13.INSTALLATION 1. The electrical work related to automation system, in various panels, shall be carried out by the IBMS Contractor, in full knowledge of, and with the complete co-ordination of the respective services contractor. Such electrical work shall be in total conformity with the control wiring drawings prepared by the respective services contractor and approved by the Architect / Consultant /Engineer-in-charge . All equipment other than those in the scope of this tender, shall be connected and tested in the presence of an authorized representative of the respective contractor. The decision by Architect / Consultant / Owner’s site representative shall be binding on all parties, in case of dispute. 2. All wiring and conduiting shall be properly supported. Cable routing must be approved by Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge before being installed. All field wiring shall run parallel to or at right angles to the walls. Wiring running within enclosures shall be neatly clamped and anchored. 3. Loading of all the computer programs and data files including control programs, initial parameters, settings, English descriptors etc shall be the responsibility of the IBMS Contractor. 14.TESTING : The installed system shall be tested as per relevant codes as applicable. The results for these shall be submitted in quadruplicate for scrutiny. The contractor shall pay for and arrange, without any extra cost to the Owner, all necessary testing equipment, instruments, materials, accessories, and the requisite labour. Any defects in materials and / or in workmanship detected in the course of testing shall be rectified by the contractor, entirely at his own cost, to the satisfaction of the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge. 14.1Building Automation System 88 For every analog input point tested, the system shall be capable of simulating any value of input, independent of the actual field condition. This shall be accomplished either through software or a discrete field mounted potentiometer for each analog input. For every digital input point tested, the system shall be capable of simulating either an open or closed status, independent of the actual field condition. This shall be accomplished either through software or a discrete field mounted input switch for each digital input. Handover acceptance procedures shall include but not be restricted to the following : Display and printout of all points Verification for control for all output points Concurrent point history of all points Display of all graphic screens including historical and Real time graphs for all analog points 14.2Fire Detection & Alarm System Each circuit in the fire alarm system shall be tested in accordance with the requirements of NFPA 72 Guide for Testing Procedures for Local, Auxiliary, Remote Station, and Proprietary Protective Signaling Systems. Each smoke detector shall be tested in accordance with the requirements of NFPA 72. The Integrated Building Management System (IBMS) shall be commissioned only after the contractor has certified in writing that the electrical installation work for automation services has been thoroughly checked, tested and found to be totally satisfactory and in full conformity with the approved shop drawings, specifications and manufacturers instructions. It is to be clearly understood that the final responsibility for the sufficiency, adequacy and conformity to the contract requirements, of the electrical installation work relating to IBMS interaction, lies solely with the BAS contractor in so far as the functioning of the IBMS system is concerned. 15.ACCEPTANCE TESTING As part of Acceptance Testing, following shall be submitted as minimum by the contractor: a. Submit a detailed acceptance test procedure designed to demonstrate compliance with contract requirements at least 4 weeks before the start of testing. This procedure to be approved prior to the start of the testing. b. During acceptance testing provide services of a fully qualified building automation technician who is knowledgeable of the project. c. Using the commissioning test data the Owner / Engineer-in-charge shall select, at random, functions to be demonstrated. These functions shall be demonstrated by the Contractor in accordance with the acceptance test procedure. At least 15 percent of the systems functions as selected by the Owner, or engineer shall be demonstrated. At least 95% of the functions demonstrated must perform as specified and documented on commissioning data sheets or the system must be retested. 89 d. Furnish instruments required for testing. Submit catalog data on all instruments for approval prior to performance of tests. Instrument Accuracy Temperature: ¼°F or 1/2% of full scale, whichever is less Pressure: ½% PSI or 1/2% of full scale, whichever is less Humidity: 2% RH Electrical: ¼° of full scale e. After the above acceptance tests are complete and the system is demonstrated to be functioning as specified, a thirty-day endurance test period shall begin. If the system functions as specified throughout the endurance test period requiring only routine maintenance and adjustment, the system shall be accepted. If during the endurance test period the system fails to perform as specified and cannot be corrected within eight hours, the Owner may request that the endurance tests be repeated after problems have been corrected. 16.COMMISSIONING The contractor shall indicate to the Architect / Consultants / Engineer-in-charge his readiness for commissioning of the system and shall commission the system only upon obtaining written approval for the same. Upon completion, devices subject to manual operation shall be operated in presence of Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge to demonstrate satisfactory operation. 17. CALIBRATION AND COMMISSIONING As part of Calibration & Commissioning exercise, contractor shall be required to carry out the following: a. Perform a three-phase commissioning procedure consisting of field I/O calibration and commissioning, system commissioning and integrated system program commissioning. Document all commissioning information on commissioning data sheets that shall be submitted prior to acceptance testing. Notify the Owner in writing of the testing schedule so that operating personnel may observe calibration and commissioning. b. Field I/O Calibration and Commissioning c. Prior to system program commissioning, verify that each control panel has been installed according to the shop drawings and test, calibrate, and bring on-line each control device. Commissioning to include but not be limited to: i. Sensor accuracy at 10, 50 and 90% of range. ii. Sensor range. iii. Verify analog limit and binary alarm reporting. iv. Point value reporting. v. Binary alarm and switch settings. vi. Actuator spring ranges. vii. Failsafe position on loss of control signal or electric supply. 90 e. Record calibration and test data on commissioning data sheets and submit. Data sheets shall include the device designation, the date of commissioning and the name of person who performed commissioning. f. Fan Speed Control With Out Air Flow Sensors g. The BMCS Contractor shall work closely with the Balancing Contractor to setup fan tracking per the following procedure. i. With return fan at minimum speed, set supply fan to produce volume equal to system differential. Record SF output signal. ii. Increase supply fan output signal 20% and raise return fan speed until differential is once again obtained. Record return fan output signal. iii. Continue this procedure until the supply fan is at full speed. Set all values in a look-up table so fans will track accordingly. iv. Vary the speed of the supply fan and verify fans are tracking with the proper differential. h. System Program Commissioning After control devices have been commissioned, each DDCP program shall be put on-line and commissioned. The contractor shall confirm that the DDCP program logic follows the approved software flow chart and sequence of operation. Each control loop shall be adjusted to provide stable control and control within the specified accuracies. System program test results and loop adjustments shall be recorded on commissioning data sheets and submitted. i. Integrated System Commissioning After all DDCP programs have been commissioned, the contractor shall verify the overall system performs as specified. Tests shall include but not be limited to: i. Data communication, both normal and failure modes ii. Fully loaded system response time iii. Impact of component failures on system operation iv. Time/date changes v. End of month/end of year operation vi. Global application programs vii. System backup and reloading viii. System status displays ix. Diagnostics x. Power fail/restart xi. Battery backup xii. Non-DDC Subsystems xiii. Subsystems not controlled by DDC shall also be tested and commissioned 18.COMPLETION CERTIFICATES 91 On completion of the installation, a certificate shall be furnished by the contractor, counter signed by the licensed supervisor, under whose direct supervision the installation was carried out. This certificate shall be in the prescribed form as required by the local authority. The contractor shall be responsible for getting the entire installation duly approved by the authorities concerned as required, and shall bear all expenses in connection with the same. However, any receipted fees paid shall be reimbursed by the Owner on production of proof of payment. 19.COMPLETION DRAWINGS On completion of the work in all respects, the contractor shall supply two sets of CDs and four portfolios (300x450mm) each, containing complete set of “As Built Drawings” on approved scale. These drawings shall clearly indicate system architecture with complete equipment layout, location of wiring and sequencing of automatic controls. Each portfolio shall also contain consolidated control diagrams and technical literature of the entire system. 20.OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS & MAINTENANCE MANUAL : The Contractor shall submit a draft copy of comprehensive operating instructions & maintenance schedule for all systems and equipment included in this contract. Upon approval of the draft, the contractor shall submit four (4) complete bound sets of printed operating instructions and maintenance manuals. The contractor shall also submit a preventive maintenance schedule for the hardware components supplied and flowchart of each DDC program showing interrelationship between inputs, PID functions, other functions, outputs etc. 21.OWNER’S MANUALS The Operation & Maintenance Manuals shall contain the following A. General 1. Submit 2 draft copies of owner's manuals for review. After review by authorized representative, the contractor shall incorporate review comments and submit 6 final copies. 2. Update manuals with modifications made to system during guarantee period. Provide replacement pages or supplements in quantity stated above. 3. Assemble owner's manuals into multi-volume sets as necessary and required by the Owner. 4. Protect each volume with a heavy-duty vinyl plastic binder. Volumes to have plastic printed dividers between major sections and have oversized binders to accommodate up to ½ inch thick set of additional information. 92 B. 5. Each binder to be silk-screened with project name and volume title on front cover and binder. 6. On the first page of each manual identify with project name, manual title, owner's name, engineer's name, contractor's name, address and service phone number, and person who prepared manual. Operating manual to serve as training and reference manual for all aspects of day-to-day operation of the system. As a minimum include the following: 1. Control flow diagrams. 2. Sequence of operation for automatic and manual operating modes. The sequences shall cross-reference the system point names. 3. Description of manual override operation of control points. 4. System manufacturer's complete operating manuals. C. Provide maintenance manual to serve as training and reference manual for all aspects of day-to-day maintenance and major system repairs. As a minimum include the following: 1. Complete as-built installation drawings for each system. 2. Overall system electrical power supply scheme indicating source of electrical power for each system component. Indicate which components are on emergency power and indicate all battery backup provisions. 3. Overall system shielding and grounding scheme indicating all major components and ground paths. 4. Photographs and drawings showing installation details and locations of equipment. 5. Charts showing normal operating conditions at significant points such as electrical test points. 6. Routine preventive maintenance procedures, corrective troubleshooting procedures, and calibration procedures. diagnostic 7. Parts lists with manufacturer's catalog numbers and ordering information. 8. Lists of ordinary and special tools, operating materials supplies and test equipment recommended for operation and servicing. 9. Manufacturer's operating set up, maintenance and catalog literature for each piece of equipment. 10. Maintenance and repair instructions. 11. Recommended spare parts. 12. Field test reports. D. Provide Programming Manual to serve as training and reference manual for all aspects of system programming. As a minimum include the following: 93 1. Complete programming manuals, and reference guides. 2. Details of any special software packages and compilers supplied with system. 3. Information required for independent programming of system. 4. Documentation on application and DDCP programs: Flow charts, equations, and parameters. 5. Point schedule; include all points, real and virtual. 6. Software troubleshooting procedures. 22.TRAINING A. Two training sessions shall be provided by the contractor to the Owners personnel free of cost, which shall be suitable to the type of system installed. The first training session shall be imparted in IBMS contractors local office in India. All the travelling and living expenses shall be borne by the Owner. These sessions shall include, but not be limited to: a)Written training material b)Hands-on Lab exercise c)Quiz Test The following duration of training schedules shall be offered : Operators Supervisors Managers Super User - 80 Hours 70 Hours 60 Hours 50 Hours Second training session shall be conducted at site partly during system installation and partly after system completion/testing /commissioning. B. The Contractor shall furnish the services of competent instructors who will give instruction in the adjustment, operation and maintenance, including pertinent safety requirements, of the equipment and system specified. The training shall be oriented toward the system installed rather than being a general training course. Each instructor shall be thoroughly familiar with all aspects of the subject matter they are to teach. All equipment and material required for classroom training shall be provided by the Contractor. . The training program shall be accomplished in two phases for the time interval specified for each phase : 1. The first phase shall be given prior to the acceptance test period at a time mutually agreeable between the Contractor and the Owner, and shall be at least five (5) days (8 hours/day) in length. Operating personnel to be trained in the functional operations of the BMCS installed and the procedures that the operators will employ for system operation. The training shall include but not be limited to: a. b. General BMCS Configuration Operation of Computer and Peripherals 94 c. d. e. f. g. h. i. j. k. 2. Command Line Mnemonics Report Generation Operator Control Functions Graphics Generation General equipment layout Troubleshooting procedures Preventive Maintenance procedures Sensor maintenance and calibration Proper use of service kit. The second phase shall be conducted after system acceptance testing for a period of three (3) days. The training shall include but not be limited to: a. DDCP Programming b. Data Base Generation c. Supervisory Level Operator Commands d. Topics requested by Owner. 23.MAINTENANCE DURING DEFECTS LIABILITY PERIOD : It shall be responsibility of the contractor to carry out the Maintenance of the complete system during the Defect Liability Period(Maintenance Visits) at no extra cost. The contractor shall receive calls for any and all problems experienced in the operation of the system under this contract, attend to these within 24 hours of receiving the complaints and shall take steps to immediately correct any deficiency that may exist. All components, system software, parts and assemblies supplied by the IBMS Contractor shall be guaranteed against defects in materials and workmanship for two years from the date of handing over to the Owner. Labor, repair or replacement of system components shall be the responsibility of contractor at no extra cost to the Owner. All equipment that require repairing shall be immediately serviced and repaired. All replacement parts and labour shall be supplied promptly & free-of-charge to the Owner. 24.UPTIME GUARANTEE The contractor shall guarantee for the installed system an uptime of 99%. In case of shortfall in any month during the defects liability period, the Defects Liability Period shall get extended by a month for every month having shortfall. In case of shortfall beyond the defects liability period, the contract for Operation and Maintenance shall get extended by a month for every month having the shortfall and no reimbursement shall be made for the extended period. The tenderer shall submit along with the tender, a detailed operation assistance proposal for the Architect / Consultant / Owner’s site representative’s review. This shall include the type of service planned to be offered during Defects Liability Period and beyond. The operation assistance proposal shall give the details of the proposed monthly reports to the Management. 95 The tenderer shall include a list of other projects where such an Operation Assistance has been provided. 25.OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE Contractor may be required to carry out the operation of the installation for a period of ONE YEAR from the date of commissioning and handing over the entire system, i.e. during the defects liability period. Further, he may also be required to carry out operation and all inclusive maintenance of the entire system for a period of four years beyond the defects liability period. 25.1 Operation contract i.16 hours a day, year round during working office hours for full load. ii. All stand-by equipment to be operated as per mutually agreed program.. iii.Proper entry and upkeep of relevant log books. iv.Maintain complaints register. Submit weekly report. v.Proper housekeeping of all areas under the contract. vi.Prepare daily consumption report and summary of operation. 25.2 All Inclusive Maintenance Contract aScope The AMC shall cover all the items installed by the Contractor including consumable like gas, Proximity Cards, etc. b.Routine Preventive Maintenance Schedule to be submitted i. Schedule to cover manufacturer’s recommendation and/or common engineering practice (for all plant and machinery under contract). ii. Monthly status report. c.Uptime during maintenance contract i.98% uptime of all systems under contract. ii. Up time shall be assessed every month and in case of shortfall during any month the contract shall be extended by a month. iii. There shall be no reimbursement for the extended period. iv. Break-downs shall be attended to within ten hours of reporting. d.Manpower i. Adequate number of persons to the satisfaction of the Owner’s site representative shall be provided including relievers. 96 ii. Statutory requirements of EPF, ESIC and other applicable labour legislations to be complied with; and monthly certification to that effect to be submitted. iii. Duty allocation and Roaster control shall be contractor’s responsibility. iv. No overtime shall be payable by Owner for any reason whatsoever. 97 e.Shut Downs f. i. Routine shut downs shall be permitted in consultation with Owner. ii. Contractor shall be at liberty to carry out routine maintenance as and when required but with prior permission of the Owner. Payment Terms i. Quarterly payment or as per the main contractors payment schedule as per G.C.C. based on measurement and pro-rata basis. 26.PARTIAL ORDERING : The Owner through the Architect / Consultant / Engineer-in-charge reserve the right to order equipment and materials or parts thereof from one or more tenderers. 27.POWER REQUIREMENT : The contractor shall identify and submit with their tender, their requirement of power at each of their major power consuming equipment. 28.COMPLIANCE LIST AND TECHNICAL DATA : The contractor shall submit paragraph-by-paragraph listing of strict word-for-word compliance or non-compliance of specifications. In case of any item of conditional compliance or noncompliance , the tenderer shall spell out the substitute to the feature. At the time of tender, all tenderers shall include a detailed compliance statement, listing each clause of the specifications and highlighting : a.Exceed specification requirements (explanation required) b.Meet specification requirements c.Meet intent of specification (explanation required) d.Deviation from specification Each tenderer must also submit alongwith his tender the technical data for all items listed in schedule of quantities. Failure to furnish technical data with tenders may result in summary rejection of the tender. The contractor shall also submit the following documents and details at the time of submission of the tender. These shall be from the system which contractor is offering for this project. i. Available services for full system maintenance, software updates and modifications, hardware spare parts, adds and changes, system changes and training classes. ii. Technical data for all hardware components as asked for in the tender as per Appendix III. 98 iii. Manufacturers, Test Certificate for each device/ sensor / equipment, clearly highlighting the conforming standards. 29.EXCLUSIONS 1) Services contractor shall provide potential free contacts for digital points, wherever required, to ensure compatibility with the BAS system. The responsibility for providing the above rest entirely with the respective services contractor. 2) All theequipment’s whose start/stop is being governed by the IBMS shall be provided with STOP/MANUAL/AUTO two pole selector switch in the panel by the respective services contractor. Necessary modifications required in the panel for this shall be carried out by the respective services contractor. 3) The electrical terminations in the other services panels shall be done by respective services contractors. 4) Provision of power supply wherever required to power the BAS equipment shall be provided by the electrical contractor within 2 meters distance of the BAS equipment. 5) Breaking and making good of openings for cable crossings shall be in scope of Civil Contractor. 6) a) For sensors, transmitters which are installed on pipes, the respective services contractor shall provide a nipple/socket and an isolation valve duly installed. b) For control valves, the services contractor shall provide counter flanges wherever counter flanges not come as a part of the valves/couplings(150 lbs rating) welded/threaded on the pipes drilled and machined as per standards. Control valves / Butterfly valves shall be installed by HVAC Contractor. BAS contractor will provide power supply and necessary control signal and associated wiring for controlling the valves. All switching relays and transducers shall be mounted in a separate cabinet and shall be designed, supplied, installed & commissioned by the BAS contractor. Cabling between the relay/transducers panel and the local panel shall be supplied and laid by the BAS contractor. Termination on the relay panel shall be carried out by the IBMS Contractor. Terminations on the local panel shall be done by the respective services contractor. All structural supports for panels & instruments shall be in the scope of IBMS Contractor. 7. Provision of space in all panels for mounting transducers and power supply arrangement to the transducers shall be provided by the respective services contractor. 30.LIST OF ITEMS AGAINST DUTY BENEFIT Following items shall be imported against duty benefit : a.Sensors, transmitters, controllers and system integration units. b.Detectors, devices and Fire Alarm Control Panel 99 c.CCTV cameras, multiplexers, video switches and video monitor. d.Card reader and field device controller e.Agent for gas suppression system. Owner shall open 5 Nos. letter of credit for equipment identified above. Associated local items like wires, conduits, pipes, sensors, devices etc. shall not be entitled for duty benefit. In case the contractor requires more than 5 Nos letter of credits, then same shall be identified at the time of submission of bid. 31. SPECIAL CONDITION Audiovisual system, Networking system, BMS System etc. are all specialized works which involve acute and precision electronic works. Contractors should engage special agencies with reputation of completing similar type of work successfully and with adequate infrastructure to take up the work. Contractors should submit the name of such agencies with their credentials and infrastructure details of their firm to the Engineer-incharge/Employer and gets his approval before engaging the agency in the work. Name of some of the agencies who can undertake such works on turnkey basis is listed below. The intending contractors are to entrust the works to any of the following firms. i) ii) M/s. ACE Acoustics and Audio Video Solutions Pvt. Ltd. Dihang Arcade, 1st floor (opposite Dona planet) G.S. Road, Guwahati – 781005, Assam Ph : (0361) 2466601/02/03/04/06, Mob : 9864091093. M/s. Sterling and Wilson Security System Pvt. Ltd. (Associates of M/s. Shapoorji & Palonji and Co. Ltd.) IT Building (3rd floor) Benfish, 31, G.N. Block, Sector – V, Salt Lake City, Kolkata – 700 091. Tele : (033)3011-8182, FAX : 3011-8249, Mob : 9903387814. iii) M/s. Godrej Security. & Surveillance System, Godrej & Boyce Mfg. Co. Ltd., Sector – V, Salt Lake City, Kolkata – 700 091. Tele : (033)6601-3960, FAX : (033)23578271, Mob : 9836882727. iv) M/s. Siemens Ltd., Infrastructure & Cities , Sector SAS RC-IN-IC-BT REM ERS 43, Shantipally. Rashbehari Bypass connector, Kolkata – 700 042 Tele : (033)3093-9526, FAX : (033)2444-9667, Mob : 94322-54665 v) M/s. Voltas Limited, Gillander House, 8, N. S. Road, Kolkata – 700 001 Tele : (033) 6626 6200. vi) M/s. Blue Star Limited, 7, Hare Street, Kolkata – 700 001 Tele : (033) 2213 4000. 100 APPENDIX – I LIST OF DRAWINGS Sl. No. Drawing No. Title To be submitted by specialized sub contractor alongwith tender under main contractor. All vendors are encouraged to visit the office of Architect / Consultants for any clarification / details. 101 APPENDIX – II GUARANTEE PROFORMA GUARANTEE FOR IBMS INSTALLATION We hereby guarantee the year round IBMS System which we have installed in the Complex described below : Building: The New State Legislative Assembly building at Dispur, Guwahati, Assam. Location: Dispur, Guwahati, Assam. Owner : Govt. of Assam (P.W.D) For a period of 5 Years from the date of acceptance/commissioning of the total installation, WE AGREE TO repair or replace to the satisfaction of the Owner, any or all such work that may prove defective in workmanship, equipment or materials within that period, ordinary wear and tear and unusual abuse or neglect excluded, together with any other work, which may be damaged or displaced in so doing. In the event of our failure to comply with the above mentioned conditions within a reasonable time, after being notified in writing, we collectively and separately, do hereby authorise the Owner to proceed to have the defects repaired and made good at our expense, and we shall pay the cost and charges thereof, immediately upon demand. WE ALSO HEREBY UNDERTAKE to test the entire installation on following the completion of the installation, to check and do everything necessary to ensure that the specified indoor conditions in all spaces are maintained, that all water and air systems are properly monitored, that all controls are calibrated accurately, and that all units are functioning satisfactorily. SIGNATURE OF CONTRACTOR for IBMS NSTALLATION DATE SEAL 102 APPENDIX – III TECHNICAL DATA SUBMITTAL The contractor shall submit details of installed system and instruments detailed dates for record to the owner for future reference and maintenance. The details to be submitted in the following format. Name of the instrument and installation :a. Manufacturer : b. Country of Origin : c. Local Agent : d. Model : e. Processor : f Minimum ROM (K Bytes) : g Clock Frequency : h RAM Capacity Installed : i Ram Capacity Expandable : j Cache Memory (K Bytes) : k Hard Disk Capacity (M Bytes) : l CD Drive Capacity (M Bytes) : m CD Drive Size : n Split Screen Capacity : o Dimension Overall (mm) : p Ambient Operating Temperature (deg.C) : q Ambient Operating R.H (%) : r Power Supply : s Power Consumption (Watts) : t UL Listing : 103 GENERAL NOTES ON BOQ: MISCELLANEOUS Notes: Items 292 & 293 of BOQ are very specialized item and the work is to be got done from any of the following specialised agencies with due approval from Engineer-in-Charge/Architect 1. M/s. Constro Art Engineering Company. Sl. No. 50/4,5 Narhe - Ambegaon Road, Narhe, Pune – 411041 Tel. : 91 20 24426797 / 4446 [email protected] 2. M/S Construction Catalyser Pvt. Ltd 483/37, Mitramandal Colony Opposite House of Jagtap, Paravati Pune-411009 Tel-912024426797/4446 [email protected] 3. Saksi Engineering Projects Harthala Railway Station Road, Vidyanagar, Harthala (Sonakpur) Moradabad-244001 (U.P.) 09897622006/09307123456 [email protected] FURNITURE AND ARTEFACTS Notes: All the furniture are very much descriptive as per the picture given and the finishing should be factory made of International standard. LIGHTING AUTOMATION CONTROL SYSTEM Notes : Supply of items Like Enclosures, with ELCB and MCB protection for Dimmers for site basis are in Client's scope. AUDIO VIDEO SYSTEM Notes : Audio video system including design and project management, programming as required, design and as built drawings (reproducible), operation and maintenance manuals - including equipment manuals, training - operation and maintenance, warranty - 24 months extended manufacturer's warranty at same terms and conditions. Telephone & networking System PART - I : ACTIVE COMPONENTS Notes : i) Bidder shall provide OEM authorisation certificate in 104 original certifying the bidder to participate in the tender. The name of the project should be clearly mentioned in the certificate ii) Bidder shall provide schedule of all items and shall give in the format indicating the make & listing of the components. Quantities shall be checked at site and approval shall be taken from the Engineer In charge before procuring the materials. iii) iv) Quantity of materials shall be supplied after approval of shop drawings and as per instructions of Engineer-incharge only. PART II: PASSIVE COMPONENTS Notes : Bidder shall provide OEM authorisation certificate in original certifying the bidder to participate in the tender. The name of the project should be clearly mentioned in the certificate. 1 2 Bidder shall provide schedule of all items and shall give in the format indicating the make & listing of the components. Quantities shall be checked at site and approval shall be taken from the Engineer In charge before procuring the materials. 3 4 Quantity of materials shall be supplied after approval of shop drawings and as per instructions of Engineer-in-charge only. IP TELEPHONE SYSTEM i) Bidder shall provide OEM authorization certificate in original certifying the bidder to participate in the tender. The name of the project should be clearly mentioned in the certificate. ii) Bidder shall provide schedule of all items and shall give in the format indicating the make & listing of the components. iii) Quantities shall be checked at site and approval shall be taken from the Engineer In charge before procuring the materials. iv) Quantity of materials shall be supplied after approval of shop drawings and as per instructions of Engineer-in-charge only. BUILDING MANAGEMENT SYSTEM Notes: i All data historical log shall be saved to hard disk before the expiry of 50 days. ii All controllers shall be UL listed. 105 iii Catalogues for all controllers shall be submitted with bid. iv Contractor shall provide schedule of all items in a format indicating the make & listing of the component (UL) & Indian/Imported. v Quantities shall be checked at site and approval shall be taken from the Engineer Incharge before procuring the materials. The Quantity of cable/wire/conduits are tentative. The contactor has to provide the DDC controllers as per manufacturer selected from list of approved makes and the qty. of cables/wires/conduits etc. will depend on the selection of controllers. vi vii viii Procurement shall be done after the approval of shop drawing and material data sheets. Other details shall be as per the technical specification. CHILLER/ PUMPS/ COOLING /TOWER SYSTEM : i) All data historical log shall be maintained for minimum 50 days. AHU/TFA/VENT./EXHAUST FANS : NOTE: i) All data historical log shall be maintained for minimum 50 days. PLUMBING/FIRE FIGHTING/STP/WTP/RO/ELECTRICAL : NOTE: The Bidder must submit OEM authorisation certificate along with submission of the Bid document. The name of the project should be clearly mentioned in the certificate. All data historical log shall be maintained for minimum 50 days. 106 H. Joint Ventures. Para’s for joint Ventures Bidders willing to participate in a Joint Venture (JV) must submit their JV agreement in sealed envelop along with the Technical Bid at ……………………….. (Address) and clearly marked ………………….. (Name of project) Joint Ventures 2.6.1 Joint venture partners would be limited to three (including the lead partner but excluding the financial partner). 2.6.2A) One of the partners, who is responsible for performing a key function in contract management or is executing a major component of the proposed contract, shall be nominated as being in charge during the bidding periods and, in the event of a successful bid, during contract execution. The partner in charge shall be authorized to incur liabilities and receive instructions for and on behalf of the partner(s) of the joint venture; this authorization shall be evidenced by submitting a power of attorney signed by legally authorized signatories of all the partners. B) All the partners of the joint venture shall be, jointly and severally liable, during the bidding process and for the execution of the contract in accordance with the contract terms, and a statement to this effect shall be included in the authorization mentioned under sub clause 2.6.2(A) above. The bid shall be signed so as to legally bind all the partners, jointly and severally. Bid security and the performance guarantee as required will be furnished by the Lead partner and joint venture partner(s), out of their account in proportion to their participation in joint venture. Qualifying criteria for joint ventures 2.6.3 General Experience: The Applications shall meet the minimum qualification criteria as defined in Clause No.4.5 of Section-1(Instructions to bidders) except 4.5A(c), the lead partner must fulfill criteria of similar nature of single work as indicated in 4.5A(c) however a successfully or 90% completed similar nature of single work by the same JV partners will be considered as qualifying criteria. 2.6.4 Personnel Capabilities. The applicant must have available key personnel for this work as defined in Clause No.4.5 of Section-1(Instructions to bidders) 2.6.5 Availability of key and critical equipments as defined in Clause No.4.5 of Section-1(Instructions to bidders) 107 2.6.6 Financial position. The applicant should demonstrate that he access to or has available liquid assets ( working capital each in hand and bank guarantees) and / or credit facilities of not less than 10% of the contract / contracts applied for, construction cash – flow may be taken as 10% of the estimated value of contract / contracts. (See Clause No 4.3(vii) and 4.5 of Section-1(Instructions to bidders) 2.6.7 The audited balance sheet for the last five years should be submitted, which must demonstrate the soundness of the applicant’s financial position showing long – term profitability including an estimated financial projection for the next two years. Where necessary, the employer will make inquires with the applicant’s bankers. (See Clause No.4.3 (vi) of Section-1(Instructions to bidders) 2.6.8 Litigation History. The applicant should provide accurate information on any litigation or arbitration resulting from contracts completed or under execution by him over the last five years. A consistent history of awards against the applicant or any partner of a joint venture may result in failure of the applicant. 2.6.9 Bid capacity : Applicant should fulfilled the clause No.4.8 of Section-1 (Instructions to bidders). Note : In case of a joint venture, the available bid capacity will be applied for each partner to the extent of his proposed participation in the execution of the works and combined. 2.6.10 Disqualification: This should be as per clause No.4.9 of Section-1(Instructions to bidders). 2.7 Joint Ventures must comply with the following requirements: Refer to Clause No.4.6 of Section-1 of ITB. 2.7.2 Refer to Clause No. 4.6.2 of Section-1 of ITB. . 2.8 Deleted. 2.9 Conflict of interest 2.9.1 The Applicant (including all members of a joint venture) must not be associated, nor have been associated in the past, with the consultant (M/S Dulal Mukherjee & Associates, Kolkata ) or any other entity that has prepared the design, specifications and bidding documents for the project, or what was proposed as Engineer for the contract, over the last five years Any such association may result in the disqualification of the Applicant. 2.10 General: 2.10.1 A firm or a member of a joint venture may participate in only one bid for the contract. If a firm submits more than one bid singly or in joint venture all bids including that party will be rejected. This rule will not apply in respect of bids which include specialist subcontractors who are used by more than one bidder. 108 2.10.2 Bidders will be required to provide bid security in the form of a bankers cheque/bank guaranties or / other security acceptable to employer about 1% of the estimated cost and the successful bidder will be required to provide performance security. Example of acceptable forms will be supplied with the bidding documents. 2.10.3 The employer reserves the right to : a) amend the scope and value of any contract (s) to bid. b) Reject or accept any application, and c) The employer shall neither be liable for any such actions nor be under any obligation to inform the applicant of the grounds for them. ADDITIONAL SPECIAL CONDITIONS FOR JV A copy of the Joint Venture (JV) entered into by the partners shall be submitted with the application. Alternatively, a letter of intent to execute a JVA in the event of a successful bid shall be signed by all partners and submitted with the Application together with a copy of the proposed Agreement. Pursuant to sub-clause 2.6.2(A) & 2.6.2(B) above, the JV shall include among other things, the Joint Venture’s objectives, the proposed management structure, the contribution of each partner to the Joint Venture operation, the commitment of the partners to joint and several liability for due performance, recourse/sanctions within the Joint Venture in the event of default or withdrawal of any partner and arrangements for providing the required indemnities. In case of withdrawal of any partner from the Joint Venture the following shall be applicable: i) Stepping into the shoes of the existing partners of Joint Venture with all the liabilities of the existing partners from the beginning of the contract. ii) With prior approval of Assam PWD. iii) Not withstanding demarcation or allotment of work between two JV partners JV shall liable for non-performance of the whole contract irrespective of their demarcation or share of work. iv) In case of successful bid being accepted by Assam PWD, the payments under the contract will only be made to the JV and not to the individual partners. 2) Joint venture agreement shall contain a clause to the effect that there shall be a separate JV Bank Account (distinct from the bank accounts of the individual partners) to which the individual partners shall contribute their share capital and/or working capital. Joint Venture agreement shall contain a clause to the effect that the financial obligations of the JV shall be discharged through the said JV Bank account only and also all the payments received or paid by the Govt.of Assam or by the JV shall be through that account alone. 4) Joint Venture is applicable to the project costing Rs.15.00 Crore or above 109 5) Inclusion of a financial partner in the JV is permitted who need not have any technical qualification but may offer financial support to the JV. Member(s) of the JV , other than the Financial member should collectively meet all the experience requirements. ANNEXURE FOR JOINT VENTURE (application format) Letter of Application. [ letterhead paper of the Applicant, or partner responsible for a joint venture, including full postal address, telephone no , fax no, telex no, and cable address] Date ___________________________ To ____________________________ ____________________________ ____________________________ [ Name & Address of the Employer} Sir, Being duly authorized to represent and act on behalf of ______________________ (hereinafter “the Applicant”), and having reviewed and fully understood all the qualification information provided for JV the undersigned hereby apply to be qualified by yourselves as a bidder for the work of____________________________(Name of work) 2.Attached to this letter are copies of original documents defining: (A) the Applicant’s legal status; the principal place of business; and the place of incorporation (for applicants who are corporations) ; or the place of registration and the nationality of the owners (for applicants who are partnerships or the individually-owned firms) authority letter(s) for signatory (ies). A.For applications by joint ventures, all the information requested in the qualification documents is to be provided for the joint venture, if it already exists, and for each party to the joint venture separately. The lead partner should be clearly identified. Each partner in the joint venture shall sign the letter 3. Your agencies and its authorized representatives are hereby authorized to conduct any inquiries or investigations to verify the statements, documents, and information submitted in connection with this application, and to seek clarification from our bankers and client regarding any financial and technical aspects. This Letter of Application will also serve as authorization to any individual or authorized representative of any institution referred to in the supporting information, to provide such information deemed necessary and requested by yourselves to verify statements and information provided in this ap plication, or with regard to the resources, experiences, and competence of the Applicant. 4.Your Agency and its authorized representatives may contact the following persons for further information : (B) General and managerial inquiries Contact 1 Telephone 1 110 Contact 2 Telephone 2 Personal inquiries Contact 1 Contact 2 Telephone 1 Telephone 2 Technical inquiries Contact 1 Contact 2 Telephone 1 Telephone 2 Financial inquiries Contact 1 Contact 2 Telephone 1 Telephone 2 5. This application is made in the full understanding that : (a) bids by pre-qualified applicants will be subject to verification of all information submitted for pre-qualification at the time of bidding ; (b) your Agency reserves the right to : amend the scope and value of any contracts/bids under this project, and reject or accept any application and ( c) your Agency shall not be liable for any such actions and shall be under no obligation to inform the applicant of the grounds for them. _______________________________________________________________________________ B. Applications by joint ventures should provide on a separate sheet equivalent information for each party to the application . 6. Appended to this application, we give details of the participation of each party, including capital contribution and profit/loss agreements, to the joint venture or association. We also specify the financial commitment in terms of the percentage of the value of the (each) contract, and the responsibilities for execution of the (each) contract. 7.We confirm that in the event that we bid, that bid as well as any resulting contract will be ; (a)signed so as to legally bind all partners, jointly and severally; and (b) submitted with a joint venture agreement providing the joint and several liability of all partners in the event the contract is awarded to us. 8.The undersigned declare that the statements made and the information provided in the duly completed application are complete, true and correct in every detail. Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of the Applicant of a joint venture} Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of partner} 111 Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of the partner} Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of partner} Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of the partner} Signed Name For and on behalf of {name of partner} APPLICATION FORM (I) General Information All individual firms and each partner of a joint venture applying for pre-qualification are requested to complete the information in this form. Nationality information to be provided for all owners or applicants who are partnerships or individually-owned firms Where the Applicant proposes to use named subcontractors for critical components of the works, or for work contents in excess of 10 percent of the value of the whole works, the following information should also be supplied for the specialist subcontractor(s) 1. 2. Name of Firm Head office address 3. 4. 5. Telephone Fax Place of incorporation / registration Contract Telex Year of incorporation / registration 112 APPLICATION FORM (IA) Structure and Organisation 1. The applicant is (a) an individual (b) a proprietor firm (c ) a firm in partnership (d) a limited company or corporation (e) a group of firms / joint venture ( If yes, give complete information in respect of each partner) 2.Attach the organization Chart showing ______________________ the structure of organization, including the names of the Director and position of officers. 3.Number of years of experience : (a) as a Prime contractor (contractor shouldering major responsibility) (i) in own country ______________________ (ii) other countries (specify country) ______________________ (b) in a joint Venture (i) in own country ______________________ (ii) other countries (specify country) ______________________ (c ) as sub-contractor in (specify main contractor) (i) in own country (ii) other countries (specify country) ______________________ ______________________ 4.For how many years has your organization ______________________ been in business of similar work under its ______________________ present name ? What were your fields when ______________________ your organization was established ? Whether______________________ any new fields were added in your organization? _____________________ And if so, when?______________________ 5.Were you ever required to suspend ______________________ construction for a period of more than six ______________________ months continuously after you started?______________________ If so , give name of project & give reasons ______________________ 113 thereof. 6.Have you ever left the work awarded to ______________________ you incomplete? ( If so, give name of ______________________ project & reasons for not completing work) ______________________ 7.In which field of civil engineering ______________________ construction do you claim specialization ______________________ and interest. ______________________ 8.Give details of your experience in ______________________ Sanitary & Water Supply Works ______________________ In Building 9.Give details of your experience in ______________________ Electrical Works in Building Works ______________________ 10. Give details of your experience in ______________________ Audio Visual System ______________________ IBMS ________________________ Access control System ________________________ IPTV ________________________ Telephone networking system ________________________ Fire Alarm System ________________________ Security & surveillance System ________________________ C.These are sample illustration to be modified as appropriate. 114 APPLICATION FORM (2) General Experience Record Name of Applicant or partner of a joint Venture All individual firms and all partners of a joint venture are requested to complete the information in this form. The information supplied should be annual turnover of the Applicant (or each member of the joint venture) in terms of the amount billed to clients for each year for work in progress or completed. Use a separate sheet for each partner of a joint venture. Annual turnover data (construction works only) S.No. Year 1. 2009-10 2. 2010-11 3. 2011-12 4. 2012-13 5. 2013-14 Turnover Indian Rupees 115 APPLICATION FORM (2A) Joint Venture Summary Sl. No. 1. Name of all partners of a joint venture Lead partner 2 3. Partner Partner Total value of annual construction turnover, in terms of work billed to clients, in Indian Rupees, converted at the rate of exchange at the end of the period reported. Annual turnover data (construction works only, Indian Currency) Sl. No. 1. Partner Lead partner Form 2 Page No. Year 1 Year 2 Year 3 Year 4 Year 5 2. Partner 3. Partner TOTAL Indicate responsibility in case of planning, finance, construction equipment, key. Personal and execution of the work of the lead firm of the joint venture and each of the Joint Venture partners: Details regarding financial responsibility and participation (percentage share in the total) of each firm in the Joint Venture. Attach a Memorandum of Understanding for the Proposed Agreement of Joint Venture which should lay down responsibility regarding work and financial arrangements in respect of each of the firms in the Joint Venture. (Refer para 2.7) Details of participation in the Joint Venture [Indicate responsibility and extent of participation in respect of finance, planning, construction equipment, key personnel and execution of the work of the major/lead partner of the joint venture and other partner of JV] Participation details Financial Planning Construction equipment Key personnel Execution of work (give details on construction of each) (Major/lead partner) Partner Partner 116 APPLICATION FORM (3) Particular Experience Record Name of Applicant or Partner of a joint venture APPLICATION FORM (3A) Details of Contracts of Similar Nature Works Name of Applicant or partner of a joint venture Use a separate sheet for each contract. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5 6. 7. 8. 9. 10 11 12 Number of contract Name of contract Country Name of Employer Employer’s Address Name of works and special features relevant to the contract for which the Applicant wishes to pre-qualify. Contract role (check one) *Sole contract * sub-contract * Partner in a joint venture (Percentage participation) Value of total contract *(at completion, or at date of award for current contracts) Date of award Date of completion Contract duration ( years and months) Years Months Specified requirements ( as in ……………..) Name and professional qualification of applicant’s Engineer-in-charge of the work Were there any penalties/ fines/ stop-notice/ compensation/ liquidated damages imposed? (Yes or No) If yes, give amount and explanation Insert any specified criteria required for particular operations, such as annual volume of earthmoving, underground excavation, or placing concrete, as applicable. _________________________________________________________________________ *In case of contracts in foreign currency, the value of the contract in that currency should be stated. A certificate of completion from the Employer / Engineer must be enclosed. 117 APPLICATION FORM (4) Summary Sheet: Current Contract Commitments / Works in Progress. Name of Applicant or partner of a joint venture Applicants and each partner to an application should provide information on their current commitments on all contracts that have been awarded, or for which a letter of intent or acceptance has been received, or for contracts approaching completion, but for which an unqualified, full completion certificate has yet to be issued. Sl. No Name of Contract Name of Client 1. 2. 3. Contract value Stipulated date of completion Value of Estimated outstanding Completion work APPLICATION FORM (5) Personal Capabilities Name of Applicant For specific positions essential to contract implementation, applicants should provide the names of at least two candidates qualified to meet the specified requirements stated for each position. The data on their experience should be supplied in separate sheets using one Form (5A) for each candidate. 1. Title of position Name of prime candidate 2. Name of alternate candidate Title of position Name of prime candidate 3. Name of alternate candidate Title of position Name of prime candidate 4. Name of alternate candidate Title of position Name of prime candidate Name of alternate candidate 118 APPLICATION FORM (5A) Candidate Summary Name of Applicant Position Candidate information 1.Name of the Candidate Present Employment 4. Name of the Employer Address of the Employer Candidate * Prime * Alternate 2. Date of birth 3. Professional Qualification Telephone Contact (Manager/ personal Officer) Fax Job title of Candidate Telex Years with present Employer Summarize professional experience over the last 20 years, in reverse chronological order. Indicate particular technical and managerial experience relevant to the Project. From To Company/Project/Position/relevant technical & managerial experience 119 APPLICATION FORM (6) Equipment Capabilities Name of Applicant The applicant shall provide adequate information to demonstrate clearly that it has the capability to meet the requirements for each and all items of equipment listed in the Instruction to Applicants. A separate Form (6) shall be prepared for each item of equipment listed in para 2.6.5 of the Instruction to Applicants, or for alternative equipments proposed by the Applicant. Item of Equipment Equipment Current status Source 1. Name of manufacture 3. Capacity 5. Current location 6. Details of current commitments 7. Indicate source of the equipment * Owned * Rented * Leased 2. Model and power rating 4.Year of manufacture * Specially manufactured Omit the following information for equipment owned by the Applicant or partner. Owner Agreements 8. Name of owner 9. Address of owner Telephone Contact name and title Fax Telex Details of rental/ lease/ manufactured agreements specific to the Project. 120 APPLICATION FORM (7) Financial Capability Name of Applicant or partner of a joint venture Applicants, including each partner of a joint venture, should provide financial information to demonstrate that they meet the requirements stated in the Instructions to the Applicants. Each applicant or partner of a joint venture must fill in this form. If necessary, use separate sheets to provide complete banker information . A copy of the audited balance sheets should be attached. Banker Name of Banker Address of banker Telephone Contact name and title Fax Telex Summarise actual assets and liabilities in Indian Rupees (INR) (at the exchange current at the end of each year) for the previous five years. Based upon known commitments, summarize projected assets and liabilities in INR equivalent for the next two years. Financial Information in Indian Rupees 1. Total Assets 2.Current Assets 3. Total liabilities 4.Current liabilities 5. Profit before taxes 6. Profit after taxes Actual: Previous five years 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Projected: Next two years 6. 7. Specify proposed sources of financing to meet the cash flow demands of the Project, net of current commitments (Instructions to Applicants, para 3.5) Sl. No 1. 2. 3. 4. Sources of financing Amount in Indian Rupees Attach audited financial statements for the last five years ( for the individual applicant or each partner of a joint venture) Firms owned by individuals, and partnership, may submit their balance sheets certified by a registered accountant, and supported by copies of tax returns, if audits are not required. 121 APPLICATION FORM (8) Litigation History Applicants, including each partners of a joint venture, should provide information on any history of litigation or arbitration resulting from contracts executed in the last five years or currently under execution ( Instructions to the Applicants, para 2.6.8 ). A separate sheets should be used for each partner of a joint venture. Year Award for or against applicants Name of Clients, cause of litigation, and matter in dispute Disputed Amount (current value in Indian Rs) Actual awarded amount in Indian Rs 122 APPLICATION FORM (9) INFORMATION REGARDING CURRENT LITIGATION, DEBARRING/ EXPELLING OF TENDERER OR ABANDONMENT OF WORK BY TENDERER 1 2. 3. (a) Has the Applicant or its constituent partners consistent history of litigation awarded against him (b) If yes, give details (a) Has the Applicant or its constituent partners being debarred/expelled by any Agency in India, during the last 5 years, excepting on account of reasons other than non-performance, such as rescinding of joint venture pulling out, court directions leading to breaking up of a joint venture before start of work. (b) If yes, give details (a) Has the Applicant or its constituent partners abandoned any contract work in India, during the last 5 years If yes, give details YES/NO (a) Has the Applicant or its constituent partners been declared bankrupt during the last 5 years. YES/NO (b) If yes, give details, including present status. (b) 4. YES/NO YES/NO Note :If any information in this schedule is found to be incorrect or concealed, prequalification application will be summarily rejected 123 APPLICATION FORM (10) AFFIDAVIT (To be given separately by each partner of Joint venture) 1.I, the undersigned do hereby certify that all the statements made in the required attachments are true and correct. 2.The undersigned also hereby certifies that neither out firm M/s ______________________ nor any of its constituent partners have abandoned any work on Building works in India nor any contract awarded to us for such works have been rescinded during last five years prior to the date of this bid. The undersigned hereby authorize(s) and request(s) any bank, person, firm or corporation to furnish pertinent information deemed necessary and requested by the Department to verify this statement or regarding my (our) competence and general reputation. The undersigned understand and agrees that further qualifying information may be requested, and agrees to furnish any such information at the request of the Department/ Project implementing agency. ____________________________________ (Signed by an Authorised Officer of the Firm) ________________ Title of Officer ______________________ Name of Firm DATE 124 SECTION - 4 CONTRACT DATA 125 CONTRACT DATA Clause Reference with respect to Section - 3 Items marked “N/A” do not apply in this contract 1. The Employer is the Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. ( Cl. 1.1 ) Name of authorized Representative: Addl. Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.) O/o the Chief Engineer,PWD,Assam, Guwahati – 3. 2. The Engineer is the Executive Engineer, PWD, PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati-06 ( Cl. 1.1 ) 3. The Dispute Review Expert appointed by the Employer is : ( Cl. 1.1 ) * Name : * Address : 4. The Defects Liability Period is 365 days from the date of completion. ( Cl. 1.1 & 3 ) 5. (a) The Start date shall be 15 days from the date of issue of the Notice to proceed with the work. ( Cl. 1.1 ) 6. The Intended Completion Date for the whole of the works 9 months after start of work with the following milestones: (Buildings to be operationally ready within nine months). (Cl. 1.1, 17 & 28) 7. Milestone dates : ( Cl. 2.2 & 9.1) Milestone Physical works to be completed Within the time Milestone - 1 25% of contract value 3 months Milestone - 2 60% of contract value 6 months Milestone – 3 100 % of contract value 9 months 8. The Site is located at : Dispur, Guwahati-6, Assam. ( Cl. 1.1 ) 9. The name and Identification number of the Contract is : NO:CS/T/BD/8/2013/46 , Dated Guwahati, the 17/03/2015 ( Cl. 1.1) 10. The works consist of the following: : " Construction work of the proposed ( Cl. 1.1) 126 New Assam Legislative Assembly Building at Dispur with Budgetary cost estimate & revised Design proposal (Interior works for Assembly Main Building)” A. Flooring. B. Wall cladding, partition walls, paneling & false ceiling. C. Door shutters & other civil works including painting and polishing. D. Stage Craft. E. Acoustic treatment. F. Loose furniture /built in furniture. G. Kitchen equipments. H. Sanitary fittings & testing. J. Light fittings for interior illumination with connected works. 11. The law, which applies to the contract, is the law of Union of India and Govt. of Assam. Indian Contract Act 1872 and Indian Council of Arbitration and Reconciliation Act. 1996. 12. The languages of the Contract documents is English. ( Cl. 3.1) 13. Limit of subcontracting 20% of the Initial Contract Price. It is made clear that the balance 80% of the work cannot be sublet/subcontracted to any other company, firm of individual. ( Cl. 7.1) 14. The Schedule of other contractors 15. The Schedule of Key Personnel : As per Appendix – II to Section - I ( Cl. 9) 16. The minimum insurance cover for physical property, injury and death is Rs. 5 lakhs per occurrence with the number of occurrence limited to four. After each occurrence, contractor will pay additional premium necessary to make Insurance valid for four occurrences always. ( Cl. 13) 17. Site Investigation report. ( Cl. 14) 18. The Site Possession Dates shall be within 7 (seven) days from the date of Notice to proceed with the work. ( Cl. 21) 19. Fees and types of reimbursable expenses to be paid to the Dispute Review ( Cl. 25) - NIL ( Cl. 3.1) ( Cl. 8) 127 Board 20. - 50% by the Employer - 50% by the Contractor. Appointing Authority for the Dispute Review Expert is the Employer ( Cl. 26) 21. The period for submission of the programme for approval of Engineer Shall be 21 days from the issue of Letter of acceptance. ( Cl. 27.1) 22. The period between programme updates shall be 30 days. ( Cl. 27.3) 23. The amount to be withheld for late submission of an updated programme shall be Rs.30 Lakh. ( Cl. 27.3) 24.0 The defect liability period shall be 365 days from completion. However, guarantee for furniture items shall be for 10 years from the date of completion. 25. The following events shall also be Compensation Events : ( Cl. 35 ) ( Cl. 44) Substantially adverse ground conditions encountered during the course of execution of work not provided for in the bidding document. i. Removal of Underground utilities detected subsequently. 26. The currency of the Contract is Indian Rupees (INR) ( Cl. 46) 27. Deleted ( Cl. 47) 28. The proportion of payments retained (retention money) shall be 6% from each bill subject to a maximum of 5% of final contract price. ( Cl. 48) 29. Amount of liquidated Damages for delay in completion of works. ( Cl. 49 ) i) For Milestone - 1 Rs. 0.50 lakh per day ii) For Milestone - 2 Rs.1.2 lakh per day iii) For Milestone - 3 Rs.2.0 lakh per day 30. Maximum limit of Liquidated damages for delay in completion of work. 31. Deleted. 32. Deleted. 10% of the Initial Contract Price rounded off to the nearest thousand ( Cl. 49) 128 33. The amounts of the advance payment are : Nature of Advance (Cl. 51 & 52) Amount (Rs.) Conditions to be fulfilled i) Mobilization 5% of Tender value On submission of unconditional Bank Guarantee, (to be drawn before the end of 20% of contract period). The contractor may furnish four equal bank guarantees, valid for full period. ii) Secured advance for non-perishable materials brought to site 75% of Invoice value i) The materials are in accordance with the specification for works; Samples of materials have been approved by Engineerin-charge. ii) Such materials have been delivered to site, and are properly stored and protected against damage or deterioration to the satisfaction of the Engineer. The contractor shall store the bulk material in measurable stacks; iii) The contractor’s records of the requirements, orders, receipt and use of materials are kept in a form approved by the Engineer and such records shall be available for inspection by the Engineer. iv) The contractor has submitted with his monthly statement the estimated value of the materials on site together with such documents as may be required by the Engineer for the purpose of valuation of the materials and providing evidence of ownership and payment thereof; v) Ownership such materials shall be deemed to vest in the Employer for which the contractor has submitted an Indemnity Bond in an acceptable format; and vi) The quantities of materials are not excessive and shall be used within a reasonable time as determined by the Engineer. 34. Deleted. 35.0 Repayment of secured advance : The advance shall be repaid from each succeeding monthly payments to the extent materials (for which advance was previously paid pursuant to Clause 51.4 of G.C.C.) have been incorporated into the (Cl. 51.4) 129 Works. 36. The securities shall be for following minimum amounts equivalent as a percentage of the Contract Price. (Cl. 52) Performance Security for 5 per cent of contract price plus Rs………… (to be decided after evaluation of the bid) as additional security in terms of ITB Clause 29.5. The standard form of Performance Security acceptable to the Employer shall be an unconditional Bank Guarantee of the type as presented in Section 8 of the Bidding Documents. 37. The Schedule of Operating and Maintenance Manuals at the time of installation. (Cl. 58) 38. The date by which “as-built” drawings (in scale as directed) in 4 sets are required before the issue of certificate of completion of whole or section of the work, as the case may be. (Cl. 58) 39. The amount to be withheld for falling to supply “as-build” drawings by The date required is Rs. 25 lakh (Rupees twenty five lakh ) only. (Cl. 58) 40. The following events shall also be fundamental breach of contract : (Cl. 59.2) “The Contractor has contravened Sub-clause 7.1 and Clause 9 of GCC”. 41. The percentage to apply to the value of the work not completed representing the Employer’s additional cost for completing the Works shall be 20 percent. 42.0 No price escalation is intended in the contract. The contractor’s quoted rate shall be unchanged during the currency of the contract including extended period of contracts. (Cl. 3, 60) 130 SECTION: 5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION 131 Technical Specification : 1. The Technical Specification as stated in APWD Schedule of Rates for Buildings (Civil works) for 2013-14 and latest relevant I.S. Codes will be followed. 2. The Technical Specification as stated in APWD Schedule of Rates for Buildings (Sanitary & Water supply works) for 2013-14 and latest relevant I.S. Codes will be followed. 3. The Technical Specification as stated in APWD Schedule of Rates for Buildings (Electrical works) for 2013-14 and latest relevant I.S. Codes will be followed. 4. The Technical Specification as stated in APWD General Specification of Buildings & Electrical works. 5. The Technical Specification of items of work. 6. Other Specifications for Civil, Sanitary and Water Supply works :All works will be carried out as per details of provisions and specifications mentioned in the items of BOQ as well as specifications mentioned above unless and otherwise specified in the bid documents. All materials used shall be of best quality and must conform the details and brand mentioned in the BOQ and above mentioned schedule as well as tested for strength and quality as per relevant IS code. Samples of materials to be used must be approved well in advance by the Engineer. 132 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION FOR INTERIOR WORKS FOR ASSAM LEGISLATIVE ASSEMBLY PREAMBLES 1.0 The work shall be carried out strictly in accordance with the particular specifications and drawings. The drawing and specification shall be taken complimentary and also supplementary to each other and shall from part of this contract. Any work or material shown on drawing and not specifically included in specification or vice versa shall be executed and deemed to have been included in the scope of work for rate or items. If any item required for requirement for its functional utility and not specifically included in either BOQ or in drawings, the same is supposed to be included in the rates of items of BOQ. 2.0 Wherever no specification is included in the specifications but item shown on drawing, the same are to be specified by the approved manufacturer of the product and manufacturer’s specification should be followed. 3.0 The tenderer shall inspect the site and ascertain all the conditions impediments and facilities available there and shall cater for all contingencies expenses to complete the work in all respects. 4.0 The items in the BOQs shall briefly cover the specifications and in drawings. The technical specifications given hereinafter will be supplementary to the description given in BOQ. 5.0 The specification of earth work, PCC, brickwork and R.C.C. etc. shuttering, reinforcements and steel work wherever required should be as specified on the Assam PWD Specifications. No separate specification for these items have been specified in this tender. In case of valuation of the items APWD schedule 2013 shall be followed. 6.0 The built in furniture and loose furniture articles where specification are not exhaustively given either in the description of BOQ, these shall be carried out as per approved manufacturers’ specifications. The quality of steel, timber, plywood and block boards are to be as per specification in the latest ISS Specifications. Timber used shall be well seasoned and within the specified quality and density. No immature or unseasoned timber should be used in the work. Contractor will have to produce sample of the species of timber for approval from Engineer-incharge. 7.0 All fittings, fixtures and accessories for furniture, doors windows and panellings shall be of approved make from Hafele, Hettich, Hilti or DORMA. List of vendors are also included in the vendors list. 8.0 Contractor have to produce the samples of all items of work and get the approval of Engineer-incharge or Architect before actual work on ground start. Standard of acceptance should be obtained and the samples shall be maintained till completion of work. 9.0 Wherever manufactured loose furniture is shown on drawing with manufacturer’s trade marking, the said articles are to be got approved from Engineer-in-charge before ordering the bulk quantity. However, it will not absolve contractor’s responsibility for any defective material 133 supplied by the manufacturer. Manufacturer’s guarantee also to be handed over to the Engineerin-charge before completion of the work. For all furniture items guarantee of minimum 10 years should be given by contractor. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION FOR INTERIOR WORKS 1. MATERIALS : All materials used in the work shall be of respective kind and quality as specified in the schedule of quantities, obtained from approved source/manufacturer and shall be subjected to prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/Interior Designer. Samples of materials shall be got approved before placement of order and approved samples shall be deposited with the Engineer-inCharge/Interior Designer’s office. Specification of all building materials, dismantling, redoing etc. will be as specified in APWD Schedule. 2. WORKMANSHIP : All works shall be of best workmanship and shall be carried out in proper manner and in accordance with sound engineering practice to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge/ Interior Designer. No work shall be considered complete until the Engineer-in-Charge / Interior Designer’s certificate in writing that it has been completed. Levels of finish and quality of workmanship should be of international standards. Contractor should deploy the Craftsman who can produce that type of finish in the interior works. Neat and superior finish is the essence of the contract. 3. APPLICATION OF WHITE CEMENT BASED WALL CARE PUTTY : Surface at wall / ceiling where specified shall be treated with white cement base wall care putty of minimum thickness 1.5 mm. The particular brand of the special plaster and its composition must be previously approved by the Engineer-in-Charge/Interior Designer. The basic materials for the putty shall be white cement. The entire surface must be very smooth and unevenness must be removed. Before application of wall care putty, the surface to be treated shall be thoroughly cleaned, brushed and scrapped properly and then all holes, cracks, and patches shall be made good with approved materials. 4. APPLICATION OF PLASTER OF PARIS Surface of walls / ceilings where specified shall be treated with Plaster of Paris of minimum thickness 1.5mm. The particular brand of this special plaster and its composition must be previously approved by the E.I.C. The basic materials for the plaster shall be either Calcium Sulphate or Gypsum. The entire surface must be very smooth and unevenness must be removed. Special trained and skilled artisans with previous experience of this work will have to be employed for the purpose of achieving high grade finish. Before application of Plaster of Paris the surface to be treated shall be thoroughly cleaned, brushed and patching must be scraped properly, and then all holes, cracks, and patches shall be made good with approved materials.. 5. ARTIFICIAL STONE/PATENT STONE FLOORING / PCC FLOORING 134 It shall consists of an underbed and a topping; laid on matured concrete base. a) b) c) Thickness : I) Underbed : Unless otherwise specified the underbed thickness shall be of 22 mm to 32 mm. ii) Topping : The top finish thickness shall be of 3 mm MiX : i) Underbed : 1 part by Volume of cement : 2 parts by Vol. of course sand : 4 parts by volume of stone chips. ii) Topping : The top finish thickness shall be of 3 mm. Laying : The toppings including the underbed shall be laid in alternated bays or in chequred board pattern. No panel shall be cast in contact with another already laid till the contraction of the letter has already taken place. The maximum area of each panel shall be 3 sq.m of which no side shall be more than 2 M long. A cement grout shall be applied and worked into the surface to receive the finish, the underbed then laid, compacted and levelled to proper grade with a screed or float. The topping shall be applied evenly on the underbed while it is not fully set but firm enough and rolled and pressed to get full bond. The topping shall trowelled to a dense finish to the satisfaction of the Engineer. All trowel marks shall be mopped out with a soft cloth to give a clean smooth surface. d) Curing : After the surface is sufficiently set, the finished floor shall be kept moist for a minimum period of 7 (seven) days. If desired the finish shall be polished as directed. 6.0 GRANITE STONE IN FACIA, DADO FLOOR 6.1 Materials : Shall be of selected quality, hard, sound, dense and homogeneous texture, free from cracks, decay, weathering of flaws. Stone slabs shall be of uniform colours and as approved by the Architect/Employer. They shall be machine cut and machine polished / honed finish / leather finished where specified and shall conform to the required sizes. Thickness shall be as specified in the respective items. Source of all granite stone shall be from South India. 6.2. Workmanship : Stone or stone slab shall be of size as shown on drawings or as directed by Consultants. Exposed faces, full beds and joints shall be dressed/finished as directed. Joints shall be cut square to the face and shall be at right angles to each other or as directed. The facing shall be fixed truly in plumb and in perfect place straight or curved as shown on drawing, the bed being fully flushed with mortar. The joints shall be exactly vertical and horizontal. The joints shall be exactly vertical and machine polished/fine tooled/clear punched and chisel 135 dressed work. The stones shall break joins for about half height of the coarse. Courses shall be shown on the drawing or as directed. Gap between the facing stone and the wall shall be filled with 1:4 cement mortar. Small pieces of stone to be fixed with approved epoxy based adhesive at the back of each stone pieces and kept at least 48 hours for curing prior fixing. Gun metal, wrought iron/copper pins and hold fasts shall be used as and wherever directed. Lead caulking shall be used for fixing holdfasts. The surface shall be protected from sun and rain and cured for ten days. Face shall be finished as specified or directed after pointing the joints with approved joint filler. 7.0 PRE-POLISHED KOTA STONE FLOORING/WALL CLADDING It shall be hard, sound, dense and homogenous in texture with crystalline and coarse grains. It shall be free from stains, cracks, decay and weathering, flaws, defects or damages. 7.1. Materials : 7.1.1 Kota Stone slabs - The slabs shall be of selected quality of approved sizes, as shown on drawings, hard, sound, dense and homogenous in texture, free from cracks, decay, weathering and flaws. They should be of the colour indicated in the drawings or as instructed by the Architect/Employer. The slabs shall have the top (exposed) face polished before being brought to site. The slabs shall conform to the size required. Before starting the work, the contractor shall get the samples of slabs approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 7.2 Workmanship : 7.2.1. Dressing of Slabs - Each slab shall be cut to the required size and shape and fine chisel dressed at all the edges to the full depth. The sides thus dressed shall have a full contact if a straight edge is laid along. The sides shall be table rubbed with coarse sand or machine rubbed before paving. All angles and edges of the slabs shall be in true square and free from chippings giving a plane surface. 7.2.2. Thickness - Thickness shall be 25 to 37.5 mm or as specified in the item. Tolerance allowed shall be as under :The thickness should be as specified with a tolerance of +/- 2 mm. 7.2.3. Preparation of Surface - The surface shall be clean and wetted thoroughly before commencing the fixing work. 7.2.4 Kota stone fixing arrangement on walls :At the back of all the stone slab small piece of stone chips to be fixed with epoxy based adhesive and kept for 48 hrs. for curing. The entire back surface of the stone slab to be covered with non-skid adhesive prior pressing it over the (20mm thick minimum) green mortar (1 cement: 4 coarse sand) Gunmetals / copper pins and hold fasts shall be used for fixing of stone on wall. Pins will be fixed by lead caulking. The stone slabs thus fixed are to be properly supported till it fixed with the bed mortar rigidly. Proper tools should be used while fixing the slab. Care should be taken that no cavity is formed behind the stone slab with the wall. The joints should be filled up with approved joint filler. 7.2.5. Laying for flooring - 136 Sub-grade shall be cleared, wetted and mopped, bedding for kota stone shall be of 1:4 cement sand mortar of minimum thickness at any place not be less than 10mm. The slab shall be washed clean before laying. It shall be laid on top, pressed, tapped gently to bring it in level with the other slabs. It shall then be lifted and laid aside. Top surface of the mortar shall then be corrected by adding fresh mortar at hollows or depressions. The mortar is then allowed to harden a bit. Over this surface is bid a cement slurry of honey like consistency at 4.4 kg of cement per square metre. The edges of the slabs already paved shall be buttered with gray or white cement with or without pigment to match the shade of the kota slabs as given in the description of item. The slab shall then be gently placed in position and taped with wooden mallet till it is properly bedded, in level with and close to the adjoining slab. The joint shall be as fine as possible and surplus cement on the surface of the slab shall be removed. The slabs fixed in the floor adjoining the walls shall enter not less than 10 mm under the plaster, skirting or dado. The junction between the wall and floor shall be finished neatly. The finished surface shall be true to lines, levels and slopes as specified in the drawing and or instructed by Architect/Employer. 7.2.6 Curing - The floor shall be cured for a minimum period of seven days/or as per direction of E.I.C. 7.2.7. Rates to Include - Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere in this contract, the rates for item of kota stone flooring/cladding shall include for the following :- 7.2.8. i) All labour, materials and equipment, consumables, including preparing/ treating the surface of the base or structural member to the required line and level or slope, cutting to the required configuration cleaning the sub-base, laying mortar bed and cement grout and fixing kota stone slab as specified above, and making up the joints. ii) Any cutting and waste if required. iii) Curing (wherever necessary). iv) Cleaning the surface from all stains etc. v) Forming coves at junctions of well and rounding or nosing at the edges, including butting or making holes in slabs for providing opening in floor wherever required and finishing of the same with the adjoining surface. vi) Work at all positions/ heights/depths line and level and with all lead and lift. Mode of Measurement : The measurement shall be in square metres for the actual kota stone flooring/wall cladding provided. 137 8.0 CERAMIC TILE FLOOR 8.1. Materials : Ceramic tiles should conform to I.S. 770, B.S. 6431, E.N. 777 of the latest editions. Sizes may be 600x600 mm / 450 x 450 mm / 300 x 300 mm. The thickness of the tiles shall vary from 7.3 mm to 9.5 mm. The colours and brand shall be approved by E.I.C. 8.2. Workmanship : 8.2.1 Sub-floor preparation - The floor should be structurally sound and rigid and cleared off waxy / oily films and curing compounds. Surface must be free from rising dampness and hydrostatic pressure. If required, the floor should be levelled with screed concrete as per directions of the E.I.C. 8.2.2. Floor layout - The room should be squared off, measured and chalk lines are snapped. Once in place, lay loose tiles across the slope in both directions to balance the room so that the cut lines are of the same size on each wall. 8.2.3. Fixing - Tile fixing adhesive shall be applied on the entire back surface of the tiles and pressed rigidly on the levelelled subbase firmly and pitted with wooden mallet etc. The joints should be filled with approved tile joint filler. 9.0 CERAMIC TILES IN DADO/SKIRTING 9.1. Materials :Ceramic tiles - Sizes may 200 x 200mm / 200 x 300mm / 300x450mm, the thickness of tiles shall vary from 5mm to 9.5mm. The colours and brand or design shall be approved by the Architect/E.I.C. 9.2. Mortar Backing :All joints in the face work shall be racked out to a depth equal to not less than the width of the joints or as directed by the Architect/E.I.C. Concrete surfaces shall be properly backed to the lines and levels. All dirt, oil, dust or any other loose materials that might interfere with satisfactory bond shall be removed. The surface shall be cleaned and scrubbed with fresh water and kept wet for 6 hours prior to applying backing mortar. The dado/skirting work shall not be commenced unless the preparatory work is approved by the Architect/E.I.C. The proportion of mortar for backing shall be 1:4 cement mortar (1 cement : 4 coarse sand). The thickness of mortar backing shall not be less than 15mm. 9.3. Workmanship :a) Fixing of Tiles :Tile fixing adhesive shall be applied on the entire back surface of the tiles and pressed rigidly on the levelling sub-base firmly and pitted with wooden mallet etc. The joints should be filled with approved tile joint filler. 138 b) 9.4. After the tiles have been fixed the surplus mortar that may have been come out of the joints shall be cleared off before it sets. After the complete curing, the dado or skirting work shall be washed thoroughly clean. Rates to include :Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere in this contract, the rates for the items of dado or skirting shall include the following :i) Preparing/tracing the surface of the base or structural member to the required line, level or slope to the specified configuration with all bye works. ii) Backing mortar. iii) Providing and fixing tiles including all specials, like round edges, angles, copings etc. in neat cement float over backing mortar including cutting of tiles and wastage of tiles etc. iv) Jointing of the tiles with approved tile joint filler. v) Curing. vi) Cleaning the wall, dado, skirting surface and flooring from all stairs and removal of all debris. vii) All labours, material, use of tools and equipments and consumables for carrying out the items as specified above including all bye-works for achieving the required surface finish. viii) Work at all positions, heights depths, line, and level, with all lead and lift. Mode of Measurement :Measurement shall be in Sq.m. as provided. 10.0 MARBLES & GRANITES : Marbles to be used shall be hard, dense and durable and of selective quality. These shall be obtained from the approved supplier. The shades of marble to be used shall be approved by the Interior Designer / Engineer-in-Charge before laying the same. These shall be free from any cracks or other defects developed during sawing Pre-polished granite shall be of approved shades and colour and of selective quality. These shall be hard, dense and shall be obtained from the approved supplier. These shall be free from any sorts of cracks. 11.0 MARBLE FLOORING / GRANITE STONE FLOORING 11.1. Materials : 11.1.1 Marble Slab The marble shall be approved shade/texture and sources as mentioned in the schedule of quantities and their size and the thickness shall be as shown on the drawings and as 139 approved by the Architect/Employer. They shall be of selected quality, hard, dense, uniform and homogeneous in texture and free from flaws, cracks or other structural defects. It shall have even and crystalline grains. The surface shall be machine polish to an even and perfectly plain surface and edges machine cut true and square. The rear face shall be rough enough to provide a key for the mortar. No slab shall be thinner than the specified thickness at its thinnest part. A few approved samples of finished slabs to be used shall be deposited by the contractor in the office of the Architect/Employer. Unless otherwise mentioned the thickness of the marble shall be of not less than 18 mm. 11.1.2. Granite slabs shall not be less than 18 mm thick and will conform to all physical characteristics as stated in above para. Thickness of flamed granites shall not be less than 25mm or as specified in the item. Concrete Base & Mortar Bedding The base of cement concrete shall be laid and compacted to a true plain surface and to the required slopes and below the level of the finished floors to the extent of the thickness of the slabs and mortar bedding. Cement mortar for bedding may be mixed manually or by a mechanical mixer as directed. The amount of water added shall be the minimum necessary to give just sufficient plasticity for laying and satisfactory bedding. Care shall be taken in preparing the mortar to ensure that there are no hard lumps that would interfere with the even bedding of the stones. Before spreading the mortar subfloor or base shall be prepared/ treated exactly to the lines, levels and slopes, cleaned of all dirt, scum, or loose materials and then well wetted without forming any pool of water on the surface. In case of R.C.C floors, the top shall be left a little dry. All point of level for the finished paving surface shall be marked out. The mortar shall then be evenly and smoothly spread over the base by the use of screed battens only over so much area as will be covered with slabs within half an hour. The thickness of the mortar bedding shall not be less than 20 mm. For laying granite flooring above procedure should be followed. 11.1.3 Workmanship (For marble stones slabs and granite stone slab) 11.1.4 Laying Marble slabs / granite stone slab - Before laying , the marble shall be thoroughly wetted with clean water. Neat cement grout of honey like consistency shall be spread on the mortar bed over as much area as could be covered with the slabs within half an hour. The specified type of marble slabs shall be laid to pattern as directed on the neat cement float and shall be evenly and firmly laid to pattern as directed to the required level and slope in the mortar bed Each slab shall be gently tapped with a wooden mallet, till it is firmly and properly bedded. There shall be no hollows left. If there is a hollow sound gently tapping on the slabs, such slabs shall be removed and rested properly. The edges of the slabs shall be buttered with slurry of gray/white cement mixed with pigment matching the colour of stone slab and joint shall be hair fine in width and straight line grouted with neat coloured cement slurry to match the colour of the marble. The Joints shall be struck smooth but there shall be no smearing over the mortar of the slabs. The edges of the adjoining slabs shall be in one plan. All surplus cement slurry Shall be removed and the surface wiped out clean with wet soft cloth. The flooring shall be kept undistrubed for at least 7 days, and wet of fourteen days. Marble flooring shall be finished as specified by the Architect/Consultant. The same procedure shall be followed while laying granite stone slabs. 140 Rates to include : 11.1.5 Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere in this contract, the rates for item of marble flooring shall include for the following : 11.1.6 i) Preparing/treating the sub-floor or base. ii) All labour, materials and equipments and consumables, sub-base, laying mortar bed and cement grout and fixing marble slabs, as specified above and making up the joints including grinding and finishing to the satisfaction of Architect/Employer, polishing and all bye works. iii) Any cutting and wastages, if required, to make it in required size/shape and configuration as specified in the drawing. iv) Curing and removal of muck. v) Cleaning the floor from all stains etc. vi) Forming coves at junctions of wall, rounding or nosing at the edge and making holes or opening wherever required and finishing with the adjoining surface and machine polishing wherever required. vii) At all positions, heights, depths, line and level, with all lead and lift. Mode of Measurement : The measurement shall be in sq. metres for the actual marble / granite stone flooring provided. 12.0 ARTIFICIAL STONE FLOORING WITH HARDENER 12.1. Flooring with Non-metallic floor hardner It shall consist of an underbed and a topping laid on an already laid and matured concrete base. a) Thickness b) Mix : : i) Underbed : c) Unless otherwise specified, the underbed thickness shall be of 40mm and topping shall be of 12 MM. 1 part by vol. of cement + 2 parts by vol. of course sand + 4 parts by vol. of 10mm graded stone chips. Materials : The material should be ready to use, high abrasion and wear resistant. Bonds monolithically to the base concrete. It must be resistant to oils and grease and should not shrink or crack. The materials should conforms to IS-1237 and ASTM-E97. The material should be single component and have compressive strength of 70N/Sq.mm. after 28 days curing. d) Application : 141 The material should be evenly spread on the freshly laid concrete surface when it has set initially but still green enough to react with the floor hardener. Wooden floats or power trowel with disc may be used to make the surface uniformly finished smooth. the procedure of application and finishing as laid down by the manufacturers may be followed. The rate of application shall be 5 kg. of Hardener per sq. metre of area. e) Curing : The floor with non-metallic hardener finish should be cured for 28 days before putting it on to traffic. 13.0 WOODEN FLOORING i) Seasoning and preservations All timber used for under floor members i.e. joists and battens shall be thoroughly seasoned in accordance with IS : 1141. After seasoning of timber shall be treated with approved preservative in accordance with IS : 401. ii) Supporting joists and battens Main beam and joists of the class of wood sections specified in the description of item or as specified/directed by Engineer-in-charge shall be fixed in position to dead levels. The width of joints of the members shall not be less than 50mm. The arrangement of joists and battens shall be as per the design furnished by contractor or sub vendors whose products are approved. iii) Boards It shall be of class of timber and type as specified in schedule only selected boards and uniform width shall be used and shall conform to perfect geometrics. Edges clean. The width of boards shall not be less than 100mm and more than 150mm width. The same width of boards shall be maintained throughout the length of the room unless the width of the room is not in exact multiple of width of board. The length of board shall not be more than 2.40m in length. The length of board should be chosen such a way that the board do get at least 3 supports and supporting joists/battens should not be more than 600mm apart. The boards shall be planed true to its surface and longitudinal joints of the planks/boards should be tongued and grooved and end joints may be rebated. The bottom surface of the boards should also be planed where it is exposed. The boards shall be fixed with the joists/battens with stainless steel screws. The joists on which the planks/boards are to be fixed should be perfectly in level and true to line. The end planks/boards shall be accurately fixed and tightened in position. The screw holes should be filled with approved filler/stops. Each adjacent board shall be carefully jointed and tightened. For fixing the boards to the joists two screws shall be used at each end of the board and one screws at each of the intermediate joist in a zig zag manner. In case of parquete or other type of special type of flooring where components (top) are 142 factory manufactured and thin in section, they will be fixed on a plywood board of adequate thickness to be fixed on joists and battens, over which the specialized floor tiles shall be fixed with approved adhesive and headless pins. The surface shall be finished as per manufacturer’s specifications. Wherever branded floors are indicated in the schedule the said branded flooring system should be done as per the manufacturer’s specification. Preferably with their authorised applicators. 15.0 PLYWOOD : It shall be of the type specified in the drawing and shall conform to relevant I.S. Code and shall be obtained from approved manufacturer. All plywood / veneered surface shall be of matching type and as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge/ Interior Designer. 16.0 PHENOL BONDED PLYWOOD (BWR) : Commercial plywood, conforming to I.S : 303/1989 bonded with Phenol Formaldehyde Synthetic Resin of B.W.R. Type specified in I.S : 848/1974, of any approved make. 17.0 PHENOL BONDED BLOCK BOARD (BWR) : Commercial Solid core Board conforming to I.S : 1659/1990 boded with Phenol Formaldehyde Synthetic Resin of B.W.R. Type specified in I.S : 848/1974 of any approved make. 18.0 PANEL DOOR : Unless otherwise specified, factory made Panel Door shutter conforming to I.S : 1003 (Part - ) / 1999 made of best wood and treated with preservative with 100mm. width styles and top rail and 175mm. width lock and bottom rail having panel insert of 9mm/12mm. thick plywood conforming to I.S : 303/1989 bonded with Phenol formaldehyde Synthetic Resin of B.W.R. type specified in I.S : 848/1974 of any approved make. 19.0 PHENOL BONDED WOODEN FLUSH DOOR : Unless otherwise specified commercial wooden flush door shutter (40mm or above) with Solid Block Board Core consisting of wooden strips less than 25mm. width encased in a frame constructed of styles and rails of 65mm. width conforming to I.S : 2202 (Part - /1999) bonded with Phenol Formaldehyde Synthetic Resin of B.W.R. type specified in I.S : 848/1974 of any approved make. 20.0 DECORATIVE LAMINATES / VEENERS : Laminate sheets /Veeners shall be laminated 1mm to 1.5mm. and veneers 3mm to 4mm thick with tolerances as specified by the manufacturers and shall be obtained from the approved source. Samples must have prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/ Interior Designer. 21.0 BRASS MONGERIES : 143 Samples of all fittings, fixtures, nails, screws, hinges, etc. shall be of approved make and shall conform to specifications laid down in the schedule or in absence thereof to the directions of the Engineer-in-Charge/Interior Designer. 22.0 WOOD & WOOD WORK : It shall be of good quality and well seasoned and shall have uniform colour, reasonably straight grains and shall be free from large, loose, dead knots, cracks, shakes, wrap, twists bends, sapwood or defects of any kind. Before using the wood, prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/Interior Designer shall be obtained and wood is to be chemically treated as per direction of the Engineer-inCharge. Timber shall be termite/wood borer proof and guaranteed against such damages for a period of 5 (five) years to be provided. The scantlings shall be sawn in the direction of grained. All wood work shall be neatly and truly finished to the exact dimensions required. No patching or plugging of any kind will be allowed. All joints shall be simple, neat and strong, truly and accurately fitted and coated with white lead before being fitted together. Dimension of the wood specified in the schedule should be treated as raw dimension, unless otherwise specified. The kind of nails and screws shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/ Interior Designer and the heads of the same shall be sunk and putted or dealt with as the Engineer-inCharge / Interior Designer may direct. All timber surfaces unless otherwise specified in the Schedule of Quantities are to be finished in approved/natural colour with N.C. Lacquer in matt satin finish or as directed by the Engineer-inCharge. All plywood veneered surface should be matching type and should be upto the full satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge / Interior Designer. Glue used shall be of approved quality of the approved manufacturer.. 23.0 BAMBOO ARTICLES The following articles of bamboo origin products are proposed to be used. 23.1. Bamboo Strip Boards (BSB) : a) Supply of Prefinished Bamboo Strip Boards for Flooring/Cladding made out of treated and seasoned all four sides planed bamboo strip to be supplied in standard Size – 960 X 96 X 15mm, Type Vertical Carbonated, Finish – Gloss, coated with 5 layers of transparent, UV – Cured Polyurethane coatings on the top and one layer base coat at the back, Tongued and Grooved on all four sides matched for each laying. (Dimensional Tolerance +/-0.1mm). b) Supply of Prefinished Bamboo Strip Boards for Skirting made out of treated and seasoned all four sides planed bamboo strip to be supplied in standard Size – 960 X 96 X 15mm, Type Vertical Carbonated, Finish – Gloss, coated with 5 layers of transparent, UV – Cured Polyurethane coatings on the top and one layer base coat at the back, machined and milled on all four sides quarter round on top edge and 18mm wide 8mm deep grove at the back for (Dimensional tolerance (Dimensional Tolerance +/-0.1mm). 144 23.2. c) Supply of Raw Bamboo Strip Boards for Handrails/Architrave/Beads/Lipings/ Moldings made out of treated and seasoned all four sides planed bamboo strips in standard 1000mm length, machined at right angle on all four sides as per DMA approved design. (Dimensional Tolerance +/-0.2mm); (Standard Section : 75 X 75, 75 X 60mm, 60 X 60mm, 60 X 50mm, 30 X 15mm, 25 X 15mm, 20 X 12mm, 12 X 12mm, 12 X 8mm). d) Supply of Raw Bamboo Strip Board Sections for furniture making made out of treated and seasoned all four sides planed bamboo strips in standard 1000mm length, machined at right angle on all four sides. (Dimensional Tolerance +/- 0.2mm), 33(Standard Section : 60 X 60mm, 50 X 60mm, 50 X 50mm, 50 X 40mm, 40 X 40mm, 40 X 30mm, 40 X 20mm and 20 X 20mm). Bamboo Flat Boards (BFB) : Supply of Raw Bamboo Flat Boards for sub-floor having multiple cross-grained layers of treated and seasoned flattened bamboo strips with the top layers having unshaven bamboo skin, duly trimmed in all four sides, Size : 2140 X 1220mm, Thickness : 20mm, (Dimensional Tolerance : +/1mm). 23.3. Bamboo Composite Boards (BCB) : a) Dimensional Tolerance : +/ - 1%). Supply of Raw Bamboo Composite board sections for door frames made of treated and seasoned flattened bamboo strips as inner core and four side squared bamboo strips in top line having not more than one tight joint to gain length, duly machined and rebated as per requirement, with 8mm flat lipping on both side edges, in Sizes : 3050 X 150 X 50mm with 30/35/40mm wide rebate; 2450 X 150 X 50mm with 30/35/40mm wide rebate. 23.4. Bamboo Mat Boards (BMB) : Supply of Raw Bamboo Mat Boards for partitions, paneling, cladding etc. made of multiple layers of treated and seasoned woven bamboo mats, duly trimmed and sanded in standard sizes and thickness (as specified by DMA) (Standard Thicknes : 4/6/8/12/18mm) (Dimensional : Tolerance : +/-1mm). 23.5. Installation and fixing of Articles of Bamboo : i) Laying and fixing of Bamboo Flat Boards as Sub-floor at dead level to be nailed or glued to concrete floor. (Charges to include costs of necessary hardware and adhesive). ii) Laying and fixing of Prefinished Bamboo Strip Boards as flooring on Sub-floor with tongue and groove structure at edges and ends tightly joined and floated freely over a combination of polyethylene and thermorex foam following free floating installation guideline of the board manufacturer. (Charges to include costs of polyethylene, thermorex foam and necessary hardware, adhesive and PU coating for touch ups). iii) Laying and fixing of Prefinished Bamboo Strip Boards as wall base to be glued and nailed to 145 cemented walls following installation guideline of the board manufacturer. (Charges to include costs of necessary hardware and adhesive). 24.0 N.C. LACOUER : N.C. Lacquer should be of “CI” or similar equivalent. Approval of Engineer-in-Charge / Interior Designer is obligatory. Application of N.C. Lacquer would be guided by the manufacturer’s specification. 25.0 MELAMINE POLISH : The surface to be prepared as per approved shade and texture with French Polish coating. Necessary water paper to be applied for preparation of smoothen surface before applying Sealer coat. After drying of first coat of Melamine polish water paper to be applied before second and third coat of final polishing. The work has to be carried out to the satisfaction of the Engineer-inCharge / Interior Designer. 26.0 PREPARATORY WORKS FOR PAINTING ETC. : Painting, polishing, plaster of Paris work etc. shall not be taken up unless the surfaces to be so treated are made ready with all related preliminary works and the approval of the Engineer-inCharge / Interior Designer is obtained. 27.0 GYPBOARD CEILING : Gypbaord ceiling shall be obtained either from the manufacturer or of their authorized dealers.(M/s. Gyproc of St. Gobain, M/s. Lloyd Insulation or of M/s. India Gypsum Ltd. etc. The entire installation work is to be carried out in conformity with manufacturer’s specification and as per detail drawing of the Interior Designer. 28.0 CEILING LININGS : 28.1.1. M/F suspended ceiling regular (single layer) (GS-MFSC-4.1). 28.1.2. M/F suspended ceiling which includes G.I. perimeter channels of size 0.55mm thick having one flange of 20mm and another flange of 30mm and a web of 27mm alongwith perimeter of ceiling, screw fixed to brick wall/partition with the help of nylon sleeves and screws, at 610mm centers. Then suspending G.I. having hologram intermediate channels of size 45mm, 0.9mm thick with two flanges of 15mm each from the soffit at 1220mm centers with ceiling angle of width 25mm x 10mm x 0.55mm thick fixed to soffit with G.I. cleat and steel expansion fasteners. Ceiling section of 0.55mm thickness having knurled wed of 51.5nn and two flange of 26mm each with lips of 10.5mm are then fixed to the intermediate channel with the help of connecting clip and in direction perpendicular to the intermediate channel at 457mm centers, 12.5mm tapered edge Gypboard (confirming to IS: 2095-1982 & 2542-1981) is then screw fixed to ceiling section with 25mm drywall screws at 230mm centers. Screw fixing is done mechanically either with screwdriver or drilling machine with suitable attachment. 28.1.3. Finally the boards are then jointed and finished so as to have flush look which includes filling and finishing the tapered and square edges of the boards with jointing compound, joint paper tape and two coats of drywall top coat suitable for Gypboard (as per recommended practices of India 146 Gypsum or equivalent). Note : For light fittings, grill diffusers & cutouts etc. have to be made with frame of perimeter channels of size 20mm x 27mm x 30mm x 0.55mm thick, supported suitably. 28.1.4. Metal stud partition (Single layer) (GS-MSP-975-1.2) 28.1.5. 97mm thick Metal stud partition which includes one layer of tapered edge 12.5mm thick Gypboard (conforming to IS :2095-1982 & 2542-1981) Screw fixed with 25mm drywall screw at 300mm centers to either side of 70mm studs (0.55mm thick having one flange of 34mm and another flange of 36mm made of G.I. Steel having hologram) placed at 610mm center to center in 72mm floor and ceiling channel (0.55mm thick having two equal flanges of 32mm made of G.I. steel) with joints staggered to avoid through joints. Finally square and tapered edges of the boards are to be jointed and finished so as to have a flush book which includes filling and finishing with jointing compound, joint paper tape and two coats of drywall top coat suitable for Gypboard (as per recommended practices of India Gypsum or equivalent). 28.1.6. Specification of Luxalon Unperforated Linear Aluminium False Ceiling System – 84C/300C a) Specification of Luxalon® UnPerforated Linear Aluminium False Ceiling System – 84C./300C Luxalon 84C Unperforated Linear aluminum panel false ceiling system as manufactured by Hunter Douglas India Pvt. Ltd. or any other similar equivalent (shade as per Luxalon® Colour chart). The system shall consist of Panel 84mm wide X 12.5mm deep X 0.5mm thick with square edges andRecess Flange of 24mm in standard length of 1 meter – 6 meters. The Panels shall be coil coated on a continuous paint line, double baked & roll formed from stove enameled corrosion resistant aluminum alloy AA5050 (Al.Mg.) for higher strength & good roll forming characteristics. Panels shall be clipped to an enameled & roll formed Aluminum panel carrier of 32mm wide X 39mm deep X 0.90mm thick in standard length of 5 meters. The panel carrier shall be double baked & roll formed from enameled corrosion resistant aluminum alloy AA5050/5052 (Al.Mg.) in Black colour with cut outs to hold the panels in modules of 100mm & provide a 16mm closed gap between 2 panels. The carriers shall be fixed at a distance of 1.3 meters c/c. The carriers shall be suspended from the roof by 4mm diameter G.I. suspension rod with special height adjustment clips made from spring steel. The rod hangers shall be fixed at a distance of 1.2 meters c/c. The G.I. rod hangers shall be fixed to the roof by ‘J’ hooks & nylon inserts. Wherever required, two panels will be coupled horizontally with panel splice & similarly for carriers, carrier splice shall be used. At the perimeter, where the panels & wall meets ‘L’ Edge profile Powder coated shall be used. b) Specification of Luxalon® UnPerforated Linear Aluminium False Ceiling System – 300C. Luxalon 300C Unperforated Linear aluminum panel false ceiling system as manufactured by Hunter Douglas India Pvt. Ltd. or any other similar equivalent (shade as per Luxalon® Colour chart). The system shall consist of Panel 300mm wide X 29mm deep X 0.7mm thick. The panels to feature 5mm bevel edge to form a visually closed ‘V’ grove joint between 2 panels. The panels shall be in standard length of 1 meter – 6 meters. The Panels shall be coil coated 147 on a continuous paint line, double baked & roll formed from stove enameled corrosion resistant aluminum alloy AA3005 for higher strength & good roll forming characteristics. Panels shall be clipped to an enameled & roll formed Aluminum panel carrier of 41.5mm wide X 62mm deep X 0.95mm thick in standard length of 5 meters. The panel carrier shall be double baked & roll formed from enameled corrosion resistant aluminum alloy AA5052 (Al.Mg.) in Black colour with cut outs to hold the panels in modules of 300mm. The Carrier shall be provided with special Lock In Clips to lock the panels if desired. The first carriers shall be fixed at a distance of 300mm from the wall & thereafter at 1.3 meters c/c. The carriers shall be suspended from the roof by 4mm diameter G.I. suspension rod with special height adjustment clips made from spring steel. The rod hangers shall be fixed at a distance of 1.2 meters c/c. The G.I. rod hangers shall be fixed to the roof by ‘J’ hooks & nylon inserts. Wherever required, two panels will be coupled horizontally with pressure clips & similarly for carriers, carrier splice shall be used. At the perimeter, where the panels & wall meets ‘L’ Edge profile Powder coated shall be used. c) Paint Finish: The panels shall be chromatised for maximum bond between metal & paint & enameled twice under high temperature, visible side with full primer & finish coat & inner side with primer coat & skin coat in a continuous paint line. 28.1.7. G.I. FRAME WORK (600 X 600) CLADDED WITH 12MM PLY (BWR) BOARD FOR FALSE CEILING WORK 28.1.8. G.I. frame work (600 x 600) shall be consist of G.I. perimeter channels of size 0.55mm thick having one flange of 20mm and another flange of 30mm and a web of 27mm alongwith perimeter of ceiling, screw fixed to brick wall/partition with the help of nylon sleeves and screws at 600mm centers. Then suspending G.I. having hologram intermediate channels of size 45mm, 0.9mm thick with two flanges of 15mm each from the soffit at 1200mm centers with ceiling angle of width 25mm x 10mm x 0.5mm thick fixed to soffit with G.I. cleat and steel expansion fasteners. The ceiling section 0.5mm thick having knurled web of 51.5mm and two flanges of 26mm each with lips of 10.5mm are then fixed to the intermediate channels with the help of connecting clip and in the direction perpendicular to the intermediate channels at 457mm centers. 12mm BWR ply board as per IS : 740/1996 is then screw fixed to ceiling section with 25mm dry wall screws at 230mm centers. Screw fixing is done mechanically either with screwdriver or drilling machine with suitable attachment. 28.1.9. Plywood : Plywood shall be 12mm thick marine ply (WBP) as per IS 710/1996. 148 149 9.0 GLASS & MIRROR : Glasses and mirrors shall be free from waves, scratches and any other defects and shall be of superior quality available in the market. Before using, samples to be got approved from the Engineer-in-Charge / Interior Designer. 30.0 HARDWARE : All hardware materials should be of approved variety. Before using samples to be got approved from the Engineer-in-Charge / Interior Designer. 31.0 AUTOMATIC SLIDING DOORS : Specification Text for Sliding Door Operator Product : DORMA ES200 Sliding Operator system or its equivalent system Automatic sliding door operator Automatic sliding door operator, modular design, including internal cover. 1/2 - panel sliding door Operator Dimensions (H x T): 100 x 180 mm. Microprocessor control, self-learning, reverses when obstruction is encountered. Clear Passage Width : 2-panel = 900 – 2,000 mm (for 4,150mm Operator length) 2-panel = 900 – 3,000 mm (for 6,250mm Operator length) Clear Passage Height : LH = 2,100 mm – 3,000 mm Door weight : Bi-Parting Door Panel, max. 2 x 160 kg. Single-Parting Door Panel, max. 1 x 200 kg Function programs : Program modes : Off, Automatic, Permanent open, Partial opening, Exit only, Self-regulating partial open, Exit only partial opening, Night-bank facility. Compliant with future European standards and specifications as per EN 12650. 150 Microprocessor-controlled control unit. Self-learning, with adjustable parameters for opening and closing speed, hold-open time and opening and closing force. With pulse expansion for cheque card or code card reader or key switch. Class of protection IP 20. Produced according to the guidelines for power-operated windows, doors and gates BGR 232, the UVV and the VDE regulations. TÜV design tested, tested according to the low voltage guidelines, production according to ISO 9001:2000 certification. Fulfils the DIN V18650 (EN 12650). DORMA ES200 Operators are of very sturdy design with Self balancing Panel suspension system and with Anti-Jump fitting. Operator System Section: 100 mm (Ht) X 180 mm (Depth). With clip-on Cover Profile for easy installation and Service. With separate Track Profile with Rubber lining with ‘Noise Reduction’ and Smooth-ride quality. Program Function: Off, Automatic, Permanent open, Exit only, Partial open. Night-bank switch (Optional) – Additional External Operation Switch incase Operator has been Locked. Adjustable Hold Open Time: Hold Open is easily adjustable at module as per client’s requirement. Hold Open Range: 0.5 Sec – 30 Sec. Adjustable Parameters Via parameter display and selection key at electronic module. Adjustable closing Speed: 10 -50 Cm/S. Adjustable Opening Speed: 10 – 70 Cm/S Hold Open time: 0.5 – 60 Sec Night Bank Opening time: 0.5 – 30 Sec Auto Error Display, with Error Code Display for error correction. Read-out error store with error codes Additional Equipment Integration: Connection for External 24V DC supply: Operator can be integrated and also supply operating voltage of 24V DC for one external device e.g. Smoke Detector, alarm system. Carrier-head assembly designed for: a.Frameless Glass Sliding Panels. b.Aluminum / Wooden Framed Panels. 151 Emergency off – Connection for Emergency Off Button, On activation Operator will Open Fully and Stop all functions, enabling passenger to pass through in case of Panic. Fail Safe / Fail Secure: Choice between emergency opening(Fail Safe) and emergency closing (Fail Secure) in the event of a power cut (with battery pack). Connections for Air-Lock Control. Safety devices : Inbuilt Obstruction detection feature with automatic reversing cycle on obstruction, dynamic and static force limitation, emergency control unit (emergency stop). Safety Photo Cells: 1 / 2 Pair of Photo Cells are provided for safety of passenger standing in line of motion of Moving Panel and for through-passage monitoring. Operator can be also be integrated with following Systems. Access Control System with Proximity Card system / Codic Card Reader. Keypad System. Biometric sensor system. Push Buttons. Connection : 230 V, 50/60 Hz, Stabilized-UPS Supply. Activators : (√) Radar system: 02 Nos, with 24 GHz, Mandatory as Int’Nat Standards. ( -01 Pair Locking : (√ ) Electro-mechanical locking, Bi-stable. Color light alloy parts : (√) silver, Anodised E6/C0 - standard 32.0 PAINTING : a) Ready mixed synthetic enamel paints and primer shall be of approved quality, colour and shall be obtained from approved ,manufacturer’s. These shall be in sealed containers. Surface to be painted shall be thoroughly cleaned sand papered and/or rubbed with emery cloth. In case of rusted steel surface, it shall be ensured all corroded rust is 152 removed. In case of timber, the knots and nail hole shall be filled with knotting and stopping materials. The prepared surface shall be allowed to dry and sand papered smooth. The paint shall be applied with brushes of type and size suitable for the job and subsequent coat shall be applied on the previous coat and care shall be taken so that dust or other foreign materials do not settle. b) 32.1. Textured paints shall be of approved quality, colour and shall be obtained from approved manufacturers. These shall be applied with foam roller or brush as per discretion of Interior Designer/Engineer-in-Charge. These shall be applied one or more coats as per the item described in B.O.Q. MATERIAL : The paint and primers in general shall be of approved quality, colour and shade. 32.2. SCAFFOLDING : This shall be strong and stout, rigidly tied, catering to the safety needs and shall be double or single scaffolding as required and directed. If ladders are used, pieces of gunny bags or cloths bags shall be tied on their tops to avoid damage of scratches to the plastered surfaces. Proper stage scaffolding shall be erected when painting the ceiling. 32.3. PREPARATION OF THE SURFACE : a) New Surface : The surface to be painted shall be cleaned and all cracks, holes and surface defects shall be repaired with plaster of paris for spot fillings, and with filler prepared with whiting, water and a little quantity paint for filling and levelling the wider areas. b) Old Surface : i) The surfaces, which had been previously painted with emulsion paint, shall be lightly rubbed down and washed with clean water. ii) The surface, which had been painted with oil bound distemper or oil paint, shall be cleaned, washed and sand papered. iii) The surface, finished with lime colour wash, powdered distemper, etc. shall be completely scrapped off to the bare surfaces. iv) In case, after scrapping the surface, any cracks, holes or other surface defects are noted, the same shall be repaired, before applying priming coat, with plaster of paris for spot filling and with filler prepared with whiting, water and a little quantity of paint for filling and levelling the wider areas. 153 32.4. PRIMING COAT : The priming coat of the approved shade shall be applied over the completely dry surface in the manner as recommended by the paint manufacturers. The emulsion paint in the priming coat may be thinned down with 20% water or as recommended by the paint manufacturer. Tarpentine or any other solvent shall not be used for thinning the paint. 32.5. APPLICATION OF PAINT : The recommendation of approved paint manufacturer, whose product is used, shall be followed regarding the preparation of the surface and the application of the priming and finishing coats. The Contractor shall arrange for technical assistance and supervision from the paint manufacturer during the execution of the painting work. After the priming coat has been applied and perfectly dried, all holes, scratches, if any, shall be repaired as mentioned in preparation of surface and then the second coat of paint of shade of approved shade and manufacture shall be evenly applied and allowed to dry. The third coat shall be carefully applied to achieve smooth and even surface after the previous coats have dried. Minimum 3 coats shall be applied inclusive of primer coat. All paint are to be applied with good quality brushes and finished with spongy roller so that no impressions of hair line remains on the surface. This is to be approved by Architects/Employer. If a proper and even surface is not obtained to the satisfaction of the Architect/Employer in coats, the Contractor shall carry out additional coats of painting for the approval of Architects/ Employer at Contractor's expenses. Care shall be taken so that dust or other foreign materials do not settle or disfigure the various coats. 32.6. RATES TO INCLUDE : Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere in the contract the rates for the item of paint shall include for the following :i) All labour, materials, consumables and equipment necessary to carry out the work. ii) Supplying the approved emulsion paint for priming and finishing coats. iii) Preparing the surface for receiving the primer and finishing coats. iv) Providing scaffolding/ladder/platform/staging including its erections and dismantling. v) Application of one primer coat and minimum two coats of finishing. If a proper and even surface is not obtained to the satisfaction of Architects/ Employer, coats of painting to be done for the approval of Architects/ Employer at Contractor's expense. vi) Protection of painted surface when they have dried and being handed over. vii) Expenses, if any, for supervision and technical assistance supplied by the approved paint manufacturers. viii) Cleaning the floor of droppings and splashes. 154 32.7. MODE OF MEASUREMENT : The measurement shall be in square metre. The mode of measurement shall be applicable similar to that for white washing. 33.0 SYNTHETIC ENAMEL PAINT : 33.1. Material : Synthetic enamel paints and primers, in general, shall be of approved quality, colour and of approved manufacturer. These materials shall be in sealed tins and shall be opened in the presence of the Architects/Employer. 33.2. Preparation of Surface : 33.2.1. Iron and Steel Works : Surface to be painted shall be thoroughly cleaned, sand papered and/or rubbed with emery cloth, if necessary, to remove grease, mortar or any other foreign materials. In case of rusted surface, it shall be first cleaned with wire brush till the corroded rust is removed. The prepared surface shall be shiny and free from brush marks, patches, blisters and other irregularities. The surface thus finished shall be got approved for painting. 33.2.2 Wood Work : All surface to be painted shall be thoroughly cleaned, sand papered and free from all foreign materials. In case of surfaces having knots and nail holes, this shall be filled knotting and stopping materials. The materials shall consist of pure shellac dissolved in methylated spirit. Stopping materials shall consist of putty. The surface thus treated shall be allowed to dry and then sand paper smooth (for veneered surface, a surface film or french chalk shall be provided to give a smooth surface prior to application of primer). 33. 2.3. Application : After preparing the surface, a primer coat shall be applied. The primer coat shall be ready mixed of approved make and manufacturer. After the primer coat is applied and perfectly dried, all holes, cracks etc. still remaining shall be filled in with putty and the surface sand papered smooth. Then a second coat of paint of approved shade and manufacturer shall be evenly applied and allowed to dry. The third coat shall be carefully applied to achieve smooth and even surface after the previous coat has dried up. Minimum 3 coats of paint shall be applied inclusive of a primer coat. If a proper and even surface is not obtained to the satisfaction of the Architects/Employer in 3 coats, Contractor shall carry out additional coats of painting for the approval at Contractor's own expenses. Care shall be taken to see that dust or other foreign materials do not settle or otherwise disfigure the various coats. 33.4. Rates to Include : 155 Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere in this contract, the rate for the item of painting shall include for the following :- 32.5. i) All labour, materials, consumables, equipment etc. necessary to carry out the work. ii) Supplying the approved paint for priming and finishing coats. iii) Preparing the surface including knotting and stopping for receiving the priming and finishing coats. iv) Providing strong and stout, catering to safety needs (wherever required), single or double scaffolding including its erection and dismantling. v) Application of a minimum of one primer coat and two coats of finishing, to the required finish line and level, at all heights, with all lead and lift and adopting all safety measures. If a proper and even surface is not obtained to the satisfaction of the Architects/Employer in 3 coats, Contractor shall carry out additional coats of painting to the approval of Architects/Employer at Contractor's own expenses. vi) Protection to painted surface till dried and handed over. vii) Cleaning walls, floor, etc. of dropping and splashes. Mode of Measurement : Painting to wood work, steel etc. shall be measured separately, as per I.S. 1200 (Part - XV) 1968. 33. WOOD & STEEL PRIMER : a) Wood primer Wood primer of approved brand and manufacturer is to be applied on the wooden surface which would be free from moisture and loose particles. b) Steel primer For steel surface red oxide zinc chromate primer of approved brand and manufacture and as per direction of the Engineer-in-charge is to be applied on the surface. The surface should be made free of grease, rust, moisture and loose particles. 34.0 SPECIAL TYPE OF PAINTING : 34.1 Polyurethene wood finish painting for Interior works. The finished painted surface produce wood texture finish. The process would involve minimum 3 coat application, if proper finish not achieved more coats would be necessary. All the stages of application shall be with spray painting with a pressure of 2.2 to 2.8 kg./Cum. inclusive of the primer application. The process should preferably be done by the authorized applicator of the approved manufacturer of the paint. After application of primer on the prepared surface, the surface will be sand paper with Emery paper 320 or 400 and wipe clean. Then apply the 2nd coat after 8 to 10 hours with 15 to 30% dilution with viscosity limit of 15 to 20. After 2nd coat surface to be Emery papered (300 to 400 grade) and wiped clean. Then apply the 3rd coat after waiting 8 to 10 hrs. If staining is required, 156 approved strainer of the same manufacturer should be used. Safety precautions as specified by manufacturer should be followed. 34.2 Polyurethene painting with Palette finish for Interiors & Exteriors PU palette finish paint should be from an approved manufacturer. In order to achieve the best finish it is advisable to get the work done by the authorized applicator oh the manufacturer. Otherwise a skilled painter may apply the said paint with manufacturer’s supervision. For optimum performance the paint should be applied at a temperature of 200 C to 400 C And humidity not above 70%. The PU palette finish paint should be applied on solid wooden base duly treated with Emery paper 320 and applying the primer with spray at 2.20 to 2.80 kg./Cum pressure. In case to be applied on previously painted surface, the existing painting must be scraped clean. The dilution of paint shall be 25 to 35% and viscosity level between 17 to 21. 4-5 hours gap should be given for subsequent coating. The final coating should be finished with shine paper till it achieve the desired sheen in the surface. Safety precaution as directed in the manufacturer’s specification should be followed. 35.0 ALUMINIUM PARTITION : 35.1. All aluminium partition or others shall be procured from the reputed manufacturers, subject to the approval of Architect/Employer. Aluminium sections for fabricating frame work of doors, windows, etc. shall be of extruded sections conforming to I.S.: 1948 & 1949 of latest edition or as manufactured by Indian Aluminium Co. Ltd. or approved equivalent. The alloy used shall conform to I.S. Designation H.E.9 - WP of I.S. 733. Extruded section shall have a minimum 3mm thickness. All sections shall be approved by Architect/Employer before fabrication is taken up. Door frames, mullions, transoms etc. shall be anodised to 20 Micron thickness in a bath of sulphuric acid to provide a uniform coating. A protective transparent coating shall be applied to the sections before shipment from the factory. All works for doors, windows and frames etc. shall be fitted and shop assembled to a first class job, and ready for erection. Shop joints shall be made to hair lines and then welded or braced. Work on the above, other than these described shall be carefully fitted and assembled with neat in concealed location and on edges of doors. Field connections of all work may be made with concealed screws or other approved type of fasteners. All fasteners connecting aluminium members should be of stainless steel. Glazing beads shall be of snap fit type without visible screw and shall be of sizes to accommodate upto 5.5mm or 6mm thick glazing and or as specified. 35.2. HANDLING & STORAGE OF FABRICATING MATERIALS : All aluminum doors, windows, jallies, etc. shall be packed and created properly, before despatch, to ensure that there will be no damage to the fabricated materials. Loading into 'Wagons'/'Trucks' shall be done with all care to ensure safe arrival of materials at site in undamaged condition. All the fabricated materials at site shall be stored under cover in such a way to prevent damage or distortion. Special care shall be taken to prevent staining of aluminum products by mortar, etc. after erection at site. 157 36.0 STRUCTURAL GLAZING / CURTAIN WALL AND GLASS PARTITION WALLS 36.1. Scope This specification only broadly describes the proposed requirements for structural glazing/ curtain walls and glass partitions. 36.2. Applicable Codes and Specifications The following Indian Standards and Codes are made part of this Specification. all the Standards and Codes of Practice referred to herein are references to the latest editions including any and all official amendments and revisions. 36.3. 36.3.1 IS 419 Specification for putty for use on window frames. IS 1081 Code of Practice for fixing and glazing of metal, (steel and aluminium) doors, windows and ventilators. IS 2553 Specification for safety glass. IS 2835 Specification for flat transparent sheet glass. IS 3548 Code of Practice for glazing in building. IS 5437 Specification for wire and figured glass. Materials Glass All glasses unless otherwise stated shall be atleast 6mm thick best quality flat, transparent and clear free form cracks, blisters, specks, flaws, waves, blemishes, bubbles, stones, scratches and other defects that can interfere with the vision and service of the glass with square corners and straight edges and shall not show any distortion of light when tested in accordance with the relevant Standard and shall confirm to relevant IS/BIS/ASTM standards and be of approved make quality size shade etc. and shall not have defects greater than those given in the table of IS 2835 and tests shall be conducted in accordance with IS 2835-Appendices A, B and C. a) Tint. Sheet/Reflective Glass Tint. Sheet/Reflective Glass shall be flat transparent/reflective and clear when judged by the unaided eye and when tested shall not show any distortion of light greater than in accordance with the relevant Standard. b) Plate Glass Plate glass shall be flat glass formed by a rolling process, ground and polished on both sides with plane and parallel surfaces. 158 c) Rough cast wired and figured Glass Wired and figured glass shall be in sheet form 6.4mm thick +/- 0.4mm thick form and shall not contain and stones or cracks. Wire mesh shall be steel wire 0.46mm to 0.56mm in diameter, the pattern of mesh being square or diamond with wires welded or hexagonal with wires twisted. Wire mesh shall be completely embedded minimum 1mm from either of glass surfaces and shall not contain more than 3 broken wires per square metre. Wired and wired figured glass shall satisfy fireproof tests as prescribed by IS 5437 - Appendix A. d) Toughened or Laminated Safety Glass Transparent, translucent or coloured, toughened or laminated safety glass shall conform to IS : 2553 and be made of sheet glass of selected best quality in accordance with IS 2835. Toughened or laminated glass shall be subject to uniformity, fragmentation, humidity, fracture and adhesion tests as prescribed in IS 2553-Appendixes A,B,C and D respectively. e) Frosted or obscured Glass Frosted or obscured glass shall be best quality sheet glass ground to achieves frosting and obscuring effect. Grinding shall be done uniformly and glass cleaned thoroughly to avoid stain formations on surfaces. Obscuring with sand blasting method shall be preferred. Sand blasting should be factory made and level of obscurity should be got approved from the sample. Abrasive sand blasting can be done to from pattern or murals in the surfaces. The pattern and murals will be as shown on drawings. f) Approved Imported Glass for single and double Glazing. All imported glasses for single and double glazing unless otherwise stated shall be atleast 6mm thick best quality flat, transparent and clear free from form cracks, blisters, specks, flaws, waves, blemishes, bubbles, stones, scratches, and other defects that can interfere with the vision and service of the glass with square corners and straight edges and shall confirm to relevant IS/BIS/ASTM standards and be of approved make quality size shade etc. g) Stained glass The stained glass wherever specified and shown on drawing shall be factory manufactured by adding oxides to the glass. The pattern and usage of stained glass shall be as shown on drawing. Designs should be got approved before fixing the stained glass in the skeleton shutters. 36.3.2 Structural Glazing : a) Single Glazing All glasses for single glazing shall be imported in the specified thickness and shall be float 159 quality tempered clear transparent, tinted or approved solar reflective glass of approved make such as Glaverbel Belgium or Glaverbas, Singapore or Saint Gobain, France with the following characteristics : b) Coated face ..... 2 Daylight reflection ..... 27% Daylight transmission ..... 45% Solar energy reflection ..... 21% Solar energy absorption ..... 27% Solar energy transmission ..... 53% Solar factor ..... 0.6 Shading Co-efficient ..... 0.69 U Values (ISO) W/sqm. Deg C ..... 5.8 Double Glazing Double glazing units shall comprise in outer faces imported 6mm thick flat quality tempered, reflective of approved colour shade (such as Glaverbel, Belgium or Glaverbas, Singapore or Saint Gobain, France) with Indian Manufactured 6mm thick clear float glass of approved colour shade in inner surfaces (such as Modifloat or Asahi or approved other equal) and fixed on at least 12mm wide aluminium perforated spacer members. Aluminium spacer members shall be filled with best quality silica gel and complete units hermetically sealed with Silicon Sealant of approved make as manufactured by GE silicones/wackier Silicones/ Dow coring or approved equal as shall be directed by Architect. All the norms laid down by silicone manufacturer will be adhered to the full satisfaction of Architect. c) Frame Work i) Material : Approved aluminium extruded sections made of aluminium alloy conforming to I.S. : 63400 artificially aged or precipitation heat treated/ hermally sheathed with minimum ultimate tensile strength of 21 KG/Cum. hard coated anodised of 20-25 micron shall only be used as shall be directed and to the entire satisfaction of the Architect. ii) Putty : Approved putty shall consist of a homogenous paste, free from dust, grit and other visible impurities and conforming to I.S. 419. 160 iii) Gasket : All structural gaskets shall be of high resistance of organic, prolong compressive material with ability to recover from compression or deformation and shall have the property to allow joint movement. iv) Fire & Smoke Resistance : The system should include approved fire & smoke seals at all required places as per approved design. v) Thermal and acoustic insulation : The structural glazing system should conform to the relevant standards for thermal and acoustic performance vi) Air & Water tightness The structural glazing system shall be designed to prevent Air and water penetration as per relevant IS/BIS/ASTM standards. vii) Load : The structural glazing system shall be capable of accommodating dead load, wind load, seismic force, thermal movement and any other forces without reducing its performance or causing permanent damages. However maximum permissible deflection should not exceed 1/200 and no permanent deformation for 1.5 times the design load shall be permitted. viii) Static/Structural performance : The system shall be strong enough to withstand a positive and negative pressure for any particular designated section. 36.3.3 Curtain Wall : a) Sections for the curtain wall : For the main structure Indal Section No. 9303 weighing 1.879 kg./m. For the top cover section No. 7557 weighing 0.317 kg./m. For pressure plate section No. 7559, weighing 0.515 kg./m. 161 b) 36.4. Suitable E.P.D.M. Gaskets are to be used on both sides of the glass. Workmanship : General : The contractor upon approval by Architect to his initial scheme with detailed specifications covering all factors for the entire works of structural glazing/curtain wall shall before taking up any portion of the work shall submit to the Architect all shop drawings for initial approval as also shop drawings from time to time or as may be directed for execution of all relevant portions of the works only after specific approvals thereto. The contractor shall however remain solely responsible for designing procurement manufacture fixing and installation or otherwise for the entire works and for its due performance and to the entire satisfaction of the Employer. The entire works of structural glazing/curtain wall shall conform to relevant building codes/safety regulations. The contractor shall take special care for Load, Static/ Structural performance, Air and Water tightness, Fire & Smoke Resistance, Thermal and acoustic insulation etc. Structural glazing system with glazed panels would be factory made to the unit size as per design. Fixing of the structure shall be all round by approved suitable fasteners and supporting brackets of Aluminium/Stainless Steel fixed with stainless steel bolt and nuts. Glazing work shall be executed strictly in accordance with IS 3548 for glazing to timber frames and IS 1081 for metal frames where applicable. Glass for glazing shall have a clearance of not less than 2.5mm between the edges and the surrounding wood or metal frames. Aluminium frame work shall be either colour anodized / power coatd / MRF Vapouring as shall be decided by the Architect whose approval therefore shall also be taken before commencement of the work. Sufficient compound shall be applied to rebates such that when glass is pressed into the rebate a bed of compound not less than 1.5mm thick remains between glass and rebate. Beads shall then be bedded with compound against glass and rebate. Beads shall be as detailed in the relevant Standard and/or as approved by the Architect/Engineer-in-Charge/ E.I.C. and shall be secured with panel pins or screwed as approved, care being taken to ensure that no voids are left between glass and beads. 36.5 Glass Thickness and Tolerances shall be as specified and as indicated in the relevant codes of BIS/ASTM standards. 36.6. RATES TO INCLUDE Apart from other factors mentioned elsewhere herein, the rates of items of structural glazing/curtain wall in the schedule of quantities shall include besides for all stages and scope of 162 work and all things incidental thereto besides for all labour, material, consumables, supply, fabrication, fixing/installing, use of plant machinery, tools tackles etc. including for the wastages etc. all lead and lift work at all levels, all bye works for the completed finished work and no extra whatsoever on this account will be entertained. 36.7. 37.0. Payments for single and or double glazing system shall be made for actual finished approved area measured in sq. metre. from one side only. WALL PANELLING : Wherever wall paneling is specified and shown on drawings, the same will be done in two stages. The primary stage and top finishing stage. The primary surface will be the base for the decorative finishes as specified in the schedule of works. Primary surface shall be prepared with plywood or gypsum board fixed on timber battening work fixed to wall surface with timber or nylon plugs driven on wall. Battens will be 40m to 50mm wide and 25mm thick or as shown on drawing. Battens are placed generally 500mm to 600mm c/c both ways or as shown on drawing. Plywood, commercial finish will be fixed on the battens with nails to form the base primary surface. The battens should be treated with wood preservatives before fixing. The edges of the primary surface to be finished with wooden beads as shown on drawing. Wherever gypsum board are forming the primary surface the 12.50mm thick gypboards will be fixed on the wall battens with screws and finished the gypsum board surface with paper tape and gypsum powder. 37.1 GLASS PANELLING ON WALL Glass sheets 6mm thick plain or obscured glass or stained glass sheet will be fixed on the primary surface with SS studs or patch fittings as directed and as shown on drawing by interior designers. The variety of glass sheet must be toughened glass sheets for glass paneling works and must have machine finished edges. 37.2 WALL PANELLING WITH SELECTIVE VENEERS The selective veneers (either teakwood, rosewood or burl, etc.) not less than 3mm to 4mm thick should be fixed on a 6mm thick BWR commercial plywood with phenol formaldehyde adhesive. The 6mm thick plywood with veneer facings shall then be fixed to the primary surface of wall paneling with SS studs or otherwise as shown on drawing. The edges of the veneered toping over the plywood should be finished with teak wood beads at the edges and melamine finish the surface upto the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-charge. 37.3 WALL PANELLING WITH WOODEN OR BAMBOO SLATS Wherever wall paneling with wooden slats or bamboo composite laminate slats are shown on drawing the said paneling work should be done with wooden slats of selective timber species size ranging from 50mm to 75mm wide and 12mm thick shall be fixed on the 12mm thick BWR commercial plywood base with phenol formal dehyde adhesive pressed hard to have good grip. The edges should be finished with teakwood beads 25mm to 40mm wide as shown on drawing. The bamboo composite slats also shall be pasted in similar manner and edges 163 finished. The plywood board then be fixed over the primary surface with either with stainless steel studs or to be screwed with stainless steel screws. Louvered paneling shall be done in similar manner. Edges finished with wooden moulding. 37.4 WALL PANELLING WITH CARPETS Wall paneling with the carpets shall be done with the carpet directly fixed on the primary surface plywood with nails (preferably stainless steel) and edge moulding done wherever catered for in the item. It should be ensured that the carpet is flattened and fixed tight and wriggle nowhere formed. The carpet preferably be ironed and planed before fixing. 37.5 CLOTH OR FABRIC PANELLING ON WALL Approved cloth either silken or cotton or decorative fabric cloth shall be fixed on a 6mm thick BWR plywood boards with stainless steel nails or screws with identical cloth washers tightly spread on the plywood wriggle free as per the direction of Engineer-in-charge or interior designer. It is advisable to iron the cloth or fabric before fixing and a thin layer of foam is backed below the cloth / fabric for proper surface appearance. The edges of the board should be finished with appropriate moulding either PVC or wooden as per the description in the schedule. 37.6 WALL PANELLING WITH CANE OR BAMBOO WORKS Cane paneling on wall shall be done with finely wooven cane work with 2mm to 3mm wide cane strips, woven in a pattern as shown by the interior designer. The woven cane mat then be fixed on a 6mm thick BWR commercial plywood board and edges finished with wooden moulding as per direction of interior designer. The completed board then be erected and fixed on the primary surface. The surface shall be coated with 2 to 3 coats of melamine polish upto the satisfaction of Engineer-in-charge. Wherever decorative art work is done with half round matured canes the same shall be done on a 6mm thick or 12mm thick BWR plywood boards. The half round matured and dried canes should be used for the said work. The half round cane sticks shall be laid over the plywood board and fixed with nails as per the design pre=approved by the interior designer. For this type of work, it shall be ensured that the size of half round cane sticks are reasonably of the uniform size. The art work after completion, the board is to be finished with teak wood moulding and finished. The completed board should then be fixed on the primary surface either with SS studs or can be directly screwed. The surface to be treated with 2 to 3 coats of melamine polish. Wherever cane work is to be placed on ceiling panels, the same system should be followed and the completed board be fixed directly on the ceiling frame work. All as shown on drawing and as directed by the Engineer-in-charge / Interior designer. 38.0. TIMBER : (for Built in and Loose Furniture) i) Unless otherwise specified, all timber for frames and shutters for doors, windows, ventilators, cupboards, etc. shall be first class, sound, well matured teak wood and shall be free from knots, shakes, fissures, flaws, sub-cracks and other defects. The planned surface shall be smooth and free from blemishes and discolourations. Wherever in B.O.Q. Sal wood is specified, it shall be Siliguri Sal. 164 ii) All timber for carpentry and joinery in touch with masonry or concrete shall be creosoted before fixing. iii) All full fabricated timber in general shall be air seasoned (except teak wood) on site of work for a period of not less than two months to allow for any shrinkage that may take place. The preparation of timber for joinery is to commence simultaneously with the beginning of the project work and should generally proceed continuously until all the wood work is prepared and fixed/stacked on or near the site as the case may be. iv) Each member of all frames, transoms, mullions, etc. of doors and windows shall be made out of single piece of timber only. v) Unless otherwise specified all joints shall be through toned having thickness not less than 1.25 cm. and close fitted truly and fully without filling into the mortice of the adjoining member of the frame to the full width of the latter and pinned with corrosion resisting metal pins or wooden dowels not less than 8mm and 10mm respectively, as approved by the Architect/Employer. The surfaces in contact with tendon and mortises shall be treated with an approved adhesive before joining together. Door and window frames shall be held and ensured square and flat at the time of delivery and while fitting and fixing in position, shrinkage if any in any direction shall not impair the appearance and strength of the finished work. 39.0 WORKMANSHIP & CONSTRUCTORS : i) The workmanship shall be first class and to the approval of the Architect/ Employer. Scantlings and boarding shall be accurately sawn and shall be of required finished width and thickness. All carpenter's work shall be wrought except where otherwise described. The workmanship and joinery shall be accurately set out in strict conformity according to the drawings and shall be framed together and securely fixed in approved manner and with properly made joints. All work is to be properly tennoned, shouldered, wedged, pinned, braced, etc. and properly glued with approved quality glue to the satisfaction of the Architect/ Employer. ii) Screws : Unless otherwise specified all screws to be used in wood work and joinery shall be of stainless steel and of approved quality and manufacturer. The size (diameter and length) should conform to those specified in hardware schedule. iii) Tolerance : 1.5 mm (1/6") tolerance will be allowed for each wrought face of sizes specified except where described as finished in which case they shall hold to the full dimensions. 165 iv) Protection : All edges of timber frames etc. shall be protected from being damaged during construction by providing rough timber casing securely fixed and other adequate protective measures. 40.0 40.1 v) If it is decided by the Employer to provide anti-termite treatment, the buildings Contractor shall co-ordinate his work suitably as directed by the Architect/ Employer. vi) Where door frames are fixed flush with plaster to wall teak wood cover mould 20 mm x 12 mm ,35 mm x 15 mm specified as per drawings shall be provided all round where the plaster is flush with the frame painted or finished as in doors. (This will be paid as a separate item as described in schedule of quantities). LOOSE FURNITURE TABLE - GENERAL TOP All four sides with Burma Teak wood finished mouldings out of 75 X 38 sections with 18mm thick BWR plywood surface with secondary species. Timber frame with teak veneer surface duly polished and melamine finish. Top measuring approx. 6’-0” X 3’-0” or as shown on drawing, wherever glass top has been specified in item 12mm thick plain toughened glass shall be placed over veneered table top fixed with side clips or studs at shown on drawings. 40.2 DRAWER & CUPBOARD UNITS Catered for in BOQ Carcass made out of 18mm BWR plywood with veneer finish all sides with a drawer and cupboard unit and a fixed panel to be fixed with a decorative M.S. frame out of hollow sections (25mm) with two flanges with circular plate in one side only of the table with bottom support on both faces of the cup-board. The unit is provided with necessary grooves, provide best quality Burma Teak wood moulds, lipping, etc. M.S. frame should be provided as foot rest and fixed to the right side bottom of the cup-board. All drawers to be fixed on best quality slides. All drawers with 12mm plywood construction finished with polish to desired shade. Set Lock to be provided for the drawer and lockers. 40.3 SIDE UNIT Basic structure with 12mm thick BWR plywood with best quality lipping, moulding with one drawer and cup-board unit and one of semi open type drawer with teak wood front. All exterior surface to be finished in polish and melamined on decorative veneer surface. Note : For necessary embellishment to add value to the table and side units. Set lock to be provided for all the side units. 166 40.4 WORK STATIONS Work station may be of 4 units compact or double unit compact comprising of the following elements :- 40.5 i) Partitions. ii) Work Top. iii) Drawer Units. iv) Key Board Tray. v) Hard Disc Carrier. vi) Locker Unit. PARTITIONS Frame work with seasoned teakwood frame work with 6mm thick BWR plywood skin on both side upto approx. 1,350mm height partition upto 2 ft. high with either decorative veneer / or laminate on both sides. Above 2 ft. one 150mm thick timber band to receive all plugs and switches. Provide for running electrical and low line conduits. Above 3ft. high partition is provided with partly frosted / clear glass and partly pin up board panel on both sides fixed with Burma Teak wood beads /Mouldings etc. duly polished and melamine finish top and side runs provided with Burma Teak Wood beads/Mouldings with grooves etc. out of 80 X 25 sections. Partition on smaller sides should also be considered. All partition etc. will have 100mm wooden skirting both sides. 40.6 WORK TOP Made of 18m of BWR plywood with decorative veneer with polish and melamine finish of appropriate finished thickness, necessary Burma Teak wood lipping / mouldings etc. as per layout plan (L shaped) provide for side run on left or right hand side. 40.7 DRAWER UNIT & KEYBOARD TRAY Made of 18m of BWR plywood with decorative veneer finish exterior surface with necessary mouldings, lipping, drawers made of 12mm thick plywood structure and 6mm plywood bottom duly polished with lipping as necessary. Each unit to have one drawers and cup-boards with shutters locking arrangements. With all best quality drawer slides etc. Key board tray front with Burma Teak wood timber as per sketch and the Tray is polished on 6mm veneer finish surface. 40.8 METAL HARD DISC holder with approximately of standard size and finishes matching with the workstation finish. Wooden foot rest shall be provided with 1st class hard wood and finishes with French polish and PVC coating. 40.9 LOCKER UNIT Locker unit shall have 2 tired cupboard shelves shall be made with 12mm thick BWR plywood supported with 2 wooden beads fixed on cupboard wall. Shelves and inside of locker finished 167 with polish and PU finish complete. The locker door made of 18mm thick BWR plywood with commercial finish, exposed surface shall be provided with approved veneer finish edges provided with hardwood lipping complete Locks should be of Hafele or Hettic as approved by Architect. Guaranteed period of the work station shall be 10 years. Contractor shall submit the written guarantee to the Engineer-in-charge. 41. SOFA SETS - STANDARD & BRANDED Sofa sets wherever indicated in the drawings to be provided as per the model and make from reputed classic furniture manufacturers. The basic specifications of those articles shall be as per approved manufacturer’s specifications. The leather and fabric upholstery should be specified while placing order. The skeleton timber frame work should be with seasoned hardwood. The base support may be on swiveled wheeled or with compressed nylon shoes, hard enough to withstand the wear and tear. While selecting the model of furniture these points may be examined. Manufacturer’s guarantee for each article to be obtained from supplier and contractor to hand over the same to the Engineer-in-charge. Guarantee period should be minimum 10 years. 42.0 SOFA SETS - NON STANDARD / CUSTOMISED Basic structure of the sofa frame shall be with seasoned hardwood. The wooden structure should be stout enough to withstand the vagaries of use of sofas. The springs shall be copper coated steel to be fixed as per standard carpentry practice. Padding for back and sides shall be with medium density foam and bottom seat shall be with high density foam, cotton and coir packing and cushioning should be done as per direction of Engineer-incharge or as per design. Workmanship for upholstery should be of high precision and quality, finish, samples of workmanship to be got approved. Upholstery shall be either with leather or fabric as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. Where leather or synthetic leather (leatherite) upholstery is specified the quality and cost of the leather and shall be not less than Rs. 500.00 per Sqft. for normal leather, for synthetic leather or leatherite it should be Rs. 200.00 per Sq.ft. and fabric shall be minimum Rs. 1,000.00 per R.M. Samples of cloth and leather should be got approved from the Engineer-in-charge before starting the upholstery works. The whole unit of sofa can either be mounted on swiveled roller wheels or on compressed nylon studs as directed by the Engineer-in-charge or as per BOQ. It is imperative that the contractor shall get the drawings/sketch of the sofas to be got approved from Engineer-in-charge or Architect. Guarantee of the article should be given by the contractor. The guarantee period shall be minimum 10 years. 43.0 SPECIFICATION FOR CENTRE TABLES AND SIDE TABLES Centre tables and side tables may be of the following types as specified in the BOQs. i) Centre table with glass table top and stainless steel support frame work (single or two tired). 168 43.1 ii) Wooden Centre tables and side tables with glass or laminated top. iii) Wooden Centre table or side tables with BWR plywood base, top and side with veneered finish. Centre tables with glass top and stainless steel tubular support structure. Tubular support structure may be either 20mm dia. or 25mm dia. With seamless finished bright polished. The joints in the tubes should be soldered/welded/polished to match the tubuler finishes. The lugs to hold the glass top or bottom tires also welded to main frame. Holders will be screwed with stainless steel screws. Design of the table with drawings/ sketches should be got approved from Engineer-in-charge/Architect. Side units shall also be of matching specification. 43.2 Wooden centre tables shall be made with 1st class teakwood (Burma teak or C.P. teak) with high precision finish. Table top shall be either of glass or with laminated top. Wherever glass top is specified, the glass thickness shall be 10mm thick toughened glass. The supporting plywood (BWR grade with commercial finish shall be with P.U finish. All timber surfaces shall be French polished and with a P.U. coating. Side units shall also match the specification of centre table. The centre table may be mounted on swiveled wheels specifically ordered. Otherwise all the supporting legs should be fitted with highly compressed nylon shoes. 43.3 Centre tables with complete plywood structure with BWR grade high quality plywood. The top and sides of the units may be with classical selected veneers. Edge mouldings will be provided with 1st class teak wood beads. The joints should be neatly finished with proper filling and sand papering joints shall be dovetailed joints with approved glue. Screwing should be done with stainless steel screws. The screw position should be properly sealed with putty. The entire unit is to be treated with 1st class French polish with P.U. finish. The whole system shall be mounted on wheeled system (swiveled wheel) to facilitate shifting position as required. Otherwise highly compressed nylon studs may be fixed at bottom for support. 44.0 SEATING SYSTEM Executive Chairs (Revolving type) wheeled and reclining with high back and head rest . Officers chair (revolving) low height cushioned and headrest wheeled. Conference Chairs – revolving low height or mid height cushioned backrest. Chairs for Ministerial staff Chairs for visitors Assembly hall chairs and desks Auditorium Chairs (tip up type) – fabric cushioned VIPs’ Chairs and Sofa sets. 44.1 EXECUTIVE CHAIRS Chairs for Ministers, Dy. Speakers and high officials. 169 Chairs should have stout metal framed 5 prong support (either highly polished alluminium or epoxy coated or stainless steel) with swiveled wheels for free mobility. Highly compressed nylon wheels mounted on appropriate ball bearing for hastle free movement. With telescopic height adjustment mechanism and bearing revolving system for the castor. Back rest shall be high with headrest facilities. Adjustable reclining facility , hand rest shall be 1st quality, teakwood with polish and melamine finish, upholstered with superior quality, leather, synthetic leather or high quality fabric duly padded with cotton coir and hessian cloth cover and medium density foam for back and sides and high density foam for seat. Design and curvature for utmost comfort of the person as per latest design available in the market of reputed furniture manufacturers. Contractor should get the model approved from Engineer-in-charge. Colour and design of upholstery should be got approved before ordering the model. Contractor should submit a guarantee for the product for a period of 10 years to the Engineer-in-charge. Tentative design of the chair is shown on the drawings. (Basic rate of leather Rs. 500.00/Sq.ft., Synthetic leather 200.00 / Sq.ft., and fabric Rs. 1,000.00/Rm. 44.2 CHAIRS FOR OFFICERS Chairs for officer, section heads, visiting officers etc. Chairs should have stout metal frames on 5 prong support with swiveleld wheels for free mobility . Metal frame should be nickelled and polished or of stainless steel. Telescopic height adjustment mechanism and bearing revolving system castors. Reclining system with adjustable reclining position. Back rest will be low height cushioned. Cushioning shall be with high quality coir and cotton and padded with medium density foam at back and high density foam on seat. Back rest will be of low height with no separate head rest. The upholstery shall be with synthetic leather or fabric as approved. The model of chair conforming to above specifications should be chosen from the approved manufacturer’s model available in the market. Sample shall be got approved before ordering the same. Contractor to give written guarantee for smooth functioning of the chairs at least for 10 years. 44.3 CHAIRS FOR MINISTERIAL STAFF Chairs for ministerial staff shall be either fixed type or swiveled revolving type. Back rest will be either metal encapsulated with PVC net or with plastic caned net. Bottom shall be cushioned with high density foam and synthetic leather upholstery. The bottom support shall be with epoxy powder coated metal frame with nylon shoes at bottom. The model of furniture should be chosen from the range of products available in the market from approved manufacturers. Model should be got approved from Engineer-in-charge before ordering the same. The contractor should submit a written guarantee for the performance of the chair for a period of at least 10 years. 170 44.4 CHAIRS FOR VISITORS Visitors chairs in speakers office, chief minster office and deputy speakers office should also conform to the specification of Executive chairs. Models of chairs be chosen form the products available in the market of slightly at a lesser costs. As regards the visitors chairs in other offices and other officers room shall be as specified below. The chairs shall be revolving type mounted on 5 prong stout metal frame of stainless steel and height adjustable castors. The 5 prong pedestals shall be mounted on stout bearing swiveling compressed nylon wheels for trouble free mobility. The hand rest shall be of high polished stainless steel. The seats shall be cushioned and padded with high density foam, Selected quality synthetic leather quality upholstery. ( Basic cost of synthetic leather Rs. 200.00/Sq.ft. 44.5 CONFERENCE CHAIRS Revolving chairs mounted on 5 prong stout metal epoxy coated base with matching bearing castors and telescoping lockable height adjuster for the under carriage system. Seating with synthetic leather upholstered foam seats duly padded with cotton and coir and high density foam and back rest with adjustable recline system and upholstered with synthetic leather in approved colour and medium density foam cushion duly padded with coir and cotton completed all as per model no……………….. complete and as directed by Architect and Engineer-in-charge. 44.6 STACKABLE BANQUET CHIARS Under carriage (legs) shall be either circular or rectangular / square hollow sections ranging from 20mm to 25mm and made of stainless steel or stainless steel with epoxy powder coating. The steel tubing may be finished in silver epoxy in approved pattern and colour. The seat is made of moulded in tough recyclable polypropylene in approved colour. The colour should be uniform and should not fade away during passage of time. Chairs should conform to model no……… of M/s AMBER Mumbai or its similar equivalent. 44.7 WAITING AREA Beam seating – legs, arms rest and frame compound of the seating shall be of cast alluminium polished to mirror finished or stainless steel of reputed manufacturers. The legs should have compressed nylon shoes. Body shapes – formed out of 2mm cold rolled steel plates the back rest is supported by cast alluminium finised in epoxy powder coating. Wherever back rest is specified with cusion as per the models, the back rest cusion shall be made with medium density foam, upholstered with synthetic leather. Bottom cusion shall be with high density foam upholstered with synthetic leather and back rest shall be of nylon encapsulated metal mesh complete as per model no………… as shown on drawings. 171 45.0 SPECIFIED SPECIFICATIONS FOR VIP CHAIRS 45.1 SPEAKERS AND CHIEF MINISTER OFFICE CHAIRS These chairs shall be with stout metal skeleton frame and the 5 prong support system with stout metal castors. It shall be encased in highly precision carved teak or mehagony wood finely joined ……………….. and polished with 1st class French polish two or more coat with melamine coating. The hand rests in th chair also shall be in similar manner carved and finished with teak or mahogany timber finely jointed and finished with 2 or more coats of French polish in approved tint and melamined finish. The upholstery should be with imported leather and high density foam for padding of and base of seat and for back rest, hand rest and head rest shall be with medium density foam. Stitch and allied sewing works with high precision craftsman. The contractor has to submit a written guaranteed for 10 years for its good performance. 45.2 DEPUTY SPEAKERS, PRINCIPAL SECRETARY CONFERENCE AND PRESENTATION OFFICE. These chairs shall broadly conform to the specifications as stated in para 45.1 above. The upholstery shall be either of leather or synthetic leather. Colour pattern etc. to be chosen and approved by Engineer–in-Charge. Model of chairs shall be as per no. 9 of attached drawing. 46.0 SEAT AND DESK FOR SPEAKER IN ASSEMBLY HALL Seat of the speaker shall be with high back seat as per the dimension shown on drawing. The chair shall be made with teak wood crafted as per the design which comprises of partly lathe work and partly fine carpentry work with intricate finish. Back rest will be cushioned with high quality imported leather of approved shade upholstered with proper padding and medium density foam. The seat will be upholstered with high density foam on plywood base and imported leather. The entire system to be intricately finished and polished with 1st class French polish and melamine coating in approved shade complete. The desk should be made with seasoned Burma teak frame as per drawing side and front panels should be with 12mm thick BWR Commercial Plywood forming partially raised and sunk panels and topped with approved veneers. Necessary teak wood beads fixed as per approved design and finished intricately. Table top will be with 19mm thick BWR plywood with approved veneer finish on plywood top. Necessary edge moulding with approved teak wood beads moulded as per design. The table shall be finished with 1st class French polish in approved tint and finished with melamine coating. 47.0 SPEAKER’S AND CHIEF MINISTER’S REST ROOM CHAIR (SOFA) : 172 The skeleton structure and main body shall be built with seasoned 1st quality Burma Teak or Mehogany wood as shown on drawing. The curved work in the sofa type chair shall be intricately designed and meticulously carved. Bottom, sides and back panels shall be with 12mm thick BWR plywood fixed with selected veneer. The bottom upholstery shall be with fine imported leather and high density foam cushion and cotton and coir padding as per design. Backrest and sides shall be upholstered with medium density foam and coir and cotton padded covered with superior quality imported leather not less than Rs. 500.00/Sq.ft. The exposed veneer and timber surface should be finished with 1st class French polish and melamine coating. Drawing for the chair/(sofa) is given. Wherever cloth upholstery shall be done cloth quality shall be Rs. 1,000.00/R.M. 48.0 SEAT AND DESK FOR MEMBERS OF ASSEMBLY HALL : The seat of the members in the Assembly hall shall be as per the design and drawing and to be built in Burma Teak with fine carpentry work, involving partly with lathe finished elements. Back and side panels shall be with 12mm thick BWR commercial plywood panels topped with selective decorative veneers finished with precision work as shown on drawing and as directed by Engineer-in-charge. Upholstery shall be with superior quality synthetic leather and cushion for back and side with medium density foam and seat cushion will be with high density foam. Pattern of padding and upholstered cushion shall be as shown drawing. (Refer the picture of the finished model). The desk of the members shall be made with teak wood frame work side and front panels will be with 12mm thick commercial plywood finished with veneer topping, edges finished with teakwood moulding. The top of table shall be with 19mm thick plywood finished with selective veneer finish on top and sides to be finished with approved teak wood moulding. The side and front panels may be done with partly raised and sunk surface. Sample to be got approved from Engineer-in-charge and then the other units will be made. Approved sample shall be preserved till completion. The entire seat should be finished with 1 st class French polish and 2 or 3 coats of melamine finish. 49.0 COMPACT LAMINATED BOARDS : Compact laminated boards wherever shown should conform to ISO 4586, and will satisfy at the requirement or tests as per EN438-4. (Merino, BESCO standard grade compact laminates or its similar equivalent shall be used – manufacturer’s test certificate is must for approval of sample) The boards should be hard durable scratch free and will be true to geometrics. No warped or scratched or edge damaged boards will be accepted. The colour of the boards shall be chosen by the Engineer-in-charge or Architect. Necessary fixing arrangements, hinges for doors and 173 locking systems shall be as per standard manufacturer’s specification. Studs and patch fittings and all other allied fitting shall be of stainless steel and as per the recommendations of the board manufacturer’s. The rates of the item shall be inclusive of all and fittings and fixtures as per approved manufacturer’s specification. 50. PARTITION : 50.1 Supply and installation of 138 mm thick dry wall partition system which includes Two layers of 15 mm thick Gypsum Plaster Board on either side of 72mm stud partition system in combination of 3mm thick Visco elastic polymer material .Dry wall partition are finished with acrylic based emulsion paint of approved shade. 50.2 Construction (Frame work) Framework consists two sets of 72mm Floor/ Head galvanised channels having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, equal flanges of 32mm and web of 50mm fixed to floor and ceiling with suitable fasteners at 300mm centres staggered. Noise and fire rated caulking compound to be caulked along the perimeter of the partition frame before fixing channels. Then 70mm Stud channel having thickness 0.5 mm, length 3600mm, unequal flanges of 34/36 mm and web of 70 mm should be placed into the floor/head channel positioned vertically at 610mm centres. Extra reinforcement to be provided at openings (doors, windows, etc.,) all the steel studs used shall have high quality galvanising and must be fully knurled. Ensure studs are firmly fixed and no undulations before boarding Note : All services related works to be completed before fixing Visco elastic polymer. Frequent removing of visco elastic polymer is not recommended 50.3 Cavity Filling Stud to be filled with polyester fibre having density of 1000 GSM and thickness of 50 mm. Polyester fibres is held in position by using galvanised cross wire braces or by using adhesive tapes. 50.4 Boarding 72mm Channels are first lined by using 3mm thick visco elastic polymer material having a surface density of minimum 4.88kg/m2. Visco elastic layer used shall of UV resistant, resistance to mold , water, heat, and shall be 100% recyclable. Visco Elastic polymer material used should have noise isolating properties and are screw fixed to channels by using self tapping pan head screws of 25mm 174 at 450mm centres. Joints of visco elastic polymer sheets are lined by using special jointing tapes. Two layers of 15 mm thick gypsum plaster boards are then fixed on visco elastic layer, on either side of stud partition system by using 3.5mm x 35mm/50mm Corrosion resistant self-tapping zinc plated steel screws with countersunk cross-head drywall screws. Gypsum plaster boards joints to be staggered to each other. Joints are lined by using fiber tape and jointing compound recommended by manufacturer. 50.5 Finishing Dry wall partitions to be finished with acrylic emulsion paint of approved colour. Note • Suitable metal corner profiles to be used for finishing external and internal corners of the partition system. • All partitions are upto full height. • All service openings to be sealed by using jointing compound. • Switch boxes between rooms to be staggered with a backing of noise isolating material 50.6 Tender item Supply and installation of 200mm thick dry wall partition system which includes Two layers of 12mm thick BWP FR Grade marine ply on one side side of double stud partition system and 2 layers of 12.5mm thick Gypsum plaster board on other side in combination of 3mm thick Visco elastic polymer material .Dry wall partition finished with wooden veneer approved shade on one side and paint finished on other side. 50.7 Construction (Frame work) Framework consists two sets of 72mm Floor/ Head galvanised channels (placed next to each other with gap off 3mm) having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, equal flanges of 32mm and web of 50mm fixed to floor and ceiling with suitable fasteners at 300mm centres staggered. Noise and fire rated caulking compound to be caulked along the perimeter of the partition frame . Then 70mm Stud channel having thickness 0.5 mm, length 3600mm, unequal flanges of 34/36 mm and web of 70 mm should be placed into the floor/head channel positioned vertically at 610mm centres. Extra reinforcement to be provided at openings (doors, windows, etc.,) all the steel studs used shall have high quality galvanising and must be fully knurled. Ensure studs are firmly fixed and no undulations before boarding. Note –all services related work to be completed before fixing visco elastic polymer. Frequent removing and repairing of visco elastic polymer layer reduces overall performance of the partition . 175 50.8 Cavity Filling Both studs are to be filled with polyester fibre having density of 1000 GSM and thickness of 50 mm. Polyester fibres is held in position by using galvanised cross wire braces or by using adhesive tapes. 50.9 Boarding Both sets of the channels are first lined by using one layer of 12mm thick FR Grade Marine ply wood & other side by using one layer of 12.5mm thick gypsum plaster board, then 3mm thick visco elastic polymer sheets having a surface density of minimum 4.88kg/m2. UV resistant, resistance to mold , water and heat, and shall be 100% recyclable and has noise isolating properties. Visco elastic polymer sheets are screw fixed to 12mm thick FR Grade marine ply/ 12.5mm thick gypsum plaster board by using self tapping pan head screws of 25mm at 450mm centre. Joints of visco elastic polymer sheets are lined by using special jointing tapes. Again layer of 12 mm thick FR Grade marine ply boards / 12.5mm thick gypsum plaster board are than fixed on visco elastic layer, on either side of double stud partition system by using 3.5mm x 35/50mm Corrosion resistant self-tapping zinc plated steel screws with countersunk cross-head screws. Marine ply boards joints to be staggered to each other. Marine board used shall be of BWP grade, resistance to moisture and density of minimum 800Kg/m3 . 50.10 Finishing Marine ply board partitions to be finished with 4mm thick veneer of approved shade and finished with polish and gypsum plaster board partitions are finished by using acrylic emulsion of approved colour. Note • Door and window frames are to suitably reinforced by using wooden members. • All partitions are upto full height . • All service openings to be sealed by using jointing compound . • Switch boxes between rooms to be staggered with a backing of noise isolating material . 50.11 Tender item Supply and installation of 200mm thick dry wall partition system which includes Two layers of 12.5mm thick Gypsum Plaster Board on either side of double stud partition system in combination of 3mm thick Visco elastic polymer material .Dry wall partition are finished with acrylic based emulsion paint of approved shade on one side and the plywood surface to be finished with 4mm thick approved veneers and polishing and melamine finish etc. all as specified and shown on drawing and as directed. 50.12 Construction (Frame work) Framework consists two sets of 72mm Floor/ Head galvanised channels (placed next to each other with gap off 6mm) having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, equal flanges of 32mm and web of 50mm fixed to floor and ceiling with suitable fasteners at 300mm centres staggered.Noise and fire rated caulking compound to be caulked along the perimeter of the partition frame Then 70mm Stud channel having thickness 0.5 mm, length 3600mm, unequal flanges of 34/36 mm and web of 70 mm should be placed into the floor/head channel positioned vertically at 610mm centres.Extra reinforcement to be provided at openings (doors, windows, etc.,) all the steel studs used shall have high quality galvanising and must be fully knurled. Ensure studs are firmly fixed and no undulations 176 before boarding. Note – All services related work to be completed before fixing visco elastic polymer. Frequent removing and repairing of visco elastic polymer layer reduces overall performance of the partition . 50.13 Cavity Filling Both studs are to be filled with polyester fibre having density of 1000 GSM and thickness of 50 mm. Polyester fibres is held in position by using galvanised cross wire braces or by using adhesive tapes. 50.14 Boarding Both sets of the channels are first lined by using 3mm thick visco elastic polymer material having a surface density of minimum 4.88kg/m2. Visco elastic layer used shall of UV resistant, resistance to mold , water and heat, and shall be 100% recyclable. Visco Elastic polymer material used should have noise isolating properties. Visco elastic polymer sheets are screw fixed to channels by using self tapping pan head screws of 25mm at 450mm centres. Joints of visco elastic polymer sheets are lined by using special jointing tapes. Two layers of 12.5 mm thick gypsum plaster boards are than fixed on visco elastic layer, on either side of double stud partition system by using 3.5mm x 35/50mm Corrosion resistant self-tapping zinc plated steel screws with countersunk cross-head drywall screws. Gypsum plaster boards joints to be staggered to each other. Joints are lined by using fiber tape and jointing compound recommended by manufacturer. 50.15 Finishing Dry wall partitions to be finished with acrylic emulsion paint of approved colour. Note • • • • • 50.16 Suitable metal corner profiles to be used for finishing external and internal corners of the partition system . Door and window frames are to suitably reinforced by using wooden members. All partitions are upto full height . All service openings to be sealed by using jointing compound . Switch boxes between rooms to be staggered with a backing of noise isolating material. Tender item Supply and installation of 200mm thick dry wall partition system which includes Two layers of 12mm thick BWP FR Grade marine ply on either side of double stud partition system in combination of 3mm thick Visco elastic polymer material .Dry wall partition finished with 4mm thick wooden veneer approved shade and finishing both sides surfaces with French polish and melamine finish complete as specified and as directed by Architect and Engineer-in-charge. 50.17 Construction (Frame work) Framework consists two sets of 72mm Floor/ Head galvanised channels (placed next to each other with gap off 3mm) having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, equal flanges of 32mm and web of 50mm fixed to floor and ceiling with suitable fasteners at 300mm centres staggered. Noise and fire rated caulking compound to be caulked along the perimeter of the partition frame . Then 70mm Stud channel having thickness 0.5 mm, length 3600mm, unequal flanges of 34/36 mm and web of 70 177 mm should be placed into the floor/head channel positioned vertically at 610mm centres. Extra reinforcement to be provided at openings (doors, windows, etc.,) all the steel studs used shall have high quality galvanising and must be fully knurled. Ensure studs are firmly fixed and no undulations before boarding. Note – All services related work to be completed before fixing visco elastic polymer. Frequent removing and repairing of visco elastic polymer layer reduces overall performance of the partition. 50.18 Cavity Filling Both studs are to be filled with polyester fibre having density of 1000 GSM and thickness of 50 mm. Polyester fibres is held in position by using galvanised cross wire braces or by using adhesive tapes 50.19 Boarding Both sets of the channels are first lined by using one layer of 12mm thick FR Grade Marine ply wood on either side of channel, then 3mm thick visco elastic polymer sheets having a surface density of minimum 4.88kg/m2. UV resistant, resistance to mold , water and heat, and shall be 100% recyclable and has noise isolating properties .Visco elastic polymer sheets are screw fixed to 12mm thick FR Grade marine ply by using self tapping pan head screws of 25mm at 450mm centres. Joints of visco elastic polymer sheets are lined by using special jointing tapes. Again layer of 12 mm thick FR Grade marine ply boards are than fixed on visco elastic layer, on either side of double stud partition system by using 3.5mm x 35/50mm Corrosion resistant self-tapping zinc plated steel screws with countersunk cross-head screws. Marine ply boards joints to be staggered to each other. Marine board used shall be of BWP grade, resistance to moisture and density of minimum 800Kg/m3. 50.20 Finishing Marine ply board partitions to be finished with 4mm thick veneer of approved shade and finished with polish . Note • • • • 50.21 Door and window frames are to suitably reinforced by using wooden members. All partitions are upto full height All service openings to be sealed by using jointing compound Switch boxes between rooms to be staggered with a backing of noise isolating material. Tender item Supply and installation DGU fabricated by using 13.52mm thick laminated glass in combination of 9.56mm thick laminated glass with 24mm airspace. 50.22 Construction DGU Units are fabricated by using 13.52 laminated glass in combination of 6mm toughened glass +1.56 PVB +6mm toughened glass and other glass in combination 6mm toughened glass +1.56 +4mm toughened glass placed 24mm apart by using metal spacer . Assembly is then sealed by removing air traps and create vacuum. 178 50.23 Framework 47mm thick DGU units are then placed in solid timber frame work fabricated by using 150x 150mm thick wooden frame. Perimeter of wooden frames to be embaded with neoprene sheets of 3mm to achieve desired air tightness of the assembly. 50.24 Framework 47mm thick DGU units are then placed in solid timber frame work fabricated by using 150x 150mm thick wooden frame. Perimeter of wooden frames to be embedded with neoprene sheets of 3mm to achieve desired air tightness of the assembly. 50.25 Finishing All joints between wooden frame & masonry are to be lined with noise and fire rated caulking compound. 51.0 Panelling : 51.1 Tender item Supply and Installation of GFR grade micro perforated (3 x 3mm square) gypsum plaster board of size 1200x 2400x 12.5mm thick back lined with acoustical fleece. Gypsum boards used shall have tapered edge along the length having base density of minimum 800Kgs/m3, and lined with paintable glass fabrics. 51.2 Construction Frame work Frame work consists of Galvanised Cross channel(CC25) having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, knurled web 80mm, depth of 25mm and equal flanges 10.5mm is fastened to the drywall at 450mm centre perpendicular to Micro perforated gypsum plaster board . 51.3 Cavity Filling Ceiling frame work shall be backlined by using polyester fiber rolls of size 600mm width having a density of 1000 GSM and 25mm thick. 51.4 Boarding 1200x 2400x 12.5 mm glass fiber reinforced gypsum plaster board, having long edges tapered is than screw fixed to frame work by using 25mm dry wall screws every 300mm centres. Ensure board is in plumb level and fix glass woven fabrics to the gypsum ceiling. Joints of the plaster boards to be finished with fiber tape and jointing compound as per manufacturers recommendation. Screw heads to be covered with compound and sand the surface. Note : (use of glass fabrics) • Use products with same serial number of glass fabrics on adjacent surfaces. 179 • Allow 10-12hrs to dry it is advised to paint immediately after adhering. • Follow marking backside before gluing wall paneling. Gypsum, Brand : Danogips, Model Micro Perforated, Glass Fabric : Brand Systex. 52.5 Tender item Supply and installation of non combustible magnesite bonded wood wool board on 50mm thick glavansied channels and finished with proprietary traditional fabric at site.Wood wool boards are fixed directly on masonry brick wall lined by using visco elastic polymer material of 6mm thick . Fixing of Visco elastic polymer layer along the perimeter of assembly hall Supply and installation of 3 mm thick visco elastic polymer sheets having a surface density of minimum 4.88kg/m2. UV resistant, resistance to mold , water and heat, and shall be 100% recyclable and has noise isolating properties. Visco elastic polymer sheets are screw fixed to wall by using adhesive recommended by manufacturer ,Joints of visco elastic polymer sheets are lined by using special jointing tapes. 52.6 Construction of Frame work Frame work consists of 25mm thick GI wall channels with fully knurled surface of 0.55mm thick 80mm width, having two equal flanges of 26mm is anchored to wooden studs of 25mm thick x 100 wide. Wooden studs of 25mm thick is first grouted to wall at 600mm centres, 25mm thick channels are than fixed to wooden studs to achieve overall airgap of 50mm from the wall.To achieve sturdiness of the system channels are to be fixed perpendicular to wood wool boards. 52.7 Cavity Filling Resultant air gap between wall and channel to be lined by using polyester fiber rolls of size 600mm width having a density of 1000 GSM and 50mm thick, held in position by using adhesive or G.I binding wires. 52.8 Boarding Non combustible magnesite bonded square edge wood wool board having density of minimum 450 Kg/m3 of size 1200x 600x 25mm thick manufactured by using superfine fibres having width of 1mm and meeting fire requirements as per EN 13501-1 A2,S1 d0 is than fixed on to metal channels by using rust protected metal fasteners of size 4.5mm Ø x 50mm length . Each panel should receive minimum 6nos fasteners. Wood wool boards to be butt jointed and ensure boards are in plumb level to adhere proprietary fabric above wood wool board. Note • Screw head to be countersunk • Adhesive used shall be of spray grade to adhere proprietary Fabric • Cost of fabric not taken. Considered seperately. Brand : Magnasite Bonded Woodwool board : Heradesign Super Fine A2 , Visco elastic polymer : coustiblok 53.0 False ceiling : 180 53.1 Tender item Supply and Installation of GFR grade micro perforated (3 x 3mm square) gypsum plaster board of size 1200x 2400x 12.5mm thick back lined with acoustical fleece. Gypsum boards used shall have tapered edge along the length having base density of minimum 800Kgs/m3, and lined with paintable glass fabrics. 53.2 Construction Frame work Frame work consists of Galvanised Wall channel 25mm width having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, unequal flanges of 20 & 30mm and web of 25mm should be fixed along the perimeters of the wall (Brick/Block/partition ) with nylon sleeves and suitable fasteners at every 300mm centers. Then suspend Main channels (MC45) having thickness 0.9mm, length 3600mm, equal flanges of 15mm and web 45mm from the soffit at every 900mm centers with Suspender angle25mm having thickness 0.45mm, unequal flanges of 25 & 10mm. GI Cross channel(CC25) having thickness 0.5mm, length 3600mm, knurled web 80mm, depth of 25mm and equal flanges 10.5mm is fastened to the Main channel in the direction perpendicular to the Main Channel at every 450mm centers. All metal to metal screws must be self drilling wafer thin head 4.2mmx 13mm length. 53.3 Cavity Filling Ceiling frame work shall be backlined by using polyester fiber rolls of size 600mm width having a density of 1000 GSM and 50mm thick. 53.4 Boarding 1200x 2400x 12.5 mm glass fiber reinforced gypsum plaster board, having long edges tapered is than screw fixed to frame work by using 25mm dry wall screws every 300mm centers. Ensure board is in plumb level and fix glass woven fabrics to the gypsum ceiling. Joints of the plaster boards to be finished with fiber tape and jointing compound as per manufacturers recommendation. Screw heads to be covered with compound and sand the surface. Note • Use products with same serial number on adjacent surfaces. • Allow 10-12hrs to dry it is advised to paint immediately after adhering. • Follow marking backside before gluing. 54. Door Shutter : Tender item Acoustical Door Seals (Single shutter with door closures) Perimeter seals 181 Supply and installation of medium duty acoustic door seals manufactured by using silver anodised aluminium with grey silicone rubber gasket Tested in accordance with BS EN ISO 10140-2: 2010 fixed to wooden doors on predrilled holes . Assembly shall also consist of PVC cover strips to conceal fixings .Door set pack should consists of 3nos seals (1no for door top &other for 2 sides ) Door seal assembly shall have valid test certificate and shall have STC of minimum 33-35 . Drop down seals Supply and installation of medium duty automatic concealed door bottom seal manufactured by using silver anodised aluminium with grey silicone rubber gasket Tested in accordance with AS 1428/1 having polypropylene fins incorporated within the gasket housing to provide additional sealing properties. Tested for reliability, completing over 1,000,000 open and close cycles. fixed to bottom wooden doors by using hardware's supplied with seals Door seal assembly shall have valid test certificate and shall have STC of minimum 33-35 . seal is mortised into a 15mm x 35mm groove in the door bottom and supported by end plates,(refer seal manufacturer guidelines for groove cutting). 55. Tender item Acoustical Door Seals (Double shutter with door closers) Perimeter seals Supply and installation of medium duty acoustic door seals manufactured by using silver anodised aluminium ( powder coated to match colour of door) with Co-extruded elastomeric with flexible curved fins Tested in accordance with BS EN ISO 10140-2: 2010 fixed to wooden doors on predrilled holes . Door seal assembly shall have valid test certificate and shall have STC of minimum 33-35 . Drop down seals Supply and installation of medium duty automatic concealed door bottom seal manufactured by using silver anodised aluminium with grey silicone rubber gasket Tested in accordance with AS 1428/1 having polypropylene fins incorporated within the gasket housing to provide additional sealing properties. Tested for reliability, completing over 1,000,000 open and close cycles. fixed to bottom wooden doors by using hardware's supplied with seals Door seal assembly shall have valid test certificate and shall have STC of minimum 33-35 . seal is mortised into a 15mm x 35mm groove in the door bottom and supported by end plates, (refer seal manufacturer guidelines for groove cutting). 182 MATERIALS OF FOLLOWING MANUFACTURERS OR BRAND ARE TO BE USED IN THE WORK. TENDERER MUST QUOTE THEIR RATES ACCORDINGLY Commercial ply : Phenol Formaldehyde resin bonded ply of Century Plywood/Green Ply 3.5mm / 4mm thick teak veneers : Green ply/Century 18mm / 19mm thick block board : Phenol Formaldehyde resin bonded Boards/ Kitply/Green ply/Century 35mm / 38mm thick flush door shutter : Phenol Formaldehyde resin bonded Solid core doors of /Green ply/ Century ply High Compressed Laminate Board : Merino-Besco or similar equivalent. Particle Board/ : Green ply wood/ Century ply wood MDF Boards- Green ply. Mat N.C. Lacquer (Nitro-Cellulosse) : I.C.I. Melamine Polish : I.C.I./Asian Paints/ICCI Paints Texture Paint. : Heritage / Specturm/Asian/Berger. Synthetic Enamel Paint. : Berger paint/ ICI/ Asian Paints. Plaster of paris : Materials are to be of approved quality (Druk or similar equivalent). Putty : Birla / JK/ Berger. Patch /Spider fittings : Dormer/Geze Hafele/ Hettick Frosted film : Garware or equivalent. Adhesive (for timber work). : Pidilite / Bal Endura. 183 Glazed Tiles /Ceramic /Vitrified tiles. : Kajaria / Somany / Johnson./NIITCO Locks with Security latch : Godrej / Dorma / Hardwyn / Hafele/Geze. Door Closer : Rolex / Dorma /Hardwyn/ Hafele/Geze/Godrej Door fittings : Hafele / Hettic./Geze /Godrej. Brass hinges / handles : Best quality as approved by Interior Designer, Hafele / Hettic or similar equivalent/Godrej.. Stainless steel fasteners : Hillti / Hettic. Glass / Mirror : Modifloat/Saint Gobain, Wherever required etching/ Bevelling should be done with machine finish and edge polished. Stained glass : Saint Gobain,, Pilkingson. Floor spring : Garnish / Rolex / Dorma/Hafele./Geze. Marble (Indian & Italian) : Best quality to be approved by the Engineer-incharge / Interior Designer. Granite (Indian & Imported) : Krishna Transnational Marbles (Bangalore / Kolkata), IES make Pvt. Ltd. Radha Rani Marbles or Marudhar Marbles Kolkata. Bamboo Composite product : Emmbee Forest Products Private Limited / Similar approved Agency. Roller Blind/ Duette Blind/ Vertical Blind/ Venetian blind. : Hunter Douglas / Mac Décor Ltd./ Packman / Stellar. Sand stone for cladding : Krishna Transnational Marbles Pvt. Ltd. (Bangalore / Kolkata), Radha Rani Marbles (Kolkata) and Marudhar Marbles & Granite, Kolkata Cane works : Assam Cane Industries Ltd. or other local best 184 quality cane products. Furniture (Branded) : Merryfare/Monarch Ergonomics India Ltd. Secundrabad/ Amber Design Tech Pvt. Ltd. Mumbai/ Featherlite / Wipro Furniture system. Sofas - Giani’s / Natuzl/ specification. Wooden Furniture (Customised) : Wooden flooring : Ceiling / Acoustic Ceiling system : Stainless steel sections and architectural products. : Stainless steel rope for bracer assembly with anchorage system. : Customised as per Wooden Furniture to be crafted with best quality cabinet makers with the specified timber species and best furniture makers to produce International Standard Furniture. Square foot/ Ego Wooden Floor Mumbai/ Monarch Ergonomies Bangalore/ Armstrong Flooring System. Armstrong Ceiling System /LLyod Insulation and ceiling system./Anutone Ceiling system M/s. Jindal Architectural Ltd.,(arc) Aesthetic. M/s. Jindal Architectural Ltd., M/s. Usha Martins, Kolkata. M/s. Hemkul, Mumbai 185 Project Assembly : Assam Legislative System : Clock System Reference No : A-1& A-3 Item Description PoE, 12" Round, SAP Series, Metal Case - 1 Side& Monitoring Software The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional PoE, 12" Round, SAP Series, Metal Case - 1 Side& Monitoring So . have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification:A-1: Time Base: 50/60 Hz Voltage Input: 48 VDC (PoE model) Average Current 70mA @ 48 VDC PoE Consumption: 12 hour standard (24 hour dials available) Display: Standard black or white (custom color available) Color: 12.81” (32.54 cm) diameter, 1.2” (3.05 cm) depth Clock Siz.e: 16.81” (42.7 cm) diameter, 1.6” (4.06 cm) depth Dial: Durable polystyrene material Case: Shallow profile, smooth surface metal case Crystal: (optional ABS case available) Hand tolerance: Shatter-proof, side molded polycarbonate crystal Hour and minute hand: +/1/4 minute Second hand: +/- 1/2 minute Temperature range: 0°C - 45°C Operating: -15° 186 - 75°C Shelf: Mounting Bracket . Dimensions: (LxWxD) 12” (30.48 cm) - 12.56” x 3” x .04” (31.9 cm x 7.62 cm x .10 cm) 16” (40.64 cm) - 16.38” x 3 A3 :IP Monitoring Software . Acceptable : Saplingor Approved Equivalents 187 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Clock System A-2 Double Mount Clock, 12” Housing , Black The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Double Mount Clock, 12” Housing, Black and shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Double Mount Clock 4” Pole Length Black 12” Housing Battery type/size: 1.5 volts / “AA” Quartz frequency: 32.768 KHz Operating range: 1.2 - 1.7 Volts Current consumption: 0.110 mA Accuracy: +/- 0.8 sec./day @ 1.5 V Temperature range: Operating: -20°C - 60° C Storage: -20°C - 70° C Display: Color: Clock Size: Case: Crystal: Movemen t dimensions: (LxWxD) 12 or 24 hour dials available Standard black or white (custom colors available) 12.81” (32.54 cm) diameter, 1.2” (3.05 cm) depth 16.81” (42.7 cm) diameter, 1.6” (4.06 cm) depth Shallow profile, smooth surface metal case (optional ABS plastic cases available) Shatterproof, side molded polycarbonate crystal (optional polystyrene plastic crystals available) 2.286” x 2.174” x 0.648” (5.81 cm x 5.52 cm x 1.65 cm) 12” (30.48 cm) Clock - 4 lbs. (1.81kg) 188 Shipping weight: Acceptable: 16” (40.64 cm) Clock - 6 lbs. (2.72kg) Sapling or Approved Equivalents 189 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Clock System A-4&A-6 Master Clock, with NTP Server Upgrade & Web Interface, Rack Mount, no GPS&Server Software Upgrade & Web interface The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Master Clock, with NTP Server Upgrade & Web Interface, Rack Mount, and no GPS Server Software Upgrade & Web interfaceand shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification:A-4 Time base: Voltage input: Current Consumption: Power Consumption: Display: Color: Housing Temperature range Operating: Shelf: Calendar: Inputs: Crystal 85 VAC - 264 VAC, 50/60 Hz 0.2A at 120V and 0.1A at 230V 20 Watts .56” (1.42 cm) LED display Black Smooth surface metal case 0°C - 45°C -15° - 70°C Built-in calendar with leap years GPS (optional), SNTP, Wireless repeater, RS485, 58 minute correction, 59 Standby time keeping: minute correction, National Time and Memory: Rauland, Dukane digital Outputs: Ten (10) years Optional outputs: Non-volatile EEPROM Housing dimensions RS485 and 2 clock circuits (LxWxD): Sapling Wireless Communication (with Mounting: transmitter option) Weight: 11” x 17.5” x 1.75” (27.94 cm x 44.45 A-6Server Software Upgrade & Web interface Acceptable: Saplingor Approved Equivalents 190 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Zones Clock System A-5 4 Zones, Surface Mount Field Programmable Master Clock with GPS and 4 The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional 4 Zones, Surface Mount Field Programmable Master Clock with GPS and 4 Zoneand shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification: Operating Temperature (Maximum) : 45 C Operating Temperature (Maximum) : 113 F Operating Temperature (Minimum) : 0 C Operating Temperature (Minimum) : 32 F Maximum Frequency Response (Bandwidth) : 928000 kHz Maximum Frequency Response (Bandwidth) : 928000000 Hz Minimum Frequency Response (Bandwidth) : 915000 kHz Minimum Frequency Response (Bandwidth) : 915000000 Hz AC Voltage (Maximum) : 240 Volts AC Voltage (Minimum) : 100 Volts Depth : 11 in Depth : 279.40 mm Height : 1.75 in Height : 44.45 mm Width : 17.50 in Width : 444.50 mm Product Weight : 2.95 kg Product Weight : 6.50 lbs Color : Black Regulatory Compliance : FCC, CE, UL Digit Height : 0.56 in two line LCD display and LED display with 2X8 rubber keypad Up to 800 events can be programmed Automatic bi-annual daylight savings time 191 Two pre-programmed relays for correction of synchronous systems Optional GPS and/or transmitter option for increase system flexibility Optional web interface for complete control of the master clock from any computer via LAN connection or through a crossover cable Available in rack mount or wall mount 192 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Display Reference No: A-1 Item Description: 40" LED Display with built in DS player, HDMI, DVI-D & Display Port The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a 40" LED Display built in DS player, HDMI, DVI-D & Display Portand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Display Screen Size Panel Technology Resolution Brightness Contrast Ratio Viewing Angle (Horizontal/Vertical Orientation Response Time (G-to-G) Connectivity Input Output External Control External Sensor Power Power Supply Power Consumption (Typical/Max) Power Consumption (Standby) Internal Media Player 40" 60Hz Slim D-LED BLU 1920x1080 (16:9) 450 nits 208.3340278 178° / 178° Landscape / Portrait 8ms Video: VGA (D-Sub 15 Pin), DVI-D, Display Port 1.2, Component/Composite, HDMI, Audio: Stereo Mini Jack Video: Display Port 1.2 (Loop-Out), Audio: Stereo Mini Jack RS232C (In/Out) thru Stereo Jack, RJ45 IR, Ambient Light AC 100 - 240 V~ (+/- 10 %), 50/60 Hz 86W/121w < 0.5W Cortex-A9 1GHz Quad Core, 1.5GB DDR3, 4GB FDM, USB 2.0, Linux OS 193 Project: Assembly System: Display Reference No: 2 Item Description: Component Assam Legislative A55" LED Display with built in DS player, HDMI & The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation General Specification : The unit shall be a 55" LED Display with built in DS player, HDMI & Componentand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Screen Size 139.7cm (55) Panel Type 120Hz D-LED BLU Resolution 1920 x 1080 (16:9) Pixel Pitch (HxV) 0.21 (H) x 0.63 (V Active Display Size (HxV) 1,209.6 (H) x 680.4 (V) Contrast Ratio 5,000:1 Viewing Angle (H/V) 178:178 Response Time 8ms Display Color 10 bit Dithering - 1.07 Billion Color Gamut 0.72 H-Scanning Frequency 30 ~ 81kHz Maximum Pixel Frequency 148.5MHz V-Scanning Frequency 48 ~ 75Hz Brightness 450nit RGB In Analog D-SUB, DVI-D, Display Port 1.2 Video In HDMI1, Component (CVBS Common) Audio In Stereo Jack RGB Out DP1.2 (Loop-out) Audio Out Stereo Jack Stand Type Acceptable: Foot Stand (Optional) Samsung ,LG,Panasonic or Approved Equivalent 194 Project: System: Reference No : Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Display A-3 46" Interactive Display with 2 HDMI, USB Interface along with Pedestal Stand 195 The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : This unit shall be a 46" Interactive Display with 2 HDMI, USB Interface along with Pedestal Standand shall have the minimum specification as shown below : In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specification : Display H-Scanning Frequency Maximum Pixel 148.5MHz V-Scanning Frequency Panel Diagonal Size Type 46'' S-PVA ( B-DID) Resolution Pixel Pitch(mm) Active Display Area Brightness 1920 x 1080 (16:9) 0.53025 (H) x 0.53025 (V) 1,018.08 (H) x 572.67 (V) 450cd/m² Contrast Ratio 6,000:1 Viewing Angle (Horizontal/Vertical) 178° Response Time (G-to-G) 30kHz ~ 81kHz Frequency 56Hz ~ 85Hz (Dynamic) 178° / 8ms Display Colour Colour Gamut 8 bit - 16.7M 0.72 Contrast Ratio Connectivity Input RGB 3,000:1 Analog D-SUB, DVI-D, Display Port Video CVBS, HDMI1, HDMI2, Component (D-sub 15pin) Audio 196 Output Audio External Control RCA (L / R) , Stereo mini Jack Stereo mini Jack Power Out 5V (for SBB) RJ45, RS232C (in / out) , USB B type (touch screen) 197 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Display Reference No: A-5& A-6 Item Description: HDMI Cable 3.6& 0.9 Meters The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a HDMI Cable 3.6 & 0.9 Meter sand shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: A-5:HDMI Cable 3.6 Meters A-6: HDMI Cable 0.9 Meters TYPE High Speed and Standard Speed HDMI cables 480i, 480p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p. CONDUCTOR AWG 28 AWG (7/0.127) SHIELD Dual shield against EMI/RFI interference (a) Al− Mylar (b) Tinned Copper CABLE OD (MM) MOLDED CONNECTORS GOLD PLATED CONNECTORS: HDCP COMPLIANT: Acceptable: 7.3 Yes Yes Yes Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 198 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Installation Equipment C-1 Wall / ceiling mount bracket for the display The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications : The Wall/Ceiling Bracket for Display shall be made from mild steel or Stainless steel, can be custom made based on submitted drawings and shall be of a laser etched, matte black powder coat finish. Please note, all fixings shall be invisible from the front and all cable management shall be incorporated in the design of the unit. All Bracket designs are to be approved by the AV consultant before fabrication, sample of finish and detailed Drawings are to be provided. 199 Project: Assembly System: Equipment Reference No: 2 Item Description: Power Assam Legislative Installation C42U Closed rack or to Suit,/w Vent & Blank Panels, Shelves, Distributor 3 No’s Plus ID panel as Required. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications : Equipment racks shall be constructed of 16 gauge (minimum) cold rolled steel and shall have rear doors andsquare front vertical corners. Rack dimensions shall not exceed 22 ½” wide by 22” deep by 42 U high. Finishshall be as approved by the AV Consultant/Employer. The front door shall be a clear lockable (minimum5mm thick) perspex panel with minimum dimension opening at strategic location to enable the operator to bypass faulty equipment as necessary. Each rack shall be equipped with permanently mounted AC power 3 conductor grounded strip line rated for10amps with outlets on 6” centers, extending the height of the rack and with interior incandescent illuminationconnected thereto, for ease in servicing and connecting the installed components. Any unused panelmounting space in the racks or enclosure shall be filled in with blank or ventilating panels. Racks andenclosures shall mount standard 19” wide panels and shelves. If a tenderer wishes to offer any other brand then fully specifications will be required. Proprietary Nonproprietary manufactured units are considered. 200 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-1 Chassis with 9 slots for the Encoders & Processor Modules The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Chassis with 9 slots for the Encoders & Processor Modulesand shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail specification Power Input Enclosure Power Dissipation 100 – 240 VAC maximum 2.2 – 1A 47 - 63 Hz 200 watts via IEC Mains connector 130 watts (typical) 200 watts (maximum) External LNB power drain (from 774 DVB-S2 modules) 3A total 450mA per 774 DVB-S2 module Any combination of up to 9 Processor Modules can be fitted in a single rack Acceptable: Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 201 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-2& B-3 MPEG 2–H264 Encoder, Single Channel HDMI Input, LAN port , SD Output The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional MPEG 2–H264 Encoder, Single Channel HDMI Input, LAN port, SD output, and specification as shown below: Detail Specification: B-2 - MPEG 2–H264 Encoder, Single Channel HDMI Input, 720p output System Inputs Video Inputs • HDMI 1.3 Digital - Resolutions: All YPbPr/RGB (SoG) and VGA resolutions listed below • YPbPr/RGB (SoG), via phono connectors Resolutions 480i, 576i, 480p, 576p, 720p50, 720p60, 1080i50, 1080i60,1080p25, 1080p30, 1080p50, 1080p60 • VGA, via female HD-15 connector - Resolutions: 640x480@60Hz, 800x600@60, 1024x768@60, 1280x720@60, 1280x800@60, 1280x1024@60, 1366x768@60, 1440x900@60, 1600x1200@60, 1680x1050@60, 1920x1080@60, 1920x1200@60(RB) • S-Video: via 2 x phono connector • CVBS: via 1 x phono connector, PAL/NTSC Audio Inputs • HDMI socket, PCM digital stereo audio Encoding & Stream Protocols Video Encoding • 3.5mm jack socket, analogue stereo audio, 2.2V pk-pk into 10k Ohms • MPEG 4-10/H.264 MP@L4, CBR/VBR encoding, supported bit rates 1.5 Mbps to 12 Mbps • MPEG-2 MP@ HL, CBR/VBR encoding, supported bit rates 1.5 Mbps to 15 Mbps 202 Detail Specification: Audio Encoding • MPEG-1 Layer 2- 32, 44.1, 48 KHz sampling, 64 448 Kbps Stereo • AAC LC encoding - 16, 32, 44.1, 48, 88.2, 96 KHz sampling, 40 - 576 Kbps Stereo 203 Output Streams: Video Resolutions • Multicast/Unicast UDP MPEG2-TS • Multicast RTP video and audio streams (for use with Quicktime via onboard RTSP server) • HLS - HTTP Live Streaming • Model 778-S-SD: 480i, 576i • Model 778-S-720p: 480i, 576i, 720p50, 720p60 • Model 778-S-HD: 480i, 576i, 720p50, 720p60, 1080i50, 1080i60, 1080p25, 1080p30 • Model 778-S-HLS: All UDP stream resolutions as Model 778-S-HD (shown above) plus HLS only resolutions: 352x288@25Hz, 640x576@25Hz, 352x288@30, 640x360@30, 640x480@30, 1280x720@30 Network & Interfaces LAN • RJ45 802.3 10/100/1000 Base-T Auto MDIX • Static or DHCP IP Address • DSCP stream tagging for QoS Network Protocols • UDP, TCP, ARP, DHCP, ICMP, IGMP V2, HTTP, Telnet, SNMP, Syslog, SAP/SDP, SMTP, DSCP, HLS USB Comms • USB 2.0, type A: Host port for software upgrades • USB 1.1, type B: Serial Comms for external configuration and/or control RS232 Port • Rx, Tx, CTS, RTS up to 115,200 Baud Configured for SIPI external configuration/control or IP to RS232 bidirectional pass through for external device control • 2 separate outputs supporting Sky, Sky+, SkyHD IR formats with web page or IP command remote activation. • Remote IP command generates any IR remote control keypress • RS232, USB 1.1 serial interface • Telnet for third part connectivity via TCP control such as touch panel interfaces Infra-Red Blasters Control Interface B-3 - MPEG 2–H264 Encoder, Single Channel HDMI Input, 720p output Acceptable: Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 204 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-4& B-5 Digital Media Decoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port and HDMI Output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& Remote Control for the Decoder The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Digital Media Decoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port and HDMI Output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& Remote control for the decoder specification as shown below: Detail Specification: B4: Digital Media Decoder Communications and Control Network • Ethernet 10/100 Base T. RJ-45 modular jack with integrated LEDs Mode of Operation • Standalone or in conjunction with the MediaStar Evolution Administration Software. IP Setup and Control • Configuration via OnBoard Browser/ Remote status monitoring information. • IP/RS232 control protocol to operate with 3rd party Touch Panel Controllers. Video Input Live Network Streams • Multicast/Unicast UDP based AV streams. • H.264 and MPEG-2 video/audio contained in an MP1E9 G-02 TS. 205 (480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p60 formats). 206 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-6 Wired IR Sensor for above Decoder for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Wired IR Sensor for above Decoder for digital signage systemnand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: IR Sensor Module fitted with 3.5mm Jack for connection to Mediastar Pro Micro Set topUnit to allow the small IR sensor to be located in a convenient location and the larger receiver unit housed discreetly behind a screen. Acceptable: Media star , AMX or Approved Equivalent 207 Project: Assembly System: System Reference No: 5 Item Description: Assam Legislative IPTV & Digital Signage Management B-4& BDigital Media Decoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port and HDMI Output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& Remote Control for the Decoder The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative General Specification The unit shall be a professional Digital Media Decoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port and HDMI Output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& Remote control for the decoder specification as shown below :Detail Specification : B4 : Digital Media Decoder Communications and Control Network Mode of Operation IP Setup and Control • Ethernet 10/100 Base T. RJ-45 modular jack with integrated LEDs • Standalone or in conjunction with the MediaStar Evolution Administration Software. • Configuration via On-Board Browser/ Remote status monitoring information. • IP/RS232 control protocol to operate with 3rd party Touch Panel Controllers. Video Input Live Network Streams • Multicast/Unicast UDP based AV streams. • H.264 and MPEG-2 video/audio contained in an MPEG-2 TS. 208 (480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p60 formats). • Locally Stored Files (on-board memory of 4GB to 128 GB by option) Detail Specification: Digital Terrestrial and Satellite TV • DVB-T2 and DVB-S2 compliant 209 Audio Audio Decoding • MPEG-1/2 Audio Layers I, II • MPEG-2/4 AAC LC IR Control • Channel, volume and setup control via MediaStar Remote Control Unit. • Control through on-board IR receiver or using an IR extender RS232 • Serial port, up to 115200 baud for screen on/standby/input control. Software Updates • Latest software can be loaded either through an IP connection to an HTTP server or by inserting a USB key Video Output HDMI Digital • SD 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p • HD 720p (60fps), 1080i (50/60) Phono Analogue (YPbPr) • HD 720p(60fps), 1080i (50/60) • SD CVBS - NTSC, PAL Audio Out - Connectors • HDMI - Digital Stereo Audio • 3.5mm Jack - Analogue Stereo Audio B5: Remote Control for the above decoder Acceptable: Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 210 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-6 Wired IR Sensor for above Decoder for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Wired IR Sensor for above Decoder for digital signage systemnand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: IR Sensor Module fitted with 3.5mm Jack for connection to Mediastar Pro Micro Set topUnit to allow the small IR sensor to be located in a convenient location and the larger receiver unit housed discreetly behind a screen. Acceptable: Media star , AMX or Approved Equivalent 211 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-7 1U Rack mount Server with pre-installed media Manager 200 Media Player License & “Live” streaming server Software for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each General Specification The unit shall be a professional 1U Rack mount Server with pre-installed media Manager 200 Media Player License & “Live” streaming server Softwarefor digital signage system& shall have minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Rack Mount Server - Intel Core i3processor - (3.4Ghz, 3M Cache, No Turbo, 2C, 54W). - Motherboard - Chassis with up to 2 Cabled Hard Drives (2.5" or 3.5"). - Riser with Single x16 Gen3 PCIe Slot. - Electronic System Documentation and Open Manage DVD Kit - Bezel -1600 Mhz UDIMMs. - 4GB UDIMM, 1600 MT/s, Low Volt, Single Rank, x4 Data Width. - 256GB SSD. - No Controller. - Cable for SATA Optical Drive. - SATA 8X DVD +/- RW Drive. - C13 to C14, PDU Style, 10 AMP, 2m Power Cord. - SATA Cable for 2.5/3.5 HDD, R220. - 1U/2U Static rails for 2-Post and 4-Post Racks. - Baseboard Management Controller (12G). Preinstalled Management software, delivering a fully integrated content management system from a single interface which schedules all media sources and monitors every aspect of the distribution network, from the head-end to multiple screen locations. With a GUI interface, enriched functionality and improved ease of use.Central control function, users can also remotely control the system via an iPhone, iPad or smartphone, and estate floor plans will be integral to the application aiding with the location of units, screens and DMD. Acceptable: Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 212 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-8 1U Rackmount Server with pre-installed iVod Server Software with 60 Mbps Streaming Bandwidth , for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional 1U Rackmount Server with pre-installed iVod Server Software with 60 Mbps Streaming Bandwidth, for digital signage system& shall have minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: iVod server requirements Debian or Redhat Linux distribution 32/64 bit, based on libc6 Central iVod Server Hardware Requirements 60 or 200Mbit/sec streaming: 2-core processor, 2GB RAM, single SATA drive (or 2 in RAID-1 for redundancy) 500Mbit/sec streaming: 4-core processor, 4GB RAM, 4 * SATA drive in RAID-5 or RAID-0+1 Off-air SD content (6Mbps MPEG2) typically requires storage of 45MB/s = 2.7GB/hr High Quality HD content (10 Mbps H264) typically requires storage of 75 MB/minute = 4.5GB/hr iVod operation with a central video server or ‘distributed iVod’ content model Easy viewing of iVod server content on PCs and portable iOS and Android devices using the Media Portal web page Media Manager timed playlists and user selection lists, containing iVod file content Full play/pause/skip iVod file viewing with on-screen controls Acceptable: Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 213 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-10 Software license for 30 displays - LOT , for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Software license for 30 displays - LOT, for digital signage systemand shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Client OS/ browser requirements Acceptable: iOS V4 onwards, Safari browsers Android V4.2 Jellybean onwards, Chrome and Firefox V27 browsers Windows XP onwards, Internet Explorer 8 and above Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 214 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-10 Software license for 30 displays - LOT , for digital signage system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Software license for 30 displays - LOT, for digital signage system and shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification: Software license for 30 displays-LOT, for digital signage System Acceptable: Samsung ,Sony or Approved Equivalent 215 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-11 48Port POE Switch with mini GBIC The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as General Specification The unit shall be a professional 48Port POE Switch with mini GBIC specification as shown below: Detail Specification: External I/O ports Rack mounting Memory and Processor Latency Address Table size routing/switching capacity Throughput Management Features 48 10/100 ports (IEEE 802.3 Type 10Base-T, IEEE 02.3u Type 100Base-TX); 1 RS-232C DB-9 console port; 2 dual-personality ports each port can be used as either an RJ-45 10/100/1000 port (IEEE 802.3 Type 10Base-T; IEEE 802.3u Type 100Base-TX; IEEE 802.3ab 1000Base-T Gigabit Ethernet) or an open mini-GBIC slot (for use with mini-GBIC transceivers) Mounts in an EIA-standard 19 in. telco rack or equipment cabinet (hardware included); horizontal surface mounting only Processor type and speed: Power PC MPC8245, 266 MHz; Flash capacity: 8 MB; SDRAM: 32 MB <13.3 µs (LIFO) 8,000 13.6 Gbps up to 10.1 million pps command line interface; Web browser; configuration menu; outof- band management (serial RS-232C) Detail Specification: Communications RFC 783 TFTP; RFC 951 BootP; RFC 1542 BootP; RFC 854 Telnet; RFC 768 UDP; RFC 792 ICMP; RFC 793 TCP; RFC 826 ARP; RFC 2030 SNTP; IEEE 802.3x Flow Control; DHCP Relay; RFC 3046 DHCP Relay Agent Information Option 82; RFC 2236 IGMP v1/v2/v3; IEEE 802.1D Spanning Tree; IEEE 802.1w Rapid Convergence Spanning Tree; IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation 216 Power consumption Control Protocol; IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol; ANSI/TIA-1057 LLDP Media Endpoint Discovery (MED); RFC 1492 TACACS+; SSHv1/SSHv2 Secure Shell 100W 217 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-1 3" Full Range Recessed Ceiling Speaker 20 watts @ 8 Ohms The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as General Specification The unit shall be a professional recessed ceiling speakers providing full, high quality sound for music and speech and shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Frequency Range Power Capacity : : Nominal Sensitivity : Nominal Coverage Angle : Rated Maximum SPL : Full Range Driver : Acceptable: 68 Hz - 17 kHz 40 Watts Continuous Program Power 20 Watts Continuous Pink Noise 84 dB 130° conical coverage 97 dB @ 1 m (3.3 ft) 76mm JBL, EV, Tannoy or Approved Equivalents 218 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Audio Reference No : A-2 Item Description : Digitally Steerable slim line powered line array speakers 4" x 14 Full Range & 4x1" horn loaded dome tweeters The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Digitally Steerable slim line powered line array speakers 4" x 14 Full Range & 4x1" horn loaded dome tweeters shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification : Frequency Range Max SPL Coverage Dynamic range Typical Throw Input Power Acceptable: : : : : : : 130-18k Hz(+/-3Db) 94Db SPL Horizontal 130 deg >100Db 35 m Nominal level-0 Dbv(RMS, line input) : Maximum level-+19 dbv(Peak, line input) : Type: dual line input, transformer balanced : 8x40Wrms JBL, Tannoy, Renkus-Heinz or Approved Equivalents 219 Project : System : Reference No : Item Description : Assam Legislative Assembly Audio A-3 Surface mount two way full range speakers 100 watts @ 8 ohm with necessary mounting bracket. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Surface mount two way full range speakers 100 watts @ 8 ohm with necessary mounting bracket shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification : Freq. Range Midrange 100 Hr Power Capacity3 : Nominal Coverage Nominal Sensitivity4 Nominal Coverage : : : (-10 dB)1: 70 Hz - 23 kHz (±1.5 dB, typical)2: 130 Hz - 14 kHz 200 Watts Continuous Program Power 100 Watts Continuous Pink Noise 100° x 100° 87 dB SPL, 1W @ 1 m (3.3ft) 100° x 100° : Maximum SPL @ 1m : 113 dB continuous peak pink noise Directivity Factor (Q) : 4.9, averaged 500 Hz to 4 kHz Directivity Index (DI) : 6.9 dB, averaged 500 Hz to 4 kHz Nominal Impedance : 8 ohms Acceptable : JBL, EV, Tannoy or Approved Equivalents Minimum Impedance : 6.7 ohms at 230 Hz 220 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Audio Reference No : A-4 Item Description: 35 Watts Active Control Room Speaker The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a 35 Watts Active Control Room Speaker and shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Frequency Range: Transducer: Amplifier Power: Maximum SPL per pair: Crossover Frequency: Sensitivity: Acceptable: 80 Hz - 20 kHz LF:135mm HF:19mm 35 watts per channel 115 dB 4.2kHz Input +4dBu XLR JBL, EV, Tannoy or Approved Equivalents 221 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Audio Reference No : A-5 Item Description : UHF Wireless Handheld Microphone with receiver - 30mw power output The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : The unit shall be UHF Wireless Handheld Microphone with receiver -30mw power output and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specifications Microphone Polar patternTransducer type Frequency responseMax Input Sound Level(SPL) Hyper cardioid Electret Condenser (dynamic) 55Hz to 18kHz Max. SPL 146db Receiver Operating principle Switching bandwidth Sensitivity Antenna connection Nominal deviation Output level Compander system Signal-to-noise ratio < 0.5% at 1 kHz Squelch mV, adjustable Power supply Acceptable: True diversity receiver (UHF) 24 MHz 2 μV 2 x TNC ± 40 kHz 1.2 V NE572 > 110 dB(A) T.H.D 2 μV - 1 12 V - 15 V DC Beyer Dynamic, AKG, Audio Technical or Approved Equivalent 222 Project System Reference No. Item Description : Assam Legislative Assembly. : Audio. : A-7. : Active Antenna Set including Booster. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a antenna extension system with booster to allow the antenna to be remote from the base station. The antenna shall be matched to the exact requirement of the offered wireless microphone systems to ensure correct operation and an active booster shall be provided to lift the signal level by a minimum of +6dB. The unit shall be a ground plane system specific to the manufacturer of the wireless units supplied. Specifications UHF antenna set (620 - 960 MHz) consisting of 2 x TNC booster antenna and 2 x wall mounting kit. Acceptable : Beyer Dynamic, AKG, Shure or Approved Equivalent 223 Project System Reference No. Item Description : Assam Legislative Assembly : Audio : A-8 : Antenna Splitter (each splitter can take care of 4 receivers). The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as General Specification : The unit shall be Antenna Splitter (each splitter can take care of 4 receivers)and shall have the minimum specification as shown below. Specifications - Active UHF wideband antenna divider Frequency range 480-800 MHz 4-way 19" housing 1U for wireless systems with TNC connector. Acceptable : Beyer Dynamic, Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent. 224 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Audio Reference No : A-9 Item Description: Digital Desktop Delegate unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker, voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, Interpreted language channel selector and intercom facility. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : The unit shall beDigital Desktop Delegate unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker , voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, Interpreted language channel selector and intercom facility..and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Digital desktop discussion microphone unit with microphone array technology as a delegate version for use with Conference network. Button for switching on/off and signalling a talk request, with a green LED indicating the microphone is on and a red LED indicating a talk request. 17 microphone capsules in Line-Array set-up with corridor characteristic, two red LED illuminating bars at the side to indicate that the speaker is ready to talk. Headphone output with 3.5mm jack and twoway extended base loud speaker system. Microphone unit addressing via network and storage on unit. Two push- pull system-quick plug connection system for the conference network. LC-Display, language selector and 5 Voting Buttons. Optional expansion of microphone unit with chip card reader. Design: Profiled aluminium housing with anthracite-coloured, non-glare and scratch-resistant Nextel surface coating. Technical specifications Frequency response Microphone: line array Recording characteristic Current consumption: 67 mA (microphone on) Distortion factor Headphone socket System connections: 2 x push-pull Minimum impedance Acceptable: : : : : 130 Hz to 17,000 Hz corridor < 0.1% 3.5 mm mono jack socket : 8O Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Audio Reference No : A-10 225 Item Description: 209 Digital Desktop Chairman unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker , voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, 226 The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers General Specification : The unit shall be Digital Desktop Chairman Unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker, voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, Interpreted language channel selector and intercom facility... and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Digital desktop discussion microphone unit with microphone array technology as a chairperson version for use with Conference network. Three buttons for switching on microphone with green LED to indicate microphone on, priority switching and clearing. 17 microphone capsules in LineArray set- up with corridor characteristic, two red LED illuminating bars at the side to indicate that the speaker is ready to talk. Headphone output with 3.5mm jack and two-way extended base loud speaker system. Microphone unit addressing via network and storage on unit. Two push-pull system-quick plug connections for the conference network.LC-Display, language selector and 5 Voting Buttons. Optional expansion of microphone unit with chip card reader. Design: Profiled aluminium housing with anthracite-coloured, non-glare and scratch-resistant Nextel surface coating. Technical specifications Frequency response Microphone Recording characteristic Current consumption Distortion factor Headphone socket Acceptable : : : 130 Hz to 17,000 Hz line array : corridor : 67 mA (microphone on) : < 0.1% : 3.5 mm mono jack socket Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent. 227 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Audio Reference No: A-11 Item Description: Digital Desktop Secretary unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker, voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, Interpreted language channel selector and intercom facility. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beDigital Desktop Secretary unit with built in Microphone array, loudspeaker, voting and card reader (with facility to start and stop voting), priority panel, LCD display, Interpreted language channel selector and intercom facility..and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications: Digital desktop discussion microphone unit with microphone array technology as a chairperson version for use with Conference network. Three buttons for switching on microphone with green LED to indicate microphone on, priority switching and clearing. 17 microphone capsules in LineArray set- up with corridor characteristic, two red LED illuminating bars at the side to indicate that the speaker is ready to talk. Headphone output with 3.5mm jack and two-way extended base loud speaker system. Microphone unit addressing via network and storage on unit. Two push-pull system-quick plug connections for the conference network.LC-Display, language selector and 5 Voting Buttons. Optional expansion of microphone unit with chip card reader. Design: Profiled aluminium housing with anthracite-coloured, non-glare and scratch-resistant Nextel surface coating. Technical specifications Frequency response: 130 Hz to 17,000 Hz Microphone: line array Recording characteristic: corridor Current consumption: 67 mA (microphone on) Distortion factor: < 0.1% Headphone socket: 3.5 mm mono jack socket System connections: 2 x push-pull Minimum impedance: 8 O Temperature range: 0 °C to +40 °C Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 228 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-12 Power supply for up to 45 microphone units, conference network, 4 x Push-Pull connection, 19" housing, 2 U The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be Power supply for up to 45 microphone units, conference network, 4 x Push-Pull connection, 19" housing, 2 U. and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications: The power supply unit shall supply a maximum of 45 microphone units in the conference network via Conference network. An LED shall indicate the power on status. The unit shall provide four pushpull connectors to connect to the conference network and two phoenix terminals for external DC supply. The data transfer of the conference network shall be possible in the standby mode. The power shall be 6 A. The housing shall be 19“, 2 U. On the rear shall be venting slots and a fan. Specifications: Mains voltage: 100 - 240 V AC 47 - 63 Hz Fuse: 6.3 AT (H) Power consumption: 330 W Output current: max. 6 A DC System connections: 2 x push pull, 6-pin, type Lemo/ODU Extension connections: 2 x push pull, 6-pin, type Lemo/ODU Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 229 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-13 Digital Opto Coupler for conference network, The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and General Specification: The unit shall beDigital Opto Coupler for conference network,,.and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Conference Network Power consumption Max. DC current 2x push-pull 6-pin, Phoenix, 2-pin, 5.08 mm 6A (GI) Type 50/125 μm, 820 nm multimode Fibre type Fibre connection 2x Type ST Maximum fibre length 2000 m Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 230 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-14,A-15 Connecting cable for " conference network, Push-Pull connector, 2 m (7 with ft.) necessary connector to complete entire system The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. General Specification: The unit shall beConnecting cable for " conference network, Push-Pull connector, 2 m (7 ft.) with necessary connector to complete entire system and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications The network cable shall provide a Lemo push-pull connector system for the conference network. The length shall be 2 m. A-15Connecting cable for " conference network, Push-Pull connector, 2 m (7 ft.) with necessary connector to complete entire system Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 231 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-16 Headphones, 2 x 32 Ω, with cable 1.6 m (5 ft.), stereo mini-jack The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beHeadphones, 2 x 32 Ω, with cable 1.6 m (5 ft.), stereo mini-jack minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Transducer type Dynamic Operating principle Open Frequency response 40 20,000 Hz Nominal impedance 2 x 32 104 Db Nominal SPL Power handling capacity 100 mW Stereo jack plug 3.5 mm Connection Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent and shall have the 232 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-17 Digital T-adapter for conference network,3 x Push-Pull connection The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be Digital T-adapter for conference network, 3 x Push-Pull connection and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications: Digital 3-way adapter. Compact, rugged metal housing with three push-pull connectors for the conference network. Power supply via network. Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 233 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-18 Configuration and controller software for Digital Conference Network The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beConfiguration and controller software for Digital Conference Networkand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Control- and configuration Software for digital Conference network System Complete Software package, ICNS modules activated by license key in Central Unit Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 234 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-20 Central Processing unit The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beCentral Processing unit.and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications: Central control unit with computer processor as the core of a fully digital discussion network for controlling up to 1,400 units with 54 audio channels in the conference network. Integrated simultaneous interpreting function for up to 53 target languages. Mains adapter for supplying power to the conference network for up to 15 microphone units, can be optionally extended to 30 positions. Network connection suitable for hot plugging, integral digital-analogue audio interface, each with 2 controllable, transformer-balanced XLR inputs and outputs. Multifunction keys, 4-key navigator and LC display for menu-guided system operation and configuration. RS232 interface at the rear for operation with PC software or media control unit. System check when the control unit is switched on. Selectable operating modes such as "request", once activated, use enabled by the president; "free", each participant can switch his/her microphone unit on and off individually, up to a maximum of 16 microphones are on at the same time; "Fifo", each participant can switch his/her microphone unit on and off individually, up to a maximum of 16 microphones are on at the same time, positions which are switched on over the limit switch off the microphones which have been on the longest; "Auto", each participant can switch his/her microphone unit on and off individually, up to a maximum of 16 microphones are on at the same time, positions which are switched on over the limit are automatically switched off once one of the active microphones has been switched off; The following parameters can be set in the system configuration: Number and address of the president monitoring units, monitoring unit address assignment, operating mode including limits, level of the signal inputs and outputs, designation of the channels for interpreting mode. Optional controlunit redundancy in connection with control software and monitor switch for disaster mode, as well as optional multi-session mode for controlling several conferences via a control unit in combination with control software. A push-pull system-quick plug connection for the conference network Two 3-pin XLR built-in plugs for transformer-balanced output –28.5 dB up to +18 dB and two 3-pin XLR built-in sockets for transformer-balanced input xxdB. Stand-alone table housing, suitable for 19" installation. 2HU. Ventilation slots at the front and rear: Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 235 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-21 Analogue Audio Interface unit 6 in, 6 out , 3 x sterio - AS / EBU out , 2 push pull connector The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beAnalogue Audio Interface unit 6 in, 6 out , 3 x sterio - AS / EBU out , 2 push pull connector.and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Analogue inputs Connector Level Range Frequency response Input impedance Analogue outputs Connector Level Range Output impedance Analogue outputs Connector Sample rate Acceptable: 12-pin Phoenix socket (RM 5.08 mm) 6 dBu maxima l 0 dB ... +22.5 dB 20 Hz to 20 kHz (± 1.5 dB) 47 kΩ 12-pin Phoenix socket (RM 5.08 mm) 6 dBu maxima l -18 dB ... 0 dB 100 3-pin XLR socket 48 kHz Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 236 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-22 Interpreter desk with LCD display, Pluggable extended stem microphone, Interpreter head phone, Intercom etc. The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be Interpreter desk with LCD display, Pluggable extended stem microphone, Interpreter head phone, Intercom etc. and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications: Digital interpreter microphone unit for 1 interpreter as a single desk, up to 53 target languages for operation in the conference network. Two separate LC displays for relay channels and microphone output channels, connection for the headphone/microphone set or headphones and microphone separate, menu-controlled channel pre-selection field and listening monitor field for up to three relay channels and two microphone output channels, can be programmed for direct access. Two-band sound control for headphones and controllable monitor speakers. Service call button, president call button and cough button. Integration at any position in the conference network with integrated power supply via bus. Complies with the requirements of the AIIC (Association International des Interprets de Conference – International Association of Interpreters) and the corresponding standards (ISO 4043, ISO 2603, DIN 56924). Two push-pull system-quick plug connections for the conference network. Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 237 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-23 Control Unit for Portable Conference Units The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be Control Unit for Portable Conference Units and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications The control unit shall be the core of a discussion system with media control system. It shall be equipped with an integrated power supply unit and processor to control a maximum of 64 microphone units. The control unit shall have 2 multifunction buttons and an LC-Display with 2 lines/16 digits for menu-driven system operation and configuration. The RS 232 interface port on the front shall be used for a system configuration via PC. After switching on the control unit a system check shall be performed. The master reset shall be accessible for manufacturer’s default settings. The serial RS 232 interface shall connect to an operator’s PC or external console. The control unit shall have two inputs for sound signals 250 mV (balanced) and 1.55 V (unbalanced). The following three operation modes shall be available: Request-to-Talk (the chairman shall release the microphone of the participant who wants to talk), Autonomy (each participant shall switch on and off his microphone unit), Override (each switched on microphone unit shall switch off the previously activated microphone unit). ”Next” function control (first in - first out) in the Request-to-Talk mode. In each operation mode the talk time and warning time for the illuminated ring shall be pre-set to indicate that the talk time has elapsed. The following parameters shall be adjusted within the system configuration: number and address of the chairman microphone units, function of the priority button, number of the open microphones, number and address of the loudspeakers to be muted in the microphone units, input level of the signals and volume and sound control of the master signal. For the microphone lines 2 connections shall be available. The control unit shall have a recording output (RCA, 250 mV) and a 3-pin XLR socket for transformer balanced line level output (+6 dBm). The recording output shall be independent from the output volume adjustment. The desktop housing shall be 2 rack units high, for 19" rack mounting. The control unit shall have ventilation louvres on top and bottom. Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 238 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-24 Chairman Microphone Unit with channel selector - Portable with standard Loop The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beChairman Microphone Unit with channel selector - Portable with standard Loop and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications The digitally controlled chairman microphone unit shall provide three buttons for microphone on/off, priority and clearing. The priority functions such as switching on or switching on and clearing or muting the activated delegate units shall be programmable. The green LED shall indicate the activated microphone status. The fixed condenser gooseneck microphone (back electret) shall provide a cardioid polar pattern. The total length of the gooseneck shall be 400 mm and the diameter shall be 8 mm. The illuminated ring below the microphone capsule shall indicate the ready to talk status. The microphone unit shall provide a 15-pin Sub-D female connector. The system connecting cable shall be 3 m long with a 15-pin Sub-D male connector. The mini jack (3.5 mm) shall be used for connecting recorders. The microphone unit shall have an integrated loudspeaker with volume control. The microphone unit shall be equipped with DIP-switches to set the microphone address. The plastic housing shall be coated with a charcoalgrey, non-glare Nextel® finish. Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 239 Project: Assembly System: Audio Reference No: 25 Item Description: Portable Assam Legislative ADelegate Microphone Unit - The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall beDelegate Microphone Unit – Portableand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications The digitally controlled delegate microphone unit shall provide one button for switching on/off or request-to-talk. The dual-colour LED shall indicate the microphone on (green) or request- to-talk (red) status. The fixed condenser gooseneck microphone (back electret) shall provide a cardioid polar pattern. The total length of the gooseneck shall be 400 mm and the diameter shall be 8 mm. The illuminated ring below the microphone capsule shall indicate the ready to talk status. The microphone unit shall provide a 15-pin Sub-D female connection. The system connecting cable shall be 3 m long with a 15-pin Sub-D male connector. The microphone unit shall provide a mini jack for connecting recorders. The microphone unit shall have an integrated loudspeaker with volume control. The microphone unit shall be equipped with DIP- switches to adjust the microphone address. The plastic housing shall be coated with a charcoal-grey, non-glare and scratch-resistant Nextel® finish. Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 240 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System Reference No Item Description : : : Audio A-26 Connecting cable length 20 mtr length The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : The unit shall be Connecting cable length 20 mtr length and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Specifications Connecting cable length 20 mtr length Acceptable: Beyerdynamic , Shure, AKG or Approved Equivalent 241 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-27 Dual Channel Amplifier 100 Watts @ 4 Ohms The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Dual Channel Amplifier 100 Watts @ 4 Ohmsand shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Audio Voltage gain Stereo channel separation CMRR Audio Input Number/signal type Connectors Impedance Nominal level Maximum level Input sensitivity Input signal detection threshold Audio output Number/signal type Connectors Load impedance Amplifier type Output power 16x (24 DB) >75 dB @ 1 kHz 75 dB @ 1 kHz (typical) 1 stereo or 2 mono, balanced/unbalanced (1) 3.5 mm captive screw connector, 5 pole >10k ohms unbalanced/balanced, DC coupled +4 dBu (1.23 Vrms), balanced +20 dBu (7.75 Vrms), balanced +4 dBu (1.23 Vrms) -40 dBu ±3 dB, balanced 1 stereo, 4/8 ohm direct (1) 5 mm screw lock captive screw connector, 4 pole 4 ohms minimum Class D 60 watts rms per channel, 8 ohms, 1 kHz, <0.05% THD 100 watts rms per channel, 4 ohms, 1 kHz, <0.05% THD 242 Control/remote — amplifier Control port Pin configurations DC volume control (analog) Volume control voltage range Standby power control (contact closure) Power Consumption Standby Acceptable: >1 watts (1) 3.5 mm captive screw connector, 5 pole Pin 1 = +10 VDC, 50 mA (max.), pin 2 = volume/mute (variable voltage), pin 3 = GND 0 V (mute) to 10 V (maximum volume) Pin 4 = GND, pin 5 = standby 43 watts (4 ohms (x2)) ,8 ohms(x2) 30 watts Extron, Crown, EV, Behringer or Approved Equivalents 243 Project: Assembly System: Audio Reference No: 28 Item Description: 70.7V Assam Legislative A8 Channel Amplifier with 160 Watts @ 8 ohm & 200 watts @ 4 ohm & The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the Supplier must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be 8 Channel Amplifier with 160 Watts @ 8 ohm & 200 watts @ 4 ohm & 70.7Vand shall have the following minimum specification. Detail Specification: Sensitivity : 1.4V Frequency Response : 20 Hz 20 kHz Signal to Noise Ratio below rated power : 100 dB unweighted Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) at 1 watt : < 0.05% Crosstalk (below rated power, 20 Hz to 1 kHz) : > 80 dB Common Mode Rejection (CMR) (20 : 50 dB hz to 1 kHz) : 20 kohms, 10 kohms Input Impedance nominally balanced, nominally unbalanced Maximum Input Level : + 20 dBu Voltage Gain, 1.4V sensitivity 4/8 Ohm Operation : 20:1 (26 dB) 70V Operation : 50:1 (34 dB) 100V Operation : 71.4:1 (37 dB) Acceptable: Crown, LabGruppen, Dynacord or Approved Equivalent 244 Biamp : Assam Legislative Assembly. System : Audio Reference No. : A-29, A-30, A-31, A-32 Item Description : Digital Audio Platform DSP Charsi with Cobra Net to accommodate up to 24 Channels of I/O The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be aDigital Audio Platform DSP Charsiwith CobraNet to accommodate up to 24 Channels of I/Oand shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Chassis space) Custom I/O (card based) Analog Inputs Digital Inputs AEC Inputs Analog Outputs Digital Outputs Telephone Connection Max Inputs/Outputs Config Signal Processing (MHz) SWL Digital Audio Bus 19" (single rack Yes up to 16 up to 16 up to 16 up to 16 up to 16 up to 4 16 Software 800 256 A-30Four Channel Mic/ Line Input Card A-31Four Wide-Band Acoustic Echo Cancellation Input Cards A-32 Four Channel Mic/ Line Output Card Acceptable: BSS, Biamp ,Peavey or Approved Equivalent 245 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-33 CobraNet to 8 Analog Line output expander The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Cobra Net to 8 Analog line output Expander and shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Analog Outputs: Maximum Output Level: Frequency Response: THD: Dynamic Range: Crosstalk: D/A Latency: Digital Audio Bus: Connectors: Maximum Cable Length: Maximum Number of Nodes: Latency Per Node: Acceptable: 8 electronically balanced on Phoenix/Combicon removable screw connectors +19dBu 20Hz-20KHz (+0.5dB/-1dB) <0.01% 20Hz to 20KHz, +10dBu output 108dB typical, 22Hz-22KHz unweighted <-75dB 28/Fs [0.58ms@48K, 0.29ms@96K] 2 x RJ45 Ethernet connectors 100m/300ft on Category 5e cable between devices 60 4/Fs [0.08ms@48K, 0.04ms@96K] BSS , Biamp or Approved Equivalents 246 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Audio A-34 CobraNet to 8 Analog Line Input expander Net to The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Cobra Net to 8 Analog line input expander and shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification: Analog Inputs: Mic/Line Inputs: up to +48dB, in 6dB 8 electronically balanced on Phoenix/Combicon removable screw connectors Nominal gain 0dB, electronically switchable step s Input Impedance: Maximum Input Level: gain CMRR: 3.0kOhm 20dBu with 0dB input gain,8dBu with 12dB Input Noise (E.I.N.): Phantom Power: <-123dBu typical with 150 Ohms source 48V nominal, >40dB at 1kHz selectable per input A/D Latency 37/Fs [0.77ms@48k, 0.39ms@96k] 37/Fs [0.77ms@48k, 0.39ms@96k] Digital Audio Bus: Connectors: Maximum Cable Length: devices 2 x RJ45 Ethernet connectors 100m/300ft on Category 5e cable between Maximum Number of Nodes: Latency Per Node: Power and Dimensions: AC Power Input to Adapter: 60 4/Fs [0.08ms@48K, 0.04ms@96K] BTU Rating: <65 BTU/hr Acceptable: 19W BSS,Biamp ,Peavey or approved equivalent 247 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Audio A-35 5 Channel Mic / Line Mixer The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a5 Channel Mic / Line Mixer and shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification: Inputs : 4 selectable mic or line level 1 line level 1 direct MIX; detachable terminal block Input Impedance : Mic: >1.2 kΩ balanced; Line: >10 kΩ balanced Maximum Input Level : Mic: -20 dBu; Line: +24 dBu Phantom : Switch-selectable 24 V Gain : Mic: Off to 65 dB; Line: Off to 15 dB Outputs : Mic: -45 dBu balanced Line: +4 dBu balanced; detachable terminal block Output Impedance : 150 Ω balanced Frequency Response : Mic: 80 Hz to 40 kHz Line: 10 Hz to 35 kHz THD+N : Mic: < 0.03%; Line: <0.003% Headroom : 20 dB (above +4 dBu output) CMRR : Mic: > -65 dB (10 Hz to 10 kHz); Line: > -45 dB Noise : < -70 dB below +4 dBu output (20 Hz to 20 kHz, all mic channels at 50 dB gain; or one mic channel active at 60 dB gain); < -90 dB below +4 dBu (20 Hz to 20 kHz, all channels off) Acceptable: RDL, Kramer, Extronor Approved Equivalents 248 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Audio A-36 1:8 Balanced Stereo Audio Distribution Amplifier The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a 1:8 Balanced Stereo Audio Distribution Amplifier shall have the minimum specification as shown below. Detail Specification: INPUTS : 2 balanced stereo audio +4dBu, 100kΩ OUTPUTS : 8 (or 2 x 4) balanced stereo audio, +4dBu, 50Ω MAX. AUDIO OUTPUT : 20Vpp. AUDIO BANDWIDTH (-3DB) GAIN RANGE S/N RATIO : 100dB/1V. CROSSTALK CONTRO LS AUDIO THD + NOISE Acceptable: : 20kHz. : 0.2 to 5.8dB (4 trimmers, 2 for each input channel). : −60dB@1kHz. : Front selector switches for 1:8 or 2x1:4 operation, 4 front accessible gain trimmers : 0.02%. Kramer ,Extron, Geffen or approved equivalent 249 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description : Assam Legislative Assembly Audio A-38 Dual Channel Stereo Power Amplifier 40 Watts @ 8 Ohm The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a Dual Channel Stereo Power Amplifier 40 Watts @ 8 Ohm shall have the minimum specification as shown below. Detail INPUT : Balanced stereo audio on a terminal block connector. OUTPUT : Balanced stereo audio (speakers) on a terminal block connector. OUTPUT POWER : 19W RMS per channel into 8Ω. OUTPUT MUSIC POWER : 75W per channel. BANDWIDTH (-3dB) : 20kHz. S/N RATIO : 60.2dB. COUPLING : DC. AUDIO THD + NOISE : 1.9%. AUDIO 2nd HARMONIC : 0.3%. POWER SOURCE : 24V DC, 5A. DIMENSIONS : 10.7cm x 10.4cm x 4.0cm (4.2" x 4.1" x 1.6") W, D, H. Acceptable: Kramer ,Extron, Geffen or approved equivalent 250 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Camera ( AV System) Reference No: C-1 Item Description: High Definition DVI/HDMI Pan/Tilt/Zoom Camera with 20x Zoom The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a High Definition DVI/HDMI Pan/Tilt/Zoom Camera with 20x Zoomand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detailed Specification: Image Device Picture Elements HD Resolutions and 1080/25p Lens Glass, F1.6 : : : : 6.49mm diagonal 3.27 pixels 1080i/59.94/60, 1080/50i, 720p/59.94/60, 720/50p 1080/30p 20x Optical Zoom Lens with HiLD™ (High Index Low Dispersion) Wide to F3.5 Tele, 11-Elements in 9-Groups Focal Length : F=4.7mm wide to 94mm tele Horizontal View Angle : 2.9 to 55.2 degrees - 16:9 Format Video S/N Ratio : >50 dB Invertible : Yes - Without Frame Delay Minimum Illumination : 1.6 LUX (F1.6, 50IRE) Serial Control Protocol : RS-232 Pan Range degrees Min. Object Distance Image Control HD Video Select Output Acceptable: : Pan: +170 degrees to -170 degrees, Tilt: +90 degrees to -30 : Wide End: .01m wide end, Tele end: 1.0m : Red & Blue Gain, Detail, Chroma, Gamma, Pedestal, Iris, and Gain (available through RS-232 control) : 16-Position Rotary Switch: Used to set HD Video Resolution Vaddio, Sony or Approved Equivalent 251 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Camera ( AV System) Reference No: C-2 Item Description: Camera Control Console for controlling up to 7 PTZ camera's via RS232 , External RS232 Control, 14 pre-sets per camera The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a Camera Control Console for controlling up to 7 PTZ camera's via RS232 , External RS232 Control, 14 presets per cameraand shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detailed Specification: System I/O: Seven (7) RS-232 Camera Control Ports on RJ-45 Connectors Two (2) Link Ports (In and Out) on RJ-45 One (1) RS-232 Control Port on DB-9F Seven (7) Tally Outputs - Group A, Seven (7) Tally Outputs - Group B One (1) Power Connector (Coaxial, Positive Center, 5.5mm OD x 2.5mm ID) Joystick: 3-Axis, Hall-Effect, Non-contacting Type with Single Button Internally Stored Presets 98: (14 per PTZ camera attached) Camera Control Parameters: Iris, Gain, Detail, Red Gain, Blue Gain, Focus (for compatible cameras) Pan, Tilt and Zoom on Joystick Pan, Tilt and Zoom speed (for Joystick PTZ functions) Acceptable: Vaddio, Sony or Approved Equivalent 252 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Control D-1,D-2 10.1" wired Touch Panel The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a10.1" wired Touch Panelshall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Touch Screen Display Display Type TFT Active matrix color LCD Size 10.1 inch (257 mm) diagonal Aspect Ratio 16:10 WXGA Resolution 1280 x 800 pixels Brightness 400 nits (cd/m²) Contrast 800:01:00 Color Depth 24-bit, 16.7M colors Illumination Edgelit LED Viewing Angle ±80° horizontal, ±80° vertical Touch Screen Projected Capacitive Memory LPDDR2 RAM 1 GB Flash 4 GB Maximum Project Size 512 MB Video Streaming Formats H.264 (MPEG-4 253 part 10 AVC), MJPEG Audio Features Audio Feedback Formats Built-in microphone and speakers, Rava™ SIP Intercom, multi-language voice [1] recognition MP3 Connectors (1) 8-wire RJ45 with 2 LED indicators; 10Base-T/100Base-TX Ethernet port, Power over Ethernet compliant; Green and yellow LEDs indicate Ethernet port status D-2 TABLE TOP KIT FOR ABOVE TOUCH PANEL LAN PoE Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 254 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Control D-3 POE injector for the touch panel The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The device shall be a POE injector for the touch panel. The device shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Connectors LAN Ethernet LAN : (1) 8-wire RJ45, female;10BaseT/100BaseTX Ethernet port; Connects to LAN PoE and IEEE 802.3af Class 0 : (1) 8-wire RJ45, female; 10BaseT/100BaseTX Ethernet pass-thru port PoE Power Sourcing Equipment output Main Power Input LED Indicators POWER connected; Power Requirements Acceptable: : : (1) IEC 320 C14 socket; Mates with removable power cord, included (1) Tri-colour LED; Amber indicates power is available but no device is Green indicates a PoE device is connected and drawing power; Red (flashing) indicates a non- PoE device is connected : 100-250 Volts AC, 50/60 Hz Crestron, AMX ,CUE or Approved Equivalent 255 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: 4 Item Description: Control DIntegrated Control processor 6 RS232/ 8 I/R/Serial ports,8 I/O Versi isolated relays/ 10/100 Ethernet port The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be aIntegrated Control processor 6 RS232/ 8 I/R/Serial ports,8 I/O Versi isolated relays/ 10/100 Ethernet port shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: MEMORY SDRAM 1 GB Flash 4 GB Memory Card supports SD™ and SDHC™ cards up to 32 GB External Storage support USB mass storage devices up to 1 TB Communications Ethern et Control Subnet USB RS232/422/48 5 IR/Serial or serial TTL/RS-232 (0-5 10/100/1000 Mbps; auto-switching; auto-negotiating; autodiscovery; full/half duplex; industry-standard TCP/IP stack; UDP/IP; CIP; DHCP; SSL; IEEE 802.1X; SNMP; BACnet®/IP[2]; IPv4 or IPv6; Active Directory authentication; IIS v.6.0 Web Server; SMTP e-mail client; installer setup via Crestron Toolbox™ or MSIE[3] 10/100/1000 Mbps Ethernet, auto-switching, autonegotiating, auto-discovery, full/half duplex, DHCP server, DNS Server, port forwarding, Isolation Mode Supports USB HID and USB mass storage class devices via rear panel USB 2.0 host port, supports computer console via front panel USB 2.0 device port For 2-way device control and monitoring, all ports support RS-232 up to 115.2k bau with software handshaking, two ports also support hardware handshaking, RS-422, and RS-485 Supports 1-way device control via infrared up to 1.2 MHz Volts) up to 115.2k baud 256 Detail Specification: 100-240V~2.4A 50/60HZ G COMPUTER (front) (1) IEC 60320 C14 main power inlet; Mates with removable power cord, included (1) 6-32 screw, chassis ground lug (1) USB Type B female; USB 2.0 computer console port (6 ft cable included); For setup only LCD Display Display Type TFT active matrix color LCD Size 2.8 inch (72 mm) diagonal Resolution 320 x 240 pixels Functions other system information Power Requirements Main Power Displays configuration menus, control port activity, and 2.4 A2m3p8 s @ 100-240 Volts AC, 50/60 Hz 257 Detail Specification: CONNECTORS & CARD SLOTS S1 – S3 COM 1 –2 COM 3 –6 (3) Control card expansion slots (2) 5-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal blocks; Bidirectional RS-232/422/485 ports[4]; Up to 115.2k baud; hardware and software handshaking support (4) 3-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal blocks; Bidirectional RS232 ports[4]; Up to 115.2k baud; software handshaking support (2) 8-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal block comprising (8) IR - SERIAL OUTPUT 1–8 RELAY OUTPUT 1 – 8 IR/Serial output ports; IR output up to 1.2 MHz; 1-way serial TTL/RS-232 (0-5 Volts) up to 115.2k baud (2) 8-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal blocks comprising (8) normally open, isolated relays; Rated 1 Amp, 30 Volts AC/DC; MOV arc suppression across contacts (1) 8-wire RJ45 jack; 10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T LAN Ethernet port[4]; Connects to the customer's LAN CONTROL (1) 8-wire RJ45 jack; 10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T SUBNET USB Ethernet port[4]; Provides a dedicated MEMORY local network for Crestron devices (1) USB Type A female; USB 2.0 port for storage devices (1) SD memory card slot; I/O 1 – 8 NET Accepts one SD or SDHC card up to 32 GB for memory expansion (1) 9-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal block comprising (8) "Versiport" digital input/output or analog input ports (referenced to GND) [4]; Digital Input: Rated for 0-24 Volts DC, input impedance 20k Ohms, logic threshold >3.125V low/0 and <1.875V high/1; Digital Output: 250mA sink from maximum 24 Volts DC, catch diodes for use with "real world" loads; Analog Input: Rated for 0-10 Volts DC, protected to 24 Volts DC maximum, input impedance 21k ohms with pull-up resistor disabled; Programmable 5 Volts, 2k ohms pull-up resistor per pin (1) 4-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal block; 258 Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 259 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Control D-5 External Power -300Watt NET Power Supply The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a External Power supply -300Watt NET Power Supply shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: CONNECTIONS 1–8 (16) 4-pin 5mm detachable terminal blocks comprising (2) paralleled Control Net ports per each of (8) output channels; 24 Volt DC power outputs with Control NET data pass-thru from NET port NET (1) 4-pin 5mm detachable terminal block; Applying 24 Volts DC to the ‘24’ and ‘G’ terminals enables the power supply system when in “SLAVE” mode (1) attached input power cable (~1 ft long) with inline AC Line IEC320 socket; Controls PWR ON, PWR OFF/SLAVE Connects to grounded AC power source using 3-prong power cable or pigtail cable, both provided (1) rocker switch; enables/disables the power supply system if no external DC voltage is applied to the NET port, or selects “SLAVE” mode to allow enabling the power supply system remotely by applying an external 24V DC signal to the NET port (8) miniature pushbuttons; each resets its respective output channel, or momentarily disables the channel while held (1) miniature pushbutton; resets all output channels SYSTEM RESET sequentially, or momentarily disables all channels while held SETUP (1) miniature pushbutton; used for touch-settable ID (TSID) Power Requirements 4 Amps, 100-240 Volts AC, 50/60 Hz RESET 1 – 8 Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 260 Project Assembly : System Control Reference No : 6 Item Description: Processor Assam Legislative : D3Port RS-232/422/485 card for the Control The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The device shall be a 3 Port RS-232/422/485 Card for Control Processor. The device shall have the minimum specification as shown below : Detail Specification: COM A-C : (3) DB9 male bidirectional RS232/RS422/485 ports Up to 115.2 k baud, hardware and software handshaking support Net power usage : 3 watts (0.125 amps@24 volts DC) Temp. : 41° to 113°F (5° to 45°C) Humidity : 10% to 90% RH (non-condensing) Dimension : 24.9x27.0x172.1 (H x W x D) Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 261 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Control D-7 Infrared (IR) Emitter probe The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be an Infrared (IR) Emitter probe and should have minimum specification as indicated below… Detail Specification: Infrared OUTPUT 5mm detachable terminal blocks comprising Infrared output IR output up to 1.2 MHz Temperature : 41° to 113°F (5° to 45°C) Humidity : 10% to 90% RH (non-condensing Acceptable: Crestron,AMX or Approved Equivalent 262 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Installation Equipment E-1 Wall Plate The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications: All plates shall be made from stainless steel or equal approved, minimum thickness is to be 1.6mm. Finish is to be brushed in non-public areas and finish to ID requirements in all public areas. Plate is to be clearly marked by engraving and black filled in paint, no other form of making will be acceptable. All connectors used in constructing plates shall be D series. All plates are to be mounted flush with surface and are to be aligned correctly. All plate designs are to be approved by the AV consultant before fabrication, sample of finish and detailed Drawings are to be provided. 263 Project: Assembly System: Equipment Reference No: 2 Item Description: Plate Assam Legislative Installation ETable The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications: All plates shall be made from stainless steel or equal approved, minimum thickness is to be 1.6mm. Finish is to be brushed in non-public areas and finish to ID requirements in all public areas. Plate is to be clearly marked by engraving and black filled in paint, no other form of making will be acceptable. All connectors used in constructing plates shall be D series. All plates are to be mounted flush with surface and are to be aligned correctly. All plate designs are to be approved by the AV consultant before fabrication, sample of finish and detailed Drawings are to be provided. 264 Project: Assembly System: Equipment Reference No: 3 Item Description: display Assam Legislative Installation EWall / Ceiling mount bracket for Flat panel The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications: The Wall/Ceiling Bracket for Display shall be made from mild steel or Stainless steel, can be custom made based on submitted drawings and shall be of a laser etched, matte black powder coat finish. Please note, all fixings shall be invisible from the front and all cable management shall be incorporated in the design of the unit. All Bracket designs are to be approved by the AV consultant before fabrication, sample of finish and detailed Drawings are to be provided. 265 Project: Assembly System: Equipment Reference No: 5 Item Description: Plate Assam Legislative Installation E-4,ERack Plate / Credenza The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications: Rack / Credenza plates shall be made from stainless steel or equal approved, minimum thickness is to be 1.6mm. Finish is to be brushed in non-public areas and finish to ID requirements in all public areas. Plate is to be clearly marked by engraving and black filled in paint, no other form of making will be acceptable. All connectors used in constructing plates shall be D series. All plates are to be mounted flush with surface and are to be aligned correctly. All plate designs are to be approved by the AV consultant before fabrication, sample of finish and detailed drawings are to be provided. 266 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: -3 Installation Equipment E-6 42U Closed Rack or to suit /w Vent & Blank Panels, Shelves, Power Distributors No's plus ID panel as required The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: Equipment racks shall be constructed of 16 gauge (minimum) cold rolled steel & shall have rear doors & square front vertical corners. Rack dimensions shall not exceed 22 ½ “Wide by 15 “Deep by 42 U high. Finish shall be approved by the AV consultant /Employer. The front Door shall have clear lockable (Minimum 5mm Thick) Perspex panel with minimum dimensions opening at strategic location to enable the operator to by Pass faulty equipment as necessary. Each rack shall be equipped with permanently mounted AC power 3 Conductor grounded Strip line rated for 10 Amps with outlets on 6’ Centers, Extending the height of the rack & with interior incandescent illumination Connected there to for ease in servicing & connecting the installed components .Any unused panels mounting Space in the racks or enclosure shall be filled in with blank or ventilating Panels & Shelves. If tenderer wishes to offer any other brand then fully specifications will be required. Nonproprietary manufactured units will be considered 267 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Installation Equipment E-7 12 U Closed Rack or to suit, /w Vent & Blank Panels, Shelves, Power distributor 3 No's .plus ID panel as required The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: Equipment racks shall be constructed of 16 gauge (minimum) cold rolled steel & shall have rear doors & square front vertical corners. Rack dimensions shall not exceed 22 ½ “Wide by 15 “Deep by 12 U high. Finish shall be approved by the AV consultant /Employer. The front Door shall have clear lockable (Minimum 5mm Thick) Perspex panel with minimum dimensions opening at strategic location to enable the operator to by Pass faulty equipment as necessary. Each rack shall be equipped with permanently mounted AC power 3 Conductor grounded Strip line rated for 10 Amps with outlets on 6’ Centers, Extending the height of the rack & with interior incandescent illumination Connected there to for ease in servicing & connecting the installed components .Any unused panels mounting Space in the racks or enclosure shall be filled in with blank or ventilating Panels & Shelves. If tenderer wishes to offer any other brand then fully specifications will be required. Nonproprietary manufactured units will be considered 268 Project: Assembly System: Equipment Reference No: 8 Item Description: plates Assam Legislative Installation EBroadcasting enclosure box (outdoor rated ) with necessary The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specifications: The Broadcasting enclosure madeof mild steel can be custom made based on submitted drawings and shallbe of a matte black powder coat finish.Please note, Acceptable : Custom, Proprietary from OEM manufacturer or approved equivalent. 269 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description : Video B-1 5500 ANSI Lumens WXGA Projector with Standard Lens The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the Supplier must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be 5500 ANSI Lumens WXGA Projector with Standard Lens and shall have the following minimum specification. Detail Specification: Display Technology : 3 x LCD Native WXGA 1280 x 800 resolution Resolution : 1280 x 800 WXGA Brightness : 5,500 Lumens Contrast : 800:1 Lamp : 330W Normal mode 2000 hours, eco mode 3000 hours Signal Compatibility : Up to UXGA/SXGA+/SXGA/WXGA(Native)/XGA/SVGA/VGA/MAC Accepts current HDTV/DTV formats (720p-1080p) NTSC, NTSC 4.43, PAL, PAL M, SECAM, PAL-N, PAL 60 Pixel Clock : 140 MHz (Analog input)/162MHz (digital) Scan Rates : Horizontal frequency 15-100kHz Vertical frequency 48100Hz Inputs, Control and Networking : Input 1: HDMI (Version 1.3 with deep color) x 1; DSub 15x1 Input 2: BNC x 5 (R, G, B, H, V & Y, Pb/Cb, Pr/Cr & Composite) Input 3: S-Video (Mini DIN 4-pin), RCA x 3 (Video/Y, Pb/Cb, Pr/Cr) Audio In - Mini jack x 2 (1,2)(stereo) and RCA x 2 (R, Lmono) Outputs: D-Sub15 (Monitor out) x 1, Audio out - Mini jack x 1 (stereo) 270 RJ45 LAN x1 Control port - Dsub9 x1 Acceptable: Christie, Panasonic, Projection Design or Approved Equivalent 271 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: drop. Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-2 164" Diagonal Motorised screen 16:10 Format with 800mm additional The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : This unit shall be a 164" Diagonal Motorised screen 16:10 Format with 800mm additional drop.The unit shall have the minimum specification as shown below… ceiling with a built in housing case along with control switch. The unit shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification Screen Size : 164” 16:10 format Screen Type : Motorised Surface material : Matt white Motor shall be UL Certified with 220 -240 Volts AC 50 HZ, Three wire Instantly Reversible, Life time lubricated with Pre-set. Accessible Limit Switches. MultipleStation Control rated 220 Volts AC 50 Hz with 3 Position rocker switches with cover plates to stop Screen at Any point. Automatic Override allows only one signal to reach to motor when operates simultaneously Additional Drop – 800mm Acceptable : Dalite, Draper, Stewart or Approved Equivalent 272 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-3,B-5 3100 Ansi Lumens WXGA ultra short throw Projector ( Native : 16:10)&Pole mount bracket for the projector The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 3100 Ansi Lumens WXGA ultra short throw Projector(Native: 16:10) and Pole mount bracket for above projectorshall have the minimum specification as shown below… General Specification: Brightness: Contrast(Full On/Off): Native Resolution: 3,100 Lumens 8,000:1 1280x800 Aspect Ratio: 16:10 (WXGA) Video Modes: 3D Modes: 3D Glasses Type: Shutter Digital Inputs: HDMI HDBaseT: No Max Power: Voltage: 720p, 1080i, 1080p/60 1080p/24, 1080p/50, 525i 525p, 576p, 625i 625p, 1125i, 480p 480i PC 3D Ready 340 Watts 100V - 240V B-5 - Pole mount bracket for the projector Acceptable: Panasonic ,LG ,Samsung or Approved Equivalent 273 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 4 Item Description: Assam Legislative B76" Diagonal motorised projection Screen ( 16:10 format ) with 500mm additional drop The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a 76" Diagonal projection Screen (16:10format)and the unit shall have the minimum specification as shown below… ceiling with a built in housing case along with control switch. The unit shall have the minimum specification as shown below: Detail Specification: Screen Size format Screen Type Projection Screen Surface material white : 76” 16:10 : Tensioned Electric : Matt Motor shall be UL Certified with 220 -240 Volts AC 50 HZ, Three wire Instantly Reversible, Life time lubricated with Pre-set. Accessible Limit Switches. Multiple Station Control rated 220 Volts AC 50 Hz with 3 Position rocker switches with cover plates to stop Screen at Any point. Automatic Override allows only one signal to reach to motor when operates simultaneously Operating: LVC Module operating with 3 button dry contact Momentary closure Acceptable: Dalite, Draper or Approved Equivalent 274 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-6 22" LCD Display with HDMI(2), CV input with necessary mounting bracket The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be 22" LCD Display with HDMI(2), CV input with necessary mounting bracket. The unit shall have the minimum specification as shown below… DetailSpecification: Display Screen Size 55.88cm (22) Resolution 1920 x 1080 Video Clear Motion Rate 100Hz Dynamic Contrast Ratio Mega Contrast Video Sound Output(RMS) 3.0 watts x 2 Dolb Dolby Digital Plus/Dolby Pulse y dts 2.0 + Digital Out / DTS Premium Audio DTS Premium Sound System DTV Tuner Ready Input&Output Component In (Y/Pb/Pr) 1 Composite In (AV 1 (Common Use for Component Y) HDMI 2 USB 2 Headphone 1 Power Power Supply AC 100 - 240V 50/60Hz Power Consumption (Max) Acceptable: Samsung,LG,Panasonic or approved equivalent 275 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-7 55" LED LCD Display with 1 HDMI, 1 DVI, 1 Display Port with RS232 control The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 55" LED LCD Display with 1 HDMI, 1 DVI, 1 Display Port with RS232 control and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification Screen Size 139.7cm (55) Panel Type 120Hz D-LED BLU Resolution 1920 x 1080 (16:9) Pixel Pitch (HxV) 0.21 (H) x 0.63 (V Active Display Size (HxV) 1,209.6 (H) x 680.4 (V) Contrast Ratio 5,000:1 Viewing Angle (H/V) 178:178 Response Time 8ms Display Color 10 bit Dithering - 1.07 Billion Color Gamut 0.72 H-Scanning Frequency 30 ~ 81kHz Maximum Pixel Frequency 148.5MHz V-Scanning Frequency 48 ~ 75Hz Brightness 450nit RGB In Analog D-SUB, DVI-D, Display Port 1.2 Video In HDMI1, Component (CVBS Common) Audio In Stereo Jack RGB Out DP1.2 (Loop-out) Audio Out 276 Stereo Jack Stand Type Acceptable : Foot Stand (Optional) Samsung ,LG,Panasonic or Approved Equivalent 277 Project : Assam Legislative Assembly System : Video Reference No : B-8 & B-9 Item Description: 55" LED LCD with 5.7mm Bezel The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 55” Professional LED Monitor with 2 HDMI Input, 1 VGA Input, 1 DVI-D , 1 DP , 1 RS232 with Native HD Resolution and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Screen Size : 55” Aspect Ratio : 16:9 : Brightness Max 700 cd/m² : Contrast Ratio (Dynamic) 3500 : 1 Resolution : 1920 x 1080 Pixel pitch : 0.63mm (H) x : 0.63mm (V) Response Time 8ms Connectivity Input RGB : Analog D-SUB, DVI-D, Display Port 1.2 Video : Component(CVBS Common), HDMI1, HDMI 2 Audio Output : Stereo mini Jack RGB : Display Port : 1.2(Loop-out) Audio Stereo Mini Jack Power Supply Power Consumption : : Off Mode & Sleep Mode On Mode /713 (BTU) Dimension 96.6mm AC 100 - 240 V ~ (+/- 10%), 50/60Hz : Less than 0.5 watts 290W (Max), 175W (Typical), : 1,213.5 x 684.3 x 278 Viewing Angle(Horizontal/Vertical) : 178˚/178˚ B-9 -Specialised video wall bracket for the above display Acceptable: Samsung ,LG,Panasonic or Approved Equivalent 279 Project System Reference No. Item Description : : : : Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-10 32" LCD TV with wall mounting bracket The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a 32” LCD TV with wall mounting bracket and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Screen Size Resolution Sound Output(RMS) Speaker Type Vide o Audi o : 81.28cm (32) : 1920 x 1080 : 10 watts x 2 : Down Firing + Full Range Connectivity HDMI : 3 USB : 2 Headphone : 1 Component In (Y/Pb/Pr) : 1 Composite In (AV) : 1 (Common Use for Component Y) Digital Audio Out (Optical) : 1 RF In (Terrestrial/Cable Input) : 1 DVI Audio In (Mini Jack) : 1 (Common Use for PC Audio in) Ethernet (LAN) : 1 Tuner/Broadcast ing DTV Tuner : Ready Analog Tuner : Yes Auto Channel Search : Yes Acceptable: Samsung, Panasonic, Sony or Approved Equivalent 280 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-11 HDMI Twisted Pair Transmitter & Receiver to handle true HD resolution with deep colour up to 100 Mtr ( HDMI TX RX ) The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a HDMI Twisted Pair Transmitter & Receiver to handle true HD resolution with deep colour up to 100 Mtr ( HDMI TX RX )and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Transmitter INPUTS: 1 HDMI connector. OUTPUTS: 1 HDBaseT twisted pair RJ−45 connector. PORTS: D−sub connector. 1 IR on a 3.5mm mini jack, 1 RS−232 on a 9−pin BANDWIDTH: 10.2Gbps (3.4Gbps per graphic channel). RS-232 BAUD RATE: 115200 COMPLIANCE WITH HDMI STANDARD: Supports HDMI and HDCP. POWER CONSUMPTION: 12V DC,275mA. OPERATING TEMPERATURE: 0° to 40°C (32° to 104°F). STORAGE TEMPERATURE: −40° to +70°C (−40° to 158°F). HUMIDITY: Detail Specification: Receiver 10% to 90%, RHL non−condensing. INPUTS: 1 HDMI connector. OUTPUTS: 1 HDBaseT twisted pair RJ−45 connector. PORTS: connector. 1 IR on a 3.5mm mini jack, 1 RS−232 on a 9−pin D−sub MAX. DATA RATE: 10.2Gbps (3.4Gbps per graphic channel). RS-232 BAUD RATE: 115200 281 COMPLIANCE WITH HDMI STANDARD: POWER CONSUMPTION: Supports HDMI and HDCP. 12V DC, 295mA. OPERATING TEMPERATURE: 0° to 40°C (32° to 104°F). STORAGE TEMPERATURE: −40° to +70°C (−40° to 158°F) HUMIDITY: Acceptable: 10% to 90%, RHL non−condensing. Kramer,Extron or Approved Equivalent 282 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-12 4 x 1 HDMI Switcher The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a4 x 1 HDMI Switcher and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: INPUTS OUTPUTS BANDWIDTH COMPLIANCE RESOLUTION POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROLS Acceptable: : 4 HDMI connectors : 1 HDMI connector : Supports up to 2.25Gbps per graphic channel : HDCP& HDMI : Up to UXGA; 1080p , Deep Color : 100−240V AC, 50/60Hz, 10VA : Front panel buttons, infrared control, RS−232, Ethernet Extron ,Kramer or Approved Equivalent 283 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-13 8 x 1HDMI Switcher The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a8 x 1 HDMI Switcher and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: INPUTS OUTPUTS BANDWIDTH channel COMPLIANCE WITH HDMI STANDARD HDCP RESOLUTION color POWER CONSUMPTION CONTROLS Ethernet Acceptable : : : : : : 8 HDMI connectors 1 HDMI connectors Supports up to 2.25Gbps bandwidth per graphic Supports HDMI and Up to UXGA; 1080p, deep : 12VA : Front panel buttons, infrared control , RS−232, Extron ,Kramer or Approved Equivalent 284 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-14 HDMI 1 IN 2 out Distribution Amplifier ( 1x2 HDMI DA ) The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a HDMI 1 IN 2 out Distribution Amplifier ( 1x2 HDMI DA )and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: INPUT: 1 HDMI connector. OUTPUTS: 2 HDMI connectors. MAX. DATA RATE: 6.75Gbps (2.25Gbps per graphic channel). COMPLIANCE WITH HDMI STANDARD : Supports HDMI and HDCP. CONTROLS: EDID SETUP button, input select button. INDICATOR LEDS: INPUT , OUT 1, OUT 2, and ON LEDs. POWER CONSUMPTION: 5V DC, 910mA. DIMENSIONS: Acceptable: 12cm x 7.2cm x 2.4cm (4.7" x 2.8" 1.0") W, D, H. Extron ,Kramer or Approved Equivalent 285 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 15 Item Description: Switcher Assam Legislative B16 x 16 Digital Media The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : This unit shall be a16 x 16 Digital Media Switcher and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: VIDEO 16x16 digital matrix, modular input cards and factorySwitcher configurable outputs, Crestron Quick Switch HD® Input Signal Types Configurable via modular plug-in cards supporting HDMI®, Display Port Multimode[11], DVI, HDBaseT®, SDI, RGB/VGA, component, S-Video, composite, DM® CAT, DM Fiber, DM 8G+™, DM 8G® Fiber, DM 8G SM Fiber, & H.264 streaming Output Signal Types Configurable via factory-installed output cards supporting DM CAT, DM Fiber, DM 8G+, DM 8G Fiber, DM 8G SM Fiber, HDBaseT, HDMI, DVI[12], & H.264 streaming (All input cards also include HDMI pass-thru outputs) Forma ts HDMI, HDBaseT, or DM 8G w/Deep Color, 3D, & 4K[3]; DM (1st generation) w/Deep Color & 3D; DVI; HDCP content protection support; SD-SDI, HD-SDI, & 3G-SDI; RGBHV, RGBS, RGsB, YPbPr, Y/C, NTSC, & PAL; H.264 (MPEG-4 part 10 286 AVC) Input Resolutions for each input card Output Resolutions Refer to the specifications Refer to the specifications for each output card Backplane Data Rate 12.5 Gbps 287 Detail Specification : AUDIO Switcher switching, plus independent Input Signal Types Output Signal Types Formats card 16x16 digital multichannel audio-follow-video matrix 16x16 stereo matrix for audio breakaway Configurable via modular plug-in cards supporting HDMI, Display Port Multimode[11], HDBaseT, SDI, Analog (stereo 2- channel), SPDIF, DM CAT, DM Fiber, DM 8G+, DM 8G Fiber, DM 8G SM Fiber, & H.264 streaming Configurable via factory-installed output cards supporting DM CAT, DM Fiber, DM 8G+, DM 8G Fiber, DM 8G SM Fiber, HDBaseT, HDMI, Analog (stereo 2-channel), & H.264 streaming; (All input cards also include HDMI pass-thru outputs, and most digital audio input cards also include Analog stereo pass-thru audio outputs) Refer to the specifications for each input and output Communications Ethernet USB Digital Media 10/100/1000 Mbps, auto-switching, auto-negotiating, autodiscovery, full/half duplex, DHCP USB signal routing via select input cards, transmitters, receivers, and extenders USB computer console port for setup DM 8G+, DM 8G Fiber, DM 8G SM Fiber, DM Fiber, DM CAT, DMNet®, HDCP, EDID, CEC, PoDM, Ethernet HDBaseT HDCP, EDID, PoH, Ethernet HDMI HDCP, EDID, CEC Ethernet Switch USB SWITCH Card Slots 1 – 16 [14] ; 34-port switch with Private Network Mode; provides (1) rear panel 10Base- T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T LAN port, (1) internal 100 Mbps port for the switcher, and (32) internal 100 Mbps ports for the I/O cards 16x16 matrix, follow video or breakaway 288 DM OUTPUTS (SLOT 1 – 2) (16) DM switcher input card slots; Each slot accepts (1) DMC-series input card; Input cards are fieldinstallable (2) DM switcher output card slots; Each slot accepts (1) DMCO-series output card; Output cards require factory installation 289 Detail Specification: CONNECT ORS (1) 8-wire RJ45 female; 10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T Ethernet port LAN (16) sets of (1) 4-pin and (1) 3-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal blocks; Comprises (16) DMNet ports with “EIG” power selection ports, each set associated with a corresponding DM CAT output port on the output card in either output slot; Each DMNet port provides power and communications for a DM CAT device connected via DM cable; 24ABG / EIG 1 – 8 (SLOT 1 – 2) Each EIG port connects to an external power supply[15], or to the internal power source via a jumper, to power the DM CAT device connected to the corresponding DMNet port; Maximum Load: 40 Watts (1.66 Amps @ 24 Volts DC) per port, limited to available DMNet power from internal power supply (see "Power Requirements" below) or external power supply[15] (1) IEC 60320 C14 main power inlet; Mates with removable power cord, included 100-250V~7.0A 50/60Hz G (1) 6-32 screw, chassis ground lug (1) USB Type B female; COMPUTER (front) USB computer console port (6 ft cable included) Green LCD dot matrix, 128 x 64 resolution, adjustable LED backlight; LCD Display Displays inputs/outputs by name, video & audio signal information, Ethernet configuration and setup menus Power Requirements Main Power 550 Watts @ 100-240 Volts AC, 50/60 Hz Available DMNet Power supply 110 Watts (4.6 Amps @ 24 Volts DC) from internal power Available PoDM/PoH Power output card Refer to the specifications for each DM 8G+ input and Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent. 290 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-16 Digital media (Cat) Input Card for Digital media Switchers The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be aDigital media (Cat) Input Card for Digital media Switchers shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification : Video Input Signal Types: (Digital Media over one CAT5e twisted-pair copper wire), HDBaseT [1] Output Signal Types: HDMI or DVI[5] to switcher backplane and HDMI OUT connector Formats: HDBaseT, & HDMI with Deep Color & 3D; HDCP content protection support Input Resolutions, Progressive: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, 2048x1080@24Hz, 2048x1152@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock 291 Input Resolutions, Interlaced: 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock Output Resolutions: Matched to input 292 Detail Specification: Audio Input Signal Types: Cat , HDBaseT Output Signal Types: HDMI (multi-channel) to switcher backplane and HDMI OUT connector, Analog stereo 2-channel[3], allows audio breakaway Digital Formats: Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby® TrueHD, DTS®, DTS-ES, DTS 96/24, DTS-HD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio™, up to 8ch PCM Analog Formats: Stereo 2-channel Digital-To-Analog Conversion: 24-bit 48 kHz Performance (Analog): Frequency Response: 20Hz to 20kHz ±0.5dB; S/N Ratio: >95dB, 20Hz to 20kHz A-weighted; THD+N: <0.005% @ 1kHz; Stereo Separation: >90dB Volume Gain Range (Analog): -80dB to 0dB Connectors HDMI OUT: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio output; Also supports DVI[5] DM IN: (1) 8-pin RJ45 female, shielded; Cat input, HDBaseT compliant; PoDM and PoH PSE (Power Sourcing Equipment) port[2]; Cable POE IN: (1) 8-pin RJ45 female, PoE input; AUDIO OUT: (2) RCA female; 293 Unbalanced stereo line-level audio output[3]; Output Impedance: 100 Ohms nominal; Maximum Output Level: 2 Vrms Acceptable: Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 294 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 17 Item Description: Switchers Assam Legislative BHDMI Input Card suitable for Digital media The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. Detail Specification: Input Signal Types: HDMI, DVI, Display Port Multimode Output Signal Types: HDMI or DVIto switcher backplane andHDMI OUT connector Formats: HDMI w/Deep Color & 3D, DVI, HDCP content protection support Input Resolutions, Progressive: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, 2048x1080@24Hz, 2048x1152@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock 295 Detail Specification: Input Resolutions, Interlaced: 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock Output Resolutions: Matched to inputs Audio Input Signal Types: HDMI or Display Port Multimode supporting HD lossless multi-channel up to 7.1 Output Signal Types: HDMI (multi-channel) to switcher backplane and HDMI OUT connector, Analog stereo 2-channel , allows audio breakaway Formats: Dolby Digital , Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby True HD, DTS , DTS-ES, DTS 96/24, DTSHD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio , Up to 8ch PCM Digital-To-Analog Conversion: 24-bit 48 kHz Performance (Analog): Frequency Response: 20Hz to 20kHz ±0.5dB; S/N Ratio: >95dB, 20Hz to 20kHz A- 296 weighted; THD+N: <0.005% @ 1kHz; Stereo Separation: >90dB Volume Gain Range (Analog): -80dB to 0dB, adjustable from 0% to 100% USB Protocols: Supports USB HID class devices Connectors HDMI OUT: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio output; Also supports DVI 297 General Specification : This unit shall be a HDMI Input Card suitable for Digital media Switchers shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: HDMI IN: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio input; Also supports DVI and Display Port Multimode USB HID: (1) USB Type B female, USB device port for connection to the USB host interface of a computer or other USB HID-compliant host AUDIO OUT: (2) RCA female; Unbalanced stereo line-level audio output with level control Maximum Output Level: 2 Vrms; Output Impedance: 100 Ohms nominal Acceptable : Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 298 Project : System Reference No Item Description : : : Assam Legislative Assembly B-18,B-19 2Digital media cat output w/1 HDMI & 6 HDMI w/6 Stereo Analog Audio Output Card suitable for 16 x 16 Digital media switcher The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a2Digital media cat output w/1 HDMI & 6 HDMI w/6 Stereo Analog Audio Output Card suitable for 16 x 16 Digital media switchershould have minimum specification as indicated below… Detail Specification: Output Signal Types: Video Formats: Audio Formats: Output Resolutions, Progressive: Output Resolutions, Interlaced: (Digital Media over one single-mode fibre optic strand), HDMI, SMF & HDMI with Deep Color & 3D, HDCP content protection support; Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS, DTS-ES, DTS 96/24, DTS-HD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio, Up to 8ch PCM; 40x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x 720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960 @60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050 @60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080 @24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080 @60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, 2048x1080@24Hz, 2048x1152@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock; 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock 299 Output Signal Types: Video Formats: Audio Formats: DM CAT (Digital Media over shielded twisted-pair copper wire), HDMI®, DVI[2]; DM CAT & HDMI with Deep Color & 3D, HDCP content protection support; Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS, DTS-ES, DTS 96/24, DTS-HD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio, Up to 8ch PCM; 300 Output Resolutions, Progressive: Output Resolutions, Interlaced: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, 2048x1080@24Hz, 2048x1152@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock; 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock B-19 - 2 Digital media output with 4 HDMI output card Acceptable : SM Fiber w/1 HDMI & 6 Digital media cat Crestron, Extron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 301 Project: Assembly System: System Reference No: 20 Item Description: Controller Assam Legislative Video BDigital Media Single mode fibre Receiver & Room The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Digital Media Single mode fibre Receiver & Room Controller and should have minimum specification as indicated below… Detail Specification: Vide o Scaler HD video scaler, motion-adaptive deinterlacer, interlacer, intelligent frame rate conversion, Deep Color support, 3D to 2D , content-adaptive noise conversion[3] reduction, widescreen format selection (zoom, stretch, maintain aspect-ratio, or 1:1), video wall processing (2x2, 3x2, 3x3, 4x3, or 4x4)[6] Input Signal Type SM Fiber (Digital Media over one single-mode fibre optic strand) Output Signal Types HDMI, DVI Formats support Input Resolutions, Progressive DM Fiber & HDMI w/Deep Color & 3D[3], DVI, HDCP content protection 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 302 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, Input Resolutions, Interlaced Scaler Output Resolutions, Progressive Scaler Output Resolutions, Interlaced 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz[7], 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz[7], 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz[7], 1400x1050@60Hz[7], 1440x900@60Hz[7], 1600x900@60Hz[8], 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz[7], 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz[8], 2048x1152@60Hz[8] 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30) 303 Audio Input Signal Type Output Signal Type SM Fiber HDMI Dolby Digital®, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby® TrueHD, DTS®, DTS- Formats ES, DTS 96/24, DTS-HD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio™, up to 8ch PCM Communications Ethernet duplex, DHCP 10/100 Mbps, auto-switching, auto-negotiating, auto-discovery, full/half 2-way device control and monitoring up to 115.2k baud with hardware and software handshaking 1-way device control via infrared up to 1.1 MHz or serial TTL/RS-232 (0-5 Volts) RS-232 IR/Serial up to Digital Media 19.2k baud SM Fiber, HDCP, EDID, CEC, Ethernet HDMI HDCP, EDID, CEC Acceptable: Crestron ,Extron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 304 Project: Assembly System: System Reference No: 21 Item Description: 201 Assam Legislative Video BDigital Media Transmitter The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be anDigital Media Transmitter 201should have minimum specification as indicated below… Detail Specification: Switcher: 2x1 combination digital/Analog switch, Crestron Quick Switch HD Input Signal Types: HDMI , DVI[2], Display Port Multimode[2], RGB, component (YPbPr)[3], S-Video (Y/C)[3], composite[3] Output Signal Types: (Digital Media over one CAT5e twisted-pair copper wire)[1], HDBaseT, HDMI, DVI[2] Formats: HDMI, DVI, HDCP content protection support, computer up to UXGA/WUXGA, HD up to 1080p60, NTSC or PAL Input Resolutions, HDMI & DVI, Progressive: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 305 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, 2048x1080@24Hz, 2048x1152@60Hz, plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock Input Resolutions, HDMI & DVI, Interlaced: 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock Input Resolutions, RGB: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x7202@7640Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 306 Connectors LAN: (1) 8-wire RJ45 female, shielded; 10BaseT/100BaseTX Ethernet port DM OUT: (1) 8-pin RJ45 female, shielded; DM output, HDBaseT compliant; PoDM and PoH PD (Powered Device) port[4]; Connects to the cat input of a Digital Media switcher, receiver/room controller, HDMI OUT: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio output; Also supports DVI[2] PWR 24VDC 0.75A: (1) 2.1 x 5.5 mm DC power connector; 24 Volt DC power input; Ground: (1) 6-32 screw, chassis ground lug USB HID: (1) USB Type B female; USB 2.0 device port for connection to the USB host interface of a computer or other USB HID-compliant host HDMI IN: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio input; Also supports DVI and Display Port Multimode[2] RGB IN: (1) DB15HD female; RGB (VGA), component, S-Video, or composite video input[3]; Formats: RGBHV, RGBS, RGsB, YPbPr, Y/C, NTSC, PAL; Input Levels: 0.5 to 1.5 Vp-p with built-in DC restoration; Input Impedance: 75 Ohms; Sync Input Type: AutoDetect RGBHV, RGBS, RGsB, YPbPr; Sync Input Level: 3 to 5 Vp-p; Sync Input Impedance: 1k Ohms AUDIO IN: (1) 3.5mm TRS mini phone jack; Unbalanced stereo line-level audio input; Acceptable : Crestron ,Extron, AMX or Approved Equivalent. 307 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-22 Quad-Window High-Definition Digital Video Processor - 2 DVI-I & 2 HDMI® video inputs The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be aQuad-Window High-Definition Digital Video Processor - 2 DVI-I & 2 HDMI® video inputs shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: VIDEO Scaling/Windowing Processor: VXP® video processing, eight channel image processing, resolution management, HD technology Input Signal Types[1]: HDMI®, DVI, Display Port Multimode[2], SDI, RGB, component (YPbPr), S-Video (Y/C), composite, Input Formats: HDMI w/Deep Color, DVI, HDCP content protection support, SDI, HD-SDI, computer up to UXGA/WUXGA, HD up to 1080i and 1080p60, NTSC or PAL Input Resolutions, Progressive: 640x400 to 1920x1200, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080p[6] Input Resolutions, Interlaced: 480i, 487i (SDI), 576i, 1080i Output Signal Types: DVI, HDMI, RGB Output Formats: DVI, HDMI w/Deep Color, HDCP content protection support, computer up to UXGA/WUXGA, HD progressive up to 1080p60, HD 308 interlaced @ 1080i only Output Resolutions, Progressive: 640x400 to 1920x1200, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080p[6] Output Resolution, Interlaced: 1080i via DVI or HDMI only Color Depth: 24-bit, 16.7M colours Analog Gain: 0dB (75 ohms terminated) Analog Bandwidth: 400MHz 309 Detail Specification: MEMORY DDR RAM: 256 MB Flash: 64 MB Memory Card: Accepts up to 4 GB (1 GB CompactFlash® card included) Maximum Project Size: 200 MB Communications Ethernet: 10/100 Mbps, auto-switching, autonegotiating, auto-discovery, full/half duplex, DHCP, for control and console Control Net slave port for control and console USB: Rear panel host ports for mouse/touch screen input, front panel client port for console RS-232: Bidirectional, up to 115.2k baud, hardware and software handshaking, for console and mouse/touch screen input Connectors INPUT – HDMI IN: Up to (4) 19-pin Type A HDMI female[1]; HDMI digital video/audio inputs[7]; Signal Types: HDMI, DVI, or Display Port Multimode[2]; Input Resolution, Progressive: 640x400 to 1920x1200, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080p[6]; Input Resolution, Interlaced: 480i, 576i, 1080i INPUT – HDMI OUT: Up to (4) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio outputs (pass-thru from corresponding HDMI IN)[2]; Signal Types: HDMI, DVI[2] INPUT – DVI/RGB/YPBPR: Up to (4) DVI-I female (or DB15HD female via adapter included)[1]; DVI, RGB, or component video inputs; Signal Types: DVI, HDMI, Display Port Multimode, RGB (VGA), or component[2]; INPUT – VIDEO: UP TO (8) SETS OF (3) BNC FEMALE, EACH SET COMPRISING (1) auto-detecting multi-format Analog video input[1]; Signal Types: 310 Component, S-Video, or composite; Formats: YPbPr, Y/C, NTSC or PAL; Input Resolution: 480i, 576i, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080i; Horizontal Frequency: 15 to 67.5 kHz; Vertical Frequency: 25 to 60 Hz; INPUT LEVELS: 0.5 TO 1.5 VP-P WITH BUILT-IN DC RESTORATION; Input Impedance: 75 Ohms nominal 311 Detail Specification: INPUT – SDI/HD-SDI: UP TO (4) BNC FEMALE, SDI VIDEO INPUTS[1]; Signal Types: SDI (SMPTE 125M), HD-SDI (SMPTE 274M, 295M, 296M); Formats: SDI and HD-SDI interlaced 487i, 576i, 1080i25, 1080i30; HD-SDI progressive 720p24, 720p25, 720p30, 720p50, 720p60, 1080p24, 1080p25, 1080p30 INPUT – QM: Up to (4) 8-wire RJ45 female Input Resolution, Progressive: 640x400 to 1920x1200, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080p[6]; Input resolution, interlaced: 480i, 576i, 1080i; Horizontal Frequency: 15 to 91 kHz; Vertical Frequency: 25 to 85 Hz; Delay Skew Compensation: 0 to 22 ns; Maximum Cable Length: 450 ft OUTPUT – DVI/RGBHV: (1) DVI-I female (or DB15HD female via adapter included); DVI or RGB video output[10]; Signal Types: DVI, HDMI, or RGB (VGA)[2]; Digital Formats: DVI, HDMI w/Deep Color, HDCP content protection support, EDID; Analog Formats: RGBHV; Output Resolution, Progressive: 640x400 to 1920x1200, 480p, 576p, 720p, 1080p[6]; Output Resolution, Interlaced: 1080i (digital only); Horizontal Frequency: 30 to 91 kHz; Vertical Frequency: 50 to 85 Hz; Analog Sync Output Type: RGBHV; Analog Sync Output Level: TTL, 5Vp-p FORMAT: RGBHV; Output Resolution: Same as RGBHV OUTPUT; RS-232: (1) DB9 female, bidirectional RS-232 port; Computer console and 312 mouse/touch screen input; Up to 115.2k baud; hardware and software handshaking support LAN: (1) 8-wire RJ45 female; 10Base-T/100Base-TX Ethernet port for console and control USB A – B: (2) USB Type A female host ports for mouse or touch Acceptable : Crestron, AMX or Approved Equivalent. 313 Project : System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video System B-23 Digital Media Cat5 Receiver & Room Controller w/Scaler The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be anDigital MediaCat5 Receiver& Room Controller w/Scaler and should have minimum specification as indicated below… Detail Specification: Video Scaler: HD video scaler, motion-adaptive deinterlacer, interlacer, intelligent HD video scaler, motion-adaptive deinterlacer, interlacer, intelligent frame rate conversion, Deep Color support, 3D to 2D conversion [2] , content- adaptive noise reduction, widescreen format selection (zoom, stretch, maintain aspect-ratio, or 1:1), video wall processing (2x2, 3x2, 3x3, 4x3) Input Signal Types: Digital Mediaover one CAT5e twisted-pair copper wire), HDBaseT Output Signal Types: HDMI, DVI [3] Formats: HDMI w/Deep Color & 3D [2] , DVI, HDCP content protection support Input Resolutions, Progressive: 640x480@60Hz, 720x480@60Hz (480p), 720x576@50Hz (576p), 800x600@60Hz, 848x480@60Hz, 852x480@60Hz, 854x480@60Hz, 1024x768@60Hz, 1024x852@60Hz, 1024x1024@60Hz, 1280x720@50Hz (720p50), 1280x720@60Hz (720p60), 1280x768@60Hz, 1280x800@60Hz, 1280x960@60Hz, 314 1280x1024@60Hz, 1360x768@60Hz, 1365x1024@60Hz, 1366x768@60Hz, 1400x1050@60Hz, 1440x900@60Hz, 1600x900@60Hz, 1600x1200@60Hz, 1680x1050@60Hz, 1920x1080@24Hz (1080p24), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080p25), 1920x1080@50Hz (1080p50), 1920x1080@60Hz (1080p60), 1920x1200@60Hz, plus any other 315 Input Resolutions, Interlaced: 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30), plus any other resolution allowed by HDMI up to 165MHz pixel clock Scaler Output Resolutions, Progressive: 640x480@60Hz, Scaler Output Resolutions, Interlaced: 720x480@30Hz (480i), 720x576@25Hz (576i), 1920x1080@25Hz (1080i25), 1920x1080@30Hz (1080i30) Audio Input Signal Types: CAT , HDBaseT Output Signal Type: HDMI Formats: Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby® TrueHD, DTS®, DTS-ES, DTS 96/24, DTS-HD High Res, DTS-HD Master Audio™, Up to 8ch PCM Communications Digital Media: CAT, HDCP management, EDID format management, CEC, HDBaseT compliant Ethernet: 10/100 Mbps, auto-switching, autonegotiating, auto-discovery, full/half duplex, DHCP Connectors – Bottom HDMI OUT: (1) 19-pin Type A HDMI female; HDMI digital video/audio output; Also supports DVI[3] USB HID: (1) USB Type A female; 316 USB 2.0 host port for connection of a mouse/keyboard or other USB HID- compliant device COM: (1) 5-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal block; Bidirectional RS-232 port; Up to 115.2k baud, hardware and software handshaking support IR 1 – 2: (1) 4-pin 3.5mm detachable terminal block comprising (2) IR/ Serial ports; IR output up to 1.1 MHz; 1-way serial TTL/RS-232 (0-5 Volts) up to 19200 baud Acceptable: Crestron ,Extron, AMX or Approved Equivalent 317 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-24 4−Channel 3G HD−SDI over Single multi Fiber Optic Transmitter & Receiver to carry signal up to 1000 mtr The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 4−Channel 3G HD−SDI over Single mulƟ Fiber OpƟc TransmiƩ er & Receiver to carry signal up to 1000 mtr and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: 4 SD/HD/3G HD−SDI and dual−link, 75Ω on BNC INPUTS: connectors (673T); 1 multi−mode OM3 fibre on SC connectors (673R). OUTPUTS: (673T); 4 SD/HD/3G HD−SDI 1 multi−mode OM3 fibre on SC connectors and dual−link, 75Ω on BNC connectors (673R). BANDWIDTH: FIBER OPTIC EXTENSION: Acceptable: Up to 3Gbps for each SDI input. Up to 1000m (>3200ft) for 3G HD−SDI. Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent INPUT CABLE EQUALIZATION : 140m for HD−SDI, 120m for 3G HD−SDI. FIBER-OPTIC CONNECTION: SC connectors for multimode (OM3) fibre cable. INDICATOR LEDS: VIDEO, SOURCE, FIBER and ON LEDs. POWER CONSUMPTION: 5V DC, 520mA (673T); 5V DC, 780mA (673R). INSERTION LOSS FROM TRANSMITTER TO RECEIVER: Must not exceed 10dB. 318 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-25 HDMI to 3G HD−SDI Format Converter with Dual output The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a HDMI to 3G HD−SDI Format Converter with Dual outputand shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: NPUT: 1 HDMI connector. OUTPUTS: 2 SD/HD/3G HD−SDI on BNC connectors. MAX. DATA RATE: Up to 3Gbps. STANDARD COMPLIANCE: HDMI. 525i, 625i; 1080p INPUT FORMATS: @23.98/24/25/29.97/30/50/59.94/60; 1080i @50/59.94/60; 720p @50/59.94/60. INDICATOR LEDS: SD/HD, OUT, ON. POWER CONSUMPTION: 5V DC, 470mA. Acceptable: Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 319 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-26 1:10 3G HD-SDI Distribution Amplifier The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 1:10 3G HD-SDI Distribution Amplifier and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: INPUTS: 1 SMPTE−259M/292M/424M serial video, 75Ω on a BNC connector. OUTPUTS: connectors; 10 equalized and re clocked SMPTE−259M/292M/424M outputs, 75Ω on BNC 1 looped GENLOCK 75Ω/Hi−Z on a BNC connector. MAX. OUTPUT LEVEL: 800mVpp/75Ω. MAXIMUM DATA RATE: Up to 2.97Gbps. COUPLING: AC. POWER CONSUMPTION: 100/240V AC, 50/60Hz, 5VA. DIMENSIONS: 19" x 7" x 1U W, D, H, rack mountable. WEIGHT: (3.3lbs) approx. INCLUDED ACCESSORIES: Acceptable: 1.5kg Power cord, rack "ears" Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 320 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-27 HD Document Camera with touch sensitive control The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a HD Document Camera with touch sensitive control and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: Camera Image 2.0M CMOS Resolution WXGA, 720p, 1080p Optical 12X Digital 10X Motorized Camera Yes Sensor XGA, SXGA, Zoom Zoom Head Input/output C Video IN (RCA) (1) S Video IN (4-pin DIN) (1) Audio IN Input connectors (2) MIC IN (phone jack) (1) PC Audio (2) RGB DB15FLC (2) Output connectors 321 HDMI (1) RGB DB15FLC (2) C Video OUT (RCA) (1) S Video OUT (4-pin DIN) (1) Audio OUT (Mini Jack) (1) 322 Imaging Features Image Storage 16 Negative Yes Black/white and color selection Yes Freeze Yes Split Yes Title Yes Mirror Yes Image Rotate 0°90°180°270° Vertically Camera 330° On Board Rotation LCD Monitor 3.5" PC Connectivity Driver Plug-n-Play Frame Rate Up to 20 fps Computer Connectivity USB PC, MAC OS Support Lighting Lights Arm light: 4W LED lamps Light Box Yes Control RS232 Control Yes Remote Control Yes Form Factor Full Size Shooting Area Acceptable: 440 x 330mm Aver, Qomo or Approved Equivalent 323 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-28 Video Production Switcher with Production software with 6 HD-SDI & 2 HDMI Input & 2 HDMI Output The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a Video Production Switcher with Production software with 6 HD-SDI & 2 HDMI Input & 2 HDMI Output and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: Supports 8 or 12 HD or SD Inputs in a variety of configurations: HD Mode 1) 6 HD-SDI 2) 2 HDMI 2 HDMI outputs for multi view monitoring Audio I/O Input: 4 analogue balanced XLR Output: 2 analogue balanced XLR. Supports embedded audio SDI output from 4-CH XLR Audio input Two DSK, supports Key and Fill enr,s Kramer or Approved Equivalent AcCcute, pMtiaxbalned: Wipe withEbxotrde Clock on screen Countdown counter on multiscreen Two PIP displays with user-defined borders Tally, GPI interface and RJ45 for firmware upgrade 324 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-29,B-30,B-31, & B-32 HDMI Cable 0.9 ,1.8,3.6 &7.6 Meters The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a HDMI Cable 0.9, 1.8, 3.6, 7.6 Meters and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: B29: HDMI Cable 0.9 Meters B30: HDMI Cable 1.8 Meters B31: HDMI Cable 3.6 Meters B32: HDMI Cable 7.6 Meters TYPE CONDUCTOR AWG High Speed and Standard Speed HDMI cables 480i, 480p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p. 28 AWG (7/0.127) SHIELD Dual shield against EMI/RFI interference (a) Al− Mylar (b) Tinned Copper CABLE OD (MM) 7.3 Approved Equivalent cceptable: Extron, Kramer or Yes MOLDED CONNECTORS GOLD PLATED CONNECTORS: HDCP COMPLIANT: Yes Yes 325 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-33,B-34, & B-35 HDMI Cable 10.6 ,15,& 22.8Meters The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a Standard Speed HDMI Moulded Cables - 10.6,15, &22.8 mtr and shall have the min. spec as shown below. Detail Specification: TYPE: High−speed HDMI cables. RESOLUTIONS SUPPORTED: 480i, 480p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p. CONDUCTOR AWG: 3 SHIELD: tinned copper. Dual overall shield against EMI/RFI interference, (a) Al−Mylar, (b) MOLDED CONNECTORS: Yes. GOLDPLATED CONNECT ORS: bles use 26 AWG (7/0.16); 35 & 50ft use 24 AWG (7/0.2). Yes. HDCP COMPLIANT: Yes. FLAME TEST: CL2. Acceptable: Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 326 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 36 Item Description: cable Assam Legislative B3m HDMI to DVI The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 3m HDMI to DVI cable and shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: Data rates : Supports 4.95 Gbps Vertical frequency : Supports up to 60 Hz Attenuation per 10 m Voltage : At 0.825MHz <10 dB Pair impedance Connector Acceptable: : 30 V : 100ohms +/- 10 ohms : 1 male DVI-D single link to 1 male HDMI single link Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 327 Project: System: Reference No: Item Description: Assam Legislative Assembly Video B-37 0.3m Display Port to HDMI adapter The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a 0.3m Display Port to HDMI adapterand shall have the min. spec as shown below Detail Specification: 0.3M DISPLAY PORT TO HDMI ADAPTER Acceptable: Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 328 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-38 Component & Computer Graphics Video to HDMI ProScaleDigital Scalar The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Component & Computer Graphics Video to HDMI Pro Scale Digital Scalar and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: : INPUTS OUTPUTS OUTPUT RESOLUTION OUTPUT REFRESH RATE resolutions CONTROLS menu driven ADDITIONAL CONTROLS and blue; Acceptable : 1 UXGA on a 15−pin HD (F) connector; 1 component video on 3 RCA connectors; 1 unbalanced stereo audio on a 3.5mm mini jack connector (for the UXGA input); 1 unbalanced stereo audio (left and right) on RCA connectors : 1 HDMI connector : 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p, VGA, SVGA, XGA, WXGA, SXGA, WSXGA, UXGA, WUXGA, NATIVE : 60Hz for computer graphics resolutions, 50/60Hz for HDTV : : Front panel buttons, contact closure and infrared remote for OSD control Contrast, brightness, hue, saturation and sharpness; red, green resolution, image size Extron ,Kramer or Approved Equivalent 329 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 39 Item Description: Control Assam Legislative BProfessional DVD Player with RS-232 The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Professional DVD Player with RS-232 Control and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: GENERAL Power requirements: AC 230V, 50Hz Power consumption: 11W (at operation) 0.2W (in standby mode) Dimensions (W x H x D): 19" x 2" x 10.6" (482 x 51 x 269 mm) Weight: 5.1 lbs (2.3 kg) Audio section Analog output: Audio out: -8 dB/1 kØ Digital output*: Digital out (optical): -21 dBm to -15 dBm (660 nm ± 30 nm) * Corresponding to Linear PCM, Dolby Digital, and DTS Digital Surround (with sampling frequency - 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz) Detail Specification: 330 VIDEO SECTION Video system: NTSC Horizontal Resolution: 500 lines Signal-to-Noise Ratio: 64 dB Video output level Composite: 1.0 V(p-p)/75Ø S-video-Y: 1.0 V(p-p)/75Ø S-video-C: 0.286 V(p-p)/75Ø 331 Component-Y: 1.0 V(p-p)/75Ø Component-Pb/Pr: 0.7 V(p-p)/75Ø HDMI HDMI Output (Ver. 1.1): HDMI RS-232C Serial command: 9-Pin D-SUB Acceptable : Extron ,Kramer or Approved Equivalent 332 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 40 Item Description: Player Assam Legislative BBlu-Ray The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification : This unit shall be a Blu-Ray Player and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: Picture Quality 24p True Cinema : Yes Full HD 1080p : Yes Precision Cinema HD Upscale : Yes x.v.Colour : Yes Deep Color : Yes PhotoTV HD : Yes Preset Picture Mode : Yes IP Content Noise Reduction : Yes Video Digital-to-Analog Converter : Component (HD: 12-Bit/148.5MHz, SD: 12Bit/108MHz), Y/C (12bit/54M Hz) Audio Audio D/A Converter : 192kHz/24bit DTS-HD Master Audio Decoding : Yes Dolby True HD decoding : Yes DTS-HD Master Audio Bit: Yes Stream Out Dolby TrueHD bit-stream output : Yes 333 LPCM (2ch / 6ch / 8ch) thru HDMI : Yes / Yes / Yes DSD output : Yes DTS bit-stream out : Yes Dolby Digital bit-stream out : Yes Terminals : HDMI Output x 1 Component Video Output x 1 Composite Video Output x 1 Digital Audio Output: Coaxial x 1 Analog Audio Output 2ch Ethernet Port: Yes USB Port x 2 (Front, Rear) Acceptable : Equivalent Sony, Denon, Samsung, or Approved 334 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-41 HDMI Audio De-Embedder The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a HDMI Audio De-Embedder and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: INPUT OUTPUTS : 1 HDMI connector : 1 HDMI connector, 1 optical digital audio connector, 1 S/PDIF digital audio on an RCA connector, 1 unbalanced stereo audio on a 3.5mm mini connector : Supports up to 6.75 Gbps (2.25Gbps per graphic channel), MAX. DATA RATE 1080p COMPLIANCE WITH STANDARDS CONTROLS INDICATOR LEDS Acceptable: @60Hz, 36−bit Deep Color Supports HDMI, HDCP 1.4 : : : Audio source select button ON, IN, OUT Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent 335 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 43 Item Description: Pair Assam Legislative BRS-232 Range extender up to 100 mtr - The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: The unit shall be a RS-232 Range extender up to 100 mtr– Pairand shall have the min. spec as shown below : Detail Specification: PORT S: BAUD RATES: 1 RS−232 on a 9−pin D−sub connector, 1 twisted pair on an RJ−45 connector. INDICATOR LED: Up to 115200. Green for PC, red for device. OPERATING TEMPERATURE: 0° to +40°C (32° to 104°F). STORAGE TEMPERATURE: −40° to +70°C (−40° to 158°F). HUMIDITY: 10% to 90%, RHL non−condensing. Acceptable : Extron, Kramer or Approved Equivalent. 336 Project: Assembly System: Video Reference No: 44 Item Description: capacity Assam Legislative BRecording Streaming , Webcasting up to 1TB storage The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the Supplier must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Recording Streaming; Webcasting up to 1TB storage capacity shall have the minimum specification as shown below… General Specification : Connecters CVBS Input Standard Captured VGA Signal format Output Format for Captured CVBS Signals Video Processing Functions Audio A/D Performance CVBS A/D Performance Standard Accessories : 1 DVI-I (HDMI, VGA, YPbPr), 2 BNC (Composite Video) & 1 3.5 mm Phone Jack (Audio Line In) audio signal : PAL/NTSC, from 40 x 30 up to 2048 x 1536 pixels , FPS:1-100 Frames/sec, YUY2/I420/RGB24/RGB32, CD disc x 1, Easy Installation Guide CD x 1 : From 176 x 144 to 720 x 576 pixels, Number of FPS: up to 30 Frames/sec, UYVY/YUY2/I420/RGB24/RGB32 : RGB/YUV Conversion, 5-tap image Scale, Motion-adaptive deinterlacer with edge directed field interpolation, Gamma Correction : Audio Channel Number: 2 Channels, Sampling Frequency: 8/16/22.05/32/44.1/48/96Kh z, Sampling Precision: 24 bit, : 10 bit sampling precision, 4 times oversampling,5-line adaptive comb filter : 1 DVI-I to HDMI + YPbPr Breakout Cable 1 DVI-I to VGA Adapter Acceptable : Wow-Vision or Approved Equivalent. 337 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: IPTV & Digital Signage Management System B-45& B-46 Digital Media Encoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port & HDMI output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& IR Remote Control The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification The unit shall be a professional Digital Media Encoder & IPTV Receiver with LAN Port & HDMI output, Display Controller, 8GB Memory& IR Remote control and with specification as shown below : Detail Specification: B-45: Communications and Control Network • Ethernet 10/100 Base T. RJ-45 modular jack with integrated LEDs Mode of Operation • Standalone or in conjunction with the Administration Software. IP Setup and Control information. • Configuration via On-Board Browser/ Remote status monitoring • IP/RS232 control protocol to operate with 3rd party Touch Panel Controllers. Video Input Live Network Streams • Multicast/Unicast UDP based AV streams. • H.264 and MPEG-2 video/audio contained in an MPEG2 TS. (480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p60 formats). • Locally Stored Files (on-board memory of 4GB to 128 GB by option) 338 Detail Specification: Digital Terrestrial and Satellite TV • DVB-T2 and DVB-S2 compliant Audio Audio Decoding • MPEG-1/2 Audio Layers I, II • MPEG-2/4 AAC LC IR Control • Channel, volume and setup control via Remote Control Unit. • Control through on-board IR receiver or using an IR extender RS232 • Serial port, up to 115200 baud for Screen on/standby/input control. Software Updates • Latest software can be loaded either through an IP connection to an HTTP server or by inserting a USB key Video Output HDMI Digital • SD 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p • HD 720p (60fps), 1080i (50/60) Phono Analogue (YPbPr) • HD 720p(60fps), 1080i (50/60) • SD CVBS - NTSC, PAL Audio Out - Connectors • HDMI - Digital Stereo Audio • 3.5mm Jack - Analogue Stereo Audio B-46: IR Remote Control for the above decoder Acceptable : Media Star, AMX or Approved Equivalents 339 Project: Assam Legislative Assembly System: Reference No: Item Description: Video B-47 Wired IR Sensor for TV Decoder The following is the minimum specification for this item. The Client is open to considering any product that meets or exceeds this specification unless the specification states a specific item is to be provided with no deviation. In their submission the vendor must complete the Compliance Schedule and indicate that they meet or exceed each requirement, and where they do not comply they must indicate what their product offers as an alternative and the level of deviation must be indicated. General Specification: This unit shall be a Wired IR Sensor for TV Decoder and shall have the minimum specification as shown below… Detail Specification: IR Sensor Module fitted with 3.5mm Jack for connection to Mediastar Pro Micro Set top Unit to allow the small IR sensor to be located in a convenient location and the larger receiver unit housed discreetly behind a screen. Acceptable : AMX, Media star or Approved Equivalent. 340 Detailed Technical Specification for Building Management System PART 1 1.1 GENERAL SUMMARY A. Furnish all labor, materials, equipment, and service necessary for a complete and operating Building Management System (BMS), utilizing Direct Digital Controls as shown on the drawings, as in attached Input/Output Summary and as described herein. Drawings are diagrammatic only. B. All labor, material, equipment and software not specifically referred to herein or on the plans, that is required to meet the functional intent of this specification, shall be provided without additional cost to the Client. C. Client shall be the named license holder of all software associated with any and all incremental work on the project(s). 1.2 SYSTEM DESCRIPTION A. The entire Building Management System (BMS) shall be comprised of a network of interoperable, stand- alone digital controllers communicating via LonMark/LonTalk communication protocols to a Network Area Controller (NAC) / Router. Building Management System products shall be manufactured as per LonWorks products must be approved in writing by the consulting Engineer and be submitted for approval ten (10) days prior to the date of the bid submittal. B. The entire Integrated Control and Monitor Management System (IBMS) shall be comprise of a network of interoperable, stand-alone digital controllers communicating on an open protocol communication network to a host computer within the facility (when specified) and communicating via the Internet to a host computer in a remote location. The IBMS shall communicate to third party systems such as Chillers, Boilers, Air-Handling Systems, Energy metering systems, Lighting Management System & other energy management systems, Fire-Life safety systems and other building management related devices with open, interoperable communication capabilities. C. The IBMS framework shall utilize JAVA based automation products and services with built-in Internet connectivity to a broad range of distribution partners in the building automation, energy services, power/utility, and industrial sectors. The Framework shall bring together the computerization of control applications under the umbrella of single integrated system architecture. The suite of component software applications shall support true plug-and-play, multi-vendor interoperability, resulting in lower automation and information infrastructure costs. The Network Area Controllers (NAC’s) shall run a JAVA Virtual Machine (JVM) platform and use a common set of tools for accessing and integrating multiple protocols. D. The Building Management System (BMS) shall be comprised of Network Area Controller or Controllers (NAC) / Routers. The NAC / Router shall connect to the local or wide area network, depending on configuration. Access to the system, either locally in each building, or remotely from a central site or sites, shall be accomplished through standard Web browsers, via the Internet and/or local area network. Each NAC shall communicate to LonMark/LonTalk and/or BACnet Direct Digital Controllers (DDC) and other open protocol systems/devices. E. The following software packages shall be loaded into the system as minimum standard :- 341 a. Complete system operational software b. Site specific data manipulation software c. Active graphics software d. Energy management system software e. Alarm indication software g. Data Visualization Package h. Internet Enabled Remote Monitoring Package. 1.3 SUBMITTAL A. Eight copies of shop drawings of the components and devices for the entire control system shall be submitted and shall consist of a complete list of equipment and materials, including manufacturers catalog data sheets and installation instructions for all controllers, valves, dampers, sensors, routers, etc. Shop drawings shall also contain complete wiring and schematic diagrams, software descriptions, calculations, and any other details required to demonstrate that the system has been coordinated and will properly function as a system. Terminal identification for all control wiring shall be shown on the shop drawings. A complete written Sequence of Operation shall also be included with the submittal package. BMS contractors supplying products and systems, as part of their packages shall provide catalog data sheets, wiring diagrams and point lists to other contractors for proper coordination of work. B. Submittal shall also include a trunk cable schematic diagram depicting operator workstations, control panel locations and a description of the communication type, media and protocol. BMS contractors shall provide these diagrams for their portions of work; the Systems Integrator shall be responsible for integrating those diagrams into the overall trunk cable schematic diagrams for the entire Wide Area Network (WAN). C. Submittal shall also include a complete point list of all points to be connected to the BMS. D. Upon completion of the work, provide a complete set of ‘as-built’ drawings and application software on compact disk. Drawings shall be provided as AutoCAD™ compatible files. Eight copies of the ‘as- built’ drawings shall be provided in addition to the documents on compact disk. BMS contractors shall provide as-built for their portions of work. The BMS contractor shall be responsible for as-built pertaining to overall BMS architecture and network diagrams. All asbuilt drawings shall also be installed into the BMS server in a dedicated directory. 1.4 SPECIFICATION NOMENCLATURE A. Acronyms used in this specification are as follows: FMCS Facility Management and Control System BMS Building Management System NAC Network Area Controller DDC Direct Digital Controller IBC Interoperable BACnet Controller GUI Graphical User Interface WBI Web Browser Interface PMI Power Measurement Interface LAN Local Area Network WAN Wide Area Network OOT Object Oriented Technology 342 PICS 1.5 Product Interoperability Compliance Statement DIVISION OF WORK A. The BMS contractor shall be responsible for all controllers (DDC), control devices, control panels, controller programming, controller programming software, controller input/output and power wiring and controller network wiring. B. The BMS contractor shall also be responsible for the Network Area Controller(s) (NAC), software and programming of the NAC, graphical user interface software (GUI), development of all graphical screens, Web browser pages, setup of schedules, logs and alarms, LonWorks network management and connection of the NAC to the local or wide area network. 1.6 AGENCY AND CODE APPROVALS A. All products of the BMS shall be provided with the following agency approvals. Verification that the approvals exist for all submitted products shall be provided with the submittal package. Systems or products not currently offering the following approvals are not acceptable. 1.7 1. UL-916; Energy Management Systems 2. C-UL listed to Canadian Standards Association C22.2 No. 205-M1983 “signal Equipment” 3. CE 4. FCC, Part 15, Subpart J, Class A Computing Devices SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT A. The CLIENT shall agree to the manufacturer's standard software and firmware licensing agreement as a condition of this contract. Such license shall grant use of all programs and application software to Owner as defined by the manufacturer's license agreement, but shall protect manufacturer's rights to disclosure of trade secrets contained within such software. B. 1.8 The CLIENT shall be the named license holder of all software associated with any and all incremental work on the project(s). In addition, CLIENT shall receive ownership of all job specific configuration documentation, data files, and application-level software developed for the project. This shall include all custom, job specific software code and documentation for all configuration and programming that is generated for a given project and/or configured for use with the NAC, BMS Server(s), and any related LAN / WAN / Intranet and Internet connected routers and devices. Any and all required IDs and passwords for access to any component or software program shall be provided to the owner. The owner shall determine which organizations to be named in the SI organization ID (“orgid”) of all software licenses. Owner shall be free to direct the modification of the “orgid” in any software license, regardless of supplier. DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Provide factory-shipping cartons for each piece of equipment and control device. Maintain cartons through shipping, storage, and handling as required to prevent equipment damage. Store equipment and materials inside and protected from weather. 1.9 JOB CONDITIONS A. Cooperation with Other Contractors: Coordinate the Work of this section with that of other sections to ensure that the Work will be carried out in an orderly fashion. It shall be this Contractor's responsibility to check the Contract Documents for possible conflicts between his Work and that of other crafts in 343 equipment location, pipe, duct and conduit runs, electrical outlets and fixtures, air diffusers, and structural and architectural features. PART 2 2.1 MATERIALS GENERAL A. The Building Management System (BMS) shall be comprised of a network of interoperable, standalone digital controllers, a computer system, graphical user interface software, printers, network devices, valves, dampers, sensors, and other devices as specified herein. All systems and software within BMS shall be Year 2000 compliant and shall be supported by compliance documentation from the manufacturer. B. 2.2 The installed system shall provide secure password access to all features, functions and data contained in the overall BMS. OPEN, INTEROPERABLE, INTEGRATED ARCHITECTURES A. The intent of this specification is to provide a peer-to-peer networked, stand-alone, distributed control system with the capability to integrate ANSI/ASHRAE Standard 135-2001 BACnet, LonWorks technology, MODBUS, OPC, and other open and proprietary communication protocols in one open, interoperable system. B. The supplied computer software shall employ object-oriented technology (OOT) for representation of all data and control devices within the system. In addition, adherence to industry standards including ANSI / ASHRAE™ Standard 135-2001, BACnet and LonMark to assure interoperability between all system components is required. For each LonWorks device that does not have LonMark certification, the device supplier must provide an XIF file and a resource file for the device. For each BACnet device, the device supplier must provide a PICS document showing the installed device’s compliance level. Minimum compliance is Level 3; with the ability to support data read and write functionality. Physical connection of BACnet devices shall be via Ethernet (BACnet Ethernet/IP,) and/or RS-485 (BACnet MSTP) as specified. C. All components and controllers supplied under this Division shall be true “peer-to-peer” communicating devices. Components or controllers requiring “polling” by a host to pass data shall not be acceptable. D. The supplied system must incorporate the ability to access all data using standard Web browsers without requiring proprietary operator interface and configuration programs. An Open DataBase Connectivity (ODBC) or Structured Query Language (SQL) compliant server database is required for all system database parameter storage. This data shall reside on a supplier-installed server for all database access. Systems requiring proprietary database and user interface programs shall not be acceptable. E. A hierarchical topology is required to assure reasonable system response times and to manage the flow and sharing of data without unduly burdening the customer’s internal Intranet network. Systems employing a “flat” single tiered architecture shall not be acceptable. 1. Maximum acceptable response time from any alarm occurrence (at the point of origin) to the point of annunciation shall not exceed 5 seconds for network connected user interfaces. 344 2. 2.3 Maximum acceptable response time from any alarm occurrence (at the point of origin) to the point of annunciation shall not exceed 60 seconds for remote or dial-up connected user interfaces. NETWORKS A. The Local Area Network (LAN) shall be a 100 Megabits/sec Ethernet network supporting BACnet, Java, XML, HTTP, and SOAP for maximum flexibility for integration of building data with enterprise information systems and providing support for multiple Network Area Controllers (NACs), user workstations and, if specified, a local server. B. Local area network minimum physical and media access requirements: 2.4 1. Ethernet; IEEE standard 802.3 2. Cable; 100 Base-T, UTP-8 wire, category 5 3. Minimum throughput; 100 Mbps. NETWORK ACCESS A. Remote Access. 1. 2.5 For Local Area Network installations, provide access to the LAN from a remote location, via the Internet. The CLIENT shall provide a connection to the Internet to enable this access via high speed cable modem, asynchronous digital subscriber line (ADSL) modem, ISDN line, T1 Line or via the customer’s Intranet to a corporate server providing access to an Internet Service Provider (ISP). Customer agrees to pay monthly access charges for connection and ISP. NETWORK AREA CONTROLLER (NAC) / ROUTER A. The BMS contractor shall supply one or more Network Area Controllers (NAC) / Router as part of this contract. Number of area controllers required is dependent on the type and quantity of devices provided in IO Summary. B. The Network Area Controller (NAC) / Router shall provide the interface between the LAN or WAN and the field control devices, and provide global supervisory control functions over the control devices connected to the NAC / Router. It shall be capable of executing application control programs to provide: 1. Calendar functions 2. Scheduling 3. Trending 4. Alarm monitoring and routing 5. Time synchronization 6. Integration of LonWorks controller data and BACnet controller data 7. Network Management functions for all LonWorks based devices C. The Network Area Controller must provide the following hardware features as a minimum: 1. One Ethernet Port – 10/100 Mbps 345 2. One RS-232 port 3. One LonWorks Interface Port – 78KB FTT-10A 4. One RS-485 ports 346 5. Battery Backup 6. Flash memory for long term data backup (If battery backup or flash memory is not supplied, the controller must contain a hard disk with at least 1 gigabyte storage capacity) 7. The NAC / Router must be capable of operation over a temperature range of 32 to 122°F 8. The NAC / Router must be capable of withstanding storage temperatures of between 0 and 158°F 9. The NAC / Router must be capable of operation over a humidity range of 5 to 95% RH, noncondensing D. The NAC / Router shall provide multiple user access to the system and support for ODBC or SQL. A database resident on the NAC / Router shall be an ODBC-compliant database or must provide an ODBC data access mechanism to read and write data stored within it. E. The NAC / Router shall support standard Web browser access via the Intranet/Internet. It shall support a minimum of 32 simultaneous users. F. Event Alarm Notification and actions 1. The NAC / Router shall provide alarm recognition, storage; routing, management, and analysis to supplement distributed capabilities of equipment or application specific controllers. 2. The NAC / Router shall be able to route any alarm condition to any defined user location whether connected to a local network or remote via dial-up telephone connection, or wide-area network. 3. Alarm generation shall be selectable for annunciation type and acknowledgement requirements including but limited to: a. To alarm b. Return to normal c. To fault 4. Provide for the creation of a minimum of eight of alarm classes for the purpose of routing types and or classes of alarms, i.e.: Electricals, HVAC, Fire, etc. 5. Provide timed (schedule) routing of alarms by class, object, group, or node. 6. Provide alarm generation from binary object “runtime” and /or event counts for equipment maintenance. The user shall be able to reset runtime or event count values with appropriate password control. G. Control equipment and network failures shall be treated as alarms and annunciated. H. Alarms shall be annunciated in any of the following manners as defined by the user: 1. Screen message text 2. Email of the complete alarm message to multiple recipients. Provide the ability to route and email alarms based on: a. Day of week b. Time of day c. Recipient 3. Pagers via paging services that initiate a page on receipt of email message 4. 5. Graphic with flashing alarm object(s) Printed message, routed directly to a dedicated alarm printer 347 I. The following shall be recorded by the NAC / Router for each alarm (at a minimum): 1. Time and date 2. Location (building, floor, zone, office number, etc.) 3. Equipment (air handler #, accessway, etc.) 4. Acknowledge time, date, and user who issued acknowledgement. 5. Number of occurrences since last acknowledgement. J. Alarm actions may be initiated by user defined programmable objects created for that purpose. K. Defined users shall be given proper access to acknowledge any alarm, or specific types or classes of alarms defined by the user. L. A log of all alarms shall be maintained by the NAC / Router and/or a server (if configured in the system) and shall be available for review by the user. M. Provide a “query” feature to allow review of specific alarms by user defined parameters. N. A separate log for system alerts (controller failures, network failures, etc.) shall be provided and available for review by the user. O. An Error Log to record invalid property changes or commands shall be provided and available for review by the user. 2.6 Data Collection and Storage A. The NAC / Router shall have the ability to collect data for any property of any object and store this data for future use. B. The data collection shall be performed by log objects, resident in the NAC / Router that shall have, at a minimum, the following configurable properties: 1. Designating the log as interval or deviation. 2. For interval logs, the object shall be configured for time of day, day of week and the sample collection interval. 3. For deviation logs, the object shall be configured for the deviation of a variable to a fixed value. This value, when reached, will initiate logging of the object. 4. For all logs, provide the ability to set the maximum number of data stores for the log and to set whether the log will stop collecting when full, or rollover the data on a first-in, first-out basis. 5. Each log shall have the ability to have its data cleared on a time-based event or by a userdefined event or action. C. All log data shall be stored in a relational database in the NAC / Router and the data shall be accessed from a server (if the system is so configured) or a standard Web browser. D. All log data, when accessed from a server, shall be capable of being manipulated using standard SQL statements. 348 E. All log data shall be available to the user in the following data formats: 1. HTML 2. XML 3. Plain Text 4. Comma or tab separated values F. Systems that do not provide log data in HTML and XML formats at a minimum shall not be acceptable. G. The NAC / Router shall have the ability to archive its log data either locally (to itself), or remotely to a server or other NAC / Router on the network. Provide the ability to configure the following archiving properties, at a minimum: 2.7 1. Archive on time of day 2. Archive on user-defined number of data stores in the log (buffer size) 3. Archive when log has reached it’s user-defined capacity of data stores 4. Provide ability to clear logs once archived AUDIT LOG A. Provide and maintain an Audit Log that tracks all activities performed on the NAC / Router. Provide the ability to specify a buffer size for the log and the ability to archive log based on time or when the log has reached its user-defined buffer size. Provide the ability to archive the log locally (to the NAC / Router), to another NAC / Router on the network, or to a server. For each log entry, provide the following data: 2.8 1. Time and date 2. User ID 3. Change or activity: i.e., Change setpoint, add or delete objects, commands, etc. DATABASE BACKUP AND STORAGE A. The NAC / Router shall have the ability to automatically backup its database. shall be backed up based on a user-defined time interval. The database B. Copies of the current database and, at the most recently saved database shall be stored in the NAC / Router. The age of the most recently saved database is dependent on the user-defined database save interval. C. The NAC / Router database shall be stored, at a minimum, in XML format to allow for user viewing and editing, if desired. Other formats are acceptable as well, as long as XML format is supported. 2.9 DIRECT DIGITAL CONTROLLERS (DDC) A. Direct Digital Controllers shall be 16 bit microprocessor based Interoperable LonWorks Controllers. B. The Network Area Controller (NAC) / Router will provide all scheduling, alarming, trending, and network management for the LonMark / LonWorks based devices. C. The DDCs shall communicate with the NAC / Router at a baud rate of not less than 78.8K baud. The DDC shall provide LED indication of communication and controller performance to the technician, without cover removal. 349 D. All DDCs shall be fully application programmable. Controllers offering application selection only (non programmable), require a 10% spare point capacity to be provided for all applications. All control sequences within or programmed into the DDC shall be stored in non-volatile memory, which is not dependent upon the presence of a battery, to be retained. E. The BMS contractor supplying the DDC’s shall provide documentation for each device, with the following information at a minimum: 1. Network Variable Inputs (nvi’s); name and type 2. Network Variable Outputs (nvo’s); name and type 3. Network configuration parameters (nci, nco); name and type F. It is the responsibility of the BMS contractor to ensure that the proper Network Variable Inputs and Outputs (nvi and nvo) are provided in each DDC, as required by the point charts. G. The supplier of any programmable DDC shall provide one copy of the manufacturer’s programming tool, with documentation, to the CLIENT. H. The controller shall be capable of either integrating with other LonMark™ devices or stand-alone operation. I. The controller shall have two microprocessors. The Host processor contains on-chip FLASH program memory, FLASH information memory, and RAM to run the main HVAC application. The second processor for LonWorks™ network communications. a. FLASH Memory Capacity: 60 Kilobytes with 8 Kilobytes for application program. b. FLASH Memory settings retained for ten years. c. J. RAM: 2 Kilobytes The controller shall have an FTT transformer-coupled communications port interface for common modenoise rejection and DC isolation. K. The controller shall have an internal time clock with the ability to automatically revert from a master time clock on failure. a. Operating Range: 24 hour, 365 day, multi-year calendar including day of week and configuration for automatic day-light savings time adjustment to occur on configured start and stop dates. b. Accuracy: ±1 minute per month at 77° F (25° C). c. Power Failure Backup: 24 hours at 32° to 122° F (0° to 50° C). O The controller shall have Significant Event Notification, Periodic Update capability, and Failure Detect when network inputs fail to be detected within their configurable time frame. P Rated voltage: 20-30 VAC, 50/60 Hz Q The controller shall have an internal DC power supply to power external sensors. a. Power Output: 20 VDC ±10% at 75 mA. R The controller shall have a visual indication (LED) of the status of the device: a. Controller operating normally. b. Controller in process of download. 350 c. Controller in manual mode under control of software tool. d. Controller lost its configuration. e. No power to controller, low voltage, or controller damage. f. Processor and/or controller is not operating. S The minimum controller Environmental ratings: a. Operating Temperature Ambient Rating: -40° to 150° F (-40° to 65.5° C). b. C). c. T Storage Temperature Ambient Rating: -40° to 150° F (-40° to 65.5° Relative Humidity: 5% to 95% non-condensing. The controller shall have the additional approval requirements, listings, and approvals: a. UL/cUL (E87741) listed under UL916 (Standard for Open Energy Management Equipment) with plenum rating. b. CSA (LR95329-3) Listed c. Meets FCC Part 15, Subpart B, Class B (radiated emissions) requirements. d. Meets Canadian standard C108.8 (radiated emissions). e. Conforms requirements European Consortium standard EN 61000-6-1; 2001 (EU Immunity) f. Conforms requirements European Consortium standard EN 61000-6-3; 2001 (EU Emission) U a. The controller shall have three analog outputs (AO). Analog outputs (AO) shall be capable of being configured as digital outputs (DO). b. Input and Output wiring terminal strips shall be removable from the controller without disconnecting wiring. c. Input and Output wiring terminals shall be designated with color coded labels. V The controller shall provide for “user defined” Network Variables (NV) for customized configurations. 2.10 GRAPHICAL USER INTERFACE SOFTWARE A. Operating System: 1. The GUI shall run on Microsoft Windows XP Professional. B. The GUI shall employ browser-like functionality for ease of navigation. It shall include a tree view (similar to Windows Explorer) for quick viewing of, and access to, the hierarchical structure of the database. In addition, menu-pull downs, and toolbars shall employ buttons, commands and navigation to permit the operator to perform tasks with a minimum knowledge of the HVAC Control System and basic computing skills. These shall include, but are not limited to, forward/backward buttons, home button, and a context sensitive locator line (similar to a URL line), that displays the location and the selected object identification. C. Real-Time Displays. and functions: The GUI, shall at a minimum, support the following graphical features 351 1. Graphic screens shall be developed using any drawing package capable of generating a GIF, BMP, or JPG file format. Use of proprietary graphic file formats shall not be acceptable. In addition to, or in lieu of a graphic background, the GUI shall support the use of scanned pictures. 2. Graphic screens shall have the capability to contain objects for text, real-time values, animation, color spectrum objects, logs, graphs, HTML or XML document links, schedule objects, hyperlinks to other URL’s, and links to other graphic screens. 3. Graphics shall support layering and each graphic object shall be configurable for assignment to a layer. A minimum of six layers shall be supported. 4. Modifying common application objects, such as schedules, calendars, and set points shall be accomplished in a graphical manner. a. Schedule times will be adjusted using a graphical slider, without requiring any keyboard entry from the operator. b. Holidays shall be set by using a graphical calendar without requiring any keyboard entry from the operator. 5. Commands to start and stop binary objects shall be done by right-clicking the selected object and selecting the appropriate command from the pop-up menu. No entry of text shall be required. 6. Adjustments to analog objects, such as set points, shall be done by right-clicking the selected object and using a graphical slider to adjust the value. No entry of text shall be required. D. System Configuration. At a minimum, the GUI shall permit the operator to perform the following tasks, with proper password access: a. Create, delete or modify control strategies. b. Add/delete objects to the system. c. Tune control loops through the adjustment of control loop parameters. d. Enable or disable control strategies. e. Generate hard copy records or control strategies on a printer. f. Select points to be alarmable and define the alarm state. g. E. Select points to be trended over a period of time and initiate the recording of values automatically. On-Line Help. Provide a context sensitive, on-line help system to assist the operator in operation and editing of the system. On-line help shall be available for all applications and shall provide the relevant data for that particular screen. Additional help information shall be available through the use of hypertext. All system documentation and help files shall be in HTML format. F. Security. Each operator shall be required to log on to that system with a user name and password in order to view, edit, add, or delete data. System security shall be selectable for each operator. The system administrator shall have the ability to set passwords and security levels for all other operators. Each operator password shall be able to restrict the operators’ access for viewing and/or changing each system application, full screen editor, and object. Each operator shall automatically be logged off of the system if no keyboard or mouse activity is detected. This auto log-off time shall be set per operator password. All system security data shall be stored in an encrypted format. G. System Diagnostics. The system shall automatically monitor the operation of all workstations, printers, 352 modems, network connections, building management panels, and controllers. The failure of any device shall be annunciated to the operator. H. Programming software shall be same as GUI. The Same GUI can be used to configure the DDCs & NAC. I. Alarm Console 1. The system will be provided with a dedicated alarm window or console. This window will notify the operator of an alarm condition, and allow the operator to view details of the alarm and acknowledge the alarm. The use of the Alarm Console can be enabled or disabled by the system administrator. 2. When the Alarm Console is enabled, a separate alarm notification window will supercede all other windows on the desktop and shall not be capable of being minimized or closed by the operator. This window will notify the operator of new alarms and un-acknowledged alarms. Alarm notification windows or banners that can be minimized or closed by the operator shall not be acceptable. SPECIAL ENERGY MANAGEMENT REPORTING AND PROFILING APPLICATIONS These reports are defined below. 1. Aggregate Demand Summary - This report aggregates (totalizes) multiple points (meters) and shows the peak, minimum, average, and total consumption as well as computes load factor. By reducing peak consumption and leveling the total load, volatility is reduced and energy customers can make significant improvements in their energy procurement. This report will help identify favorable aggregation combinations and unattractive peaks. Once the user selects this report, they define parameters such as sites, meters, time period, and commodity. The following screen shot is an example of Aggregate Demand Summary. 2. Summary Ranking Reports - By selecting this report, the user can identify the 10 worst or 10 best sites in the database. Once the report type has been selected, parameters to define before the report can be generated will include the following: a. Measurement unit – KW, therms, CCF gallons, PSI, etc. The database will search for all values matching the request. 353 b. Compare an entire facility or normalize by square foot c. Time periods to compare d. Highest values or lowest values – Will be able to view either the best or worst 10 points matching the defined parameters e. Cost or consumption in future revisions 3. Spectrum Summary Report – A quick view of any point or aggregated point with color coding identifying the reasonableness of the data value. The chart can report on up to one year of data, with the ability to zoom to a higher definition. As data values approach and/or exceed historical ranges, the color on the graph will change to identify such. If all data values are within historical ranges, the user can move on to other functions. In the following screen shot, the Spectrum Summary Report is reporting on total electricity for an aggregated point, which consists of 6 schools. The reporting period is six weeks, with the blue identifying low loads overnight and on weekends. The fourth weekend in the report was a three day weekend which is identified by a larger blue gap. A user can also see rising consumption (red) as temperatures rise going into the summer season. When the user clicks on an area of the graph, the data value along with time stamp will appear. The colors and associated data value ranges are user definable. The following screen shot is an example of the Spectrum Summary Report. 354 4. Equipment Operation Reports - Users will have the ability to analyze digital points and identify run times. Comparisons between sites or points can be made and run times can be graphed. For example, comparing lighting or HVAC run hours in a group of stores or comparing HVAC run hours in June for Store 1 versus Store 2. Data will be displayed in time and percentage. 5. Relative Contribution Report – This pie chart report will give users the ability to identify how individual points contribute to a total from a point group. The user would select a group of points, calculate the aggregate consumption of the group, and report on the individual contribution of each. Data will be displayed both graphically in a pie chart as well as in tabular format. Users could identify that HVAC is 48% of the building load; lighting is 42%, or Building 1 accounts for 14% of the total enterprise load and Building 2 contributes 19%. This report will allow users to identify inefficiencies and help perform budgeting. 355 6. Average Profile – The report will allow the user to average the load for a single load across time periods and give the average load, and/or aggregate multiple meters (loads) and view the average aggregated load. This report will be very beneficial when negotiating with energy service providers because it includes the load profile and consumption totals. With the ability to filter by time periods, measurement units, points or point groups, weekdays, and weekends, load profiles with associated data will allow the user to procure exactly the amount of energy required. This reduces risk for the energy provider and therefore reduces cost for the end- user. The user will be able to manipulate between 1-minute intervals and hourly intervals. In addition, users will be able to choose between auto scale and manual scale. For example, if the minimum value is 100KW and the maximum is 500 kW, the user can have the chart automatically scale between those values or they can select any range to scale the 400kW range. When printing charts, this may be useful. This will be useful for sophisticated users who need a higher resolution of data. The following screen shot is an example of the Average Profile Report. 7. Point Trending – This report will allow the user to choose a single or multiple points and trend the values over a specified time period. Either analog or digital points can be trended and multiple variables can be selected to be report. For a visual representation of several point values, the user will view all points on the left Y-axis. If the user would like to perform a statistical analysis identifying correlation coefficient and standard deviation between variables, they will have the ability to select a single point for each Y-axis. If a point group has been created, it would be presented as a single point value. The same auto scale/manual scale feature discussed in Average Profile Report is available in Point Trending. The following screen shot is an example of the Point Trending Report. 356 8. Exception Report – This report will identify all data values for the specified period that does not fall in a user-defined range. Although the range will be user definable, the benchmark or baseline to be compared against will be historical data. Users can get to this report by selecting it among the library of report templates, or can automatically be taken here from the Average Profile Report or Point Trending Report by clicking on an “Exception” button once a profile is being viewed. 2.11 WEB BROWSER CLIENTS A. The system shall be capable of supporting an unlimited number of clients using a standard Web browser such as Internet Explorer™ or Netscape Navigator™. Systems requiring additional software (to enable a standard Web browser) to be resident on the client machine, or manufacture-specific browsers shall not be acceptable. B. The Web browser software shall run on any operating system and system configuration that is supported by the Web browser. Systems that require specific machine requirements in terms of processor speed, memory, etc., in order to allow the Web browser to function with the FMCS, shall not be acceptable. 357 C. The Web browser shall provide the same view of the system, in terms of graphics, schedules, calendars, logs, etc., and provide the same interface methodology as is provided by the Graphical User Interface. Systems that require different views or that require different means of interacting with objects such as schedules, or logs, shall not be permitted. D. The Web browser client shall support at a minimum, the following functions: 1. User log-on identification and password shall be required. If an unauthorized user attempts access, a blank web page shall be displayed. Security using Java authentication and encryption techniques to prevent unauthorized access shall be implemented. 2. Graphical screens developed for the GUI shall be the same screens used for the Web browser client. Any animated graphical objects supported by the GUI shall be supported by the Web browser interface. 3. 4. 5. 6. HTML programming shall not be required to display system graphics or data on a Web page. HTML editing of the Web page shall be allowed if the user desires a specific look or format. Storage of the graphical screens shall be in the Network Area Controller (NAC), without requiring any graphics to be stored on the client machine. Systems that require graphics storage on each client are not acceptable. Real-time values displayed on a Web page shall update automatically without requiring a manual “refresh” of the Web page. Users shall have administrator-defined access privileges. Depending on the access privileges assigned, the user shall be able to perform the following: a. Modify common application objects, such as schedules, calendars, and set points in a graphical manner. 1. Schedule times will be adjusted using a graphical slider, without requiring any keyboard entry from the operator. 2. Holidays shall be set by using a graphical calendar, without requiring any keyboard entry from the operator. b. Commands to start and stop binary objects shall be done by right-clicking the selected object and selecting the appropriate command from the pop-up menu. No entry of text shall be required. c. View logs and charts d. View and acknowledge alarms e. Setup and execute SQL queries on log and archive information 7. The system shall provide the capability to specify a user’s (as determined by the log-on user identification) home page. Provide the ability to limit a specific user to just their defined home page. From the home page, links to other views, or pages in the system shall be possible, if allowed by the system administrator. 8. Graphic screens on the Web Browser client shall support hypertext links to other locations on the Internet or on Intranet sites, by specifying the Uniform Resource Locator (URL) for the desired link. 358 2.12 SERVER FUNCTIONS AND HARDWARE A. A central server shall be provided. The server shall support all Network Area Controllers (NAC) / Router connected to the customer’s network whether local or remote. B. Local connections shall be via an Ethernet LAN. Remote connections can be via ISDN, ADSL, T1 or dial-up connection. C. It shall be possible to provide access to all Network Area Controllers via a single connection to the server. In this configuration, each Network Area Controller can be accessed from a remote Graphical User Interface (GUI) or from a standard Web browser (WBI) by connecting to the server. D. The server shall provide the following functions, at a minimum: 1. Global Data Access: The server shall provide complete access to distributed data defined anywhere in the system. 2. Distributed Control: The server shall provide the ability to execute global control strategies based on control and data objects in any NAC / Router in the network, local or remote. 3. The server shall include a master clock service for its subsystems and provide time synchronization for all Network Area Controllers (NAC) / Routers. 4. The server shall accept time synchronization messages from trusted precision Atomic Clock Internet sites and update its master clock based on this data. 5. The server shall provide scheduling for all Network Area Controllers and their underlying field control devices. 6. The server shall provide demand limiting that operates across all Network Area Controllers. The server must be capable of multiple demand programs for sites with multiple meters and or multiple sources of energy. Each demand program shall be capable of supporting separate demand shed lists for effective demand control. 7. The server shall implement the BACnet Command Prioritization scheme (16 levels) for safe and effective contention resolution of all commands issued to Network Area Controllers / Routers. Systems not employing this prioritization shall not be accepted. 8. Each Network Area Controller / Router supported by the server shall have the ability to archive its log data, alarm data and database to the server, automatically. Archiving options shall be user- defined including archive time and archive frequency. 9. The server shall provide central alarm management for all Network Area Controllers / Routers supported by the server. Alarm management shall include: 10. 1. Routing of alarms to display, printer, email and pagers 2. View and acknowledge alarms 3. Query alarm logs based on user-defined parameters The server shall provide central management of log data for all Network Area Controllers / Routers supported by the server. Log data shall include process logs, runtime and event counter logs, audit logs and error logs. Log data management shall include: 1. Viewing and printing log data 2. Exporting log data to other software applications 3. Query log data based on user-defined parameters 359 E. Server Hardware Requirements: The server hardware platform shall have the following requirements: 1. The computer shall be an Intel Pentium M based computer (minimum processing speed of 2.4 GHz with 1 GB RAM and a 100-gigabyte minimum hard drive). It shall include a DVD-ROM/CDRW Combination Drive, 2-parallel ports, 2-asynchronous serial ports and 2-USB ports. A minimum 17” flat panel color monitor, 1280 x 1024 optimal preset resolution, 25 ms response time shall also be included. 2. The server operating system shall be Microsoft Windows XP Professional. Include Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 or later. 2.13 3. Connection to the BMS network shall be via an Ethernet network interface card, 100 Mbps. 4. A system printer shall be provided. Printer shall be laser type with a minimum 600 x 600dpi resolution and rated for 60-PPM print speed minimum. 5. For dedicated alarm printing, provide a dot matrix printer, either 80 or 132 column width. The printer shall have a parallel port interface. SYSTEM PROGRAMMING A. The Graphical User Interface software (GUI) shall provide the ability to perform system programming and graphic display engineering as part of a complete software package. Access to the programming functions and features of the GUI shall be through password access as assigned by the system administrator. B. A library of control, application, and graphic objects shall be provided to enable the creation of all applications and user interface screens. Applications are to be created by selecting the desired control objects from the library, dragging or pasting them on the screen, and linking them together using a built in graphical connection tool. Completed applications may be stored in the library for future use. Graphical User Interface screens shall be created in the same fashion. Data for the user displays is obtained by graphically linking the user display objects to the application objects to provide “real-time” data updates. Any real-time data value or object property may be connected to display its current value on a user display. Systems requiring separate software tools or processes to create applications and user interface displays shall not be acceptable. C. Programming Methods 1. Provide the capability to copy objects from the supplied libraries, or from a user-defined library to the user’s application. Objects shall be linked by a graphical linking scheme by dragging a link from one object to another. Object links will support one-to-one, many-toone, or one-to-many relationships. Linked objects shall maintain their connections to other objects regardless of where they are positioned on the page and shall show link identification for links to objects on other pages for easy identification. Links will vary in color depending on the type of link; i.e., internal, external, hardware, etc. 2. Configuration of each object will be done through the object’s property sheet using fill-in the blank fields, list boxes, and selection buttons. Use of custom programming, scripting language, or a manufacturer-specific procedural language for configuration will not be accepted. 360 2.14 3. The software shall provide the ability to view the logic in a monitor mode. When on-line, the monitor mode shall provide the ability to view the logic in real time for easy diagnosis of the logic execution. When off-line (debug), the monitor mode shall allow the user to set values to inputs and monitor the logic for diagnosing execution before it is applied to the system. 4. All programming shall be done in real-time. Systems requiring the uploading, editing, and downloading of database objects shall not be allowed. 5. The system shall support object duplication within a customer’s database. An application, once configured, can be copied and pasted for easy re-use and duplication. All links, other than to the hardware, shall be maintained during duplication. LonWorks NETWORK MANAGEMENT A. The Graphical User Interface software (GUI) shall provide a complete set of integrated LonWorks network management tools for working with LonWorks networks. These tools shall manage a database for all LonWorks devices by type and revision, and shall provide a software mechanism for identifying each device on the network. These tools shall also be capable of defining network data connections between LonWorks devices, known as “binding”. Systems requiring the use of third party LonWorks network management tools shall not be accepted. B. Network management shall include the following services: device identification, device installation, device configuration, device diagnostics, device maintenance and network variable binding. C. The network configuration tool shall also provide diagnostics to identify devices on the network, to reset devices, and to view health and status counters within devices. D. These tools shall provide the ability to “learn” an existing LonWorks network, regardless of what network management tool(s) were used to install the existing network, so that existing LonWorks devices and newly added devices are part of a single network management database. E. 2.15 The network management database shall be resident in the Network Area Controller (NAC) / Router, ensuring that anyone with proper authorization has access to the network management database at all times. Systems employing network management databases that are not resident, at all times, within the control system, shall not be accepted. OBJECT LIBRARIES A. A standard library of objects shall be included for development and setup of application logic, user interface displays, system services, and communication networks. B. The objects in this library shall be capable of being copied and pasted into the user’s database and shall be organized according to their function. In addition, the user shall have the capability to group objects created in their application and store the new instances of these objects in a user-defined library. C. In addition to the standard libraries specified here, the supplier of the system shall maintain an on-line accessible (over the Internet) library, available to all registered users to provide new or updated objects and applications as they are developed. D. All control objects shall conform to the control objects specified in the BACnet specification. E. The library shall include applications or objects for the following functions, at a minimum: 1. Scheduling Object. The schedule must conform to the schedule object as defined in the BACnet specification, providing 7-day plus holiday & temporary scheduling features and a minimum of 10 on/off events per day. Data entry to be by graphical sliders to speed creation and selection of on- off 361 events. 2. Calendar Object. . The calendar must conform to the calendar object as defined in the BACnet specification, providing 12-month calendar features to allow for holiday or special event data entry. Data entry to be by graphical “point-and-click” selection. This object must be “linkable” to any or all scheduling objects for effective event control. 3. Duty Cycling Object. Provide a universal duty cycle object to allow repetitive on/off time control of equipment as an energy conserving measure. Any number of these objects may be created to control equipment at varying intervals 4. Temperature Override Object. Provide a temperature override object that is capable of overriding equipment turned off by other energy saving programs (scheduling, duty cycling etc.) to maintain occupant comfort or for equipment freeze protection. 5. Start-Stop Time Optimization Object. Provide a start-stop time optimization object to provide the capability of starting equipment just early enough to bring space conditions to desired conditions by the scheduled occupancy time. Also, allow equipment to be stopped before the scheduled unoccupancy time just far enough ahead to take advantage of the building’s “flywheel” effect for energy savings. Provide automatic tuning of all start / stop time object properties based on the previous day’s performance. 6. Demand Limiting Object. Provide a comprehensive demand-limiting object that is capable of controlling demand for any selected energy utility (electric, oil, and gas). The object shall provide the capability of monitoring a demand value and predicting (by use of a sliding window prediction algorithm) the demand at the end of the user defined interval period (1-60 minutes). This object shall also accommodate a utility meter time sync pulse for fixed interval demand control. Upon a prediction that will exceed the user defined demand limit (supply a minimum of 6 per day), the demand limiting object shall issue shed commands to either turn off user specified loads or modify equipment set points to effect the desired energy reduction. If the list of sheddable equipment is not enough to reduce the demand to below the set point, a message shall be displayed on the users screen (as an alarm) instructing the user to take manual actions to maintain the desired demand. The shed lists are specified by the user and shall be selectable to be shed in either a fixed or rotating order to control which equipment is shed the most often. Upon suitable reductions in demand, the demandlimiting object shall restore the equipment that was shed in the reverse order in which it was shed. Each sheddable object shall have a minimum and maximum shed time property to effect both equipment protection and occupant comfort. F. The library shall include control objects for the following functions. All control objects shall conform to the objects as specified in the BACnet specification. 1. Analog Input Object - Minimum requirement is to comply with the BACnet standard for data sharing. Allow high, low and failure limits to be assigned for alarming. Also, provide a time delay filter property to prevent nuisance alarms caused by temporary excursions above or below the user defined alarm limits. 2. Analog Output Object - Minimum requirement is to comply with the BACnet standard for data sharing. 3. Binary Input Object - Minimum requirement is to comply with the BACnet standard for data sharing. The user must be able to specify either input condition for alarming. This object must also include the capability to record equipment run-time by counting the amount of time the hardware input is in an “on” condition. The user must be able to specify either input condition as the “on” condition. 362 4. Binary Output Object - Minimum requirement is to comply with the BACnet standard for data sharing. Properties to enable minimum on and off times for equipment protection as well as interstart delay must be provided. The BACnet Command Prioritization priority scheme shall be incorporated to allow multiple control applications to execute commands on this object with the highest priority command being invoked. Provide sixteen levels of priority as a minimum. Systems not employing the BACnet method of contention resolution shall not be acceptable. 5. PID Control Loop Object - Minimum requirement is to comply with the BACnet standard for data sharing. Each individual property must be adjustable as well as to be disabled to allow proportional control only, or proportional with integral control, as well as proportional, integral and derivative control. 6. Comparison Object - Allow a minimum of two analog objects to be compared to select either the highest, lowest, or equality between the two linked inputs. Also, allow limits to be applied to the output value for alarm generation. 7. Math Object - Allow a minimum of four analog objects to be tested for the minimum or maximum, or the sum, difference, or average of linked objects. Also, allow limits to be applied to the output value for alarm generation. 8. Custom Programming Objects - Provide a blank object template for the creation of new custom objects to meet specific user application requirements. This object must provide a simple BASIC- like programming language that is used to define object behavior. Provide a library of functions including math and logic functions, string manipulation, and e-mail as a minimum. Also, provide a comprehensive on-line debug tool to allow complete testing of the new object. Allow new objects to be stored in the library for re-use. 9. Interlock Object - Provide an interlock object that provides a means of coordination of objects within a piece of equipment such as an Air Handler or other similar types of equipment. An example is to link the return fan to the supply fan such that when the supply fan is started, the return fan object is also started automatically without the user having to issue separate commands or to link each object to a schedule object. In addition, the control loops, damper objects, and alarm monitoring (such as return air, supply air, and mixed air temperature objects) will be inhibited from alarming during a user-defined period after startup to allow for stabilization. When the air handler is stopped, the interlocked return fan is also stopped, the outside air damper is closed, and other related objects within the air handler unit are inhibited from alarming thereby eliminating nuisance alarms during the off period. 10. Temperature Override Object - Provide an object whose purpose is to provide the capability of overriding a binary output to an “On” state in the event a user specified high or low limit value is exceeded. This object is to be linked to the desired binary output object as well as to an analog object for temperature monitoring, to cause the override to be enabled. This object will execute a Start command at the Temperature Override level of start/stop command priority unless changed by the user. 11. Composite Object - Provide a container object that allows a collection of objects representing an application to be encapsulated to protect the application from tampering, or to more easily represent large applications. This object must have the ability to allow the user to select the appropriate parameters of the “contained” application that are represented on the graphical shell of this container. G. The object library shall include objects to support the integration of devices connected to the Network Area Controller (NAC) / Router. At a minimum, provide the following as part of the standard library 363 included with the programming software: 1. LonMark/LonWorks devices. These devices shall include, but not be limited to, devices for control of HVAC, lighting, access, and metering. Provide LonMark manufacturer-specific objects to facilitate simple integration of these devices. All network variables defined in the LonMark profile shall be supported. Information (type and function) regarding network variables not defined in the LonMark profile shall be provided by the device manufacturer. 2. For devices not conforming to the LonMark standard, provide a dynamic object that can be assigned to the device based on network variable information provided by the device manufacturer. Device manufacturer shall provide an XIF file, resource file and documentation for the device to facilitate device integration. 3. For BACnet devices, provide the following objects at a minimum: 4. a. Analog In b. Analog Out c. Analog Value d. Binary e. f. Binary In Binary Out g. Binary Value h. Multi-State In i. Multi-State Out j. Multi-State Value k. Schedule Export l. Calendar Export m. Trend Export n. Device For each BACnet object, provide the ability to assign the object a BACnet device and object instance number. 5. For BACnet devices, provide the following support at a minimum a. b. Segmentation Segmented Request c. Segmented Response d. Application Services e. Read Property f. Read Property multiple g. Write Property h. Write Property Multiple i. Confirmed Event Notification 364 2.16 j. k. l. Unconfirmed Event Notification Acknowledge Alarm Get Alarm Summary m. Who-has n. I-have o. Who-is p. I-am q. Subscribe COV r. Confirmed COV notification s. Unconfirmed COV notification t. Media Types u. Ethernet v. BACnet IP Annex J w. MSTP x. BACnet Broadcast Management Device (BBMD) function y. Routing DDE DEVICE INTEGRATION A. The Network Area Controller / Router shall support the integration of device data via Dynamic Data Exchange (DDE), over the Ethernet Network. The Network Area Controller shall act as a DDE client to another software application that functions as a DDE server. B. 2.17 Provide the required objects in the library, included with the Graphical User Interface programming software, to support the integration of these devices into the BMS. Objects provided shall include at a minimum: 1. DDE Generic AI Object 2. DDE Generic AO Object 3. 4. DDE Generic BO Object DDE Generic BI Object MODBUS SYSTEM INTEGRATION A. The Network Area Controller / Router shall support the integration of device data from Modbus RTU, Ascii, or TCP control system devices. The connection to the Modbus system shall be via an RS-232, RS485, or Ethernet IP as required by the device. B. Provide the required objects in the library, included with the Graphical User Interface programming software, to support the integration of the Modbus system data into the BMS. Objects provided shall include at a minimum: 1. Read/Write Modbus AI Registers 2. Read/Write Modbus AO Registers 3. Read/Write Modbus BI Registers 4. Read/Write Modbus BO Registers 365 C. All scheduling, alarming, logging and global supervisory control functions, of the Modbus system devices, shall be performed by the Network Area Controller. D. The BMS supplier shall provide a Modbus system communications driver. The equipment system vendor that provided the equipment utilizing Modbus shall provide documentation of the system’s Modbus interface and shall provide factory support at no charge during system commissioning 2.18 OPC SYSTEM INTEGRATION A. The Network Area Controller / Router shall act as an OPC client and shall support the integration of device data from OPC servers. The connection to the OPC server shall be Ethernet IP as required by the device. The OPC client shall support third party OPC servers compatible with the Data Access 1.0 and 2.0 specifications. B. Provide the required objects in the library, included with the Graphical User Interface programming software, to support the integration of the OPC system data into the BMS. Objects provided shall include at a minimum: C. 1. Read/Write OPC AI Object 2. Read/Write OPC AO Object 3. Read/Write OPC BI Object 4. Read/Write OPC BO Object 5. Read/Write OPC Date/Time Input Object 6. Read/Write OPC Date/Time Output Object 7. Read/Write OPC String Input Object 8. Read/Write OPC String Output Object All scheduling, alarming, logging and global supervisory control functions, of the OPC system devices, shall be performed by the Network Area Controller / Router. D. The BMS supplier shall provide an OPC client communications driver. The equipment system vendor that provided the equipment utilizing OPC shall provide documentation of the system’s OPC server interface and shall provide factory support at no charge during system commissioning. 2.19 GRAPHICAL USER INTERFACE COMPUTER HARDWARE (DESKTOP) A. The browser workstation shall be an Intel Pentium based computer (minimum processing speed of 2.4 Ghz with 1.0 GB RAM and a 100-gigabyte minimum hard drive). It shall include a DVD-ROM/CD-RW Combination Drive, 2-parallel ports, 2-asynchronous serial ports and 2-USB ports. A minimum 17”flat panel color monitor, 1280 x 1024 optimal preset resolution, 25 ms response time, shall also be included. B. Connection to the BMS network shall be via an Ethernet network interface card, 10 Mbps. C. A system printer shall be provided. Printer shall be laser type with a minimum 600 x 600-dpi resolution and rated for 8 PPM print speed minimum. 366 OTHER CONTROL SYSTEM HARDWARE FIELD DEVICES 7.1 ELECTRIC AND ELECTRONIC CONTROLS RELATED EQUIPMENT General Requirements All controls shall be capable of operating in ambient conditions varying between 0-55 deg. C and 90% R.H. non-condensing. All Control devices shall have a 20 mm conduit knockout. Alternatively, they shall be supplied with adaptors for 20 mm conduit. Ancillary Items When items of equipment are installed in the situations listed below, the BAS contractor shall include the following ancillary items : (i) WeatherProtection All devices required to be weatherproofed are detailed in the Schedule of Quantities. IP ratings for the equipment is mentioned in the respective section. (ii) Pipe work Immersion Corrosion resisting pockets of a length suitable for the complete active length of the device, screwed ½” (13 mm) or ¾” (20 mm) NPT suitable for the temperature, pressure and medium. (iii) DuctMounting(MetalorBuildersWork) Mounting flanges, clamping bushes, couplings, locknuts, gaskets, brackets, sealing glands and any special fittings necessitated by the device. Additional features 7.2 (i) Concealed Adjustment : All two position switching devices shall have concealed adjustment unless detailed otherwise in the Schedule of Quantities. (ii) Operating Voltage : All two position switching devices shall operate on 230 v a.c and all accessible live parts shall be shrouded. An earth terminal shall be provided. TEMPERATURE SENSOR Temperature sensors for space, pipes and ducts, shall be of the Resistance Temperature detector (RTD) type or thermistor. These shall be two wire type and shall conform to the following specifications : 1) Immersion sensors shall be high accuracy type with a high resistance versus temperature change. 367 The accuracy shall be atleast ± 0.33 degrees F and sensitivity of atleast 2 ohm/F. 2) Immersion sensors shall be provided with separate stainless steel thermo well. These shall be manufactured from bar stock with hydrostatic pressure rating of atleast 10 kgf/cm2. 3) The connection to the pipe shall be screwed ¾ inch NPT (M). An aluminum sleeve shall be provided to ensure proper heat transfer from the well to the sensor. Terminations to be provided on the head. Flying leads shall not be acceptable. 4) The sensor housing shall plug into the base so that the same can be easily removed without disturbing the wiring connections. 5) Duct temperature sensors shall be with rigid stem and of averaging suitable for duct installation. 6) shield. 7) type. These shall be Outdoor air temperature sensor shall be provided with a sun The sensors shall not be mounted near any heat source such as windows, electrical appliances etc. The temperature sensors may be of any of the following types : 1) 2) 3) 4) 7.3 PT 100, PT 1000, PT 3000 NI 100, NI 1000 Balco 500. Thermistor HUMIDITY SENSOR Space and duct humidity sensors shall be of capacitance type with an effective sensing range of 10% to 90% RH. Accuracy shall be + 3% or better. Duct mounted humidity sensors shall be provided with a sampling chamber. Wall mounted sensors shall be provided with a housing. The sensor housing shall plug into the base so that the same can be easily removed without disturbing the wiring connections. The sensors shall not be mounted near any heat source such as windows, electrical appliances etc. 7.4 FLOW METER Water flow meters shall be either Ultrasonic type or electromagnetic type. For electromagnetic flow meter, teflon lining with 316 SS electrodes must be provided. The housing shall have IP 55 protection. Vendors shall have to get their design/ selection approved by the Consultant, prior to the supply. The exact ranges to be set shall be determined by the contractor at the time of commissioning. It should be possible to ‘zero’ the flowmeter without any external instruments, with the overall accuracy of atleast ± 1% full scale. 7.5 PRESSURE TRANSMITTER FOR WATER Pressure transmitters shall be piezo-electric type or diaphragm type. (Bourdon Tube type shall not be acceptable). Output shall be 4-20mA or 0-10V DC and the range as specified in the data sheet depending on the line pressure. Power supply shall be either 24 V AC, 24 V DC or 230 V AC. 368 Connection shall be as per manufacturer’s standards. The pressure detector shall be capable of withstanding a hydraulic test pressure of twice the working pressure. The set point shall fall within 40%70% of the sensing range and detector shall have sensitivity such that change of 1.5% from the stabilized condition shall cause modulation of the corrective element. The sensor must be pressure compensated for a medium temperature of -10 o C to 60o C with ambient ranging between 0 o C to 55 o C. 7.6 DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH FOR PIPE WORK These shall be used to measure pressure differential across suction and discharge of pumps. The range shall be as specified in the data sheet. Switch shall be ON with increase in differential. Housing for these shall be weather proof with IP 55 protection. The pressure switch shall be capable of withstanding a hydraulic test pressure of 1.5 times the working pressure. The set point shall fall in 4070% of the scale range and shall have differentials adjustable over 10%-30% of the scale range. The switches shall be provided with site adjustable scale and with 2 NO/NC contacts. 7.7 DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH FOR AIR SYSTEMS These shall be diaphragm operated. Switches shall be supplied with air connections permitting their use as static or differential pressure switches. The switch shall be of differential pressure type complete with connecting tube and metal bends for connections to the duct. The housing shall be IP 54 rated. The pressure switches shall be available in minimum of 3 ranges suitable for applications like Air flow proving, dirty filter, etc. The set point shall be concealed type. The contact shall be SPDT type with 230 VAC, 1 A rating. The switch shall be supplied suitable for wall mounting on ducts in any plane. It should be mounted in such a way that the condensation flow out of the sensing tips. Proper adaptor shall be provided for the cables. The set point shall fall within 40%-70% of the scale range and l has differentials adjustable over 10%30% of the scale range. The switches shall be provided with site adjustable scale and with 2 NO/NC contacts. 7.8 AIR FLOW SWITCHES Air flow switches shall be selected for the correct air velocity, duct size and mounting attitude. If any special atmospheric conditions are detailed in the Schedule of Quantity the parts of the switches shall be suitably coated or made to withstand such conditions. These shall be suitable for mounting in any plane. Output shall be 2 NO/NC potential free. Site adjustable scale shall also be provided. 7.9 AIR PRESSURE SENSOR The pressure sensor shall be differential type. The construction shall be spring loaded diaphragm type. The movement of the membrane in relation to the pressure should be converted by an inductive electromagnet coupling which would give an output suitable for the controller. The pressure sensor shall be in a housing having IP 54 ratings in accordance with IEC 529. Suitable mounting arrangement 369 shall be available on the sensor. The sensor shall come complete with the PVC tubes & probes. 7.10 WATER FLOW SWITCH These shall be paddle type and suitable for the type of liquid flowing in the line. Output shall be 2NO/2NC potential free. 7.11 TRANSDUCERS FOR ELECTRICAL SERVICES Electrical transducers shall be integrated electronic type and rack mounted on the field. These shall work on 230 V supply with the output being standard type i.e. 4-20 mA, 0- 10 Volts etc. Power factor, Voltage, Current, Frequency and Kilowatt transducers shall have standard output signal for measurement for the specified variable. Kilowatt-Hour metering (if any) shall be poly-phase; three- element with current transformer (CT) operated type. The metering shall feature high accuracy with no more than +/- 1% error over the expected load range. The coils shall be totally encapsulated against high impulse levels. 7.12 LEVEL SWITCH The level switches shall have requirement : Type Mounting Connection Float material Stem Material Output Switch Enclosure : : : : : : : to meet the following Float Type/Capacitance type/Conductivity type To suit application. Flanged ANSI 150 lbs RF Carbon steel 316 SS 316 SS 2 NO, 2 NC potential free IP 55 7.13 DIGITAL THERMOSTATS Thermostats for FCU’s should be Digital on/off OR Modulating Type for Actuating 2 way or 3 way Valves (On- off/Modulating) Thermostats should display Room Temp and Setpoint simultaneously which is easy to read from atleast 68 feet distance. Thermostats should have Fan Speed Control Switch (Low-Med-High-Auto). Auto Mode should be able to save energy by automatically reducing the Fan Speed when Room Temp Achieves Set Point. LCD Display should be available in Blue or Green Backlit for ease in viewing the Room Temperature and Setpoint. Thermostats should work on 230V PS for on-off models and 24V for Modulating Thermostats 370 The User Settings should be retained in Thermostat Memory in case of Power Failure The Switching Relays should be separately wired and should be mounted inside the Junction Box, so that the Thermostat front is sleek in mounting.Thermostat Thickness should be 17mm or less Thermostats should have Energy Savings Feature with dual setpoint which can be interlocked with Occupancy Sensor or Hotel Key Card input. This should be indicated in the LCD Display in the mode it is being operated. This Programming should be possible by Hotel maintenance Staff. Thermostats should be similar or equivalent to Honeywell Halo Series Digital Thermostats Model T6861(on/off) or T6865(modulating) version. 7.15 Pressure Independent Dynamic Balancing Valve (ranges from25mm to 150mm) The Valve should have self Dynamic Flow Control Valves that are pressure independent, two way, Modulating to accept digital/analog input BMS/Controller signals and should provide position feedback signal to the control system. The Feedback signal should have the feedback feature of the Valve/Actuator itself without any need of any additional accessory/instrument/device. PICV should be capable of maintaining the max flow rate atleast +/-4% Accuracy The PICV Should be capable of maintaining Linear Temperature Control, Pressure Independence and Electric Modulation in one Valve body. • The Flow rates should be field settable electronically upto 60% of the valve Max set Flow rate • The Differential Pressure Ranges for which the valve can maintain the flow rates should be mentioned in the Product literature • • • Valve Actuator housing shall be rated to IP54 • Actuator shall be driven by a 24Vac power supply and shall accept universal Input signals like 0/2-10Vdc or 420mA signal • Actuator shall be capable of providing feedback Signal of 0/2-10Vdc to the Control System/BMS • PICV should have an option for adjusting the Flow Characteristics as per AHU in every PICV to ensure Linear Temp Control. • PICV should have an option for changing the Max Flow Rates in future and no additional Instrument should be required. Flow Values can be changed by entering in LCD Display only and not by any DIP Switches or Setting Dial to improve accuracy. • PICV shall provide full valve Authority • PICV Valve body shall be rated at least PN16 • Max Close off Pressure shall be mentioned in the Product Datasheet. • Min Working Differential Pressure shall be 30Kpa • Valve shall be Internal BSP Threaded from DN25 to DN50 and Flanged end Connection for DN65 to DN150 • Min Stroke Length of the Valve shall be 20mm 371 • • • Media Temperature : 0-130 deg C Valve shall be of Brass/Bronze Construction upto DN50 and Cast Iron upto DN150 Shut off Leakage shall be 0.1 Kvs 7.16 Motorized Butterfly Valve Valve Body Type of Valve Body Material Disc Material Stem Liner Material Nominal Static Body Rating Tightness Medium Temperature Pipe Connection Actuator Type Motor Supply Travel Angle Enclosure Indicator Space Heater Stall Protection Manual Override Torque Limit Switches External Coating Make : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : Butterfly Valve Cast Iron or Ductile Iron Body Nickel plated Ductile Iron SS416 EPDM PN16 Bubble Tight -10 dec C to 120 deg C ISO7005-2 Electric 230 Vac, 50hz/60Hz 90 deg +/- 5 deg IP67 Waterproof Continuous Position Indicator 15W 220V Anti Condensation Built-in thermal protection Cut off at 125 ± 5 Reset at 95 ± 5 By Handwheel, nonclutch design 2 nos Dry Aluminium Alloy in Painted Black Honeywell 7.17 On/Off type FCU valves Two way on/off type FCU valve The two way FCU valve should be design in such a way that it can withstand a static pressure of 20 bar and a burst pressure of 100 bar. The ports are designated in such a way that flow through the two way valve can be in either direction. The valve shall be designed to handle the fluid temperature from1degreeC to 95degreeC It can withstand the differential pressure upto 4 Bar. The valve is of bronze body with stainless steel stem and Noryl cover. The FCU valve shall have a minimum stroke length of 10mm so that it has the sufficient distance to travel. The 372 hydronic FCU valves shall been designed to meet the European standard EN 60730-2-8. The actuator shall require the power supply of 220 Volts AC so that no transformer is required. The actuator is easily removable from the valve so that in case the actuator fails at site it can be easily replaced without affecting the integrity of the water system. The actuator shall have the provision to operate manually. The actuator shall meet the low voltage directive 73/23/EEC. The actuator shall be selected in such a way that the maximum power consumed by the actuator is 6 Watt. The valve should be similar or equivalent to Honeywell VC6013 version. 7.18 Snap Acting Digital Thermostats Thermostats for FCU’s should be Digital on/off for Actuating 2 way or 3 way Valves (On-off/Modulating) Thermostats should display Room Temp and Set point simultaneously which is easy to read from at least 6-8 feet distance. Thermostats should have Fan Speed Control Switch (Low-Med-High-Auto). Auto Mode should be able to save energy by automatically reducing the Fan Speed when Room Temp Achieves Set Point. LCD Display should be available in Blue or Green Backlit for ease in viewing the Room Temperature and Set point. Thermostats should work on power supply of 230V for on-off models. The User Settings should be retained in Thermostat Memory in case of Power Failure The Switching Relays should be separately wired and should be mounted inside the Junction Box, so that the Thermostat front is sleek in mounting. Thermostat Thickness should be 17mm or less Thermostats should have Energy Savings Feature with dual set point which can be interlocked with Occupancy Sensor or Hotel Key Card input. This should be indicated in the LCD Display in the mode it is being operated. This Programming should be possible by Hotel maintenance Staff. Thermostats should be similar or equivalent to Honeywell Halo Series Digital Thermostats Model T6861 (on/off) version. PART 3 3.1 EXECUTION INSTALLATION A. All work described in this section shall be performed by system integrators or contractors that have a successful history in the design and installation of integrated control systems. B. Install system and materials in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions, and as detailed 373 on the project drawing set. C. Drawings of the BMS network are diagrammatic only and any apparatus not shown, but required to make the system operative to the complete satisfaction of the Architect shall be furnished and installed without additional cost. D. Line and low voltage electrical connections to control equipment shown specified or shown on the control diagrams shall be furnished and installed by this contractor in accordance with these specifications. E. Equipment furnished by the HVAC Contractor that is normally wired before installation shall be furnished completely wired. Control wiring normally performed in the field will be furnished and installed by this contractor. 3.2 WIRING A. All electrical control wiring and power wiring to the control panels, NAC, computers and network components shall be the responsibility of the this contractor. B. The electrical contractor shall furnish all power wiring to electrical starters and motors. C. All wiring shall be in accordance with the Project Electrical Specifications, the National Electrical Code and any applicable local codes. All BMS wiring shall be installed in the conduit types specified in the Electrical Specifications unless otherwise allowed by the National Electrical Code or applicable local codes. Where BMS plenum rated cable wiring is allowed it shall be run parallel to or at right angles to the structure, properly supported and installed in a neat and workmanlike manner. 3.3 WARRANTY A. Equipment, materials and workmanship incorporated into the work shall be warranted for a period of one year from the time of system acceptance. B. Within this period, upon notice by the CLIENT, any defects in the work provided under this section due to faulty materials, methods of installation or workmanship shall be promptly (within 48 hours after receipt of notice) repaired or replaced by this contractor at no expense to the CLIENT. 3.4 WARRANTY ACCESS A. The CLIENT shall grant to this contractor, reasonable access to the BMS during the warranty period. B. The CLIENT shall allow the contractor to access the BMS from a remote location for the purpose of diagnostics and troubleshooting, via the Internet, during the warranty period. 3.5 SOFTWARE LICENSE A. CLIENT shall be the named license holder of all software associated with any and all incremental work on the project(s). The owner, or his appointed agent, shall determine which organizations to be named in the “orgid” of all software licenses. B. CLIENT, or his appointed agent, shall be free to direct the modification of the “orgid” in any software license, regardless of supplier. C. The owner, or his appointed agent, shall receive ownership of all job specific software configuration documentation, data files, and application-level software developed for the project. This shall include all custom, job specific software code and documentation for all configuration and programming that is generated for a given project and /or configured for use within based controllers and/or servers and any related LAN / WAN / Intranet and Internet connected routers and devices. Any and all required Ids and passwords for access to any component or software program shall be provided to the owner. 374 3.6 ACCEPTANCE TESTING A. Upon completion of the installation, this contractor shall load all system software and startup the system. This contractor shall perform all necessary calibration, testing and de-bugging and perform all required operational checks to insure that the system is functioning in full accordance with these specifications. B. This contractor shall perform tests to verify proper performance of components, routines, and points. Repeat tests until proper performance results. This testing shall include a point-by-point log to validate 100% of the input and output points of the DDC system operation. C. Upon completion of the performance tests described above, repeat these tests, point by point as described in the validation log above in presence of CLIENT's Representative, as required. Properly schedule these tests so testing is complete at a time directed by the CLIENT's Representative. Do not delay tests so as to prevent delay of occupancy permits or building occupancy. D. 3.7 System Acceptance: Satisfactory completion is when BMS contractor have performed successfully all the required testing to show performance compliance with the requirements of the Contract Documents to the satisfaction of CLIENT Representative. System acceptance shall be contingent upon completion and review of all corrected deficiencies. OPERATOR INSTRUCTION, TRAINING A. During system commissioning and at such time acceptable performance of the BMS hardware and software has been established this contractor shall provide on-site operator instruction to the owner's operating personnel. Operator instruction shall be done during normal working hours and shall be performed by a competent representative familiar with the system hardware, software and accessories. B. This contractor shall provide 40 hours of instruction to the CLIENT's designated personnel on the operation of the BMS and describe its intended use with respect to the programmed functions specified. Operator orientation of the systems shall include, but not be limited to; the overall operation program, equipment functions (both individually and as part of the total integrated system), commands, systems generation, advisories, and appropriate operator intervention required in responding to the System's operation. C. The training shall be in three sessions as follows: 1. Initial Training: One day session (8 hours) after system is started up and at least one week before first acceptance test. Manual shall have been submitted at least two weeks prior to training so that the owners' personnel can start to familiarize themselves with the system before classroom instruction begins. 2. First Follow-Up Training: Two days (16 hours total) approximately two weeks after initial training, and before Formal Acceptance. These sessions will deal with more advanced topics and answer questions. 3. Warranty Follow Up: Two days (16 hours total) in no less than 4 hour increments, to be scheduled at the request of the owner during the one year warranty period. These sessions shall cover topics as requested by the owner such as; how to add additional points, create and gather data for trends, graphic screen generation or modification of control routines. 375 MAKELISTFORBUILDING MANAGEMENT SYSTEM OFASSAMSTATELEGILATIVE ASSEMBLY MAIN BUILDING Sl. No. Description A) CENTRAL CONTROL STATION & DIGITAL CONTROLLERS: 1.0 Supply, installation, testing & commissioning of the central control station consisting of the following : 1.0.1 1.0.2 1.0.3 1.0.4 1.1 1.2 1.3 2.0 a b. Intel machine Core - i7, 3GB RAM, 500GB HDD, CD/DVD- R/W drive and with necessarrySerial, parallel, and network communication ports and cables required for proper system operationetc as minimum. Colour Monitor TFT – 21 inch. Laser Printer Mouse & Keyboard UPS with 30 minutes SMF battery backup for BMS equipments in control room for power back up. BMS Contractor to decide the capacity keeping in view the power required by BMS panel. Software for centralized BMS control system alongwith required hardwares for interface between automation level and management level. The software will be web enabled for control and monitoring with licensing for minimum 5 nos. simultaneous web users. Make List HP/ IBM LG/ Samsung HP/ IBM HP/ IBM Emerson/ Luminus/ APC Honeywell WEBS/ Spyder/ TREND Web Based system interface modules consisting of gateways, other interface units required as per specifications. The units shall be housed in wall mounted MS cabinets. Standalone intelligent DDC controllers with 32 bit microprocessor For Chilled Water System For AHU's/TFA's/Ventillation Fan's Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND 376 c d e f 3.0 4.0 5.0 a b c d e f g 13. 0 a) b) c) d) 14.0 For Plumbing/Fire- Fighting/STP WTP For Transformers For HT Panel For LT Panel Supply, installation, testing & commissioning of communicating type room temperature control units for FCUs with digital display and 3 speed fan (With Chilled Water Only). Hand held portable operator terminal. Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ TREND Spyder/ Spyder/ Spyder/ Spyder/ Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Software Integration Chiller integrator (4 nos.) SCHWP system integrator (9 VFD Drives) Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Hydropneumatic System integrator (4 VFD Drives) DG System Integrator Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Fire Alarm System Integrator Energy Management System integrator nos energy meter) (42 FCU -84 No's Supply & installation of black enameled MS/GI conduits in recess/on surface including its accessories, junction pull boxes GI fish wire, fixing hardware etc including chasing the wall/floor and plastering the chased portion and making good the damages etc. complete as required. 25 mm dia MS conduit 20 mm dia MS conduit* 25 mm dia GI conduit* 20 mm dia GI conduit* 2 core 1.5 Sq.mm twisted, annealed tinned copper multistranded conductor PVC insulated, shielded communication cable(Controller to Controller). Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND Honeywell WEBS/ ALERTON/ Spyder/ TREND BEC/ BEC/ BEC/ BEC/ AKG AKG AKG AKG Polycab/ Finolex/ Fusion Polymer/ Varsha/ Bonton/ KEI 377 15. 0 2 core 1.5 Sq.mm, twisted pair, annealed tinned copper multistrand conductor PVC insulated, signal cable.(From field device to DDC). Polycab/ Finolex/ Fusion Polymer/ Varsha/ Bonton/ KEI 16. 0 3 core 1.5 Sq.mm armoured twisted pair, annealed tinned copper multistrand conductor PVC insulated cable. Polycab/ Finolex/ Fusion Polymer/ Varsha/ Bonton/ KEI 17. 0 3 core 1.5 Sq.mm twisted, annealed tinned copper multistrand conductor PVC insulated power cable. Polycab/ Finolex/ Fusion Polymer/ Varsha/ Bonton/ KEI 18. 0 B) 1. 0 4-pair Cat-6 solid insulated copper UTP cable CHILLER/ PUMPS/ COOLING /TOWER SYSTEM : Supply, installation, testing & commissioning of the following field sensors:- 3 Immersion type temperature sensor for measuring chilled water & condenser water temperature at the inlet & outlet of the chiller, condenser and cooling tower. Flow meter for measuring the chilled water through the common header. (Ultrsonic type) 4 Differential pressure switches across the pumps for indicating the pump status. 2 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Polycab/ Finolex/ Fusion Polymer/ Varsha/ Bonton/ KEI Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Shenitech/Honeywell Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Level switches for cooling tower /make up water tank high & low. Current relay for cooling tower fan run status. PH monitoring of cooling tower sump water TDS monitoring of cooling tower sump Veskler/ Sontay/ Filpro Situ/Setco/ABB Triton/Omicron Triton/Omicron Duct mounted temperature sensor for supply air temperature. Duct mounted temperature sensor for return air temperature. Differential pressure switches for monitoring Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder the air filter status. 12 13 Differential pressure switches across the blower Sensors for for indicating the measuring outside fan status. air temperature Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder 378 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 Current relays ( for ventilation & current relays Exhaust Fans) (for air washer) Differential pressure switch Level switches for Air Washer (DPDT pump run status. Differential type) for tanks. pressure switch Current relays for pump status. Flow meter for measuring the raw water Pressure in fire tank Flame proof level Transmitter (Ultrasonic Fuel flow switch switch type) Fuel flow meter Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Honeywell/ Alerton/ Spyder Situ/Setco/ ABB Shenitech/Hone ywell Honeywell/ Alerton/ Veskler/ Sontay/ Spyder Greisinger/Hone Filpro Greisinger/Hone ywell ywell VII) DATAPOINTSSUMMARYFORBUILDINGMANAGEMENTSYSTEM S.No. A) 1 Function Chilled water system Water Cooled Centrifugal Chillers with VFD Chiller On / Off command Common Chilled water supply / condenser water supply header temperature Common Chilled water return / condenser water return header temperature Chilled water return header flow rate Auto Manual Switch Chiller microprocessor (software) integration for Chiller-intrinsic parameter monitoring and VFD Integration with BMS Qty AI DI AO DO Remarks 4 4 2 2 1 4 Relay output Immersion Type Temperature Sensor Immersion Type Temperature Sensor Electromagnetic type Flowmeter Potential free contacts of selector switch. Software connectivity 379 Sub Total for Water Cooled Centrifugal Chillers with VFD 2 Primary Chilled Water Pumps (3W + 1S) Primary Chilled Water Pump on / off command Primary Chilled water Pump run Status 5 4 4 4 Primary Chilled water Pump trip Status 4 Auto Manual Switch 4 Secondary Chilled Water Pumps & VFD (6W + 3S) 0 4 Sub Total for Primary Chilled Water Pumps (3W + 1S) 3 4 0 12 Differential Pressure Switch Potential free contacts of contactor. Potential free contacts of selector switch. 0 4 9 Variable speed pumping system start/stop 9 Auto Manual Switch 9 Sub Total for Secondary Chilled Water Pumps & VFD (6W + 3S) 5 Condenser Water Pumps (3W + 1S ) Condenser Water Pump on / off command Condenser Water Pump run Status 0 4 4 Auto Manual Switch 4 0 12 0 Relay output Differential Pressure Switch Potential free contacts of contactor. Potential free contacts of selector switch. 4 4 4 4 4 8 2 4 CT Make Up Water Tank Level (high/low) Auto manual switch Sub Total for Cooling Tower (AC) Sub Total for Chilled water system AHUs/TFA/FCUs/Ventilation Systems 9 4 Condenser Chilled water Pump trip Status Sub Total for CDW pumps Cooling Tower (AC) (3W + 1S ) Cooling Tower fans on / off command Cooling Tower fan run status 0 4 Trip Status Cooling Tower sump water (low/high level) B) 9 Relay output in VSPS panel for each set of pump. Potential free contacts in VSPS. Software connectivity panel for each set of pump Secondary CHW Pumps microprocessor (software) integration for intrinsic parameter control & monitoring 4 Relay output 0 5 22 59 0 0 4 25 Relay output Current relay Potential free contacts. Level Switch Level Switch Potential free contacts of selector switch. 380 1 2 OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY: Outside air relative humidity monitoring Outside air temp monitoring Sub Total for Outside Air Temp. and Humidity Horizontal AHU's with Mixing Box 1 1 2 19 19 19 19 28 28 28 28 84 28 Relay output Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Duct mount temp sensor Output signal from the DDC Controller Potential free contacts of selector switch. 28 10 10 TFA air flow/filter status TFA Fan run Status 10 10 10 Supply Air Temperature monitoring 2 Way Modulating Valve for Chilled water Line. 10 10 Auto manual switch FCU start/stop Room temperature sensor with setpoint override 19 28 28 Sub Total for AHUs (ceiling suspended) with Mixing Box 5 19 28 Auto manual selector switch Sub Total for TFA with Mixing Box Fan Coil Units 57 Relay output Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Duct mount temp sensor Output signal from the DDC Controller Potential free contacts of selector switch. 28 Fan Start/Stop Return Air Filter Status Run Status Return Air Temperature monitoring 2 Way Modulating Valve for Chilled water Line. TFA with Mixing Box TFA on / off command 0 19 19 Sub Total for Horizontal AHU's with Mixing Box 4 0 19 Auto manual selector switch AHUs (ceiling suspended) with Mixing Box 0 19 Fan Start/Stop Return Air Filter Status Run Status Return Air Temperature monitoring 2 Way Modulating Valve for Chilled water Line. 3 Outside Air RH Sensor Outside Air Temp Sensor 10 30 10 10 Relay output Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Diff. Pressure Switch - Air Duct mount temp sensor Output signal from the DDC Controller Potential free contacts of selector switch. 31 Relay output Communicating type room temperature control unit 381 Communicating type room temperature control unit Chilled / Hot Water Valve start/stop 6 Sub Total for Fan Coil Units VENTILATION AND EXHAUST FANS: 7 Fan run status Fan Start/Stop Sub Total for Ventilation/Exhaust Fan AIR WASHERS SPRAY TYPE 0 PLUMBING/FIRE FIGHTING / STP/WTP Water treatment plant and tanks 2 Underground Water Tank & Sumps High/low Level Monitoring Overhead Water Tank High/low Level Monitoring Flow measurement in the inlet header of Fire/Raw water tank Pumps Status (WTP) Pumps Start/Stop(WTP) Pump auto manual selector switch(WTP) Sub Total for Water treatment plant and tanks Water Bodies Pump Start/Stop Pump Status Pump Auto manual selector switch Sub Total for Water Bodies 3 0 0 62 0 62 0 62 62 Current relay Relay output 4 Air Washer Start/Stop Air Washer run Status Air Washer pump run Status Sub Total for Air Washers Sub Total for AHUsTFA/FCUs/Ventilation Systems C) 1 0 62 4 0 4 4 8 0 4 59 241 57 123 Relay output Current relay Differential pressure switch 7 14 Level Switch 12 24 Level Switch 1 3 3 3 1 44 0 3 2 0 2 2 4 0 Electromagnetic type Flow meter Differential pressure switch Relay output. Potential free contacts. Relay output Current Relay Potential free contacts. 2 HSD Storage and supply system Day oil tank Tank(6) High/Low Level 12 HSD Pump Start/Stop HSD Transfer Pump Status HSD Fuel Flow Status 4 4 4 HSD Fuel Flow Meter 3 Auto Manual Switch 4 Flameproof Level Switch / controllers by others Relay output. Current relay Fuel Flow Switch. Fuel Flow Meter (By HSD Contractor). Potential free contactsof selector switch 382 Sub Total for HSD Storage and supply system 4 Hydro-Pneumatic System 0 27 0 4 4 4 VFD Start/Stop 4 VFD auto manual selector switch Variable speed Pump System integration with BMS Sub Total for Hydro-Pneumatic System 5 6 7 0 Sump pump Sump Pump Start/Stop Sump Pump Status Sump pump Auto manual switch Sub Total for Sump Pumps 1 2 0 4 4 0 Sewage Treatment Plant (STP) Pump/Air Blower Start/Stop Pump/Air Blower Run Status Auto/Manual Selector Switch Sub Total for Sewage Treatment Plant 4 4 8 0 0 12 12 24 0 Relay output Current Relay Potential free contacts. 4 12 Relay Output Current Relay Potential Free Contacts 12 Fire Protection System Main Fire Pump Run Status 1 1 Diesel Fire Pump Run Status 1 1 Jockey Pump Run Status 2 2 Sprinkler Pump Run Status 1 1 Water Header pressure Sub Total for Fire Protection System Sub Total for PLUMBING/FIRE FIGHTING / STP/WTP D) 4 Potential free contacts in VSPS panel for each set of pumps Potential free contacts. Software connectivity DG SETS, TRANSFORMERS & FIRE ALARM DG SETS (5 Nos.) DG sets panel integration with BMS for intrinsic parameter monitoring. Sub Total for DG SETS Transformers (4 Nos.) Breakers status Current, Voltage, KWh, KVA, Pf, Frequency Monitoring Differential pressure switch Differential pressure switch Differential pressure switch Differential pressure switch Pressure Transmitter 1 1 5 0 0 2 116 0 29 5 Software Integration 0 0 0 0 4 4 Potential free contacts Integration with Multi function energy meter 383 Integration with Multi function energy meter Potential free contacts Energy consumption Bus Coupler status Sub Total for Transformers 3 4 5 6 Lifts 22 Nos. & Escalator - 2 Nos. Lift intrinsic parameter monitoring through software integration. Sub Total for Lifts Fire Alarm System Fire Alarm System microprocessor (software) integration for monitoring Sub Total for Fire Alarm System HT Panel (3) Breaker Status Sub Total for Fire Alarm System LT Panel (2) Breaker Status Sub Total for Fire Alarm System Sub Total for DG SETS , TRANSFORMERS & FIRE ALARM GRAND TOTAL Total Number of Data Points 0 5 9 0 0 24 Software integration 0 0 0 0 Software integration 0 0 0 0 0 13 13 0 0 0 0 36 36 58 0 0 0 0 66 474 57 177 774 3 Potential free contacts 2 Potential free contacts 384 TENDER SPECIFICATION FOR ACTIVE SWITCHING COMPONENTS PREFERED MAKE: CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT All Active Switching Component, FO Module , NMS will from Same OEM SN. Specification For Core Switch A 1 a b c d e f 2 a b c d e f g Port Density and Architecture Switch should be of non-blocking architecture for all ports from day 1 Chassis /Modular Switch should have minimum 8 universal slots The Switch should support Active – Active Cluster switching technology using VSS or equivalent technology. The proposed VSS or equivalent technology should support high availability for both Layer 2 and Layer 3 (RIP, RIPng, OSPF, OSPF v3) Including for IPVSS Multicasting (PIMtechnology v4,PIM v6) should for CCTV video The proposed or equivalent and VOIPseamless support applications. switch over of traffic between the chassis in case of any kind of link or hardware failure to ensure no traffic disruption for real time voice and video applications. The provision for VSS or equivalent Link or interconnection between 2 Chassis Switches should be of min.40Gbps with no single point of failure between the links. Interface/ port /card/software for the same should be provided from day 1. The switch should have following interface configuration from day1: a) 48 X GE UTP interface b) 6 X 10GbE SFP+ interface Performance 350Mpps or higher forwarding rate. Extensive wire-speed traffic classification for ACLs and QoS Support Jumbo frame Support Wire-speed multicasting 620 Gbps or higher Switching Fabric Min. 64K MAC addresses , support 4096 VLANs Switch should have inbuilt mechanism for proactively monitoring about any malfunction like power supply or internal temperature (full internal environment). 3 a Reliability Dual hot swappable PSUs with 1 + 1 redundancy (Populated) b c 4 a Hot-swappable modules Hot swappable fan modules Standards IEEE 802.2 (LLC) Compliance YES/NO Remarks 385 b c d e f g h i j 5 a b c d e f 6 a b c d e 7 a b c d e f g h i k 8 a b c IEEE 802.1v VLAN classification IEEE 802.1Q IEEE 802.1ad (Q-in-Q),VLAN stacking IEEE 8023ae IEEE 802.3x flow control IEEE 802.3z (1000 Base X) IEEE 802.1p Priority Tagging IEEE 802.3ab IEEE 802.3an (10 Base T) Resiliency STP, RSTP, MSTP (801s) Link Aggregation (803ad) groups Loop Protection and Loop Detection Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection technology shall have the high reliability functionality to handle dual failures and ensure the convergence of less than 50ms in case of more than one link broken in the ring. The proposed Ring protection technology shall be capable of handling data loop whose path traverse more than a single ring and the loop occurs when there is a break in a physical segment that is shared by two rings. Routing Should support RIP and RIPng from day 1 Should support VRRP and VRRPv3 from Day 1 Should support OSPF and OSPFv3 from day 1 Should support BGP and BGP4 for IPv6 from day 1 Support Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) and Equal Cost Multi-Path (ECMP) routing from day 1 IPv6 Features:IPv4 and IPv6 Dual Stack IPv6 Management ,IPv6 ACL (hardware based) SNMPv6,Telnet v6,SSHv6 NTPv6 Client and server (for time synchronization) RFC 2464 for IPv6 packet transmission over Ethernet network Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (SLAAC) RFC 3596 DNS Extension Internet Control Message protocol (ICMPv6) Should support IPv6 Addressing Architecture Multicast Support Bootstrap Router for IGMP v1,IGMP v2, IGMPv3,IGMP Query Solicitation ,MLD Snooping (MLDv1,MLDv2), MLD for IPv6,PIMv4-SM,PIM-DM,PIM-SSM RFC 4607 Source specific multicast Interoperability Rules for Multicast Routing Protocols 386 9 a b c d e f g h 10 a b c d e f 11 a b c d e f 12 a Security Support 802.1x support Should Support Dynamic & Private VLANs , Guest VLAN Network Access and Control (NAC) features or equivalent to manage end point security BPDU Protection and STP Root Guard, Access Control List based on Layer 3 and layer 4, Dynamic VLAN RFC 2865 RADIUS, TACACS + and RFC 2866 RADIUS accounting Should support MAC address filtering and MAC limiting functionality. The switch should support detection of Denial of Service (DoS) attack. MD5 Message-Digest algorithm , IP authentication using keyed MD5 of Service Quality Policy based QoS features traffic classification on priority requirement Mixed scheduling or equivalent to support complex traffic queuing requirements 8 QoS queues per port and support Voice VLAN,LLDP-MED Diffserv, Strict Priority, Round Robin. Access Control Lists (ACLs) and IEEE 802.1p Priority Tagging Management : GUI, Telnet, Industry-standard CLI with built-in Help-menu Should support software release files, configuration and other files to be stored for backup with SD card or USB drives. Port mirroring and RMON ( 4 Groups) Out of band 10/100/1000 Ethernet management port and console management port SSH and SNMPv3 for secure management, DDM – Optical digital diagnostic monitoring as per SFF – 8472 or equivalent standards NTP , Syslog and sFlow or equivalent Electrical Approvals and Compliances Restrictions on Hazardous Substances (RoHS) Compliance and Energy Efficient Ethernet compliant (EEE) compliance 387 B. Distribution Switch S.No 1 a b c d e f g h i j k 2 a b c 3 a b c Technical specification Advanced Multi Layer switch. 48 * 10/100/1000T with Min 4 * SFP + Ports to accommodate 1G or 10 G fiber module (single mode /multimode) for flexibility to choose. IEEE 802.1AX Link aggregation (static and LACP) IEEE 802.3ad Static and dynamic link aggregation IEEE 802.3x Flow control - full duplex operation Should support Active – Active Clustering - VSS or equivalent technology for high availability and quick resiliency. Card/Interface/Port/software/cable should be provided fromfor dayVSS one. The provision or equivalent Link or interconnection between 2 Switches should be of min.40Gbps with no single point of failure between the links The proposed VSS technology or equivalent should support high availability for both Layer 2 and Layer 3 (RIP, RIPng, OSPF, OSPF v3) Including for IP Multicasting (PIM v4,PIM v6) for CCTV video applications. The VSS or equivalent technology should support real time data mirroring on diversified location (min 800 Meters) as required. The switch must support Internal load sharing Dual power supplies , vendors shall propose for Internal Redundant PSU ' s The proposed VSS or equivalent technology shall support Link Aggregation between different members in an Active The switch shall be POE / POE + Compliant in –accordance Active cluster for high reliability to IEEE standards 802.3af and 802.3at .Min PoE power Budget should be min 370 watt. Performance Specifications Min 176Gbps of switching capacity Min 130 Mpps Switching throughput Min 16K Address Table Resiliency Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection technology shall have the high reliability functionality to handle dual failures and ensure the convergence of less than 50ms in case of more The Ring protection technology shall be thanproposed one link broken in the ring. capable of handling data loop whose path traverse more than a single ring and the loop occurs when there is a break in a physical segment that is shared by two rings. Compliance (Yes / NO) Remarks 388 d e f g h 4 a b c d e 5 a b c d e f g h i j k l 6 a b c d e f g Loop Detection and Loop protection Control Plane Prioritization (CPP) Dynamic link failover Should Support VRRP v2 and VRRP v3 RSTP , MSTP VLAN VTP / GVRP VLAN creation based on protocol ,Port and Subnet based IEEE 802.1Q Virtual LAN Q In Q Up to 4K configurable VLAN ' s Layer 3 Features Equal Cost Multi Path (ECMP) routing, PIMv4-SM, PIMDM, PIM-SSM – from day one. RIP v2 , OSPF v2, OSPF v3, ECMP(Equal Cost Multipath) - from day one. OSPF Graceful restart Policy-based routing Route redistribution (OSPF, RIP) ICMP router discovery messages Classless Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR) Domain Name System (DNS) and DNS Relay RIPng for IPv6 from day one PIMv6-SM and OSPF v3 Graceful restart DHCP Client / Relay DHCP Server Security Access Control Lists (ACLs) Guest VLANs for enforcing security policies BPDU protection DHCP snooping, IP source guard and Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) IP source guard or equivalent Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) Dynamic allocation of multiple VLAN s on one port for different user/devices 389 h i j k l m n O P Q R S t 7 a b c d e f 9 a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p 10 a Network Access and Control (NAC) features or equivalent to manage end point security Port-based learn limits (intrusion detection) or equivalent MAC address filtering and MAC address lock-down Private VLANs provide security and port isolation Secure Copy (SCP) Strong password security and encryption MAC-based, web-based IEEE 802.1x authentication IEEE 802.1x with Web Authentication client monitoring SSH , SSLv2 ,SSLv3 , SCP TACACS+ accounting and authentication DoS attack blocking RSTP Root Guard MD5 Message-Digest algorithm, IP authentication using keyed MD5. Quality of service IEEE 802.1p DSCP Prioritization Policy-based QoS based classifying traffic based on MAC , Port , VLAN , Protocol . ASIC based remarking capabilities Tail drop for queue congestion control Strict priority/ weighted round robin IPv6 Features Path MTU discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Router Discovery IPv6 Router Advertisement IPv6 Router Advertisement Guard Transmission of IPv6 packets over Ethernet networks Default address selection for IPv6 DNS extensions to support IPv6 Unique local IPv6 unicast addresses Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) Neighbor discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Stateless Address Auto-Configuration (SLAAC) IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) flags option IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) guard IPv4 and IPv6 Dual stack DHCP Client / Relay for IPv6 DHCP server for IPv6 Management Features SNMPv1, v2c and v3 390 B. Distribution Switch S.No 1 a b c d e f g h i j k 2 a b c 3 a b d c Technical specification Advanced Multi Layer switch. 48 * 10/100/1000T with Min 4 * SFP + Ports to accommodate 1G or 10 G fiber module (single mode /multimode) for flexibility to choose. IEEE 802.1AX Link aggregation (static and LACP) IEEE 802.3ad Static and dynamic link aggregation IEEE 802.3x Flow control - full duplex operation Should support Active – Active Clustering - VSS or equivalent technology for high availability and quick resiliency. Card/Interface/Port/software/cable should be provided from day one. The provision for VSS or equivalent Link or interconnection between 2 Switches should be of min.40Gbps with no single point of failure between the links The proposed VSS technology or equivalent should support high availability for both Layer 2 and Layer 3 (RIP, RIPng, OSPF, OSPF v3) Including for IP Multicasting (PIM v4,PIM v6) for CCTV video applications. The VSS or equivalent technology should support real time data mirroring on diversified location (min 800 Meters) as required. The switch must support Internal load sharing Dual power supplies , vendors shall propose for Internal Redundant PSU ' s The proposed VSS or equivalent technology shall support Link Aggregation between different members in an Active – Active cluster for high reliability The switch shall be POE / POE + Compliant in accordance to IEEE standards 802.3af and 802.3at .Min PoE power Budget should be min 370 watt. Performance Specifications Min 176Gbps of switching capacity Min 130 Mpps Switching throughput Min 16K Address Table Resiliency Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection technology shall have the high reliability functionality to handle dual failures and ensure the convergence lessprotection than 50mstechnology in case of more The proposedofRing shall be capable of than one link broken in the ring. handling data loop whose path traverse more than a single ring and loop occurs whenprotection there is a break in a Loopthe Detection and Loop physical segment that is shared by two rings. Compliance (Yes / NO) Remarks 391 e Control Plane Prioritization (CPP) f Dynamic link failover g Should Support VRRP v2 and VRRP v3 h RSTP , MSTP 4 VLAN a VTP / GVRP b VLAN creation based on protocol ,Port and Subnet based c IEEE 802.1Q Virtual LAN d Q In Q e Up to 4K configurable VLAN ' s 5 Layer 3 Features b c Equal Cost Multi Path (ECMP) routing, PIMv4-SM, PIM- DM, PIMSSM – from day one. RIP v2 , OSPF v2, OSPF v3, ECMP(Equal Cost Multipath) - from day one. OSPF Graceful restart d Policy-based routing e Route redistribution (OSPF, RIP) f ICMP router discovery messages g Classless Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR) h Domain Name System (DNS) and DNS Relay i RIPng for IPv6 from day one j PIMv6-SM and OSPF v3 Graceful restart k DHCP Client / Relay l DHCP Server 6 Security a Access Control Lists (ACLs) a b Guest VLANs for enforcing security policies 392 c d e f g h i j BPDU protection DHCP snooping, IP source guard and Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) IP source guard or equivalent Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) Dynamic allocation of multiple VLAN s on one port for different user/devices Network Access and Control (NAC) features or equivalent to manage end point security Port-based learn limits (intrusion detection) or equivalent MAC address filtering and MAC address lock-down k Private VLANs provide security and port isolation l Secure Copy (SCP) m Strong password security and encryption n MAC-based, web-based IEEE 802.1x authentication O IEEE 802.1x with Web Authentication client monitoring P SSH , SSLv2 ,SSLv3 , SCP Q TACACS+ accounting and authentication R DoS attack blocking S RSTP Root Guard t 7 MD5 Message-Digest algorithm, IP authentication using keyed MD5. Quality of service a IEEE 802.1p b DSCP Prioritization c d Policy-based QoS based classifying traffic based on MAC , Port , VLAN , Protocol . ASIC based remarking capabilities e Tail drop for queue congestion control f Strict priority/ weighted round robin 9 IPv6 Features 393 a Path MTU discovery for IPv6 b IPv6 Router Discovery c IPv6 Router Advertisement d IPv6 Router Advertisement Guard e Transmission of IPv6 packets over Ethernet networks f Default address selection for IPv6 g DNS extensions to support IPv6 h Unique local IPv6 unicast addresses i Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) j Neighbor discovery for IPv6 k IPv6 Stateless Address Auto-Configuration (SLAAC) l IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) flags option m IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) guard n IPv4 and IPv6 Dual stack o DHCP Client / Relay for IPv6 p DHCP server for IPv6 10 Management Features a SNMPv1, v2c and v3 394 b c d e f g h i j k l m n 0 11 a b IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) Web GUI sFlow or equivalent Industry-standard CLI with help menu and GUI CLI script option Built-in text editor User-based Security Model (USM) for SNMPv3 View-based Access Control Model (VACM) for SNMP Console management port Port mirroring locally within switch and across VSS or equivalent cluster member TFTP , NTP And Syslog, An USB or equivalent memory card socket , allowing software release files, configuration and other files to be stored– for backup anddiagnostic distribution to other switches DDM Optical digital monitoring as per SFF – 8472 or equivalent standards Built in Self-Test Multicast Support IGMP query solicitation IGMP snooping v1 , v2 and v3 a IGMP Querier and IGMP Snooping Quereier MLD snooping (v1 and v2) MLD Querier IGMP/MLD multicast forwarding (IGMP/MLD proxy) , IGMP Snooping Fast - leave , IGMP Filtering , IGMP snooping report suppression , IGMP source address check PIM neighbor filtering , IGMP static entries PIM for IPv6 , MLD Filtering , MLD Snooping fast leave , MLD snooping static mrouter ports , MLD snooping report suppression PIM - SSM Pro Active Intelligence features Event-based triggers allow user-defined scripts to be executed upon selected system events based on Time , Date , day and Event based b c The switch shall have pro active intelligence to create an ICMP polling for service reachability based on IP address and configure pro active action upon loss or re establishment of the service reachability Eco-friendly mode c d e f g h i 12 d Switch should have inbuilt mechanism for proactively monitoring about any malfunction like power supply or internal temperature (full internal environment). 13 Voice over IP a LLDP-MED ANSI/TIA-1057 395 b Voice VLAN 14 Compliances a ROHS compliant is must b IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) c UL, cUL, TUV 396 C. Access Switch: (Type 1) S.No 1 a b c d e f g h i 2 a b c 3 a b d ec f g h 4 a b c d e f 5 6 aa Technical specification Managed Access switch. 48 * 10/100/1000T with Min 4 * SFP + Ports to accommodate 1G or 10 G fiber module (single mode /multimode) to choose. IEEE 802.1AX for Linkflexibility aggregation (static and LACP) IEEE 802.3ad Static and dynamic link aggregation IEEE 802.3x Flow control - full duplex operation Should support stacking for minimum 4 Nos of switches to be managed by a single IP . Should have flexibility for stacking on min 800 meters distance between members of individual Link aggregation acrossstack stackswitches memberas required. Port Mirroring across stack member The switch must support Internal load sharing Dual power supplies , vendors shall propose for Internal Redundant PSU ' s The switch shall be POE / POE + Compliant in accordance to IEEE standards 802.3af and 802.3at .Min PoE power Budget should be min 370 watt. Performance Specifications Min 176Gbps of switching capacity Min 130 Mpps Switching throughput Min 16K Address Table Resiliency Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or technology equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection shall have the high reliability to handle dual The proposed Ringfunctionality protection technology shall failures be and ensure the convergence of less than 50ms in case capable of handling whose path traverse Loop Detection and data Loop loop protection of more than a single ring and (CPP) the loop occurs when Control Plane Prioritization more than there is a one link broken in the ring. Dynamic link failover break in a physical segment that is shared by two rings VRRP v2 and VRRP v3 Scalable RSTP , MSTP VLAN VTP / GVRP VLAN creation based on protocol ,Port and Subnet based802.1Q Virtual LAN (VLAN) bridges IEEE IEEE 802.3ac VLAN tagging Q In Q scalable Up to 4K configurable VLAN ' s Scalable Layer 3 Features The proposed access switch shall be scalable to a full layer 3 switch supporting routing protocols RIP, OSPF, Security RIPng PIM andLists other Layer 3 Multicasting features Access, Control (ACLs) without changing the base hardware for future scalability / further expansion of the network. Compliance (Yes / NO) Remarks 397 bc d e f g hi j k l c 3 a b c d e f g h 4 a b c d e f 5 a 6 a b c d e f Guest VLANs for enforcing security policies BPDU protection DHCP snooping IP source guard Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) Dynamic allocation of multiple VLAN s on one port for different Access user/devices Network and Control (NAC) features or equivalent to manage point security Port-based learn limitsend (intrusion detection) MAC address filtering and MAC address lock-down Private VLANs provide security and port isolation Secure Copy (SCP) Min 16K Address Table Resiliency Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection technology shall have the high reliability functionality to handle dual failures and ensure the convergence of less than 50ms in case of moreproposed than oneRing link protection broken in the ring. The technology shall be capable of handling data loop whose path traverse more than a single ring and the loop occurs when there is a break in a physical that is shared by two rings Loop Detection andsegment Loop protection Control Plane Prioritization (CPP) Dynamic link failover VRRP v2 and VRRP v3 Scalable RSTP , MSTP VLAN VTP / GVRP VLAN creation based on protocol ,Port and Subnet based IEEE 802.1Q Virtual LAN (VLAN) bridges IEEE 802.3ac VLAN tagging Q In Q scalable Up to 4K configurable VLAN ' s Scalable Layer 3 Features The proposed access switch shall be scalable to a full layer 3 switch supporting routing protocols RIP, OSPF, RIPng , PIM and other Layer 3 Multicasting features without changing the base hardware for future Security scalability / further expansion of the network. Access Control Lists (ACLs) Guest VLANs for enforcing security policies BPDU protection DHCP snooping IP source guard Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) 398 g h i j k l m n p p q r s 7 a b b c d e 8 a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p 9 a b c d Dynamic allocation of multiple VLAN s on one port for different user/devices Network Access and Control (NAC) features or equivalent to manage end point security Port-based learn limits (intrusion detection) MAC address filtering and MAC address lock-down Private VLANs provide security and port isolation Secure Copy (SCP) Strong password security and encryption MAC-based, web-based IEEE 802.1x SSH , SSLv2 ,SSLv3 , SCP TACACS+ accounting and authentication DoS attack blocking RSTP Root Guard MD5 Message-Digest algorithm , IP authentication using keyed MD5 Quality of service IEEE 802.1p DSCP Prioritization Policy-based QoS based classifying traffic based on MAC , Portbased , VLANremarking , Protocolcapabilities . ASIC Taildrop for queue congestion control Strict priority/ weighted round robin IPv6 Features Path MTU discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Router Discovery IPv6 Router Advertisement IPv6 Router Advertisement Guard Transmission of IPv6 packets over Ethernet networks Default address selection for IPv6 DNS extensions to support IPv6 Unique local IPv6 unicast addresses Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) Neighbor discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Stateless Address Auto-Configuration (SLAAC) IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) flags option IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) guard IPv4 and IPv6 Dual stack DHCP Client / Relay for IPv6 DHCP server for IPv6 Management Features SNMPv1, v2c and v3 IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) Web GUI sFlow or equivalent 399 e f g h Industry-standard CLI CLI script option Built-in text editor User-based Security Model (USM) for SNMPv3 i j View-based Access Control Model (VACM) for SNMP Console management port Port mirroring locally with in switch and across different stack member in a stack TFTP , NTP And Syslog An USB or equivalent memory card socket , allowing software release files, configuration and other files to be stored for backup and distribution to other switches DDM – Optical digital diagnostic monitoring as per SFF – 8472 equivalent Built or in Self Test standards IPv6 Management features SNMP v6 , Telnet v6 , SSH v6 , NTP v6 and Trace Route v6 Multicast Support IGMP query solicitation IGMP snooping v1 , v2 and v3 IGMP Querier and IGMP Snooping Querier Pro Active Intelligence features Event-based triggers allow user-defined scripts to be executed upon selected system events based on Time , Date , day and Event based The switch shall have pro active intelligence to create an ICMP polling for service reachability based on IP address and configure pro active action upon loss or re establishment of the service reachability Eco-friendly mode k l m n o 10 a 11 a b c 12 a b c d 13 a b 14 a b c Switch should have inbuilt mechanism for proactively monitoring about any malfunction like power supply or internal temperature (full internal environment). Voice over IP LLDP-MED ANSI/TIA-1057 Voice VLAN Compliances ROHS compliant is must IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) UL, cUL, TUV 400 D. Access Switch: (Type 2) S.No Technical specification 1 Managed Access switch. 24 * 10/100/1000T with Min 4 * SFP + Ports to accommodate 1G or 10 G fiber module (single mode /multimode) to choose IEEE 802.1AX for Linkflexibility aggregation (static.and LACP) IEEE 802.3ad Static and dynamic link aggregation IEEE 802.3x Flow control - full duplex operation Should support stacking for minimum 4 Nos of switches to be managed by a single IP . Should have flexibility for stacking on min 800 meters distance between members of individual Link aggregation acrossstack stackswitches memberas required. Port Mirroring across stack member The switch must support Internal load sharing Dual power supplies , vendors shall propose for Internal Redundant PSU 's Performance Specifications Min 128Gbps of switching capacity Min 95 Mpps Switching throughput Min 16K Address Table Resiliency Sub 50Ms Resiliency for 10G ring based design as per the IEEE 802.17/RPR / ERPS or equivalent technology The proposed Ring protection technology shall have the high reliability functionality to handle dual failures and ensure the convergence of less than 50ms in case of more than one link broken in the ring.proposed Ring protection technology shall be The capable of handling data loop whose path traverse more than a single ring and the loop occurs when there is a break in a physical segment that is shared by two Loop Detection rings and Loop protection Control Plane Prioritization (CPP) Dynamic link failover VRRP v2 and VRRP v3 Scalable RSTP , MSTP VLAN VTP / GVRP VLAN creation based on protocol ,Port and Subnet based802.1Q Virtual LAN (VLAN) bridges IEEE IEEE 802.3ac VLAN tagging a b c d e f g h 2 a b c 3 a b c d e f g h 4 a b c d Compliance (Yes / NO) Remarks 401 e f 5 a 6 a b c d e f g h i j k l m n p p q r s 7 a b c d e f 8 a b c Q In Q scalable Up to 4K configurable VLAN ' s Scalable Layer 3 Features The proposed access switch shall be scalable to a full layer 3 switch supporting routing protocols RIP, OSPF, RIPng , PIM and other Layer 3 Multicasting features without changing the base hardware for future Security scalability / further of the network. Access Control Lists expansion (ACLs) Guest VLANs for enforcing security policies BPDU protection DHCP snooping IP source guard Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) Dynamic allocation of multiple VLAN s on one port for different user/devices Network Access and Control (NAC) features manage or equivalent end point security Port-based learn limits (intrusion detection) MAC address filtering and MAC address lock-down Private VLANs provide security and port isolation Secure Copy (SCP) Strong password security and encryption MAC-based, web-based IEEE 802.1x SSH , SSLv2 ,SSLv3 , SCP TACACS+ accounting and authentication DoS attack blocking RSTP Root Guard MD5 Message-Digest algorithm , IP authentication using keyed MD5 Quality of service IEEE 802.1p DSCP Prioritization Policy-based QoS based classifying traffic based on MAC , Portbased , VLANremarking , Protocolcapabilities . ASIC Taildrop for queue congestion control Strict priority/ weighted round robin IPv6 Features Path MTU discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Router Discovery IPv6 Router Advertisement 402 d e f g h i j k l m n o p 9 a b c d e f g h i j k l m n 10 a 11 a b c 12 a IPv6 Router Advertisement Guard Transmission of IPv6 packets over Ethernet networks Default address selection for IPv6 DNS extensions to support IPv6 Unique local IPv6 unicast addresses Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) Neighbor discovery for IPv6 IPv6 Stateless Address Auto-Configuration (SLAAC) IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) flags option IPv6 Router Advertisement (RA) guard IPv4 and IPv6 Dual stack DHCP Client / Relay for IPv6 DHCP server for IPv6 Management Features SNMPv1, v2c and v3 IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) Web GUI sFlow or Equivalent Industry-standard CLI CLI script option Built-in text editor User-based Security Model (USM) for SNMPv3 View-based Access Control Model (VACM) for SNMP Console management port Port mirroring locally with in switch and across different stack member in a stack TFTP , NTP And Syslog An USB or equivalent memory card socket , allowing software release files, configuration and other files to be stored backup anddiagnostic distribution to other switches DDM – for Optical digital monitoring as per SFF – 8472 or equivalent features standards IPv6 Management SNMP v6 , Telnet v6 , SSH v6 , NTP v6 and Trace Route v6 Multicast Support IGMP query solicitation IGMP snooping v1 , v2 and v3 IGMP Querier and IGMP Snooping Querier Pro Active Intelligence features Event-based triggers allow user-defined scripts to be executed upon selected system events based on Time , Date , day and Event based 403 b c d 13 a b 14 a b c The switch shall have pro active intelligence to create an ICMP polling for service reach ability based on IP address and configure pro active action upon loss or re establishment Eco-friendly modeof the service reach ability Switch should have inbuilt mechanism for proactively monitoring about any malfunction like power supply or internal temperature (full internal environment). Voice over IP LLDP-MED ANSI/TIA-1057 Voice VLAN Compliances ROHS compliant is must IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) UL, cUL, TUV E. FO Module: Specification SN. G a b c 10G SFP+ Fiber Pluggable Module ( Single Mode) Data Rate: 10 Gbps, Connector Type: LC, Wave Length: 1310nm,Distance Support: 10 KM Should support Digital optical Monitoring, Hot Swappable, RoHS Compliant Environment Operating Temperature: -5 To 70 Degree C, Operating Humidity:0% to 85% (non-condensing) Compliance YES/NO Remarks F. Network Management Software: Specification SN. J a b Specifications of NMS software: Automatic topology discovery and creation of network maps for Layer 3 and Layer 2 network , All the available VLANS have high level Network Inventory polling Should capability for IP Network nodes, All available line cards , Modules , ports , Physical links , VLAN interfaces and all the Compliance YES/NO Remarks 404 other SNMP capable devices in the network c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r Should have powerful administration control Detailed performance monitoring and management Should have extensive fault manage men capabilities with Real time Event and Alarm notifications , System Logs and Audit trials Creation and management of security and QOS policies Scheduled Device configuration back-up and restore functionality Automatic Detection of configuration changes for easy trouble shooting and Isolation Should support 3rd party devices and end points Should have the functionality of Group provisioning / Scheduled configuration roll out management Should have the ability to perform scheduled or Unscheduled network wide software or Firmware upgrades Should have the ability to customize the NMS dash boards as per the requirements Should have the ability to perform / create group of devices for applying same task Should have extensive Event notification capability Should provide the flexibility to the network administrator to assign task to an Individual network engineer and assign / track the statustrouble of the issue resolution Shouldownership have extensive centralized shooting tools in built The NMS solution should be preferably from the same Active switching vendor , in case vendors proposing for 3rd party NMS solution should provide all the interoperability reports certified by both the NMS vendor and Active switching vendor on seamless All the required Hardware / Software for the NMS interoperability solution should be proposed by the bidder 405 G. AAA/RADIUS Server Solution: Specification SN. a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s Radius server should work in high available with N + 1 high availability with no single point of failure. Support for 802.1X Based Device Authentication Support for MAC Based Authentication Captive portal Access Support for Certificate based authentication Native Data base must support minimum 1000 end points scalable to minimum 4500 end points Should support Encryption based on Digital Signature algorithm or equivalent functional encryption protocols Should be on Unix/Linux/BSD based. Standards-based and vendor-agnostic, interfacing seamlessly with network access equipment from different vendors Should Adhere strictly to Radius/ AAA open standards Authentication Protocols to support EAP - TLS , TTLS , PAP Should and MDbe 5 compatible and interoperability, supporting current and future network configurations Should seamlessly integrate with the switching solution proposed for AAA and Dynamic VLAN allocation for roamingsupport user profiles Should Dynamic Statistics and reports to track / View all the authentication requests / track the duration of user connection Radius Provide high levelwith visibility toaccounting Administrators to track who logged onto or disconnected from the RADIUS server / network Should support IPv6 The Radius server should be proposed in high available mode with no single point of failure. In case of the primary server failure the secondary server should seamlessly take over with zerosolution network disruption The Radius server should be preferably from the same Active switching vendor , in case vendors proposing for 3rd party Radius server solution should provide all the interoperability reports certified by both the RAIDUS server vendor and Active vendor, on In case of 3rd partyswitching Radius solution theseamless OEM should interoperability have local presence in India and also should authorize the bidder participating Compliance YES/NO Remarks 406 PROJECT : PROPOSED NEW STATE LEGISLATIVE ASSEMBLY OF ASSAM - MAIN BUILDING MAKE LIST FOR ACTIVE & PASSIVE COMPONENTS OF NETWORKING SYSTEM AND IP TELEPHONE SYSTEM Sl. D No. e A PART - I : ACTIVE COMPONENTS s MAIN BUILDING c L3 Core Switch r Advanced Modular / Chassis Switch with 8 x i 60Gbps Expansion Bays (PSU not included), p Required t 1 Hot-swappable AC load sharing PSU i o n Advanced Layer 3 License Unit Qty. Make List No. 1 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT Nos. 2 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT No. 1 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT IPv6 Pack License (IPv6 Static Routes, Management, RIPng, MLD Snooping) No. 1 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 12x 10/100/1000TX expansion module Nos. 4 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 2 x 10GbE SFP+ slots (unpopulated) expansion module Nos. 3 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 4 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 4 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 4 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT Distruburion Switch Stackable Gigabit Layer 3 Switch with PoE+ Nos. 2 48x10/100/1000T + 4xSFP+ slots, internal Dual AC PSU 1m Stacking cable (includes 2 stacking modules) Nos. L3 Premium License Nos. Access Switch (Type 1) Stackable Gigabit Layer 3 Switch with PoE+ Nos. 3 48x10/100/1000T + 4xSFP+ slots, internal Dual AC PSU 1m Stacking cable (includes 2 stacking modules) Nos. Access Switch (Type 2) Stackable Gigabit Layer 2+/3 Switch with 4 24x10/100/1000T + 4xSFP+ slots, internal Dual AC PSU Nos. 3 3 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 2 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT 407 1m Stacking cable (includes 2 stacking modules) 5 FO Module 10km 1310nm 10GBase-LR SFP+ - Hot Swappable NMS 6 NMS Enterprise Edition Server Software , License key for NMS Enterprise Edition 100 Starter. Supports 100 managed nodes (or RADIUS/AAA Server subscriber CPEs) andSolution 5 NMS 7 RADIUS clients Server for 1000 Users B PART II: ENCLOSURES Wall Mount ENCLOSU Enclosure, 800mmW CYBERACK 42U/ RE 8 800mmD ( CRCA Steel Frame with Alumunium Profiles & Side Panel-2Nos with following items: W all Mount - Top cover APW President with cable15U entry /500D -1no;1 Section Front Glass Door 600mmW 15U with lock Bottom cover with cable entry 1no; 19” Horizontal Cable manager, 1U Fans 230 VAC 90 cfm Mounting Angles –with 2 pairs; Finish : Powder PDU 6 x 5/15amp 16AMP MCB and indicator Hardware front panel (10 nos/pkt) coated to 80 microns; Matt finish; Color Black FLEXIBOX 19", 9U/500mmD with front glass door Horizontal PDU 6 x 5amp with 5AMP fuse & Cable manager, indicator and 1.5meter feed1U cable and 10 Horizontal 3 pin plug Cantlever Shelf, Fans 230 VAC 90255mmD cfm Hardware front panel (10 nos/pkt) 2 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT Nos. 10 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT No. 1 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT No. 1 CISCO/JUNIPER OR EQUIVALENT No. 1 APW PRESIDENT/ RITTAL Nos. 7 APW PRESIDENT/ RITTAL Nos. 2 APW PRESIDENT/ RITTAL 408 Sl. No A 1 Description PART II: PASSIVE COMPONENTS COPPER CABLE COMPONENTS Solid Cable Cat 6, 4 pair, UTP, 305m box must have Fire retardant PVC Compound (FRPVC) Flame Rating material, All cables meet and exceed Category 6/Class E requirements in ANSI/TIA-568-C.2, and ISO/IEC 11801. Must be RoHS Compliant Unit Qty. Make List Mtr. 10370 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP Nos. 8 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP 2 Patch panel UTP 24 ports Unloaded, 1U with Steel-fully power coated. Performance as per ANSI/TIA-568-C.2 category 6 and ISO/IEC-11801 Class E.Performance guaranteed upto 600 MHz extended frequency, with Performance verified by ETL. UL listed as per UL94V-0 rated plastic. RoHS Compliant (lead free). Bezel must be High Impact flame retardant plastic. 3 Patch panel UTP 48 ports Unloaded, 2U with Steel-fully power coated. Performance as per ANSI/TIA-568-C.2 category 6 and ISO/IEC-11801 Class E.Performance guaranteed upto 600 MHz extended frequency, with Performance verified by ETL. UL listed as per UL94V-0 rated plastic. RoHS Compliant (lead free). Bezel must be High Impact flame retardant plastic. Nos. 2 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 4 Cat 6 unshielded copper RJ-45 keystone jack includes high performance Category 6 snap in 8-position/8-contact (8P8C) collapsible shutter jack to prevent dust entering the jack. conforming to IEC 606037-2. The jacks are designed for fast and easy snap-in and out of wall plates and patch panels. All jacks are designed in a 180° form and are available with back interconnection of krone IDC blocks. Performance as per ANSI/TIA-568-C.2 category 6 and ISO/IEC-11801 Class E, Performance guaranteed upto 600 MHz extended frequency, Performance verified by ETL UL listed as per UL94V-0 rated plastic, RoHS Compliant (lead free). Required for Face Plate Nos. 259 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 409 5 1m Cat 6 UTP Patch Cord moulded and factory crimped. Unshielded Twisted Pair, Category 6, ANSI / TIA 568-C.2. 24-26 AW G , multi - stranded copper with Flame Retardant Polyethylene Insulation 6 2m Cat 6 UTP Patch Cord moulded and factory crimped. Unshielded Twisted Pair, Category 6, ANSI / TIA 568-C.2. 24-26 AW G , multi - stranded copper with Flame Retardant Polyethylene Insulation 7 Single Port Faceplate for collapsible shutter jack, Conforms to CAT6 W ork Area Data I/O Outlet (RJ45) adhering to ANSI / TIA 568-C.2 , ISO/IEC 11801(2002) and CENELEC EN50173-1 (2002) specifications 8 BACK BOX -(Surface Mount Box) For Single and Dual 9 384 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 259 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 259 SchneiderDigilink/ SystimaxCompscope/ Simon Nos. 259 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP Cat 6 unshielded copper RJ-45 keystone jack includes high performance Category 6 snap in 8-position/8-contact (8P8C) collapsible shutter jack to prevent dust entering the jack. conforming to IEC 606037-2. The jacks are designed for fast and easy snap-in and out of wall plates and patch panels. All jacks are designed in a 180° form and are available with back interconnection of krone IDC blocks. Performance as per ANSI/TIA-568-C.2 category 6 and ISO/IEC-11801Class E, Performance guaranteed upto 600 MHz extended frequency, Performance verified by ETL UL listed as per UL94V-0 rated plastic, RoHS Compliant (lead free). Required for Face Plate 20 mm PVC conduit medium duty non FRLS Nos. 259 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 3000 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 11 SC-LC type SM 2m. Available in either 1.6mm or 3mm simplex or Duplex Zipcord. Single Mode mode 9/125 250 micron primary coated buffers. Nos. 10 Schneider/Systi max- Compscope/ Tyco AMP 12 Rack mount LIU 12 PORT 1U,Sliding type, UNLOADED with Splice Tray and Cable spool. LIU should accommodate up to 24 connections in only 1U (1.75”), Suitable for both 19” frames, Security fastened patch 5 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP 10 Nos. Nos. Nos. Mtr. Nos. 410 13 cords can exit to left or right, Metal Box and Splice tray must have Aluminium powder coated. Must have Fire retardant plastic for LIU. It should be RoHS Compliant 1x6 SC Adaptor Module Panel - SIMPLEX Nos. 5 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP 14 ADAPTOR SC SM SIMPLEX Nos. 60 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP 15 PIGTAIL SC SM (9um) SIMPLEX LENGTH- 1m Nos. 60 Schneider/SystimaxCompscope/ Tyco AMP 16 16.1 MS powder coated Raceway MS powder coated Raceway: 200 mm X 50 mm (2mm thickness). Civil work will be extra. Mtr. 250 Reputed 16.2 MS powder coated Raceway: 150 mm X 50 mm (2mm thickness). Civil work will be extra. Mtr. 50 Reputed 16.3 MS powder coated Raceway: 100 mm X 50 mm (2mm thickness). Civil work will be extra. Mtr. 110 Reputed 17 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 7 24 17 34 Reputed Reputed Reputed Reputed 1 1.1 Junction Box Junction Box of size 350 mm X 350 mm Junction Box of size 250 mm X 250 mm Junction Box of size 200 mm X 200 mm Junction Box of size 150 mm X 150 mm PART III: IP Telephone system IPT IPV6 ready 1.2 Nos. Nos. Nos. Nos. No. 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT Voice gateways with IPV6 ready No. 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 1.3 Hardware - 08 port analog trunk card No. 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 1.4 Hardware - 01 port ISDN PRI card 2 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 2 2.1 License IP User License for 125 nos of telephone sets Set 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 2.2 Attendant console License - One hard console Set 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 3 IP Phone handset Nos. 411 3.1 IP Based Managerial phones (Same make of EPABX vendor) with 10 keys , IPV6 ready, color display: Minimum 1/4 VGA, 240 x 320 pixels, 16.7 M colors, backlight,1 GB data port for PC connectivity, Embedded wireless blue tooth handset with 2 pins charge contact and blue tooth headset support, PoE ready Nos. 20 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 3.2 IP Based Managerial phones (Same make of EPABX Vendor) with minimum 6 keys , Display : Monochrome graphical with minimum 20 characters, 75 x 12 mm black & W hite, 10/100 fast ethernet data port for PC connectivity, PoE ready Nos. 105 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 4 4.1 Attendant Console IP hard console (same make of EPABX vendor), POE Ready, IPV6 ready , minimum 40 BLF keys, color display : Minimum 1/4 VGA, 240 x 320 pixels, 16.7 M colors, Backlight, 1GB Data port for PC connectivity. 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 5 5.1 Headset for Attendant Console Corded BiNaural Voice Tube Headset compatible with Hard console of OEM Voice Guidance Multi-Lingual voice guidenance facility for system features PC for IPT system administration PC compatible with above configuration for system administration complete with relevant OS 3 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT Set 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT Set 1 CISCO OR EQUIVALENT 6 6.1 7 7.1 No. Nos. 412 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION FOR INTERNAL SANITARY INSTALLATION WORKS AT DISPUR, GUWAHATI, ASSAM 413 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION FOR SANITARY INSTALLATION WORKS GENERAL REQUIREMENTS : 1.0 The installation shall be carried out in conforming with the requirements of relevant bye-laws of Municipal and other Authorities in whose jurisdiction, the work is being carried out and also with specification laid down by Indian Standards in this codes and National Building Code of Practice - No. SP : 7 - 1983 (Part IX) plumbing services. 1.1 RULES & REGULATIONS : All materials, supply, erection, testing and commissioning shall comply with the requirements of the relevant Indian Standards & Codes of Practice as given below : I.S. : 2556 : Vitreous china sanitary fixture. I.S. : 2065 - 1988 : Code of Practice for water supply in Building. I.S. : 5329 (Latest Edition.) : Code of Practice for sanitary pipe work above ground. I.S. : 1742 - 1983. : Building drainage. I.S. : 1172 - 1983. : Basic requirement for water supply, drainage and sanitation. I.S. : 3969 – 1970/1729-1964 : Specification of sand cast iron spigot and socket soil, waste, vent pipe and fitting. I.S. : 1239 (Part - I ) - 1990. : M.S. Tubes and fittings - galvanised as per I.S. : 4736 - 1986. I.S. : 1536 - 1976 & I.S. : 1537 - 1976. : Centrifugally cast (spun) pressure pipes and fittings. I.S. : 782 - 1982 : Specification for caulking lead. I.S. : 458. : Concrete pipes. I.S. : 4984. : H.D. polythene pipes for potable work. I.S. : I.S. : 780. 5961 - 1961. : : Sluice valves. C.I. gratings for drainage purpose. I.S. : 1726. : C.I. manhole covers and frame. I.S. : 5455 - 1969. : C.I. steps for manholes. I.S. : 651 - 1980. : Salt glazed stoneware pipes and fittings. I.S. : 783 - 1953. : Jointing concrete pipes. I.S. : 2379 - 1963. : Colour code for identification of pipe lines. I.S. : 4127 - 1983. : Laying of glazed stone ware pipe. 414 I.S : 3114. : 2. GENERAL: Quantities of lead and spun yarm for joint. All water supply, drainage and sanitary work shall be executed by a Licensed Plumbing Contractor and shall be in accordance with the requirement of relevant bye-laws of Municipal or other Authorities in whose jurisdiction the work is being carried out. The diameter of pipes and fittings wherever mentioned shall mean the internal diameter, unless otherwise specified. Unless otherwise specified, all exposed pipe work (within duct/outside) such as Centrifugal cast iron spun pipe H.C.I. soil, waste pipes and fittings, C.I. water pipes and fittings shall be painted with one coat of red-oxide paint and two coats of synthetic enamel paint of approved colour and make. The job shall include the cost of making necessary chases, holes etc. in walls, floors and in other places and also making good on completion of the work. Any damage caused to floors, walls etc. during sanitary and plumbing works shall be made good by the contractor to the satisfaction of Site Engineer. 3. LICENSED SANITARY CONTRACTOR : The contractor, who will be entrusted with these works, must possess licenses (both water supply and drainage) of Municipalities concerned and must have minimum 15 years experience in executing similar nature and volume of works. The contractor must have an office with telephone facilities and adequate supervising staff. The supervising staff should be able to read the drawing, participate in technical discussion and carry out the works as per drawing in a proper workman like manner complying the relevant bye-laws. The contractor must be capable in preparing and obtaining sanction for house drainage and water supplying from Municipality and also to effect the sewer and water connection. All completion drawings to be drawn by the contractor (Auto Cad drawing) (5 Nos. hard copy and 2 Nos. C.D) 4. SCOPE OF WORK : The scope of work consist of the following works of the buildings : i) Handing, fitting and fixing carefully the sanitary fixtures, as per Tender. Documents drawing and instructions of Authorities concerned and effecting necessary pipe connections, testing etc. complete in all respects. ii) Supplying, fitting and fixing including jointing centrifugal cast iron spun pipe H.C.I/U.P.V.C soil, waste pipes and fittings complete. Prior to fixing, all pipes and fittings are to be properly checked by water test and internal surface of the H.C.I. pipes and fittings are to be painted with a coat of black bitumastic anti-corrosive paint. After fixing of pipes lines, the same are to be tested by smoke test to ensure the system is leak proof. Providing and fixing on basement ceiling C.I. spun pipe lines including jointing to connect all vertical soil, waste, pipe lines to outside sewerage and system. 415 5. iii) Supplying and fitting and fixing jointing G.I./C.P.V.C. water pipe lines, valves, cocks, pumps, etc. complete for the purpose. On completion the pipe lines are to be tested by Hydraulic Pressure Machine to ensure that the system is absolute leak proof. iv) Supplying, laying, jointing and fixing underground sewer lines, yard gullies, construction of inspection pits, etc. complete including testing and effecting sewer connection with manhole on nearby main sewer line. v) Providing all tools and equipments including testing machines required for testing and supporting & fixing devices so as to install the sanitary fittings, pipe lines etc. securely in position. METHOD OF MEASUREMENT : The following method of measurement will be followed unless otherwise settled : a) Sanitary fixtures, Water Heater etc. : These shall be measured as per actual number of units fixed. b) Soil Waste & Anti-siphon Pipes & Fittings : The measurement of pipes shall be taken along the centre line the pipe lines inclusive of fittings and joints. The number of fittings and special will not be measured separately as . No extra payment is admissible for testing of pipe lines. c) Water Supply Pipes & Fittings : The measurement shall be taken along the centre line of pipe lines inclusive of Specials. Number of fittings will not be measured separately. No extra payment is admissible for testing of pipe line. Number of valves, cocks, pumps etc. are to be measured separately. d) Under ground Sewer Lines : For sewer lines, measurement shall be recorded for the finished length of the pipe line including joints i.e. overall length of sewer line excluding the internal length of manholes. For yard gully connections, measurement shall be recorded between the joint of Y.G. and inside face of manhole. Number of manhole, pit and yard gullies etc. are to be measured separately. No extra payment is admissible for testing of sewer lines. 416 6. INDIAN STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS : All work under this contract shall be carried out in accordance with the technical specification and the latest issue of the Indian Standard Specification applicable to the particular class of work. If Indian Standards are not formulated for any particular materials of work, the relevant British Standard Specification shall apply. Relevant issues of I.S. Specifications applicable to the particular work have been described along with the specification for the respective works. In case of any confusion or dispute regarding the meaning and interpretation of any specification for the respective works the decision of the Project Manager/Architects shall be final and binding on the contractor. 7. EXCAVATION OF TRENCHES (FOR U.G. WATER , SEWER & LINES) : Excavation shall generally form part of the item under the schedule and shall not be paid separately unless otherwise specified in the schedule of quantities. It includes excavation in all kinds of soil including shoring and bailing out water wherever necessary and refilling the excavated trenches in 15 cms. layers properly rammed and watered and neatly dressed at the top. If the excavation is done to dimensions The power shall be mixed with water in the storage tank. If a proprietary greater than those shown on the drawings or as directed by the Project Manager/Architect, the excess depth shall be made good at the own cost of the Contractor. The excavation work should be done in a manner that does not in any way endanger the stability of the adjacent buildings or other structure or services. Where any road pavements or crossings are cut, these shall be restored to their original conditions at no extra cost to the Owner. Moreover, after completion of the work, the Contractor shall have to dress the site including disposal of the surplus earth at his own cost as directed by the Project Manager/Architect. The bed width of the trenches shall be the exact width as shown in the drawings or as specified. In firm soil, the sides of trenches shall be widened by allowing steps of 45 Cm. (1’ - 6”) on either side after every 1.82 M. depth from the bottom so as to give side stops of (1/4” to 1”) 6mm. to 25mm. Where the soil is soft, loose or slushy, the width of steps shall be suitably increased as directed by the Project Manager/Architect. It shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to take complete instructions in writing from Project Manager/Architect regarding the stepping, sloping or shoring to be done for excavation in trenches deeper that 1.82 M. The bed of the trenches shall be made level and firm by watering and ramming. Any soft or defective spots that are found shall be filled \with concrete in the proportion as specified or as may be directed by the Project Manager/Architect. 8.0 INSTALLATION OF SANITARY FIXTURES AND FITTINGS : 8.1 General Requirement The fixtures and fittings shall be provided with all such accessories as are required to complete the item in satisfactory working conditions, whether specifically mentioned or not in the schedule of quantities, specifications and drawings. The sanitary fixtures and fittings shall be installed at the correct assigned position as shown on the 417 drawings and as directed by the Architect, and shall fully meet with the aesthetic and symmetrical requirements as demanded by the Architect. All fixtures and accessories shall be fixed in accordance with a set pattern matching the tile or interior finish as per Architect requirements. Wherever necessary, the fittings shall be centered to dimensions and pattern as called for. Fixtures shall be installed by skilled workman with appropriate tools according to the best trade practice. Manufacturer’s instructions shall be followed for the installation of fixtures. Fixtures in all toilets shall be standard height mounting as called for on the drawings. Fixtures shall be mounted rigid, plumb, and true to alignment. 8.2 Mock up and Trial Assembly The installation of the sanitary fixtures and fittings shall be as per the shop drawings approved by the Architect/Consultant. The contractor shall have to assemble at least one set of each type of sanitary fixtures and fittings in order to determine precisely the required supply and disposal connections. Relevant instructions from manufacturers shall be followed as applicable. This trial assembly shall be developed to determine the location of puncture holes, holding devices etc. which will be required for final installation of all sanitary fixtures and fittings. The above assembly shall be subject to final approval by the Architect. The fixtures in the trial assembly can be re-used for final installation without any additional payments for fixing or dismantling of the fixtures. 8.3 Supporting and Fixing Devices The contractor shall provide all the necessary supporting and fixing devices to install the sanitary fixtures and fittings securely in position. The fixing devices shall be rigidly anchored into the building structure. The devices shall be rust resistant and shall be so fixed that they do not present an unsightly appearance in the final assembly. Where the location demands, the Architect may instruct the contractor to provide chromium plated or other similarly finished fixing devices. In such circumstances the contractor shall arrange to supply the fixing devices and shall be installed complete with appropriate vibration isolating pads, washers and gaskets. 8.4. Final Installation :The contractor shall install all sanitary fixtures and fittings in their final position in accordance with approved trial assemblies and as shown on drawings. The installation shall be complete with all supply and waste connections. The connection between building and piping system and the sanitary fixtures shall be through proper unions and flanges to facilitate removal/replacement of sanitary fixtures without disturbing the build in piping system. All unions and flanges shall match in appearance with other exposed fittings. Fixtures shall be mounted rigid, plumb and to alignment. The outlets of water closet pans and similar appliances shall be examined to ensure that outlet ends are butting on the receiving pipes before making the joints. It shall be ensured that the receiving pipes are clear of obstruction. When fixtures are being mounted, attention shall be paid to the possibility of movement and settlement by other causes. Overflows shall be made to ensure that necessary anchoring devices have been provided for supporting water closets, wash basins, sinks and other appliances. 9. PROTECTION AGAINST DAMAGES : 418 The contractor shall take every precaution to protect all sanitary fixtures against damage, misuse, cracking, staining, breakage and pilferage by providing proper wrapping and locking arrangement till the completion of the installation. At the time of handing over, the contractor shall clean, disinfect and polish all the fixtures and fittings . Any fixtures and fittings found damaged, cracked chipped stained or scratched shall be removed and new fixtures and fittings free from defects shall be installed at his own accosts to complete the work. 10. SOIL,WASTE AND VENT (ANTI-SYPHONAGE) PIPES & FITTINGS : a) H.C.I. Pipes & Fittings : The heavy cast iron pipes and fittings should be of I.S. marked pipes and fittings conforming to I.S. : 1729 or 3989/1970 brand of heavy quality. The pipes shall be free from cracks and other flaws. The interior of pipes and fittings shall be clean and smooth and painted inside and outside with approved brand anti-corrosive paint. b) Cast iron centrifugal cast iron spun pipe fitting as per I.S : 153681537 U.P.V.C Pipes & Fittings : The heavy quality pipes and fittings should conforming to type ‘B’ quality of I.S : 13591 – 92. These pipes must have minimum thickness of 3.2 mm. These pipes shall be free from any floors and smooth and restriction free. c) Fixing : The pipes and fittings shall be fixed to walls by using proper clamps. The pipes shall be fixed perfectly vertical or in a line as directed. All soil pipes shall be carried up above the roof and shall have cowl on top. Where pipes are laid along walls, the pipes are to be fixed 25mm away from the wall surface. Necessary nails and clamps etc. are to be used for this purpose. The access door fittings shall be of proper design so as not to form any cavities in which filth may accumulate. Doors shall be provided with brass bolts for C.I. fittings, doors for U.P.V.C fittings shall be screwed type. Connections between main pipe and the branch pipes shall be made by using branches and bends invariably with access doors for cleaning. d) Jointing : i) C.I. Pipes : The annular space between the sockets and spigot will be first well packed in with spun yarn leaving 35mm from the lip of the socket for lead. The joint may be leaded by using proper leading rings or if they are not available by wrapping a ring of lamp rope covered with clay round the pipe at the end of the socket, leaving a hole through which molten lead shall be poured in (for pipes with sockets facing upwards) 15mm high by making small clay bound to the socket edge may be used. The depth of lead joint or C.I. pipes shall be 40 mm for the pipes upto 100 dia. 419 i) U.P.V.C fittings : Jointing shall be done with special quality rubber ring. e) Testing : Before the appliances are connected all opening of pipes shall be inspected and tested. All opening of pipes bend shall be sealed with plugs and water test in small section of pipes shall be carried out to a static head of 4.5 mtr. All pipes and fittings including joints will be tested by smoke test and left in working order after completion. The smoke test shall be carried out as stated under : Smoke shall be pumped into the drains at the lowest end from smoke machine which consists of blower and burner. The materials usually burnt are greasy cotton waste which form clear pungent smoke which is usually detectable by sight as well as by smell, if leaking occurs at any point of the drain. The contractor will have to rectify all defects traced in such tests at his own expenses to the complete satisfaction of the Project Manager/Architect. The traps and soil fittings should be of heavy cast iron and should have water seal at least (2") 50mm deep. f) Anti-syphonage Pipes : Under otherwise specified, anti-syphonage pipes shall be of U.P.V.C with rubber ring joints. The main anti-syphonage pipes shall be of 50mm dia. internal or as specified and shown in layout. 11. LAYING OF WATER SUPPLY PIPES : a) The high density polythene pipes and fittings shall run in wall chase or ceiling or as specified. The fixing shall be done by means of standard pattern holder bat clamps hooks keeping the pipes about 1.5 cm clear of the wall where to be laid on surface. Where it is specified to conceal the pipes, chasing may be adopted or pipes fixed in the shafts, ducts etc. provided there is a sufficient space to work on the pipes with the usual tools. As far as possible, pipes may be buried for short distances provided adequate protection is given against damage and where so required special care to be taken at joints. Where directed by the Construction Manager/Architect, pipe sleeves shall be fixed at a place the pipe is passing through a wall of floor for reception of the pipe and allow freedom for expansion and contraction and other movements Under the floors the pipes shall be laid in layer of sand filling. H.D polythene pipes shall be jointed with threaded and socket joints, using threaded fittings. Care shall be taken to remove any burr from the end of the pipes after threading.. Compounds containing red lead shall not be used because of the danger of contamination of water. Pipes and joints for water supply shall be tested to a pressure of 7 kg. per sq.cm. b) All cutting holes, chases, trenches etc. at any place necessary in connection with the works and subsequent mending damages are to be included in the rates and not paid extra unless otherwise specified. c) Internal Works : Internal H.D polythene pipes and fittings inside the duct walls shall be fixed by means of 420 standard pattern clamps keeping the pipe 20mm clear of the wall every where or concealed as directed. If pipes and fittings of inside wall is to be fixed concealed, it is to be by chasing floors and walls as directed. Where it is imperative to fix the pipe in front of a house or in any conspicuous position, where it looks ungainly, chasing may be adopted. The clamps shall be fixed closely as per I.S Code. Concealed pipes are to be secured to walls by hooks. The valves should be fitted with a union/long screw. In long length run of a pipe, at least in every (10') 3.05 metres apart there should be a UNION Joint. All pipes and fittings shall be fixed truly vertical and horizontal or as directed by the Project Manager/Architect. For pipes carrying hot water G.I. pipes and fittings are to be used. d) Disinfecting of piping system and storage tank Before commissioning the water supply system, the contractor shall arrange to disinfect the entire system as described in the succeeding paragraph. The water storage tanks and pipes shall first be filled and water and thoroughly flushed out. The storage tanks shall then be filled with water again and disinfecting chemical containing chlorine added gradually while tanks are being filled to ensure thorough mixing. sufficient chemical shall be used to give water a dose of 50 parts of chlorine to one million parts of water. If ordinary bleaching powder is used. The proportions will be 150 gm. Of powder to 1000 liters of water. The power shall be mixed with water in the storage tank. If a proprietary brand of chemical is used, the proportions shall be specified by makers. When the storage tanks is full, the supply shall be stopped and all the taps on the distributing pipes are opened successively working progressively away from the storage tank. Each tap shall be closed when the water discharged begins to smell of chlorine. The storage tank shall then be filled up with water from supply pipe and added with more disinfecting chemical in the recommended proportions. The storage tank and pipe shall then remain charged at least for three hours. Finally the tank and pipes shall be thoroughly flushed out before any water is used for domestic purpose. e) Testing : All pipes and fittings should be tested by hydraulic pressure machine to a pressure of 7 Kg. per sq.cm. to ensure that pipes have proper threads and that proper materials (such as white lead and hamp) have been used in jointing. All leaky joints must be made leak proof by tightening or re-doing at contractor's expenses. 421 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION FOR EXTERNAL SANITARY WORKS 1.a) LAYING OF C.I. WATER SUPPLY MAIN : The trenches for pipes shall be excavated true to lines and levels as directed. The bed of the trench shall have to be truly and evenly dressed all throughout, from one change of grade to the next. The gradient is to be set out by means of boning rods and the required depth be excavated at any point, the trench shall be regarded as directed by the Project Manager/Architects. The depth of the trench shall be not less than 1.5m. measured from the top of the pipe to the surface of the ground under the roads. The width of the trench shall be the nominal diameter of the pipe plus 15” (400 cms) but it shall not be less than 21” (52.5 cms) 3’ - 0” (90 cms) in case of rock. The bed of the trench, if in soft or made up earth shall be well watered and rammed before lying the pipes and the depressions, if any shall be properly filled with earth and consolidated in 9” (22.5 cm) layers. If the rock is met with, it shall be removed to 6” (15 cms) below the bed level of the pipe and the trench will be refilled with excavated materials and consolidated. The excavated materials shall not be placed within 3; - 0” (1 M) or half of the depth of the trench, whichever is greater from the edge of the trench. The materials excavated shall be separate and stacked so that in refilling they may be relaid or compacted in the same order to the satisfaction of the Project Manager/Architects. The trench shall be kept free from water, shoring and timbering shall be provided wherever required. Excavation below water table shall be done after de-watering the trenches. b) Materials (Cast iron pressure pipes & fittings) : i) Centrifugally cast (spun) iron pressure pipes shall conform to I.S : 1536 – 1976 and shall be of class L.A spigot and socket and/or flanged pipes as specified shall be used. The pipes shall withstand the hydrostatic test pressures of 24 Kg/Cm². after installation without showing leakage, sweating or defects of any kind. ii) Cast iron fittings for pressure pipes : Shall conform to I.S : 1538 (Part – I to XXIII) – 1936. The fittings shall withstand hydrostatic test pressures as given below without showing any leakage, sweating or defects of any kind. Test pressure upto 300mm 25 kg/sq.cm. c) Laying of pipes and specials : 422 Before being laid, the pipes shall be examined to see that there are no cracks or defects as described in (1b) above subject to the approval of the Project Manager/Architects, the damaged position of the cracked pipe may be out at a joint not less than 6” (15cm) beyond the visible extremity of the cracks Pipes shall be thoroughly cleaned of all dust and dirt ; special care be taken to clean the inside of the socket and outside of the spigot. The pipes shall be lowered into the trench by means of suitable pully blocks, sheer legs, chains, ropes etc. In no case, the pipes shall be rolled and dropped into the trench. After lowering, the pipes shall be arranged so that the spigot of one pipe shall be carefully centered into the socket of the next pipe, and pushed to full distance that it can go. The pipe line shall be laid to the levels required. Specials shall also be laid in their positions, as stated above. Whereas directed, the pipes and specials may be laid on masonry or concrete pillars. The pipes laid on level ground shall be laid with socket facing the direction of flow of water. Any deviation either in plan or elevation less than 11¼ shall be effected by laying the straight pipes round a flat curve, of such radius that minimum thickness of lead at the face of the socket shall not be reduced below ¼ (6mm) or the opening between spigot and socket increased beyond ½ (12mm) at any joint. A deviation of about 65mm. can be effected at each joint in this way. At the end of each day’s work the 1 st pipe laid shall have its open end securely closed with a wooden plug to prevent entry of water, soil and any other foreign matter into the pipe. Cement concrete thrust blocks of suitable design as approved by the Project Manager/Architects, shall be provided at 45 and 90 bends of the pipes and also at places where there is likeholld of thrust so as to withstand the dynamic and static forces developed due to water in pipe line. The thrust blocks shall be made after the joints have been caulked with lead. d) Lead Caulked Joints :Lead caulked joints with molton lead. This type of lead caulking is generally done in providing joints in gas, water and sewer lines wherever it is practicable to cast lead caulking, but not in case of wet conditions. Quantity of lead. : Weight of lead required for joints for various sizes of C.I. pipes and specials, shall be approximately as under : Dia of pipe. Lead/Jont. 80mm 1.8 kg. 100mm. 2.2 Kg. 150mm. 3.4 Kg. 200mm. 3.4 Kg. After the lead has been run into the joint, the lead shall be thoroughly caulked. Caulking of joints shall be done after a convenient length of the pipe has been laid and loaded. The 423 leading ring shall first be removed and any lead outside the socket shall be removed with a flat chisel and then joint caulked round three times with caulking tools of increasing thickness and hammer of 4 to 6 lbs. (2 to 3 kgs) weight. The joints shall not be covered till the pipe line has been tested under pressure though the rest of the pipeline should be covered to prevent expansion and contraction due to variation in temperature. f) Measurement : The length of pipes shall be measured as laid fixed in running metre excluding specials and pipes at the joints specials which shall be enumerated separately. The length of pipes shall, however, not include the portion of spigot within the sockets of pipes at the joints. 2. SLUICE VALVES /BRASS VALVE : The sluice valves are used in a pipe line for controlling or stopping flow of water. These shall be of specified size and shall be of inside not-raining screw type with either double flange or double socket ends and cap or hand – wheel. These shall in all respects comply with the Indian Standard Specifications I.S : 780 – 1956). For Class - II valves are used for working pressure of 400’ (122mm) head. The body, dome, cover, wedge gate and stuffing box shall be of good quality cast iron, and spindle of bronze, the nut and valve seats of leaded tin bronze. The bodies, spindles and other parts shall be truly machined with surfaces smoothly finished. The area of the water way of fittings shall be not less than the area equal to the nominal bore of the pipe. The valve shall be marked with an arrow to show the direction of turn for closing of the valve. The valve shall be fully examined and cleared of all foreign matter before being fixed. The fixing of the valve shall be done by means of bolts, nuts and 1/8” (3mm.) rubber insertions or chemically treated compressed fibre board 1/16” (1.5mm.) minimum thickness and of weight not less than 6 Oz. Per sq.ft. with the flanges of spigot and the socketed tail pieces drilled to the same specifications. The tail pieces shall conform to I. S : 780 – 1938. These shall be jointed to the pipe line by means of lead caulked joints. 3. LAYING G.I. WATER SUUPLY PIPE & FITTINGS : a) Laying and Fixing : Where pipes have to be cut or rethreaded ends shall be carefully filed out so that no obstruction to bore is offered. In jointing the pipes, the inside of the socket and the screwed end of the pipes shall be rubbed over with white zinc/lead and few turn of hemp yarn wrapped round the screwed end of the pipe which shall then be screwed home to the socket with a pipe wrench. Care must be taken that all pipes and fittings are kept at all times free from dust and dirt during fixing. Any thread exposed after jointing shall be painted. b) All cutting holes, chases, trenches etc. at any place necessary in connection with the works and subsequent mending damages are to be included in the rates and not paid extra unless otherwise specified. 424 c) Internal Works : Internal G.I. pipes and fittings inside the duct walls shall be fixed by means of standard pattern holder bat clamps keeping the pipe 20mm clear of the wall every where or concealed as directed. If G.I. pipes and fittings of inside wall is to be fixed concealed, it is to be by chasing floors and walls as directed. Where it is imperative to fix the pipe in front of a house or in any conspicuous position, where it looks ungainly, chasing may be adopted. The holder bat clamps shall be fixed at a distance not exceeding (10') 3.05 metre apart. Concealed pipes are to be secured to inside of the walls by hooks. The valves should be fitted with a union/long screw. In long length run of a pipe, at least in every (10') 3.05 metre apart there should be a UNION Joint. All pipes and fittings shall be fixed truly vertical and horizontal or as directed by the Project Manager/Architect. For pipes carrying hot water (if required) the pipes should be insulated. The thickness of the insulating materials shall be 12mm in the case of glass in fibreform, compressed felt end felted slag or mineral wool and 20mm in the case of asbestos. Cost of the same shall be included in the rate. d) External Work : For external U.G. work, G.I. pipes and fittings shall be laid in trenches. The width of the trench shall be of a minimum width of 450mm required for the work. The pipes laid underground shall not be less than (2') 60 cm. from the ground level. They shall be surrounded on all sides by sand of approved quality. The work of excavation and refilling shall be done in accordance with the general specification for earth work. e) Painting : All internal G.I. pipes and fittings shall be painted with paints of approved quality, manufacturer, colour and shade. The cost of such painting shall be included in the contractor's rate. All pipes and fittings in external underground work shall be painted with two coats of anti-corrosive paint. Unless otherwise specified all concealed pipes and fittings shall be painted with two coats of anti-corrosive paint. f) Testing : All G.I. pipes and fittings should be tested by hydraulic pressure machine to a pressure of 7 Kg. per sq.cm. to ensure that pipes have proper threads and that proper materials (such as white lead and hemp) have been used in jointing. All leaky joints must be made leak proof by tightening or re-doing at contractor's expenses. 04. LAYING OF CPVC PIPE : a) All flushing water supply pipe and fittings shall be chlorinated polyvinyle, chloride (C.P.V.C) having thermal stability. b) C.P.V.C pipe & fittings shall conform to relevant Indian Standard. (Shown in description of item). 425 05. c) Jointing shall be with C.P.V.C solvent cement and brass threaded fittings with jute and cement putty. d) Clamp spacing shall be of 1.0M apart. SANITARY INSTALLATION : a) INDIAN TYPE W.C. PAN : The W.C. Pan shall be of white vitreous china clay of specific size and pattern wash down type unless otherwise specified. It shall have back flush inlet. The pan shall be of approved quality and shall bear the mark of the firm manufacturing it and shall be of best quality. The pan shall be provided with a 100mm ‘P’ or ‘S’ trap as specified in the item with an approximately 50mnm seal. b) FIXING : The W.C. Pan shall be sunk or raised in floor sloped towards the pan in a workman like manner, care being taken not to damage the pan in the process of fixing. If damaged in any, it shall be replaced by the Contractor at his own cost. It shall be fixed in a proper cement concrete concrete base of 1:3:6 (with a wire netting where required) proportion, taking care that the cushion is uniform and even, without having any hollows between the concrete base and pan. The joint between the pan and the trap shall be made with cement sand mortar 1 : 1 and shall be leak proof. 06. EUROPEAN TYPE W.C. : a) EUROPEAN TYPE/ANGLO INDIAN TYPE CASCADE W.C. : Can be readily flushed, of wash down type, shall bear the mark of an approved firm and shall be of best quality. The closet shall be of vitreous china clay having integrals, trap ‘P’ or ‘S’ with or without vent hole right or left as directed. b) SEAT : The seat with lid shall be of plastic or as specified with rubber buffers and shall be fixed in position by using chromium plated(C.P.) brass hinges and screws. 07. FLUSHING CISTERN : a) Unless otherwise specified, low level type flushing cistern shall be of or white vitreous china /PVC of approved make, 10 litres capacity cistern with internal fittings, brackets and C.P. flush pipe/PVC flush pipe 40 mm dia. or as specified, brass C.P. handle etc. The low level type flushing cistern shall be connected with the E.P.W.C. / W.C. pan by means of 40mm dia. C.P. flush bend/PVC bend and rubber packing. The inlet pipes shall be of either white P.V.C. connector or brass C.P. connector or as specified. 426 b) Unless otherwise specified, low level type flushing cistern shall be of white glazed or white vitreous china of approved make 12.5 litres (3 gallons) capacity cistern with internal fittings, brackets and C.P. flush pipe 40mm. dia. or as specified, brass C.P. handle etc. The low level type flushing cistern shall be connected with the W.C. pan by means of 40mm. dia. C.P. flush bend and rubber packing. The inlet pipes shall be of either white P.V.C. connector or brass C.P. connector or as specified. c) BRACKETS : The cistern shall be fixed on cast iron or rolled steel white painted brackets, which shall be firmly embedded in the wall or fixed by using lugs and screws, Phil plug, rawl plug to the satisfaction of the Architect/Project Manager. d) OVERFLOW : The cistern shall be provided with 15mm polythene overflow pipe with fittings which shall terminate into mosquito proof coupling of the approved design with 3.05mm. dia. perforations. The cistern shall be provided with 15mm polythene overflow pipe with fittings which shall terminate into mosquito proof coupling of the approved design with 3.05mm. dia. perforations. e) FLUSH PIPE : The outlet or flush pipe from the cistern shall be of 32mm. dia. G.i. medium quality pipe or polythene pipe or as specified. The flush pipe shall be 7 ft. high approx, which shall be connected to the W.C. pan by means of an approved type of joint. The flush pipe shall be fixed to wall by using holder bat clamps or embedded as required. If the connection between the cistern and the W.C. pan is made with G.I. pipe the bends and offsets shall be made cold. f) PAINTING : Inside of cistern and fittings shall be painted with approved bituminous paint and outside of the cistern, brackets, overflow and flush flush pipe etc. shall be painted with a primary coat of red oxide and finishing two or more coats of white zinc or any other colour and shade to match with the painting of the surrounding walls. The coat of such painting shall be included in the rate quoted for the flushing cistern. 08. LAVATORY BASIN : a) LAVATORY BASIN : The basin shall be of white vitreous china of approved make. The size of the basin shall be as specified. The basins shall be of approved quality and make. b) FITTINGS : Each lavatory basin shall be provided with pillar tap as specified, having a three tap holes /Centre tap hole with C.P. protruded nose pillar cock heavy type mixer. This must be included with 32mm dia. C.P. brass waste, C.P. chain, and rubber plug 427 etc. complete in all respect and of approved quality. c) FIXING : The basin shall be supported on a pair of C.I. concealed type brackets embedded or fixed in position by means of wooden cleats and screws as required. Alternatively this should be supported on pedestal type brackets as specified. These brackets as specified. These brackets shall be painted to the required shade. d) 09. The waste pipe shall discharge into the floor trap inlet or as specified. LABOTORY BASIN : a) SINKS : Unless otherwise specified the sink shall be of stainless steel with overflow or sink shall be Mosaic silvered grey colour. The size of sink shall be as specified. The sink shall be of approved quality. b) FITTINGS : Each sink shall be provided with 32mm dia. C.P. brass waste, with C.P. brass chain and rubber plug. The fittings shall be of approved quality. c) FIXING : The sink shall be supported on a pair of C.I. cantilever brackets, embedded or fixed in position by means of wooden cleats and screws as required. The brackets shall be painted with approved shade and colour to match with the existing finish. d) 10. The waste pipe shall discharge into floor trap inlet or as specified. TOILET REQUISITES : a) MIRROR : The mirror shall be of approved make glass with beveled edge as specified. The size and shape of the mirror shall be as specified. It shall be mounted on the asbestos/masonite sheet and shall be fixed in position by means of 4 C.P. brass domical screws and washers complete. b) WATER CONNECTION : Water connection to flushing cistern, lavatory basins shall be by means of white P.V.C. 428 connector or C.P. connector with stop cock/ angular stop cock. The size of C.P. connector and stop cock shall depend upon the size of water pipe connection and shall be as specified. c) SHELF : Unless otherwise specified the glass shelf shall be of approved quality with edges rounded off. The glass shelf shall have C.P. brass anodised aluminium guard rail with C.P. on brass/anodised aluminium brackets. The brackets shall be fixed to the wall with C.P. brass screws to wooden plug firmly embedded in the wall. d) TOWEL RAIL : The towel rail shall be of C.P. on brass with two nos. C.P. on brass brackets or as specified. The size of the rail shall be as specified. The brackets shall be fixed by means of C.P. brass screws to Rawl Plug firmly embedded in wall. This should be projected 75mm from the wall. e) PAPER HOLDER : The paper holder shall be of C.P. on brass / white glazed earthen ware. It shall be fixed in position by means of C.P. brass screws. 11. BRASS WATER FITTINGS : All water fittings shall be of standard manufacture and shall in all respect comply with the Indian Standard Specifications. The brass fittings shall be fixed in pipe line in a workman like manner. Care must be taken to see that joints between fittings are made leak proof. The fittings and joints shall be tested to a hydraulic pressure of 21 Kg. per Sq.cm. unless otherwise specified. The defective fittings and the joints shall be replaced at the Contractors expense. a) BIB COCK : The bib cock shall be of specified quality, opening full way, of screw down pattern and of the size as specified. The tested pressure shall be 21 kgs/ Cm.Sq. b) STOP COCK : The stop cock shall be of specified quality, opening full way, of screw down pattern and of the size as specified. c) FULL-WAY VALVE : The full way valve shall be of gunmetal, fitted with wheel and shall be gate valve type, opening full way, of the size as specified. d) BALL VALVE : The ball valve shall be of approved quality and manufactured in brass with copper ball 429 float/polythene float and shall operate freely and efficiently in water. e) SHOWER ROSE : The shower rose shall be of specified quality with flat bottom of specified diameter with uniform perforation. The inlet size shall be (3/4” or 1/2”) 20 MM. or 15 MM. as specified. A stop cock of the requisite size shall be provided to control the inlet water supply to the shower rose. 430 LIST OF APPROVED MAKES OF PLUMBING WORKS 1. VITREOUS CHINA SANITARY WARE. : ‘PARRYWRE’ /JAQUAR. 2. C.P. BRASS FITTING. : JAQUAR OR ESS BRAND OR SIMILAR APPROVED MAKE. 3. CAST IRON SOIL, WASTE & ANTI-SYPHONAGE PIPES & FITTING. : BIC OR SILIMAR APPORVED CALCUTA CONFORMING TO (I.S : 1729 ) C.I. I.S : 3989 OF APPROVED MAKE.(HEPCO/NICO). 4. CAST IRON CENTRIFUGAL CAST SPUN PIPES AND FITTINGS. FOR SOIL, WASTE LINE. : KESORAM/ELECTRO STEEL,OR SIMILAR CAL CONFORMING TO I.S : 1536 & 1537. 5. G.I. MILD STEEL PIPES. : TATA - MEDIUM QUALITY/SIMILAR APPROVED QUALITY CONFORMING TO I.S : 1239. 6. G.I. PIPES FITTINGS. : ‘R’ BRAND. 7. U.P.V.C/PIPES & FITTINGS FOR WASTE WATER AND RAIN WATER. : KISAN / OR SIMILAR APPROVED CONFORMING TO I.S : 13591 & 13592 1992 8. STONEWARE PIPES, GULLY TRAP ETC. : PERFECT POTTERIES, JOBBALPUR/ OR EQUIVALENT ‘ISI’ MARKED. 9. G.M. VALVES AND COCK. : LEADER/ZOLOTO. 10. PRESSURE REDUCING VALVE. : LEADER/ZOLOTO. 11 PAINTS. : ASIAN/SHALIMAR. 12. SUBMERSIBLE SUMP PUMP FOR BASEMENT. : KSB/KIROLOSKAR/PHU GA 13. CAST IRON MANHOLE COVER. : ‘KAPOOR’ OR SIMILAR APPROVED BRAND CONFURMING TO I.S : 1726. 14. HIGH DENSITY POLYTHENE PIPES FOR WATER DISTRIBUTION LINE. UNDER CONSIDERATION. : FINOLEX/SUPREME/AVSL CONFORMING TO I.S : 4984 - 1978 15. C.P.V.C. PIPE : ASTROL / ASHIRBAD. 431 SECTION : 6 SECURITIES AND OTHER FORMS 432 BID SECURITY (BANK GUARANTEE) WHEREAS, _____________________________[name of Bidder] (hereinafter called “the Bidder”)has submitted his bid dated ______________________________________[date] for construction of _______________________________________[name of Contract hereinafter called “the Bid”]. KNOW ALL PEOPLE by these presents that We _______________________________________ [name of Bank] of ________________________________________ [name of country] having our registered office at ______________________________________________[hereinafter called “the Bank”) are bound unto __________________________________ [name of Employer] (herein after Called “the Employer”) in the sum of _________________________________* for which payment Well and truly to be said Employer the Bank itself, his successors and assigns by these presents. SEALED with the Common Seal of the said Bank this ____________ day of _________ 20 _____ THE CONDITIONS of this obligation are: (1)If after Bid opening the Bidder withdraws his Bid during the period of Bid validity specified in the Form of Bid. OR (2)If the Bidder having been notified to the acceptance of his bid by the Employer during the period of Bid validity. (a)Fails or refuses to execute the Form of Agreement in accordance with the Instructions to Bidders, if required; or (b)Fails or refuses to furnish the Performance Security, in accordance with the Instructions to Bidders; or (c)Does not accept the correction of the Bid price pursuit to Clause 27. We undertake to pay to the Employer up to the above amount upon receipt of his first written demand, without the Employer having to substantiate his demand, provided that in his demand the Employer will note that the amount claimed by him is due to him owing to the occurrence of one or any of the three conditions, specifying the occurred condition or conditions. This Guarantee will remain in force up to and including the date ____________________** days after the deadline for submission of Bids as such deadline is started in the Instructions to Bidder or as it may be extended by the Employer, notice of which extension (s) to the bank is hereby waived. Any demand in respect of this guarantee should reach the Bank not later than above date. DATE _________________SIGNATURE ________________________________ WITNESS ___________________________SEAL ________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________ [Signature, name and address] *The Bidder should insert the amount of the guarantee in words and figures denominated in Indian Rupees. This figure should be the same as shown in Clause 16.1 of the Instructions to Bidders. 433 **45 days after the end of the validity period of the Bid. Date should be inserted by the employer before the Bidding documents are issued. 434 PERFORMANCE BANK GUARANTEE To EXECUTIVE ENGINEER, PWD (BLDG.), ASSAM PCC DIVISION, DISPUR, GUWAHATI-6 WHEREAS _________________________________________ [ name and address of Contractor] (hereinafter called “the Contractor”) has undertaken, in pursuance of Contract No. ____________ dated _____________ to execute ______________________________ [name of Contract and brief description of works] (hereinafter called “the Contract”). AND WHEREAS it has been stipulated by you in the said Contract that the Contractor shall furnish you with a Bank Guarantee by a recognized bank for the sum specified therein as security for compliance with his obligation in accordance with the Contract; AND WHEREAS we have agreed to give the Contractor such a Bank Guarantee: NOW THEREFORE we hereby affirm that we are the Guarantor and responsible to you on behalf of the Contractor, up to a total of ______________________________________ [amount of guarantee]* _____________________________ (in words), such sum being payable in the types and proportions of currencies in which the Contract price is payable, and we undertake to pay you, upon your first written demand and without cavil or argument, any sum or sums within the limits of _________________________ amount of guarantee] as aforesaid without your needing to prove or to show grounds or reasons for your demand for the sum specified therein. We hereby waive the necessary of your demanding the said debt from the contractor before presenting us with the demand. We further agree that no change or addition to or other modification of the terms of the Contract or of the works to be performed there under or of any of the Contract documents which may be made between your hand and the Contractor shall in any way release us from any liability under this guarantee, and we hereby waive notice of any such change, addition or modification. This guarantee shall be valid until 28 days from the date of expiry of the Defect Liability Period. Signature and Seal of the guarantor ___________________ Name of Bank ___________________________________ Address ________________________________________ Date _________________ ________________________________________________________________________________ *An amount shall be inserted by the Guarantor, representing the percentage of Contract Price specified in the Contract including additional security for unbalanced Bids, if any and denominated in Indian Rupees. 435 BANK GUARANTEE FOR ADVANCE PAYMENT To EXECUTIVE ENGINEER, PWD (BLDG.), ASSAM PCC DIVISION, DISPUR, GUWAHATI-6 ____________________________________ (Name of Contractor) Gentlemen: In accordance with the provisions of the Conditions of Contract, sub-clause 51.1(“Advance Payment”) of the above mentioned Contract, _________________________________________________________________________________ [Name and address of the Contractor] (hereinafter called “the Contractor”) shall deposit with _____________________________________________ (Name of Employer) a bank guarantee to guarantee his proper and faithful performance under the said Clause of the Contract in an amount of ______________________________________________________[amount of guarantee]* _________________________________ [in words]. We, the ______________________________[bank or financial institution], as instructed by the Contractor, agree unconditionally and irrevocably to guarantee as primary obligator and not surety merely, the payment to_____________________________ (Name of the Employer) on his first demand without whatsoever right of obligation on our part and without his first claim to the Contractor, in the amount not exceeding ________________________[amount of guarantee]* ___________________________________[in words]. We further agree that no change or addition to or other modification of the terms of the Contract of works to be performed there under or of any of the Contract documents which may be made between______________________________________[Name of the Employer] and the Contractor, shall in any way release us from any liability under this guarantee, and we hereby waive notice of any such change, addition or modification. This guarantee shall remain valid and full effect from the date of the advance payment under the Contract until _______________________________________[name of the Employer] receives full repayment of the same amount from the Contractor. Yours truly, Signature and Seal ________________________________ Name of Bank /Financial Institution___________________ Address ________________________________________ Date _________________ *The Bank or Financial Institution, representing the amount of the Advance Payment, and denominated in Indian Rupees, shall insert an amount. 436 INDENTURE FOR SECURED ADVANCES FORM 31 (For use in cases in which the contract is for finished work and the contractor has entered into an agreement for the execution of a certain specified quantity of work in a given time) This indenture made the ___________________ day of ___________________________20 ______ BETWEEN ___________________________________(hereinafter called the Contractor which expression shall where the context so admits or implies be deemed to include his executors, administrator and assigns) or the one part and the Employer of the other part. Whereas by an agreement dated ___________________________ (hereinafter called the said agreement) the contractor has agreed. AND WHEREAS the contractor has applied to the Employer that he may be allowed advanced on the security of materials absolutely belonging to him and brought by him to the site of the works the subject of the said agreement for use in the construction of such of the works as he has undertaken to executive at rates fixed for the finished work (inclusive of the cost of materials and labour and other charges). AND WHEREAS the Employer has agreed to advance to the Contractor the sum of Rupees ____________________________________________________________ on the security of materials the quantities and other particulars of which are detailed in Accounts of Secured advances attached to the Running Account Bill for the said works signed by the Contractor on ________________ and the Employer has reserved to himself the option of making any further advance or advances on the security of other materials brought by the Contractor to the site of the said works. Now THIS INDENTURE WITNESSETH that in pursuance of the said agreement and in consideration of the sum of Rupees ___________________________ on or before the execution of these presents paid to the Contractor by the Employer (the receipt where of the Contractor doth hereby acknowledge) and of such further advances (if any) as may be made to him as a for said Contractor doth hereby covenant and agree with the President and declare as follows: (1)That the said sum of Rupees __________________________________ so advanced by the Employer to the Contractor as aforesaid and all or any further sum of sums advanced as aforesaid shall be employed by the Contractor in or towards expending the execution of the said works and for no other purpose whatsoever. (2)That the materials details in the said Account of Secured Advances which have been offered to and accepted by the Employer as security are absolutely the Contractor’s own property and free from encumbrances of any kind and the contractor will not make any application for or receive a further advance on the security of materials which are not absolutely his own property and free from encumbrances of any kind and the Contractor indemnified the Employer against all claims to any materials in respect of which an advance has be made to him as aforesaid. (3)That the materials detailed in the said account of Secured Advances and all other materials on the security of which any further advance or advances may hereafter be made as aforesaid (hereafter called the said materials) shall be used by the Contractor solely in the execution of the said works in accordance with the directions of the Engineer. 4)That the contractor shall make at his own cost all necessary and adequate arrangements for the proper watch, safe custody and protection against all risks of the said materials and that until used in construction as aforesaid the said materials shall remain at the site of the said works in the Contractor’s custody and on his own responsibility and shall at all times be open to inspection by the Engineer or any officer authorized by him. In the event of the said materials or any part thereof being 437 stolen, destroyed or damaged or becoming deteriorated in a greater degree than is due to reasonable use and wear thereof the Contractor will forthwith replace the same with other materials of like quality or repair and make good the same required by the Engineer. (5)That the said materials shall not be any account be removed from the site of the said works except with the written permission of the Engineer or an officer authorized by him on that behalf. (6)That the advances shall be repayable in full when or before the Contractor receives payment from the Employer of the price payable to him for the said works under the terms and provisions of the said agreement. Provided that if any intermediate payments are made to the Contractor on account of work done than on the occasion of each such payment the Employer will be at liberty to make a recovery from the Contractor’s Bill for such payment by deducting there from the value of the said materials than actually used in the construction and in respect of which recovery has not been made previously, the value for this purpose being determined in respect of each description of materials at the rates at which the amounts of the advances made under these presents were calculated. (7)That if the Contractor shall at any time make any default in the performance or observance in any respect of any of the terms and provisions of the said agreement or of these presents the total amount of the advance or advances that may still be owing of the Employer shall immediately on the happening of such default be repayable by the Contractor to be the Employer together with interest thereon at twelve percent per annum from the date or respective dates of such advance or advances to the date of repayment and with all costs, charge, damages and expenses incurred by the Employer in or for the recovery thereof or the enforcement of this security or otherwise by reason of the default of the Contractor and the Contractor hereby covenants and agrees with the Employer to reply and pay the same respectively to him accordingly. (8)That the contractor hereby charges all the said materials with the repayment to the Employer of the said sum of Rupees ____________________________________ and any further sum of sums advanced as aforesaid and all costs, charges, damages and expenses payable under these presents PROVIDED ALWAYS and it is hereby agreed and declared that not withstanding anything in the said agreement and without prejudice to the power contained therein and whenever the covenant for payment and repayment herein before contained shall become enforceable and the money owing shall not be paid in accordance there with the Employer may at any time thereafter adopt all or any of the following courses as he may deem best: (a)Seize and utilize the said materials or any part thereof in the completion of the said works on behalf of the contractor in accordance with the provisions in that behalf contained in the said agreement debiting the contractor with the actual cost of effecting such completion and the amount due to the contractor with the value of work done as if he has carried it out in accordance with the said agreement and at the rates thereby provided. If the balance is against the contractor, he is to pay same to the Employer on demand. (b)Remove and sell by public auction the seized materials or any part thereof and out of the moneys arising from the sale retain all the sums aforesaid repayable or payable to the Employer under these presents and pay over the surplus (if any) to the Contractor. (c)Deduct all or any part of the moneys owing out of the security deposit or any sum due to the Contractor under the said agreement. (9)That except in the event of such default on the part of the contractor as aforesaid interest on the said advance shall not be payable. (10)That in the event of any conflict between the provisions of these presents and the said agreement the provisions of these presents shall prevail and in the event of any dispute or difference arising over the construction or effect of these presents the settlement of which has not been here-in-before 438 expressly provided for the same shall be referred to the Employer whose decision shall be final and the provision of the Indian Arbitration Act for the time being in force shall apply to any such reference. 439 GOVERNMENT OF ASSAM OFFICE OF THE CHIEF ENGINEER : PWD, BUILDING, ASSAM, GUWAHATI No Dated Guwahati the 2015 LETTER OF ACCEPTANCE To _________________________________(Name and address of the Contractor) __________________________________ __________________________________ Sub: Dear Sirs, This is to notify you that your offer dated ___________________________for execution of the ________________________ (name of the contract and identification number, as given in the Instructions to Bidders) for the Contract Price of Rupees __________________ (__________ ___________________________) (amount in words and figures), as a corrected and modified in accordance with the Instructions to Bidders is hereby accepted by the department of P.W.D. We accept / do not accept that _______________________ be appointed as the Adjudicator. You are hereby requested to furnish performance Security, in the form detailed in Para 34.1 of ITB for an amount equivalent to Rs._________________ within 21 days of the receipt of this letter of acceptance valid upto 28 days from the date of expiry of Defects Liability Period i.e. upto ___________ and sign the contract, failing which action as stated in Para 34.2 of ITB will be taken. Yours faithfully, Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.), Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati - 3 440 Issue of Notice to proceed with the works ________________________(date) To _________________________________(Name and address of the Contractor) __________________________________ __________________________________ Dear Sirs, Pursuant to your furnishing the requisite as stipulated in ITB Clause 34.1 and signing of the construction of ______________________________________________________________ __________________________________________ at a bid of Rs.____________________ You are hereby instructed to proceed with the execution of the said works in accordance with the contract documents. Yours faithfully, ( Signature, name and title of signatory Authorized to sign on behalf of Employer ) 441 Agreement Form Agreement No…………………………………………………………………………………………. This agreement made this…………………….... day of…………………………….between Chief Engineer, PWD (Bldg.),Assam,Chandmari, Guwahati-3 (hereinafter called “the Employer”) and ………………………………………………………………… ( name and address of contractor ) hereinafter called “the contractor” of the other part. Whereas the Employer is desirous that the Contractor execute………………………………….. …………………………………………………………………….. (names and identification number of Contract) (hereinafter called “the works”) and the Employer has accepted the Bid by the Contractor for the execution and completion of such works and the remedying of any defects therein, at a cost of Rs……………………………………… NOW THIS AGREEMENT WITHNESSETH as follows : In this Agreement, words and expression shall have the same meanings as are respectively assigned to them in the conditions hereinafter referred to any they shall be deemed to form and be read and construed as part of this Agreement. In consideration of the payments to be made by the Employer to the contractor as hereinafter mentioned, the Contractor hereby covenants with the Employer to execute and complete the works and remedy any defects therein in conformity in all aspects with the provision of the contract. The Employer hereby covenants to pay the contractor in consideration of the execution and completion of the Works and the remedying the defects wherein Contract Price or such other sum as may become payable under the provisions of the contract at the times and in the manner prescribed by the Contract. The following documents shall be deemed to form and be ready and construed as part of this Agreement viz. i.Letter of Acceptance; ii. Notice to proceed with the works; iii. Contractor’s Bid iv. Condition of Contract : General and Special v. Contract Data vi. Additional condition vii. Drawings viii. Bill of Quantities and ix. Any other documents listed in the contract data as forming part of the contract. 442 Time of completion: 9 (nine) Months In witnessed whereof the parties there to have caused this Agreement to be executed the day and year first before written. The common seal of ……………………………………………………….............................. was hereunto affixed in the presence of : Signed, Sealed and delivered by the said …………….……………………… …………. ……… … ………………………………………………..……………………………………………………. in the presence of : Binding Signature of Employer …………………………………………………. Binding Signature of Contractor……………………………………………………. 443 UNDERTAKING I, the undersigned do hereby undertake that our firm M/s……………………………………….. ………………… …………. agree to abide by this bid for a period …………….………………… ……………………………………………… days for the date fixed for receiving the same and it shall be binding on us and may be accepted at any time before the expiration of that period. _________________________________________ ( Signed by an Authorised Officer of the firm ) Title of Officer Name of Firm 444 SAMPLE FORMAT FOR EVIDENCE OF ACCESS TO OR AVAILABILITY OF CREDIT FACILITIES ( CLAUSE 4.3 OF ITB ) BANK CERTIFICATE This is to certify that M/s. ………………………………………………………….…………… is a reputed company with good financial standing. If the contract for the work, namely construction …………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………………………….. is awarded to above firm, we shall be able to provide overdraft/credit facilities to the cost of Rs…………………………………………………… (Rupees ……………………………………… to meet the working capital requirements for executing the above during the contract period. ------------------------------------------------- ( Signature ) Name of the Bank ……………………………………….. Senior Bank Manager Address of the Bank 445 AFFIDAVIT 1. I, the undersigned, do hereby certify that all the statements made in the required attachments are true and correct. 2. The undersigned also hereby certifies that neither our firm M/s………………… ………………………………. have abandoned any worked by CPWD/ State PWD in India nor awarded to us for such works have been rescinded, during the last five years prior to the date of this bid. 3. The undersigned hereby authorize (s) and requested any Bank, person, firm or corporation to furnish pertinent information deemed necessary and requested by the Department to verify this statement or regarding my (our) competence and general reputation. 4. The undersigned understand and agrees that further qualifying information may be requested and agrees to furnish any such information at the request of the Department / Project implementing agency. ____________________________________ (Signed by an Authorised Officer of the Firm) __________________________ Title of Officer ____________________________________ (Signed by an Authorised Officer of the Firm) _________________________ Title of Officer _________________________ Name of Firm ________________________ Date 446 UNDERTAKING I, the undersigned do hereby undertake that our firm M/s……………………………………….. ………………… …………. would invest a minimum cash upto 25% of the value of the work during implementation of contract. _________________________________________ ( Signed by an Authorised Officer of the firm ) Title of Officer Name of Firm Date 447 AUTHORITY Chief Engineer PWD (Bldg) Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati-3 is hereby authorized to seek reference from my Banker, as and when required. Name & Address of Banker With Contact No./ Fax No. Date: Place: Signature of Bidder Name (Capital Block letters): Address: 448 UNDERTAKING FOR BID VALIDITY Bid for the work: An undertaking is hereby given that the bid submitted by me/us shall remain valid for a period not less than 180 days after the deadline date for submission specified in clause 20. Date: Place: Signature of Bidder Name (Capital Block letters): Address: 449 SECTION 7 FORM OF BID 450 FORM OF BID Description of the Works To The Chief Engineer, PWD (Building), Assam, Chandmari, Guwahati – 3. We offer to Execute the Works describe above and remedy any defects therein in conformity with the conditions of Contract, specifications, drawings, Bill of Quantities and Addenda for the sums(s) of Rs…………………………….(Rupees ………………………………………………….) We undertake, if our Bid is accepted, to commence the Works as soon as is reasonably possible after the receipt of the Engineer’s notice to commence, and to complete the whole of the works comprised in the contract within the time stated in the document. We agree to abide by the Bid for the period of 180 days from the date fixed for receiving the same, and it shall remain binding upon us and may be accepted at any time before the expiration of that period. Unless and until a formal agreement is prepared and executed this Bid, together with your written acceptance thereof, shall constitute a binding contract between us. We understand that you are not bound to accept the lowest or any bid you may receive. We accept the appointment of _________________________________________________ as the Dispute Review Expert. (OR) We do not accept the appointment of _____________________________________________ _______________________ Review Expert and propose instead that Shri_______________ _____________________appointed as Dispute Review Expert, whose BIO-DATA is attached. Dated this ______________ day of _____________________/2010. Signature ______________________________in the capacity of ___________________duly Authorized to sign bids for and on behalf of ____________________________(in block capitals or typed) ______________________________________________________ Address ______________________________________________ Witness ______________________________________________ Address ______________________________________________ _____________________________________Occupation. 451 SECTION : 8 BILL OF QUANTITIES 452 SECTION : 9 DRAWINGS 453 The drawings may be seen/ collected from the office of the Executive Engineer, PWD (Building), PCC Division, Dispur, Guwahati-6 Assam in due course. 454 SECTION : 10 DOCUMENTS TO BE FURNISHED BY THE BIDDER 455 DOCUMENTS COMPRISING THE BID The Bid to be submitted by the Bidder as Volume-IV of the BID DOCUMENTS refer Clause 8 of the ITB shall be in 2 (Two) parts comprising the followings : PART – I shall be names as “TECHNICAL BID “and shall comprise: Bid Security in form specified in SECTION – 6 Qualification information and supporting documents as specified in SECTION – 2 Certificates, Undertakings, Affidavits as specified in SECTION-6 & 2 Any other information pursuant to Clause 4 of the ITB Undertakings that the Bid shall remain valid for the period specified in Clause 15.1 of ITB PART – II shall be named “FINANCIAL BID “and shall comprise. Form of Bid as specified in SECTION – 7 Priced Bill of Quantities for Items specified in SECTION – 8. Part – I will be separately sealed and marked in accordance with the sealing and marking Instructions in Clause 19 and signed at very pages by the Bidder or authorized signatory. Part – II shall be submitted online.
© Copyright 2024